: ' BOUGHT WITH THE INCOME , FROM THE SAGE ENDOWMENT FUND THE GIFT OF H^nrg W. Sage .4/.^^^£.t '^/Z^... "TmniiiiiiSi'iiiil'' "fl*" ■rtlllery. olln 3 1924 030 759 280 B Cornell University B Library The original of tliis book is in tine Cornell University Library. There are no known copyright restrictions in the United States on the use of the text. http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924030759280 HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. BT A. B. gYEE, First Lieutenant, Ftmrth Artillery, U. S. A. FIRST EDITION. FIRBT THOUSAND.. NEW YORK : JOHN WILEY & SONS. London CHAPMAN & HALL, Limited. ■■ 1896. Copyriglit, 1896, BY A. B. DYEE. ROBERT DKUMMONB, ELECTROTYPKR AND PRINTER, NEW YORK. PREFACE. In preparing this work it has been my endeavor to place in compact form all the data I could obtain that might prove of service to those persons interested in the subject of light artillery, both in the Eegular Army and in the National Guard. I have held strictly to the lines laid down in Army Kegulations, Drill Kegulations, Official Eeports, etc., as regards the matter extracted from such sources; and such as has not been so obtained has been carefully selected from the best authorities I have been able to consult. I make no claim to originality in this work. It is drawn on the lines of similar handbooks in foreign services; and a great deal of the matter has been copied verbatim from the works consulted. To the writers and compilers of those works I hereby express my thanks. While I do not consider that machine-guns are proper weapons lor the light artillerist, I feel that occasions may arise when knowledge regarding them may prove of service; hence the chapter pertaining to them. I express, with pleasure, my thanks to Lieut.-Colonel B. B. Williston, 3d U. S Artillery, for his assistance. I, am particularly obliged to Captain L. L. Bruff, iv PREFAGS. Ordnance Department, for having permitted me to copy from the manuscript of his work on Ordnance and Gunnery (now being published), and also for the use of many of his cuts. His friendly consideration in so doing is fully appreciated. I also express my appreciation of the assistance given me by Colonel A, E. Bufflngton, Ordnance Department; Captain V. McNally, Ordnance Department; Captain J. L. Lusk, Corps of Engineers; Captain James Parker, 4th Cavalry; Captain L. A. Craig, 6th Cavalry; Captain S.W., Taylor, 4th Artillery; Lieut. E. B. Babbitt, Ord- nance Department; Lieut. M. M. Patrick, Corps of Engi- neers; Lieut. B. Kusse], 5th Artillery; Mr. J. E. Trautwine, Jr.; Mr. Charles W. Parker; and Mr. L. V. Benet of the Hotchkiss Ordnance Company, The following is a partial list of the works consulted : U. S. Army Eegulations; U. S. Drill Regulations for Light Artillery; U. S. Drill Regulations for Cavalry; 17. S. Drill Eegulations for Hospital Corps; Soldier's Handbook, TJ. S. A.; Reports of the Chief of Ordnance, U. S. A.; Ordnance Notes; Manual of Heavy Artillery Service, United States Army, Tidball; Manual of Guard Duty; Ordnance and Gunnery, Metcalfe; Gunnery for Non-com- missioned Officers, Cronkhite; Description and Service of Machine-guns, Mills; Lectures on Explosives, Walke; Modern Explosives, Eissler; Interior and Exterior Bal- listics, Ingalls; Preliminary Tactics, Baker; Handbook for Field-artillery, R. A. Service Institution; The Soldier's Pocketbook, Wolseley; Manual of Military Engineering; Aide-m§moire de Campagne; Aide-m6moire, R. E.; Ar- tillerist's Manual and Soldier's Compendium; the hand- books of Trautwine, Haswell, and Kidder; The Future PREFACE. V Traiuing and Employment of Mounted Infantry, Parr; The Soldiers' First Aid Handbook, Dietz; Nystrom's Mechanics; Horses and Stables, Fitzwygram; The Vet- erinarian's Vade Mecum, Gamgee; The Book of the Horse, Sydney; The Mule, Eeilly; Special Eeport on the Diseases of the Horse, U. S. Department of Agriculture; the pam- phlets of Hotchkiss, Gatling, Maxim, Driggs-Schroeder. etc. etc. A. B. Dtek, 1st Lieut., 4tli Artillery. West Point, N. T., March 1, 1896. CONTENTS. PART I. MOUNTAIN-ABTILLERT. Chaptkr I. PAGES Description of 1.65 inch and 3.0 inch Guns — Carriages — Ammunition — Paclting-outfit — Range Tables — Organi- zation of Mountain-batteries 1-38 Chapter II. The Pack-train— How Packed 39-48 Chaptbb III. The Mule— Description — Diseases— Treatment .... 49-57 Chapter IV. General Instructions for Mountain Artillery — Supply of Ammunition — Care and Preservation of Harness— In- structions for Drivers — Marches — Camps — Weights and Dimensions of Foreign Mountain-artillery . . . 58-71 PAET ir. FIELD-ARTILLEB Y. Chapter I. Detailed Construction of Field-guns 73-88 Chapter II. 3.3 inch Guns — Sights^— Ammunition — Fuzes— Range Table 89-107 Chapter III. 3.6 inch Gun— Sights — Ammunition — Fuzes — Carriages —Range Table 108-113 3.6 inch Mortar — Sights — Ammunition — Fuzes — Range Table — Weights and Dimensions of Foreign Field- artillery 118-133 vii viii CONTENTS. PASES Chapter IV. Wheel — Carriage — Limber — Caisson — Battery- wagon and Forge — Artillery- wagon — Harness — Water-cart —Revolver— Hunting-knife 124-160 Chaptbk v. Care and Fitting of Harness— Cafe of Carriages — Care of Guns— Care of Ammunition— Guard Orders .... 161-187 Chapter VI. The Horse — How Obtained — Description of — Inspection of —Power of Teams — Weight behind Artillery Teams — Gaits of Artillery — Dentition— Plate of Diseases- Health and Disease — Veterinary Medicines — Drugs and Doses, and How to Administer Them — ^Mashes — Poultices, etc. — Veterinary Notes, witb Symptoms and Treatment of Various Diseases — Stables and Stable Management — Grooming — Feeding —Kinds of Food — Watering — Training Horses — Rules for Treatment and Care of Horses — Destruction of Horses 188-260 Chapteb VII. Organization of Artillery — Composition of Light Batteries — Equipment — Equipment and Clothing for Marches — Marches — Selection of Camps — Making Camp — Break- ing Camp — Allowance of Wagons 261-300 Chapter VIII. Transportation by Rail; by Sea — Embarkation — Care of Animals — Diseases of Animals at Sea — Disembarka- tion 301-315 Chapter IX. Machine-guns — The Hotchkiss Revolving Cannon — The Gatling Gun — The Gardner Gun — The Maxim Gun — The Metallic Carriage for Machine-guns 816-361 Chapter X. Theoretical Gunnery — Definitions — General Principles — Probability of Fire— Burst of Shell— Burst of Shrapnel 362-372 Chapter XI. The Causes of Bad Shooting — Estimating Distances — Range-finding— Rule for Sighting— General Duties of Artillery Commanders — Target Practice, How Con- ducted — Projectiles Used — Kinds of Targets — Night- firing 373-391 CONTENTS. ix PAGES Chapter XII. Cordage, How Preserved — Strength — Blocks and Tackle — Knots, Hitclies, etc.— Lashings 392-403 Bridges — Trestles, Piers, etc. — Single-sling and Double- sling Bridges — Stringer Bridges — Fords — Flying and Floating Bridges — Rafts and Casks 408-418 Chapteb XIII. Hasty Demolition — Gunpowder — Dynamite — How Used in Blasting — Guncotton — Rack-a-Rock — Handling, Transportation, and Storage of High Explosives — Charges for Hasty Demolition — Where and How to Place Charges 419-430 Chapteb XIV. Battery Books and Records — Rolls, Reports, and Re. turns — The Ration — Salt and Vinegar for Public Ani- mals — The Travel-ration — Present Organization of U. S. Light Field-battery— Cost of a Battery of Four 3.3" Guns, in Detail — Price-list of Artillery-harness — Price- list of Harness for 1.65" Mountaiu-gun — Price-list of Artillery Accoutrements, etc. — Price-list of Horse Equipments — Price-list of Stencil and Marking Outfits — Supply Table of Ordnance Stores for a Battery of Light Artillery for Six Months — Allowance of Ammu- nition for Target Practice— Standard Supply Table of Veterinary Medicines — Tableware and Kitchen Uten- sils—Allowance of Clothing, Equipage, Fuel, Lights, etc.— Weights of Certain Articles of Clothing and Equipage— Pay Table of Enlisted Men— Summary Court, and List of Punishments— U. S. Signal and Telegraph Code— Penetration of Projectiles — Cover for Field-artillery — Treatment of Sick Men — Tables of Weights, Measures, etc.— Tables for Converting Cus- tomary and Metric Weights and Measures — Salutes — Camp Furniture and Mess Outfits for Ofllcers . . . 431-496 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. PART I. MO UNTAIN-ABTILLEB Y. CHAPTEE I. Guns. Carriages. Ammunition. Packing Outfit. Range Tables. Organization of Mountain-batteries. THE 1.65-INCH HOTCHKISS MOUNT AIN-GUN. Fig. 1. DESCBIPTION. Material steel Total length 3.83 feet Length of bore 3.48 " Travel of projectile 3.10 " Calibre 1.65 inches Weight 121 pounds "Grooves 10 Twist of rifling, uniform 1 in 39.83 cals. Muzzle- velocity 1398 ft.-sec. Maximum range ., . . 3500 yards 1 2 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLBBT. The gun (Fig. 2) consists of the body and the breech mechanism. n ^T^ L+- FiG. 3. The body of the gun is made from a single forging of oil-tempered and annealed steel. The trunnion-ring is screwed on the gun-body just forward of the reinforce, and provides a support for the front sight. The bore is rifled with a uniform right-hand twist. The lands are very narrow in proportion to the grooves, and are ten in num- ber. The Breech-block is a solid prismatic block of steel with rounded corners, having a horizontal movement in a mor- tise cut completely through the breech of the gun. The front face of the block is perpendicular to the axis of the bore, whilst the rear face is slightly inclined. The left end of the block is bored to form a prolongation of the chamber when the breech is open, and its front upper corner is cut away to allow free movement of the extractor. The horizontal movement of the breech-block is limited by the stop-bolt, which, passing through the breech of the gun, engages in a guide in the upper part of the block. In the right end of the breech-block is mounted a shaft on which is secured the locking-screw, and which ter- minates in a handle for manoeuvring. The thread of the locking-screw is cut away for about 100°, in such a man- ner that the breech-block may be locked or unlocked by a half-turn of the handle. The Extractor is a single piece of steel working in a longitudinal groove in the top of the breech-mortise. Its forward end is formed into a claw to grasp the head of the MOUNTAIN-ABTILLEBT. 3 cartridge. On the same side as the claw is a stud which, following a groove in the top of the breech-block, imparts motion to the extractor. The Vent is a cylindrical channel passing diagonally through the breech and breech-block, and changing direc- tion in the block so as to follow the axis of the bore. The friction-primer cannot be inserted until the two parts of the vent are in prolongation from the complete closing and locking of the breech-block. The ordinary friction-primer is used. NOMEHrCLATITRE. The Mechanism. — (J) breech-block; loading-hole; (s) stop-bolt; spring washer; (r) stop-bolt guide; (e) extractor; (A) extractor-hook; (« k) extractor-guide; (c) locking- screw; locking-screw shaft; locking-screw pin; [l) handle; stop; stop keep-screw. .e i) Fia. 3. ACTIOK OF THE MECHANISM:. The gun having been fired, the handle is turned to the rear, unlocking the block and starting it in the mortise. 4 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. Drawing the handle smartly to the right, the breech is opened, the extractor, actuated by the moTement of the . block, commences to move very slowly back with a power- fal leverage, starting the cartridge-case from its seat. When the breech-block has moved sufficiently to unmask the bore, the change of direction in the extractor-guide causes the extr-actor to make a quick movement to the rear, throwing the cartridge clear of the gun. A new charge being inserted, it is pushed home until the head of the cartridge brings up against the extractor. The breech is now closed by pushing it smartly to the left, and is locked by turning the handle to the front. A primer may now be inserted in the vent, and the gun is ready for firing. DIRECTION'S FOE DISMOUNTIKG THE MECHANISM. Unscrew the stop-bolt about four turns, or remove com- pletely. Withdraw breech-block. Kemove extractor, which is now free. In general nothing further need be dismounted for cleaning and inspection. To dismount completely continue' as follows: Remove locking-screw pin with screw-driver. Remove stop keep-screw. Drive out stop with the drift, interposing a bit of wood or leather to avoid bruising the stop. Withdraw handle and locking-screw shaft. Remove locking-screw. To mount, proceed in reverse order. CARE AND PRESERVATION. The gun requires no special care beyond that of being kept clean, free from rust and undefaced. MO UNTAIN-ABTILLBBY. Brick-dust or gritty substances must never be used on any part of the gun. The parts of the mechanism must never be scraped with knives or metal, or be de- faced or roughened in any luay. All parts of the gun must be kept lightly oiled as a protection from rust. After firing, the gun should invari- ably be thoroughly cleaned. To do this, dismount the mechanism completely and wash every part thoroughly with warm fresh-water soapsuds; mechanism, breech- block, mortise, and barrel should all be treated alike. After thoroughly scrubbing all parts, dry them carefully and let all stand for a short time to air and dry ofE the moist- ure. After drying, rub all parts over with a well-oiled rag. Mount the mechanism. On the march the breech and muzzle should always be protected by the covers supplied for the purpose. When parked, guns and carriages should be covered with paulins. SIGHTS. The Front Sight is a plain roughened steel point-sight, and is permanently fixed to the right rim-base.- The Bar Tangent Sight (Pig. 4) is a plain vertical bar-sight carrying a slid- ing leaf conveniently graduated. Both the bar and the leaf have clamp-screws to fix them in position. The tangent sight is only mounted on the gun §- In Pig. 4. 6 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGBT ARTILLERY. when in action, being at other times removed to avoid in- juring it. The bar is graduated to 15°, each being subdivided into six parts. It may be graduated in yards or metres. It is compensated for natural drift. A vernier-mark on the head of the sight and graduations on the sliding leaf cor- rect ordinary deviations. The Gunner's ftuadrant, for mountain-guns, is a small pocket-quadrant with a spirit-level limb pivoted. On the arc are inscribed both the degrees of elevation and ranges corresponding to the gun for which it is used. It is thor- oughly reliable both for direct and curved fire, and to a very great extent supplants the sight-bar. The recoil is checked by rope-brakes, hooked to the trail-handles and passed around the felloes of the wheels. No limber is used, but a pole which is readily attached to the trail is provided for hauling the carriage. AMMUNITIOK. The ammunition is fixed, and consists of common shell and canister. Weight of round (common shell) 3.63 pounds Weight of shell, filled 1.95 " Weight of round (canister) complete 3.47 " Weight of canister 3.8 " Number of balls in canister 30 Powder-charge 5^ oz. mortar Bursting-charge of shell 1.8 oz. Weight of cartridge case empty 5.3 " Weight of fuze 1.9 " The drawn metallic cartridge-case (Fig. 5) is of brass, and is drawn from the solid metal to shape. It is rein- forced at the base by inside (c) and outside (6) cups of the same metal. The head {d) is fastened to the base by brass rivets which clamp the body, cups, and head solidly to- gether. A vent {v) is pierced through the head of the MO UNTAm-ARTILLEBT. cartridge, and five eccentric flash-holes (a) through the reinforcing-cups. The jet of flame from the primer, enter- ing the vent, lifts the reinforcing-cups and forces its way through the flash-holes to the charge. The charge being V'' * Pig. 5. Fig. 7. ignited, the pressure of the gas immediately forces back the reinforcing-cups and seals the vent. The charge, con- sisting of 5^ oz. of black powder, is well shaken down and separated from the base of the projectile by a felt wad. When smokeless powder is employed, an igniter contain- ing about 40 grains (3 grammes) of musket-powder is placed in the bottom of the cartridge-case. The vent is sealed with a thin coating of wax. The Common Shell (Fig. 6) is of the cylindro-ogival pattern with a brass band, and is fitted with a base per- cussion-fuze. It contains a bursting-charge of about IJ oz. (950 grammes) of musket-powder. The Canister (Fig. 7) consists of a thin envelope of drawn brass, containing thirty hardened 1-oz. lead balls packed in sulphur. On the body is an annular stop to prevent inserting too far into the cartridge-case. The cartridge-case can be recharged on an average about eight times. A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. The Carriage, Weight complete 341 pounds Height of axis of trunnions above ground. 37.55 inches Diameter of the wheel 37.4 Track of wheel 2.46 feet Fig. 8. Nomenclature (see Fig. 8).— (a) trail; (b) axle; (c) wheel; (t?) eap-squares; (e) breast-transom; (/) elevating- screw; {g) lunette; (Ji) hook. description. The carriage-body consists of two steel brackets form- ing cheeks and trail. They are reinforced by angle-steel and connected by transoms. The axle is secured in beds riveted to the brackets, and is aiTanged to be readily dis- mounted when required. The elevatingrgear consists of a simple screw working in a stout steel transom, and sup- ports the breech of the gun; the preponderance is suf- ficient to insure stability. The sponge and rod are secured to the right side of the trail by suitable attachments. A pole is provided for draught when easy country is encoun- tered, and provision is made for attaching it to the lunette. MO UNTAIN-ARTILLER T. 9 The following articles are carried in the gunner's haversack: I tangent-sight; 1 lanyard; 1 spare -extractor; 1 spare stop-bolt; 1 dismounting-pin; 1 oil-can; 2 cleaning- brushes; 1 screw-driver; 1 pair cutting-pliers; 1 vent- cleaner; friction-primers. Leather covers are provided for the breech and muzzle of the gun. Two bricoles are provided for use in moving by hand. The band of the bricole is of stout canvas, having a short length of rope at its lower end, provided with a stout hook for hooking into the swivels on the ends.of the axles. HOTCHKISS POIKT PbRCUSSION-FUZE. The Hotchkiss Point Fuze (Fig. 9) consists of four main parts : the body A, the plunger B, the head G, and the safety-plug D. The Body is cylindrical and of brass, with a screw- thread and stout shoulder at the upper end for secur- ing in the shell. The outside of the shoulder is shaped to the ogive. A chamber is fashioned in the body, whose base has a conical hole bored for the safety-plug. The Plunger is a hollow brass cylinder with a lead lin- ing to give it weight, and containing a chamber in which is a small charge of powder with a fulminate cap over it, the whole being covered with foil as a preservative against moisture. A small brass wire is inserted in the lower part of the plunger, bent up so that the ends project through the safety-plug hole. The Safety-plug is a lead stopper forced tightly into the hole in the bottom, and by pinching the ends of the brass wire holds the plunger steady. The Head is of giin-metal, the outside following the ogival contour and being provided with a screw-thread for securing it in the body. In the centre of the lower 10 A HANDBOOK FOB LI&ET ABTILLEBT. RANGE TABLE FOR 1.65-INCH HOTCHKISS MOUNTAIN-GUN. Kind of powder, Dupont H. N. Weight of charge, 5^ oz. Weight of shell, 1 lb. 15 oz. Initial velocity, 1,398 ft. -sec. Angle of jump, -)- 32 minutes Length of line of sight, 17.93 inches 1 1 < 1 1 n 1 a if If gtnS Yards. o / o / Inches. Yards. Inches. Sec. Feet. Yards 100 -0 12 13 0.000 0.1 0.008 0.1 1,243 100 300 00 23 0.000 0.1 0.009 0.4 1,191 300 300 +0 11 35 0.057 0.3 0.013 0.7 1,135 180 400 23 048 0.130 0.3 0.014 1.0 1,099 131 500 85 1 02 0.183 0.4 0.014 1.3 1,066 103 600 49 1 16 0.355 0.5 0.015 1.6 1,037 83 700 1 03 1 31 0.338 0.7 0.018 1.9 1,007 69 800 1 17 1 53 0.401 0.9 0.030 3.3 984 56 900 132 3 16 0.479 1.3 0.034 3.5 961 46 1,000 148 3 39 0.563 1.5 0.036 3.8 942 40 1,100 3 04 3 03 0.646 3.0 0.033 3.1 923 34 1,300 3 31 3 37 0.735 3.5 0.037 3.4 903 30 1,300 3 39 3 53 0.829 3.3 0.044 3.8 886 37 1,400 2 57 4 23 0.923 3.9 0.050 4.1 869 24 1,500 3 16 4 48 1.032 4.6 0.055 4.5 853 23 1,600 3 36 5 19 1.127 5.5 0.062 4.9 837 30 1,700 3 57 5 50 1.237 6.1 0.065 5.3 833 18 1,800 4 18 6 33 1.347 7.0 0.070 5.7 810 16 1,900 4 39 6 55 1.457 8.0 0.076 6.1 797 15 2,000 5 01 7 38 1.572 9.0 0.081 6.5 784 14 2,100 5 33 8 03 1.688 10.0 0.086 6.9 771 13 3,300 5 47 8 36 1.814 11.0 0.090 7.3 758 12 3,300 6 11 9 14 1.941 13.0 0.103 7.7 748 11 2,400 6 36 9 57 2.073 15.0 0.113 8.1 735 10 3,500 7 01 10 36 3.305 17.0 0.123 8.5 733 10 2,600 7 37 11 18 3.343 30.0 0.139 8.9 713 9 2,700 7 53 13 00 3.480 33.0 0.151 9.3 703 9 3,800 8 20 13 43 3.634 34.0 0.155 9.8 689 8 2,900 8 48 13 36 3.773 36.0 0.163 10.3 679 8 3,000 9 17 14 10 3.938 38.0 0.170 10.6 669 7 3,200 10 15 15 39 3.239 35.0 0.199 11.6 650 g 3,400 11 16 17 11 3.569 41.0 0.331 13.6 630 6 3,600 12 20 18 45 3.917 48.0 0.345 13.5 610 5 3,800 13 27 20 30 4.384 57.0 0.377 14.5 591 5 4 4,000 14 35 33 00 4.996 70.0 0.335 15.5 571 If the axle of the carnage be not horizontal, multiply the differ- ence of level of the wheels m mches (or the inclination of the trun- nions in degrees) by the elevation in degrees for the given range: the theWgh^er ^hSl ''' '"''"'*'' *° ^' ^^P"^^ °° *^^ «*de of MO TINTAIN-ARTILLER T. 11 surface is fixed a small point forming a striker for the fulminate. When the shell is fired, the plunger is forced to the rear, driving the safety-plug into the shell. The small wires being free to let the plunger drive forward, hold it steadily with the rotation of the shell, and keep it from dropping forward on the de- scending arc of a high trajectory. On impact the plunger drives forward, and the little magazine is exploded by contact with the point. A Prankford Arsenal point percus- sion-fuze, small (model 1894), weight 2^ oz., is now made for 1.65-inch ammunition. It is similar to the fuze for the 3.2-inch field-gun. DISMOUNTIlfG. To dismount the mechanism : See page 4. To dismount the gun: Throw back the cap-squares and lift straight up at breech and muzzle. To dismount the wheels: Take out the linch-pins, lift the carriage at the axles and slip the wheels off. To dismount the axle: Slack back the clamp-screws about one turn; back the small keep-screws about four turns. Dismount the wheels; pull out the axle. To mount the parts, proceed in inverse order. LOADING-TOOLS AND IKSTETJCTIOlSrS. NOMEifCLATUKE. — Loading-press; loading-sleeve; com- mon shell-plunger; canister-plunger; ejector; charge- measure; burster-measure; cartridge-funnel; shell-funnel; cleaning-brush ; fuze- wrench. The loading-tools are supplied in sets, enclosed in an 12 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. oak chest. They are not to be carried into the field, but should be set up in an appropriate laboratory room. For methods to be followed see instructions given for preparing ammunition for 3-inch gun, page 31, et seq. The Packing Outfit foe 1.65-in^ch Gun. This consists of: One pack-saddle, for carrying the gun and wheels of the carriage. One pack-saddle, for carrying the gun-carriage, the pole, the splinter-bar, the harness-sack (containing the harness and the pole-yoke), and the ammunition-pack. One pack-saddle, for carrying the four ammunition- boxes. One set of double harness. One pole and neck-yoke (the pole is hinged so that it can be folded for packing). One splinter-bar. Four ammunition-boxes holding 18 rounds each. One ammunition-pack holding 6 rounds, for use in an emergency. Blinds, for use when packing. The Pack-saddles are identical, with the exception of the yokes for carrying the different parts and a few minoi* changes in the pads. The Harness is for two mules and consists of bridles, breast- collars, martingales, breeching, traces and pole- straps, and harness-sack (duck). The pole, neck-yoke, and splinter-bar are made of hickory. Ammunition-boxes are made of pine and are 24" X 8" X 8". They have sliding covers, which are connected to the box by a lifting hinge. Each box holds 18 rounds of ammuni- tion, and friction-primers. Weight of box empty II lbs. 8 oz.; weight of box filled 59 lbs., about. MO UNTAIN-ABTILLEB T. 13 PARTS OF OUTFIT PER GUIT. 1 pack-saddle for gun. 1 crupper. 1 belly-cincha. 1 saddle-cincha. 8 wheel-straps. 2 hub-straps. 1 gun-pad. 1 lasting-rope. 2 bridles. 2 breast-collars. 2 martingales. 2 breechings. 2 pairs traces. 2 pole-straps. 1 blind. 1 blind. 1 pack-saddle for carriage. 1 crupper. 1 belly-cincha. 1 saddle-cincha. 1 cargo-cincha. 1 trail-strap. 1 lashing-rope. 1 harness-sack. 1 neck-yoke. 1 neck-yoke brace. M j neck-yoke brace- ( billet, and chapes. 1 pack-saddle for am- munition, 1 crupper. 1 belly-cincha. 1 saddle-cincha. 1 cargo-cincha. 1 lashing-iope 1 pole. 1 splinter-bar. Trail-hooks for attach- ment of splinter-bar. 4 ammunition-boxes. 1 cartridge-pack. 1 blind. METHOD OF PACKING. 1. On long marches with a wagon train the whole packing outfit will be carried in the wagon train when practicable. 2. On packing the outfit to make expeditions, if it is known that there will be no occasion for hauling the gun and carriage, the hauling appliances, viz.,harness, pole, yoke, and splinter-bar, can be left behind in the wagon train, at a camp or post, as the case may be; but as the haluling ap- pliances add little to the pack, and unexpected occasions for their use are probable, they should be carried as a rule, 3. The gun and carriage are to be hauled whenever practicable country for hauling occurs, on a long march, to ease the animals, and especially if their backs get sore, and also in action if the ground will admit of it. 4. If the draught animals are led, the pack-saddles can be left on the animals loosely cinched. 5. If a driver rides one draught animal, its pack-saddle can be placed on the other animal, or both saddles can be placed on gun and carriage. 14 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. 6. Pressure should fall on back, not on spine and not on sides. Mules differ in shape; the same mule is not always symmetrical, and the condition varies; therefore, when saddles fit do not change them without good reason. Fold saddle-blanket in four folds and place it carefully on the animal ; then place the saddle on the blanket and in the middle of the animal's back, so as to interfere as little as possible with his free action, and cinch tightly with saddle-cincha. They should be drawn tighter than with riding-saddles, but only tight enough to keep the saddle securely in its place. With a young mule tighten gradually and gently. Ammunition-mules scarcely need such tight girthing as saddle-mules. The dock of the crupper must be kept soft, smooth, and pliable. 7. See that cTerything fits properly before loading. Place the hand under the blanket to make sure that pres- sure does not fall on the withers. On the least sign of a rub on the ribs take measures to relieve the pressure from that point, changing the load if possible. In cases of this sort, an ounce of prevention is worth a pound of cure. A slightly galled mule can generally carry its saddle, and sometimes be worked, if proper measures are taken. After cleansing and drying the wound dust it with sulphur 3 parts, iodoform 1 part, and then put a piece of old- fashioned court-plaster over it if the animal is to be worked. • Iksteuctions fob Packing. Saddles. — Fold saddle-blanket in four folds and place it on the animal; place saddle on blanket and cinch tightly with saddle-cincha. No. 3 saddles the carriage-mule and acts as driver. MO UNTAIN-ABTILLEB T. 16 No. 4 saddles the gun-mule and acts as driver. No. 5 saddles the first ammunition-mule and acts as driver. No. 6 saddles the second ammunition-mule and acts as driver. FIEST ANIMAL. (See Fig. 10.) Gun and Wheels. — The gunner removes the tangent- sight, placing it in the haversack, and puts on the breech- cover. No. 1 throws back the right cap-square and puts on the muzzle-cover and grasps gun by manceuvring-handle. No. 2 throws back the left cap-square and grasps end of breech-block. Pig. 10. No. 4 leads the gun-mule to the gun and places him three yards to the rear of the trail, facing to the rear. The gunner, grasping the muzzle, commands "Lift," and all lift the gun from the carriage and place it in its bearings, breeeh in front, sight down. 16 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. The gunner, assisted by Nos. 1 and 3, puts cafgo-cincha over gun, trunnions passing through slots, edge of cincha nearest to slots in front j cinches to belly-cincha; and then puts gun -pad on breech of gun. N"os. 1 and 3 on their respective sides then lift the axle while the gunner removes the wheels and replaces linch- pins and washers; Nos. 1 and 3 fasten them together with wheel-strap, dish of wheels inside, and place them astride of gun, hubs between wheel-pads on cargo-cilicha, lower them to their proper position, and suspend them with the hub-strap which passes around the hubs and over top of gun. On most animals the best position for wheels is to have the distance froin bottom of hub, measured over top of saddle, 36 inches. Nos. 1 and 3 then buckle around the rim of wheel, on their respective sides, the two wheel-straps, which are attached to the belly-cincha chape, two spokes apart on each side, and tighten these straps until the wheels are in the best position and bear firmly on the cargo-cincha wheel-pads, and on the gun-pad. The wheel-pack is then secure and can be easily adjusted from time to time to aid the animal on the march. If further security is required, lash the wheels with the lashing-rope ; fasten one end of rope to one hub, pass it around wheels, under corners of saddle- pads and over and under the animal, and draw tight. (The most expert packer of the detachment should be required to perform the duties pertaining to that work when neces- sary, as it is very important that the work shotild be done properly.) SBOOND ANIMAL. (See Fig. 11.) Carriage and Harness.— No. 3 leads the carriage-mule up and places him three yards in front of muzzle, facing to the front. MO UNTAIN-ARTILLER T. 11 No. 1 places harness (in its sack) on left side with pole- yoke under flap of harness-sack, and secures them Trumpeters Cooks Wheelwright Gun 4 Carriage 4 4 Second atninunition, . . , 4 Spare carriage 1 Blacksmith's tools, etc. . Wheelwrights, etc Spare 3 Pack-train ? 9 38 SO+increase of pack-train. Service of the 1.65-inch Hotchkiss Gun. Men Eeqnired. — A gunner and fiye privates. Nos. 1, 2, and 3 serve as cannoneers; Ifos. 4 and 5 attend animals. Equipments. — Gunner and No. 1, primer-pouches; Nos. 2 and 3, cartridge-pouches. Duties. — The gunner commands, attaches and detaches the pole, sets the sight, points, and superintends the ser- vice of the ammunition. No. 1 mans right wheel, controls brake-rope, opens and closes breech, and fires piece. No. 2 mans the left wheel, controls brake-rope, intro- duces the ammunition into the bore, and assists in pointing. No. 3 keeps No. 3 supplied with ammunition and assists the gunner in attaching and detaching the pole. Nos. 4 and 5 attend animals. MOUNTAm-ARTlLLMBY. 23 HOTCHKISS 3-INCH MOUNTAIN-GUN. Fig. 13. DESCKIPTlOSr. Material steel Total length 3.76 feet Length of bore 3.25 " Travel of projectile 3.03 " Calibre 3 inches Weight 316 pounds Grooves ^. 24 Twist of rifling, uniform 1 in 25.59 cala. Muzzle-velocity 870 f. s. Maximum range ,. . . 4000 yards The breech-mechanism of this gun differs from the 1.65- inch in that its stop-bolt engages in a guide in the lower part of the block. Tlhe front sight is of the open type, allowing of a large field of view. The tangent-sight is provided with a sliding head by means of which it may be set before placing it on the gun, and a deflection-slide for correcting for drift, wind, etc. On the deflection-slide is an open notch for rough, and a peep-sight for fine, sighting. The sight-bar is graduated on one side in ranges, on the other in milli- metres. The sights are on the left side. M A HANDBOOK FOU LMET ABTILLBBT. The Caeeiagb. Fig. 14. NoMBNCLATUEE. — (1) trail; (2) axle; (3) wheel; (4) cap-squares; (5) hooks; (6) elevating-screw; (7) elevating- lever; (8) elevating-transom; (9) lunette; (10) lunette- plate; (11) trail -handles; (12) brakes; (13) sponge and rod. DESCBIPTION. Length of carriage-body 53.75 inches Weight of carriage-body 205 pounds Weight of sponge and rod 4.5 " Weight of two wheels. 133 " Total weight of carriage 333 " Height of trunnion-centres above ground. . 23.7 inches Diameter of wheels 37.4 " Track of carriage 28.35 " Vertical field of fire +20°,— 10° Total weight of gun and carriage 570 pounds The carriage-body consists of two steel brackets form- ing stock and trail. They are reinforced by angle-steel and connected by transoms. The axle is stiffened by a re- inforcing-plate to which is riveted the carriage-body. The MO UNTAIN-ARTILLERY. 25 elevating-gear consists of a forked lever, pivoted at its nearmost end, and traversed near the middle by the ele- vating-screw. The latter is supported by an inclined plane on the elevating-transom. The breech of the gun rests freely on the end of the elevating-lever, the preponder- ance being sufficient to insure stability. Kecoil is checked by two rope-brakes, which are hooked to the trail-handles and passed around the felloes of the wheels. For the march one end of each brake is hooked to a trail-handle, the rope passed diagonally over the trail end and the free end secured to one of the hooks under the axle. The sponge and rod are secured by suitable attachments on the right side of the trail. The Pbaieie Limber. Fra. IS. Nomenclature. — (1) axle; (2) axle-beds; (3) frame; (4) body; (5) pintle; (6) pintle-key; (7) shafts; (8) prop; (9) prolonge-hooks; (10) ammunition-chests. 26 A EANBBOOK FOR LIQBT ABTILLER7. DBSCEIPTIOSr. Weight of limber-body 263 pounds Weight of two wheels 133 Weight of four chests 133 " Weight of limber complete 554 " Number of rounds carried 33 Weight of limber fully equipped. . . 1005 pounds Weight of a pair of ammunition-chests fully loaded. ,. 335 " Total weight of gun limbered 1575 ' ' This limber is designed to relieve the pack-animals where possible. It carries four of the mountain ammunition- chests, which may at once be removed and carried on the pack when necessary, the limber-body being temporarily abandoned. Two of the pack-animals will be found suffi- cient for draught, leaving three as a relief or for the trans- port of forage. The Limber consists of a frame of angle-steel, which is provided with beds to receive the axle. The body is formed of steel plate, with compartments for the reception of four ammunition-chests. The outer chests are raised slightly above those in the middle, and may be opened without removing them from the limber. On the limber are carried a paulin, a combined prolonge and picket-rope, a felling-axe, a shovel and a pickaxe. The Ammunition-chests are made of wood, covered with waterproof canvas, and are strongly ironed. They provide for carrying eight rounds of ammunition, and have a com- partment wherein may be placed a package oi friction- primers and the fuze-case. The latter is a metallic box having compartments for five combination fuzes in their sealed packages. MO TTNTAIN-ARTILLEB T. 27 The Ammunitioit. Weight of cartridge-case 1.25 pounds Weight of cliarge 14 ounces Weight of projectile. .'. 13 pounds Total weight of complete cartridge 14 " Total length of complete cartridge 14.1 inches Bursting-charge, common shell 6.3 ounces Bursting-charge, shrapnel 1| " Number of balls in shrapnel 160 Effective fragments, shrapnel 180 Number of balls in canister 125 The Ammunitioii consists of a cartridge-case containing the powder-charge, and the projectile. The drawn metal cartridge-case (Pig. 16) is of brass, and is drawn from the solid metal to shape. It is reinforced at the base by inside and outside cups of the same metal. The head is fastened to the base by brass rivets, which clamp the case, cups, and head solidly together. A vent is pierced through the head of the cartridge, and five eccentric-fire holes through the rein- forcing-cups. Between the reinforc- ing-cups is held an iron obturator. The jet of flame from the primer, •entering the vent, lifts the obturator and forces its way through the fire- holes to the charge. The charge being ignited, the pressure of the gas imme- diately forces back the obturator and seals the vent. The Charge consists of 14 oz. I. K. granular powder. In order to vary the charge the ammunition is made in two parts, viz., projectile and cartridge-case. The car- Fia. 16. 28 A HANDBOOK FOB LI&HT ARTtLLBBT. tridge is put into the metallic case in two half-charges, in bags, so that one may be removed if desired. The Tent of the cartridge is sealed with a thin coating of wax. The Common Shell (Pig. 17) is of the cylindro-ogival pattern, with a copper band, and is fitted with a point percussion-fuze. It contains a bursting-charge of about 6.3 ounces (180 grammes) of fine-grain powder. ■Pig. 17, Pig. 18. Pig. 19. The Shrapnel (Pig. 18) is made of cast iron. It consists of a body to which the head is attached by three copper rivets. The bursting-charge of about If ounces of fine- grain powder is contained in a chamber in the base, which is brought into communication with the fuze by a central MOUNTAIN-ARTILLERY. 29 igniting-tube. The shrapnel is loaded with 160 hardened balls packed in sulphur. These projectiles are transported plugged, the combined time and percussion fuze being in- serted at the moment of action. The Canister (Fig. 19) consists of a thin brass envelope, which is lined with six wrought-iron segments. The head is of wood, and is fitted with a false point to bring it to the same length as the common shell. On the body is an annular stop to prevent inserting too far into the cartridge- case. The canister contains 125 hardened lead balls. The common shell are painted black, the shrapnel red, and the canister are unpainted. ACCESSOEIES AND SpABE PaETS. The following accessories and spare parts are supplied with each gun, carriage, and limber : GUN. 1 breech-cover, russet leather. 1 muzzle-cover, russet leather. 1 gunner's haversack, containing: 1 breech-sight. 1 gunner's quadrant in case. 1 lanyard. 1 Universal fuze-wrench. 1 cannoneer's haversack, containing: 1 spare extractor. 1 spare "ton-bolt. 1 spare spring-washer. 1 dismounting-pin. 1 drift. 1 oil-can. 2 cleaning-brushes. 1 screw-driver. 30 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 1 fuze-wrench. 1 pair of cutting-pliers. 1 Tent-cleaner. GUN-CAREIAGB. 1 pair of shafts. 1 sponge-cover. 1 sponge and rod. 2 brake-ropes. PRAIEIB LIMBEB. 4 ammunition-chests. 4 fuze-cases. 1 pair of shafts. 1 felling-axe. 1 pick-axe. 1 shovel. 1 waterproof panlin 13' X 6^'. 1 picket-rope and prolonge 20' long. Abtificbr's Tools akd Supplies. In the composition of a complete mountain-battery must be included the necessary tools and supplies for making any repairs that may be required, for shoeing the pack- animals, etc. These constitute the loads for four mules, as follows: " PIONEER-PAdK. 2 felling-axes, with handles. 1 crowbar, steel. 2 sledge-hammers (8 pounds), handled. 4 bill-hooks. 4 pick-axes, handled. 4 shovels. 6 reaping-hooks. 4 hatchets. 50 feet of 1-inch hemp rope. MOUNTAIN- ABTILLEUY. 31 FORGE-PACK. 1 mountain-forge, complete. 1 set of smith's tools. ARTIFICBES' PACK. 1 set of wheelwright's tools. 1 set of saddler's tools. SUPPLY-PACK. 1 set of wheelwright's stores. 1 set of saddler's stores. 1 set of farrier's stores. Loading-tools and Instructions. Tools for loading the ammunition are supplied in sets, enclosed in an oak chest. They are not to be carried into the field. The set consists of: Common-shell plunger. Shrapnel plunger. Case-shot plunger. Loading-sleeye. Ejector. Loading-press. Fuze-key. Cleaning-brush. Shell-funnel. Cartridge-funnel. Cartridge-gauge. to fill common shell. Insert the funnel in fuze-hole and pour in bursting- charge, at the same time tapping side of shell with a wooden mallet. Clean the fuze-hole carefully with brush, and make sure that no powder remains in the thread. Screw the fuze tightly home. If the fuze requires more force than can be given with the key to screw it home, lay it aside. Never strike a fuze or attempt to force it. 32 A HANDBOOK FOB LIOHT ABTILLEBT. TO FILL THE CAKTEIDGB-CASB. Weigh the charge (never measure it) and pour it in the case through a funnel. Shake the charge well down by tapping side of case with flat of the hand. Insert the wad. TO ASSEMBLE CAETBIDGE (1'.65), The common shell are inserted filled and fuzed, the shrapnel empty. Oil the base of the projectile lightly, and centre in the mouth of the cartridge case, the latter stand- ing on the bench. Slip the sleeve vertically over pro- jectile and cartridge-case. Turn the sleeve to a horizontal position, holding the head of the cartridge with the left hand, and lay the sleeve in the press. Insert the proper plunger, so that it bears on the head of the projectile. Screw the press home until the band of the projectile touches the mouth of the cartridge, or until the shoulder of the plunger bears against the front of the sleeve. Un- screw the press, remove the plunger, push out cartridge with the ejector. Never strihe the ejector under any pre- tence. Pass the cartridge into the gauge and close slide. TO FILL SHBAPNBL. The shrapnel is assembled with the cartridge-case be- fore filling. Pour in the bursting-charge very slowly, at the same time tapping the projectile lightly with a mallet. Clean the fuze-hole carefully, and screw the plug firmly home. Shrapnel should not be fuzed except in the field, at the moment of their employment. The above rules find general application, the methods being modified to suit the case, viz., whether fixed ammu- nition, or charge and projectile separate. MO UNTAIN-ARTILLEltY. 33 3-mCH MOUNTAIN-GUN RANGE TABLE. Charge, 14.1 oz. Ca. Initial velocity, 853 ft.-seo. Projectile, 13 lbs. Angle of jump, 0° 39'. Length of line of sight, 17".56. Range. Angle of De- Eleva- Sight- Drift. De- flec- Time of Fuze- An^le Rem. parture tion. marks. tion. Flight. scale. Fall. Veloc. Yards. o / o , Inciies. Feet. m/m Sec'nds [nches. O / Feet. 0.000 Right Left 0.0 0.00 858 100 23 • • • • 0.1 0.1 0.3 0.14 • . . • 842 200 46 6"7 0.036 0.3 0.2 0.7 0.34 831 800 1 10 31 0.158 0.4 0.2 1.1 0.55 831 400 1 34 55 0.381 0.7 0.3 1.4 0.76 811 500 1 59 1 30 0.409 1.1 0.3 1.8 0.99 2'i6 801 600 3 34 1 45 0.536 1.6 0.4 3.2 1.22 791 700 2 50 3 11 0.670 3.3 0.5 3 6 1.46 782 800 8 16 3 37 0.803 3.0 0.6 3.0 1.69 773 900 3 42 3 3 0.936 3.9 0.7 3.4 1.91 764 1000 4 9 3 30 1.074 4.9 0.7 3.8 2.13 4' 33 755 1100 4 37 3 58 1.218 6.0 0.8 4.3 2.33 746 1300 5 5 4 26 1.861 7.2. 0.9 4.6 2.54 787 1300 5 38 4 54 1.504 8.5 1.0 5.0 3.75 728 1400 6 2 5 38 1.655 9.9 1.1 5.4 2.95 719 1500 6 32 5 53 1.810 11.5 1.2 5.8 3.16 719 710 1600 7 2 6 23 1.965 13.3 1.3 6.3 3.36 703 1700 7 33 6 54 2.135 15.3 1.4 6.7 3.57 694 1800 8 5 7 26 2.291 17.5 1.5 7.3 8.78 686 1900 8 37 7 58 2.458 19.8 1.6 7.6 3.99 678 2000 9 10 8 31 2.630 23.8 1.7 8.1 4.20 10 '44 670 3100 9 44 9 5 2.807 25.1 1.8 8.5 663 2200 10 19 9 40 2.991 38.1 1.9 9.0 654 2800 10 54 10 15 3.175 31.3 2.1 9.5 646 2400 11 30 10 51 3.366 34.8- 2.2 10.0 • . . 638 2500 13 7 11 28 3.562 38.5 3.3 10.5 • . . 14' 39 630 2600 13 45 13 6 3.765 43.5 2.5 11.0 623 2700 13 25 13 46 3.979 46.8 2.7 11.6 616 2800 14 6 13 27 4.200 51.5 2.8 12.1 609 2900 14 48 14 9 4.437 56.6 3.0 12.7 . . . 601 8000 15 31 14 53 4.661 63.1 3.3 13.2 19 '37 594 3100 16 16 15 37 4.908 68.1 3.4 13.8 587 8300 17 2 16 33 5.163 74.5 3.6 14.4 • . . 580 3300 17 49 17 10 5.435 81.4 3.9 15.0 573 3400 18 38 17 59 5.700 88.9 4.1 15.6 . . . 567 3600 19 39 18 50 5.989 97.0 4.4 16.3 ... 25' "3 560 (From Hotchkiss Pamphlet.) 34 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. Suggested Oeganization of a S-inch Hotchkiss MOUNTAIir-BATTBET. The organization is made on the same principles as those of the 1.65-inch mountain-battery. The section, consisting of one piece, requires for its service and transport ten men and nine pack-animals. Of the men, gunner and Nos. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 as cannoneers; 7, 8, 9, attend animals. The pack-animals are distributed as follows : 1 gun-mule. 1 carriage-mule. 1 wheel, shafts, and accessory mule. 6 ammunition-mules. The proportion of each kind of ammunition carried will depend upon the nature of the campaign, but in gen- eral each ammunition-chest should contain five shrapnel, two common shell, and one canister, making a total allow- ance per gun: 60 shrapnel with combination fuzes. 24 common shell with percussion-fuzes. 12 canister. A full battery should consist of six pieces, and should comprise, in addition to the equipment of six sections : 1 pioneer outfit, with mule and driver. 1 mountain-forge, with mule and driver. 2 artificer's chests, containing farrier's, wheelwright's, and saddler's tools, with mule and driver. 2 chests with farrier's, wheelwright's, and saddler's sup- plies, one spare wheel, with mule and driver. 1 spare carriage complete, with two mules and one driver. 3 ammunition-chests, with small-arms ammunition and small stores, with mule. EcLuipments. — Gunner's pouch; No. 1, primer-pouch; Kos. 2. 3 and 4 cartridge-pouches. MO UNTAIN-ABriLLEB T. 35 Duties. — Gunner commands; limbers and unlimbers; sets the sight; points, and superintends service of ammuni- tion. No. 1 mans the right wheel; controls brake-rope; opens and closes breech; fires piece. No. 2 mans the left wheel; controls brake-rope; intro- duces the ammunition into the bore; assists in pointing. No. 3 keeps No. 2 supplied with ammunition (first setting time-fuze and removing safety-pin) and assists the gunner in limbering and unlimbering. No. 4 keeps No. 2 supplied with ammunition (first setting time-fuze and removing safety-pin). No. 5 receives ammvinition from No. 6; removes plugs from shrapnel; fuzes same; loosens cap of time-fuze, and issues prepared ammunition to Nos. 3 and 4. No. 6 passes ammunition to No. 5 ; opens time-fuze cyl- inders, and brings up ammunition-mules as required. At the command "Cease firing," Nos. 5 and 6 equalize ammunition in boxes. Nos. 7, 8, and 9 attend animals. TO PACK. The mules are brought up at a trot, and stationed : Gun-mule three yards in rear of trail and facing to rear. Carriage-mule three yards in front of muzzle, facing to front. Wheel-mule three yards to left of gun, facing to front. To Pack the Gun (Fig. 20).— No. 4 takes the lifting-bars from wheel-pack and passes them to the gunner and No. 3; No. 3 procures breech and muzzle covers from gun-pack, hands muzzle-cover to No. 1 and straps on breech-cover; No. 1 throws open cap-squares and adjusts muzzle-cover; the gunner and No. 2 pass ends of lifting-bars to Nos. 3 and 1. All numbers facing to the rear, the gunner com- 36 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBY. mands, "Lift." The gun is placed on the pack and secured by Nos. 1 and 2. Fig. 30. To Pack the Carriage (Eig. 21). — The gunner and No. 3 remove the linchpins; Nos. 1 and 2 lift the axle; the Fig. 31. gunner and No. 3 remove the wheels and replace the linchpins; Nos. 1 and 2 grasping the axle-arms, the gun- MO UNTAIN-ARTILLBR T. 37 ner aud No. 3 pass a lifting-bar through the trail-handles. All numbers facing to the front, the gunner commands. " Lift," and the carriage is placed on the pack and secured by Nos. 1 and 2. AMMUJS'ITION MULE. Pig. 23. To Pack the Wheels (Pig. 22).— The gunner and No. 3 lift the wheels and place them separately on the pack, 38 A HANDBOOK FOR LIOHT ARTILLERY. where they are secured by No. 4j No. 4 places and secures the lifting-bars; Nos. 3 and 5 take off their haversacks and secure them on the wheel-pack. Unpaching is performed in the reverse order to packing, WEIGHT CAEBIED BT EACH MULE. Gun-mule. Carriage-mule. Saddle Gun .. 69 lbs. ..218 " 287 " Saddle 69 lbs. Carriage 205 " 374 " Wheel-mule. Ammunition-mule. Saddle Wheels Shafts, etc .. 60 lbs. ..133 " ..33 " 305 " Saddle 581bs. Two chests with 8 rounds each 380 " 838 " Mo UNTAIN-ABTILLEB Y, 39 CHAPTER II. The Pack-train. How Packed. PACK-TRAINS. Gen. Holabird says : A pack-mule carries on an aTerage 200 pounds. Allow one pack-mule to six or seven men for detachments out scouting from five to eight days ; twelve mules to two officers and sixty or seventy men for six days; eight mules to one officer and fifty men of cavalry for six days. The above allowance does not contemplate the carrying of forage. Cavalry drill-regulations state: With fifty packs there should be twelve packers. Bach troop should have four mess-boxes, seven-eighths inch lumber, dovetailed, 11 inches by 18 inches by 26 inches, and, when packed in pack-cover, without lids. In camp or garrison, logs of wood, 26 inches long, and sacks of corn, double-sacked and lashed to avoid breaking sacks, having the weight it is intended the mule should carry, are kept on hand for drill purposes. Each pack should be provided with two coils of three- eighths inch rope, 18 to 28 feet long, for lashing packs. The pack-saddle consists of the saddle proper; two pads; crupper; corona;' manta or pack-cover; two pieces of canvas, each 84 inches by 22 inches, stitched together on the long edges; halter and strap; canvas cincJia, 10 inches wide; ,sling-rope, half -inch best hand-laid manilla whale-line, 20 to 32 feet long; and leather cincha, with 40 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. h-rope, five-eighths inch whale-line 42 feet long. There should be one blind for every five packs. The size of rope is given by the measurement of its diameter. A "full-rigged" saddle has sling -straps and cargo- cincha ; the sling and lash ropes are then dispensed with. While saddling, loading, or readjusting the packs, the animals should be blinded. The mules should be trained to stand perfectly quiet while the blind is on; they should never be led or forced to move without first removing the blind. TO FIT THE SADDLE. The pack-saddle is fitted to the animal in a manner similar to that of the riding-saddle; it is so constructed that it can be placed one and one-half inches farther for- ward than the riding-saddle. If the pads are not square, draw the screws, unlace the pads from the skirts, then square and fit them to the ani- mal by placing the canvas cincha immediately around the animal's girth, the front edge touching the breast-bone (cartilages of true ribs), the middle of the cincha being exactly in the middle of the lower edges of the pads; then screw the pads to the saddle-bars, keeping the cincha in place till the adjustment is made; then remove the cincha and relace the pads. Adjust the canvas cincha so as to be long enough to go nearly around the girth of the mule, over the saddle. Adjust the crupper by lengthening or shortening the lace-strings that attach it to the saddle, taking care not to make it too tight. TO SADDLE Place the corona on the mule's back, about two to two and one half inches in front of where the pommel end of MOUNTAm-ABTILLERT. 41 the saddle is to rest; place the folded saddle-blanket oyer the corona; take the saddle by both yokes and place it squarely in position, a little in rear of its proper place; place the crupper under the dock and gently move the saddle forward to position; pass the ring end of the canvas cincha over the saddle from left to right and under the belly; pass the latigo through the ring and tighten the cincha; when cinched, the ring end of the cincha should be above the lower edge of the near pad. CARGOES. The rations should be carefully put up in one-hundred- pound packs lashed solidly, and carried on the best pack- mules; each pack is plainly marked with its contents and weight. Salt, sugar, cofEee, and beans are double-sacked, and lashed in one-hundred-pound packages. Bacon, in one- hundred-pound packages, is packed in from five to eight pounds of clean straw or hay, double-sacked and lashed firmly. The yeast-powder cases should be opened and hay or straw stuffed closely around the boxes to prevent shaking, and, with other articles, lashed into one-hundred-pound packages. Each cargo is in two side-packs of about one hundred to one hundred and twenty-five pounds each, and should match in size, shape, and weight as nearly as practicable, each side-pack having, as nearly as may be, the following proportions: width one half more than thickness, length nearly one half more than the width; e. g., 13 inches by 18 inches by 25 inches. All the salt, sugar, coffee, and beans should not be placed in one cargo. Ammunition should be in cargoes. Pads or cushions of hay 26 inches by 44 inches may be 42 A HANDBOOK FOB. LIGHT ABTILLmT. placed under the eincha to keep long and rough packs from the animal's hips and shoulders. TO LOAD CARGO. The packers should work by threes, designated Nos. 1, 3, and 3. No. 1 is on the near side. No. 2 on the ofE side of the mule; when No. 3 works with No. 1 he is nearest the croup; when with No. 2 he is opposite the mule's shoulders. The mule is placed near to and with its left side next to the cargo by No. 3, who then puts on the blind. No. 1, on the near side, passes the centre of the sling- rope over the saddle to the ofE side far enough to allow the rope to pass over the off-side pack and come back within his reach, the parts of the rope separated by six to twelve inches. Nos. 2 and 3 take the off-side pack, place it well up on the saddle; No. 3 grasps the loop of the sling-rope with his right hand, brings the rope up against the pack and lets the loop drop over his right shoulder in readiness to pass it over the pack; No. 3 holds the pack in place. No. 3 passes to the near side and with No. 1 takes the near-side pack and places it, flat side next the mule, well up on the saddle, lapping the upper edge well over the upper edge of the off-side pack. No. 1, with his back to the mule's shoulder, takes the end of the front part of the sling-rope, passes it from the outside through the loop, and pulls it down with the right hand; he now grasps the rear end of the sling-rope with the left hand, and ties the ends together in a square bow-knot, the packs high up. No. 1 calls out, "Settle" ; No. 1 and No. 3 each grasps his side of the cargo by the lower corners, lifts upward and outward, settling the upper edges well together and bal- ancing the load. If the packs are tied too high they are easily lowered, but if tied too low they must be lifted and placed as in the first trial. MO TTNTAIN-ARTlLLEliT. 43 While Nos. 1 and 2 are tying and placing the cargo. No. 3 takes the lash-rope, throws the free end to the rear of the mule, convenient to No. 2, and places the cincha end in front of No. 1. No. 1 grasps the rope with the Fia. 24, right hand, three feet from the cincha, and passes the hook end of the cincha under the mule to No. 2, who takes the hook (if, Fig. 24) in the left hand; No. 1 with the left hand grasps the rope three feet above the right, raises the Near aj'g eo«) g HH ce O i-i r-4 -^^ lO CO S'k.M t-i -."^ 'Eo S OS • ■ S^e lO CO 00 00 00 00 CQ »n5 1 '-«"||i s § ^^° OOTii T3 to coco [^ s t4 P lOGO if Ca t- o OJ^ a l- ?H lO IN CO ai ■a i gS ■S.S ■ 00 S eocs E3 S'S g W,-|Osg|j (M O . J> . c3 CO CO ec«3 o e •g^ OSl-HlHOO !0 1-1 CO lO fl a?s CO CO 1 . .OIO OO -H i> ?C o oS OOOSOJ OO 00 OS »a- T-i tH ZO f-t •i cS 050005 5O50 io3 ■ -oco OS« 3 ©i'o QO.-I— OS K y- bl a totooso ■*■* OO to to ■5 « C-0-* C-O j§ u ■ • T-H OO £- « t- OStH rH « 10 ^ QD • *-H « V si OOJ 03 03 OS 00 oco OO -^-s o-r: o a-3 • ■«-* (>;* OS S O g <» M '-' M g CO qo 1 100-5IH os« « « O iH la t- .s c S-St^ OS CO was T-l -i* S • .50C- 003 «o '-I 1 1 t-S" »T-1 OS 1-1 • 9 : « ■ O ni Weight (full), lbs Bursting-charge, Kumbev of bullet Initial velocity, f. 4 0) .0 ■i ■is 1 -> 5 1 ft P- (1- a a '3 3 tH S M fl is >H S p CQ ^ fl PART II. FIELD- AB TILLER Y. CHAPTER I. Construction of Field-guns. DETAILS OF CONSTRUCTION OP FIELD-ARTILLJIRT GUNS (LATEST MODEL). The guns described in this and the next chapter are built-up guns made of low steel, and all the parts are tem- pered in oil. The tube enters the jacket from the front* and has shoulders upon it, which come in contact with correspond- ing shoulders in the jacket. These shoulders prevent any forward movement of the tube or rear movement of the jacket. The tube tapers from in front of the jacket to the muzzle, which ends in a swell. The exterior of the jacket is made up of a series of tapering surfaces. On the interior surface, starting from the rear end, there are first, the seat for the carrier-ring in the jacket, which also contains the slotted and threaded sectors for holding the breech-block; in front of this is the tapering gas- check seat in the tube; and forward of this is the cylin- drical powder-chamber, which is connected to the shot- chamber by a slope. The shot-chamber also is cylindrical and connected with the bore by a slope. * In tlie model of 1885 it enters from the rear. 73 MELD-ARTILLERT. n The vent being axial in the model of '90, enters the powder-chamber through and along the axis of the spindle of the obturator. In front of the gas-check seat in the model of '85 there is a cylindrical surface leading to the ellipsoidal powder-chamber, which is connected with the shot-chamber by a slope, and the radial vent entei% 12^ inches from the rear face of the jacket and at the maximum diameter of the powder-chamber. The vent- piece, made of copper, is screwed into position, the part projecting above the surface of the piece being rectangular. The Bbebch Mechanism. The principal parts are the breech-block, the carrier- ring, the obturator, the lever-handle, the bronze handle, and the vent-cover. THE BEEECH-BLOCK. Pig. 30. The Block, Fig. 30, is threaded for a distance of four inches from its forward end, and the circumference of the thread is divided into six equal parts. The threads of the block are 74 A HANDBOOK POlt LIGHT ABTILLERT. remoTed along three alternate sectors, as is usual in the interrupted-screw fermature, to allow the block to slide in the corresponding slotted sectors in the jacket (or base- ring in earlier model). The threaded sectors engage in the corresponding slotted sectors in the breech-block, but one sixth of a turn of the block will engage the screw-threads of both. The interior of the block is bored out to form the obtu- rator-spindle recess. At the end of the block are two lugs for the lever- handle. On the right one is a shoulder which limits the motion of the lever-handle. The Nose is the front end of the block, slightly reduced in diameter in order to partly enter the gas-check seat. The Stop-groove, into which the stop on the carrier-ring enters, is in the planed sector on the left-hand side. The Latch-groove (Fig. 31) is in two parts, one longitudinal id), at the front end of the block, and the other transverse Fig. 31. (ffl), at the rear end. The stem of the latch drops into the front groove (e) when the block is withdrawn, and into the rear groove {b) when the block is revolved into its firing position, in each case unlocking the carrier-ring from the jacket — in the first case, so that it maybe swung back; MELD-ARTILLEB Y. 75 in the second, to prevent the breaking of the latch when the gun is discharged. The locking-recess (e) is at the front end of the longitu- dinal latch-groove. The stem of the latch drops into it when the block is withdrawn, and thus locks the block positively to the carrier-ring. The Guide-groove is the cylindrical recess at the rear of the block in which the guide-sectors move when the block is rotated. THE CAEBIBE-EISTG. z. / n e d' ^ s >3 Fig. 33. The Guide-sectors (5, Fig. 33) are three projections from the interior of the carrier-ring (A), which fit in the slotted sectors of the breech-rblock and guide it during its motion through the carrier -ring. The Latch- cover (%) is a separate piece which covers the latch and its spring, and is secured to the carrier-ring by two screws (/). On removing this plate the latch and spring can be taken out. 76 A HANDBOOK FOR LIQBT ARTILLERY. The Latch (/in Fig. 33) fits in a recess in the carrier- ring on the right side. It is acted on by a spring (5, Pig. 33), which pushes it constantly toward the axis of the carrier-ring. Its inner end or stem (a) rests on the surface of one of the slotted sectors, ex- cept at the end of its travel, when it drops into the corre- sponding recess in the block. As long as its stem rests on the surface of the sector its outer end or nose projects beyond the exterior surface of the carrier- ring, and, entering a recess in the jacket, locks the carrier-ring to the jacket. When the stem Fig. 33. drops into its recesses, the nose of the latch is withdrawn by the action of the spring and the carrier-ring is unlocked. The front face of the latch has a recess (A), into which fits a hardened stud (s) that is screwed into the rear face of the jacket. This stud acting against the recess lifts the latch out of its locking-recess in the breech-block, and holds it in a position such that the stem can pass up the inclined grooye. In order that the stud may act on the latch, a hole {g) is drilled through the front face of the carrier-ring for the stud to pass through. The functions of the latch-spring have already been ex- plained. The Stop (c. Fig. 32) enters the carrier-ring on the left side between the lugs (e), and projects beyond the bore of the carrier-ring, entering a groove in the breech-block which is cut for it. This stop limits the travel of the block to the rear in withdrawing it, and also limits its rota- tion. The Hinge-pin enters the lugs (e) of the carrier-ring and FIELD-ARTILLBB Y. 77 a corresponding lug on the jacket from below, and the carrier-ring swings around it in opening. The bore is the diameter of the ring across guide-sectors. The exterior taper forms the surface of contact of car- rier-ring with jacket. The lugs (e) are the bearings for the hinge-pin. The carrier-ring, as its name indicates, carries the breech-block when the latter is withdrawn, and by means of it the block may be swung round out of the way for loading. THE DE BANGE OBTURATOR. Fig. 34. The principal parts are : the spindle (a) ; the front cup {/) ; the rear cup (/') ; the pad {g) ; the spring {j) ; the nut (A) ; the spline-screw {k). The spindle has a mushroomrshaped head (6), and a stem, which extends through the breech-block and termi- nates in a screw-thread. The breech-block is recessed cor- respondingly. In guns with axial vents, the vent (c), 0.3 inch in diameter, passes through the axis of the spindle. 78 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. and the copper bushing (d) is inserted by pressure at the front end. The front and rear gas-check cups are of steel, and hold between them a plastic pad made of certain proportions of asbestos and tallow and coTered with canvas (with disks of copper (w) on either side in the revised model, and a diagonally-split ring {n) of steel is used to cut oflE the es- cape of gas. A spiral spring ( /) surrounds the stem of the obturator at the rear of the block, and bears against a shoulder on the block and a hut (A) on the screw-thread of the spindle. This spring, which acts to press the spindle back, keeps the cups and pad in place, takes up any set of the pad due to firing, and prevents the fracture of the screwed end of the stem. The spline-screw ijc) holds the nut on the spindle in position and prevents its unscrewing when the pad sticks in its seat after firing. THE FRETRB OBTUBATOE. Pia. 35. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. Y9 The principal parts are (Fig. 35) : the spindle (a) ; the gas-check ring (/) ; the spring (e) ; the obturator-nut {d) ; the locking-nut {d'), or the spline-screw. The Spindle has a head(5') at the forward end, its surface being plane and its sides conical, with the larger diameter of the cone in front. The vent (c), 0.3 inch in diameter, passes through the axis of the spindle, and the copper bushing (c) is inserted by pressure at the front end. The Gas-check Ring (/) is nearly triangular in section, coming to a point at the front. It fits accurately on the conical surface of the head of the spindle, and is slightly longer in the direction of the axis of the bore than this head. Its rear surface rests against the front surface of the block, while the rear surface of the head is not in con- tact with this front surface, and can only be brought in contact with it by a heavy pressure, which will expand the gas-check ring. The Spring (e) acts against a shoulder in the block and a corresponding shoulder on the obturator-spindle, and tends to press the spindle forward. The Obturator-nut {d) prevents the action of the spring from forcing the spindle too far forward, and also regulates the tension of the spring. The spline-screw acts as in the de Bange system. This screw is used in place of the locking-nut {d') shown in figure. THE LBVBB-HAIfDLB. (See Fig. 37.) This handle (A) acts as a lever to rotate the block, its head acting as a cam to withdraw the block and obturator when the latter sticks after firing, and to lock the block in the carrier-ring and prevent rotation during firing. It is supported in the lugs {I) of the breech-block by a pin (e) and rotates with the pin j to which it is secured by a screw 80 A HANDBOOK FOR LIQBT ARTILLERY. entering Tsrtically. The head of this pin has a projection (a) which strikes against the corresponding stop on the right lug and limits the motion of the lever-handle. THE BEOlfZE-HANDLE. (See Fig. 37.) This handle {g) is attached to the breech-block by two screws. Its purpose is to assist in withdrawing and push- ing in the breech-block. THE VENT-COVEB. "3 -C i L- \ In — . Pig. 36. For Axial Vent.— A radial slot («, Fig. 36) is made in the rear part of the breech-block, in which slides a piece of metal (6) having a pin (c) projecting from its forward face next the gun. This pin fits into a groove {d) cut in the rear face of the carrier-ring, which is eccentric at its lower end, so' that when the block is placed in firing position the slide is raised and the vent uncovered. For Radial Vent. — This consists of a long arm, secured in position on top of the gun so that it can slide. The under side at its rear end has a slight projection, which engages over a shoulder on the lever-handle. When the le^er-handle is raised a shoulder on it bears against the end FIELD-ABTILLEB Y. 81 of the arm, pushes it forward and covers the vent; when the block is in firing position and the lever-handle is low- ered the shoulder bears against the projection and draws back the arm, thereby uncovering the vent, ACTION OF THE BEEBOH MEOHAinSM:. Fig. 37. Suppose the breech closed and the gun ready for firing. In this position the threads of the breech-block are engaged in the threads of the jacket (revised model) or base-ring (model '85); the gas-check is in its seat; the lower end of the latch is at the end of the transverse groove in the block; the nose of the latch is withdrawn from its re- cess in the jacket, and the carrier-ring is unlocked; the lever-handle is vertical, its cam in the recess in the carrier- ring, and its lower end in the recess in the jacket. To Open the Breech. — Grasp the lever -handle (A, Fig. 37) with the left hand, thumb down, and raise it until it strikes the stop, then rotate the block as far as possible to the left; 82 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. lower the lever-handle: its cam (d), acting against the sur- face (?•) of the carrier-ring, will withdraw the gas-check if it sticks in its seat. This rotation of the block pushes the latch into its recess and locks the carrier-ring to the jacket. Grasp the bronze-handle {g) with the right hand, thumb to the right, and withdraw the block until it comes up against the stop. In this position the stem of the latch drops into the locking-recess, locking the block to the carrier-ring, and at the same time unlocking the carrier- ring from the jacket; swing the block and carrier-ring around to the left and insert the projectile and charge. To Close the Breech. — Seize the bronze-handle with the right hand, thumb to the right, and swing the carrier-ring and block around until the carrier-ring is in its seat, grasp- ing the lever-handle with the left hand, thumb down, at the same time, and raising the handle until it strikes the stop. The carrier-ring should be brought up to its seat sharply, but without slamming, and should be held/firmly for an instant, otherwise the ring may start back slightly from the jar and the retracting-stud fail to hold the latch- pin high enough to allow the block to move forward. When the carrier-ring strikes its seat the retracting-stud enters the hole in the front face of the ring, and, acting on the recess in the latch, lifts the latch to its travelling- posi- tion, that is, lifts it out of the locking-recess and holds it in such a position that when the block is pushed forward, the lower end of the latch will strike the inclined surface at the front of the longitudinal groove. Kaise the lever-handle until it rests against the stop, and push the block forward until it' stops. During this travel the lower end of the latch has moved up the inclined surface of the longitudinal groove and has locked the carrier-ring to the jacket. , Eevolve the block one sixth of a turn until it strikes the stop; lower the lever-h9,ndle to its proper position, when FIELD-ABTILLEB T. 83 CTerything will be in the condition first described, the vent will be uncovered, and the gun will be ready for firing. When the block is revolved one sixth of a turn the lower end of the latch gradually drops into its groove, unlocking the carrier-ring, which remains so during firing. INSTEUCTIONS FOR DISMOUNTING. 1. Raise the lever-handle and turn the breech-block to the left. 3. Take out hinge-pin screws and remove the hinge-pin. 3. Withdraw the breech-block with carrier-ring. 4. Take out the latch-cover screws and remove the latch- cover, latch-spring, and latch. 5. Take out the stop-screw and remove the stop. 6. Take off the carrier-ring. 9. 10, De Bange Obturator. Remove the spline-screw and take off the nut. Take out the spindle. Take out the spring. Take ofE the obturator cups and pad. Freyre Obturator. 7. Remove the spline-screw and take ofE the nut. 8. Take out the spindle. 9. Take out the spring. 10. Take off the gas-check ring and face-plate. INSTRUCTIONS FOE ASSEMBLING. De Bange Obturator. Put the obturator cups and pad in place on spindle. Put in the spring. Pat in the spindle. Screw on the nut, and put in the spline- §crew. Freyre Obturator. Put the gas-check ring and face - plate in place. 2. Put in the spring. 3. Put in the spindle. 4. Screw on the nut, and put in the spline- screw. 1. 84 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLEBT. 5. Put the carrier-ring on the breech-block. 6. Put in the stop and screw. 7. Put in the latch, the latch-spring; put on the latch- corer and screws. 8. Insert the breech-block with carrier-ring into the gun. 9. Put in the hinge-pin and screws. 10. Lock the block. Experiments are now being made with the view of in- troducing metallic ammunition, and it is possible that a breech mechanism similar to the Driggs-Schroeder or the Gerdom will be adopted. A general description of each is therefore given, and also the proposed method of supply- ing ammunition. The Dbiggs-Schkobder Breech Mechanism. Fig. 2,1a. The cuts show the positions of the block when locked, when un- locked, and when revolved to the rear. The breech-block (5), weighing 31 lbs., has bands (c) on top and sides that fit in corresponding grooves in the FIBLB-ARTILLER7. 85 jacket ; these bands have an inclination of 2| degrees to the front and upward to secure complete obturation and facilitate locking and unlocking. There is a transverse hole (i) through the block for the main bolt (d) ; it is lengthened in a nearly vertical direction so that the first motion of the operating-handle causes, by the action of the main cam (e), the block to descend and disengage the bands from the grooves in the breech, after which the block rotates to the rear and rests on the tray. Guide-bolts {k), screwed through each side of the curtain, project into guide-grooves {I) cut in each side of the block and confine its movement. The main cam, firing-pin and spring, and sear and sear- spring are contained in the block, the front face of which bears a heavy removable plate (a). The firing-pin has under its rear part full-cock and half- cock studs; and the sear, actuated by its spring, presses up against it and engages the studs in succession as the firing- pin is forced to the rear by the action of the main cam against the lug on the under side of the firing-pin. The point of this lug always rests in the circular groove in the upper rear face of the main cam. The extractors [j), one on either side, lie flat against the rear face of the tube of the gun and in recesses in the front face of the block. They revolve oh pivots which work in recesses in the curtain. The rear sides of the tails of the extractors and the lower front corners of the breech-block form cam surfaces so arranged that when the block rotates to the rear the extractors extract and eject the cartridge- case. The spring lock on the handle prevents the main bolt and block from moving, when the breech is closed, under stress other than that applied directly to the handle. 86 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. TO DISMOUNT. 1. Back out the guide-bolts far enough to clear the guide-grooves. 2. Half-cock. 3. Take off handle. 4. Tap the main bolt gently to start it and withdraw it completely, supporting the block with the hand. 5. Lower the block out of place, tilting it slightly to the rear so as to clear the extractors. THE BEEBCH-BLOCK BEING OUT, TO TAKE THE MECHAN- ISM APART. 1. Pull-cock the firing-pin before removing the face- plate. 2. Kemove face-plate. 3. Ease firing-pin for- ward and remove finger-catch. 4. Take out main cam, firing-pin, and spring. 5. Push sear-plug in a little, turn it until the stud is fair for coming out, and remove it and the sear and spring. TO ASSEMBLE THE MECHANISM. Proceed in the reverse order. Put in successively the firing-pin spring, the firing-pin, and the main cam. The front side of this cam is marked "out." The firing-pin must be full-cocked before putting on the face-plate and then let down to lialf-cock. An arrow on the head of the main bolt being brought in line with the arrow on the cur- tain indicates the proper " square " for the hexagonal bear- ing in the cam. Gerdom Eapid-firing Breech Mechanism. The breech-block has two threaded and two plain sectors (each 90 degrees) with corresponding sectors in the breech of the gun, so that the block is locked or unlocked by a quarter of a turn. The block contains a firing-pin which, with its spring, is inserted from the front end of the block. FtELD-ARTlLLMRT. Bl which is then clos'ed by a threaded cap. The centre hole in this cap permits the striking end of the pin to come through to the front in certain positions of the block and to hit the primer. The rear end of the block is counter- sunk to receive the operating-lever, the locking-latch and its spring, the cocking-lever and its hinge-pin, the trunnioned collar, the notched cap, and the sear and its spring. The extracting-device engages in front of the cartridge- head and grips it for more than one eighth of its circum- ference. Its motion is guided parallel to the axis of the piece by two cylindrical arms working in slots cut in the breech. Swinging the carrier-ring around its pivot causes the extracting-device first to act as a wedge to loosen the cartridge-case, and then by a rapid motion the case is thrown out of the gun, or far enough to the rear in the breech to be easily removed by hand. The operation of the mechanism of the gun is as follows: The operating-lever is seized with the left hand, and a handle on the right rear face of the carrier-ring with the right hand. The lever is pulled slightly more than 90° to the left. The first motion of the lever unlocks the cooking-latch ; the remainder of the motion rotates the block in the carrier- ring, disengaging the screw-threads. During this motion of rotation the cocking-lever has pulled back the firing- pin, which is held in position by an edge of the sear engag- ing under a notch on the screw-cap. The carrier-ring is then swung to the left by the handle in the right hand. The block moves to the left with the ring and passes partly through the slot out of the breech and uncovers the bore. The first motion of the ring loosens the cartridge-case, as before described, and then ejects it. The new charge is 88 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLBRT. then thrown in, no care being taken to seat it; the ring swung to, and the block rotated and locked. As soon as the block is locked, pulling the sear fires the gun. FIXED AMMUKITION". Smokeless powder will be used, about If lbs. forming the charge. The shell, cast iron, weighs 16 lbs. and also contains a bursting-charge of 8 oz. of powder. The shrapnel will be similar to the Frankford Arsenal shrapnel now manufactured, but longer and heavier (16 lbs. 10 oz.), and will break into about 240 pieces (balls and fragments). The metallic case, brass or aluminum, has the projectile inserted in it to the distance of 1.75 inches, the base of the projectile being separated from the powder-charge by a felt wad. The total length of a round is 18.33 inches. Experiments with charges of Troisdorf powder from 1 lb. 8 oz. to 3 lbs. 1 oz. have given with the 3.2-inch gun Telocities from 1765 to 2032 ft. -sec. Supplying Ammunition. — It is proposed to haye boxes that can be readily opened and closed containing a cer- tain number of rounds, about ten for 3.3-inch gun, carried by the supply-train. When a battery requires ammuni- tion, the boxes will be taken from the ammunition-wagon, opened and the chests filled. The empty metallic cases with the battery are then placed in the boxes, which are securely closed, loaded on the ammunition-wagon and returned to the depot by the officer in charge; and are from there returned by the ordnance officer to the Frank- ford Arsenal to be again filled and prepared for service. The cost of supplying ammunition by this method will be less than it is now. PIELD-ARTILLEB T. CHAPTER II. 3.3-inch Guns. Sights. Ammunition. Fuzes. Range Table. 3.3-INCH B. L. RIFLE, MODEL 1885 (MODIFIED). (Fig. 38.) Material steel Total length 7.56 feet Calibre 3.2 inches Weight 839 pounds Grooves 34 Twist of rifling, uniform 1 turn in 30 calibres Axis of trunnions above ground 3.56 feet Powder-chamber ellipsoidal Vent radial Preponderance 50 pounds Muzzle velocity 1685 ft. -sec. Maximum range for shrapnel * 6613 yards This gun consists of a tube {a), jacket (b), trunnion- ring (c), sleeve (d), key-ring (e), locking-ring (/), base- ring (g), and breech mechanism, De Bange obturator, vent-bushing of copper. 3.3-rNCH B. L. RIFLE, MODEL '90. (Fig. 39.) Material steel Total length 7.31 feet Calibre.. 3.3 inches Weight 794 pounds Grooves 34 ( 1 turn in 50 to Twist of rifling, increasing. ........ -j j ^^^^ 5^,35 csMhKS * The point at which the projectile has a remaining velocity of 500 ft, -sec, the minimum at which shrapnel is effective. 90 A HANDBOOK FOB L1G3T AUTlLLBRT. Axis of trunnions above ground 3.56 feet Powder-chamber cylindrical Vent axial Preponderance 31 lbs. Muzzle velocity 1685 ft. -sec. Maximum range for shrapnel 6613 yards Distance between sights 30.7 inches This gun consists of tube {g), jacket (/»), and breech mechanism, De Bange obturator, vent-bushing of copper. The jacket, trunnion-ring, base-ring, and sleeve, of the model of 1885, form one piece, and the key-ring is omit- ted, as the tube and jacket are locked firmly together by shoulders (a, b, c) m rear and shoulders in front, -with a projection on the tube that fits into a corresponding recess in the jacket. d is the powder-chamber, / the slope from no lands to maximum lands, and e the connecting slope for seat of rotary band. The vent-cover is a pin working in a slot in the face of the carrier-ring. (See Pig. 36.) SIGHTS. The Front Sight (Fig. 40) is attached to the right rim-base. e-f- d- c'"- b -Jl Vk_ r a Fig. 40. : and consists of the base a, the standard 6, and the cylinder c, all formed in one piece. The cylinder c is a bushing open FIELD-ABTILLBRT. 91 rm m—? %3, ^. J" <>!.-.! F ns i Fig. 38. -«■' -) Kg, 39. 92 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLBRT. ^^ at both ends, the interior being formed of two conical frustums c' joined at their smaller bases and having at this junction cross-wires (+), d, of platinum, which give the exact centre of the sight. In the new sights the cross- wires of watch-spring are placed diagonally (x). The cross-wires are used with the peep of the breech-sight, and the point e on top is used with the open sight. The Breech-sight (Fig. 41) consists of a tangent scale af- fixed to a circular base revolv- ing in a plane normal to the axis of the piece to compensate for inclination of trunnions when on uneven ground. The scale moves laterally on its base to correct lor wind and drift, and bears a spirit-level, /. Along the vertical limb, C, of the sight, which is slotted, moves an eye-piece, D, actuated by a screw, d. This eye-piece (bear- ing the peep-sight d') extends on either side of the slot, the lower edge being horizontal and bevelled. The one on the right is graduated into ten equal parts, fhe vertical limb being graduated into de- grees (0 to 15°), and then sub- divided by diagonals into sixths, a diagonal scale of equal parts reading to minutes d' // e' D LjdL e' '•A Fig. 41, is obtained. The rear sights now being issued have range FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 93 scales in yards for shell and shrapnel engraved upon the sight in addition to the degree scale. The scale of yards for shrapnel on the rear face of the sight, left side, is arranged with diagonal lines, to be read in the same manner as the degree scale. Each diagonal embraces 350 yards of range, and there are five divisions on the upper edge of the slide, by which this space is sub-divided, so that the intervals of 50 yards in range are read directly from the scale. The scale of yards for shell, on the front face of the sight, is marked for each 100 yards of range, and is read from an index line on the slide. The 'horizontal limb, or cross-bar, e, which is actuated by the screws e'e', is graduated into spaces, each of which corresponds to a deviation equal to -^-^ of the range. (In future constructions this division will correspond to -j-dV-b- of the range.) This variation is tabulated in the range table under the heading " Deflection for one division of the horizontal scale." By means of a pivot, B, the sight proper is attached to the stem A, the axis of rotation being at the zero of the scale. The stem tapers so as to fit into the sight-socket fixed at the breech. A pin projecting from the stem, and fitting in a recess in the socket, insures the sight being properly placed on the gun. The sight is first levelled and clamped by means of the clamp-screw a before sighting. Vertical and horizontal changes for elevation, drift, etc., are given by the thumb- screws d and e'e'. THE POIKTING ARC. (Fig. 41a.) This instrument, now under consideration for use with field-artillery, to replace wholly or in part the rear sight, is made principally of bronze, and comprises the arc a, the slide b, and the level-piece c. 94 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. The arc has f wo small seating plates, d d, secured to its base by countersnuk screws. The slide is connected to the arc by a dovetail-joint, and moves over it, the friction of a spring keeping the slide in any desired position. The tension of this spring is ad- justed by the two screws on the side of the slide. Fig. 41a. The steel pin on the under surface of the slide moves in the groove on the upper surface of the arc, and, by abutting against the steel stop-pins e at each end of the groove, pre- vents the slide from being moved off the arc. The arc is graduated from to 20 degrees, but readings to 2 minutes are obtained by means of the vernier, /, at the rear of the slide. Plates, graduated in yards for shell or shrapnel, are on either side of the arc. They are removable, being gradu- ated for the piece with which the arc is used. The zero index-marks on the sides of th.e slide are sup- plemented by two others equidistant, plus 2 degrees and minus 3 degrees. Any one of the three may be used in setting the slide to a desired range in yards, FIBLD-ABTTLLBBT. 95 The top of the slide has a scale, graduated 3 degrees on either side of the zero, with sub-divisions of 6 minutes; the markings plus and minus are the reverse of those on the side of the slide. The vernier, g, on the level-piece permits of a least reading of 2 minutes being obtained. Motion is given the level-piece by the deflection-screw h. To set the pointing arc, make the zero of the level-piece coincide with the zero of the slide-scale, and then take the required elevation in yards on the side desired. Should the piece and object fired at be on different levels, and the angle known, the index of the level is moved to indicate this angle — to the plus side if an elevation, and to the minus side if a depression; then take the elevation in yards as before. The correction is made in this way for 3 degrees or less, but for angles above 3, up to 5 degrees, the 2-degree marks on the side of the slide must be used, the index mark of the level being moved to coincide with the mark corre- sponding to the number of degrees — elevation or depres- sion — less 2 degrees. The plus 2-degree mark is used as an index when the object has an elevation, and the minus 2-degree mark when a depression. To obtain the angle corresponding to difference of level, sight the piece on the object by the ordinary sight, using any elevation; set the pointing arc at this elevation, and move the level-piece by the deflecting-screw until the air- bubble is centred. The index of the level-piece then points to the desired angle — plus if an elevation, and minus if a depression. If the wheels of the carriage be not on the same level the gun will shoot towards the lower wheel. A correction for this is made by a deflection-scale. The correction for deflection due to inclination of trun- nions, expressed in units of the deflection-scale, is, at any range, equal to the product of the angle of elevation and 96 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEB7. the angle of inclination of the trunnions, both expressed in degrees, into a constant multiplier. When the divisions of the deflection-scale are -^^ of the distance between the sights this multiplier is 0.1523; when the divisions are y^^it is 0.3046. The rear sight must be moved towards the higher wheel. Ammunition sok 3.2-iisrcH Gun. The ordinary friction-primer is used for radial vents; for axial vents an attachment is made to the friction- primer of a thin brass wire about 18 inches long, looped or coiled for convenience, and having one end fastened in the loop of the friction-wire, and the other around the head of the body of the friction-primer. The cartridge-bag is used, but experiments are now be- ing made with metallic cases. (This proposed metallic am- munition for 3.2-inch guns comprises a projectile weighing 16^ pounds, with a suitable charge of smokeless powder to give an initial velocity of 1450 ft.-sec.) Charge of powder 1 ip°'i?'^ipU^ero.hex. Weight of projectile filled 13 J " Burstiog-charge of shell 7 ounces Bursting-charge of shrapnel 3 " Shell, shrapnel, and canister are used. Shell. — The base-percussion-fuze shell (Fig. 42) is made of cast iron in one piece, having a band of soft brass or copper forced into a recess on the outside, | of an inch from the base. The body and half of the head are painted black; the half of the head nearest the point is painted vermilion. Canister.— The canister (Pig. 43) consists of a hollow cylin- FIELB-ABTILLEB T. 97 der of malleable iron, with one end closed by a cast head. The case is filled with from 222 to 226 balls, and a metal cover is inserted. Around the case are several slits, their ends overlap- ping to secure the thorough breaking up of the case on dis- charge. There are several small holes in the head, through which a portion of the gas of the ex- ploded powder-charge enters, drives forward the balls, and as- sists in disrupting the case. Total weight of a round, 11 lbs. 10 oz. Fig. 43. This projectile is painted black. Shrapnel. — The Frankford Ar- senal shrapnel (Fig. 44) weighs 13f^ lbs. Exclusive of filling it consists of three parts, viz., head {d), body (a), and base (J). The head is made of cast iron, bored and threaded to re- ceive the fuze, and contains a pow- der-chamber which is lacquered to prevent danger of premature igni- tion by friction. The body is made of lap-welded wrought-iron or low- steel tubing, and is weakened for fracture by circular and longitudinal grooves on the inside. It contains 163 hardened lead balls, ^ inch in diameter, which are assembled in circular layers and held in position Fig. 44. by cast-iron separators, which increase the effect of eX' 9-8 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. plosion by furnishing additional fragments. The base is made of cast iron threaded to screw into the cylindrical case, and is so formed as to provide a support for the cop- per band to prevent deformation of the case at this point from shock of discharge, c is the rotating band. This projectile is painted, body black, head vermilion. Total weight, ready for firing 13 lbs. 10 oz. Total number of balls and individual pieces. 301 BuTSting-charge 3 ounces SHRAPNEL MADE BY AMEBICAlir PKOJBCTILE CO. (Fig, 45.) The entire case is of wrought steel electrically welded together so as to form a complete hard- ened wrought-sfceel case with- out joint. The powder-chamber is formed in the base by a hard wrought-steel diaphragm {d) sup- ported by a cast-iron spider, and connected through the centre of the shell (axially) to the fuze-open- ing by a cast-iron tube. It is smooth-finished, and either tinned or lacquered. The shell contains 170 bullets (34 to the pound) packed in circular layers, and they are held firmly in position by a resin matrix. The bullets are in- troduced through a hole at c. The exterior is painted as fol- lows : body from the band for- ward, to include three fifths of head, black ; remaining part of head, and part of body in rear of The band is of copper. Fig. 45. band, vermilion. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 99 Total weight of projectile complete 13^ pounds Total number of balls and individual pieces 238 Weight of bursting-charge 3 ounces The Prankford Arsenal combination fuze is used. This fuze weighs 17^ ounces; but if made of aluminum it will weigh only 7f oz. For field-artillery guns it is graduated from 1 to 15 seconds, the graduations being based upon the time of burning in flight. Each entire second is marked by a through-hole in the cone-cover, and each of these spaces is sub-divided into six equal spaces by holes nearly through the cover, which for the 3.2-inch gun will corre- spond to the following distances, viz. : 70 yards at 1000 yards range; 55 yards at 2000 yards range; 48 yards at 3000 yards range; 42 yards at 4000 yards range. The following table gives the mean of five shots in each group : Seconds. Range. 2 ..,, 888 yards 3 1401 " 5 1966 " 6 3438 " 8 3037 " 9 3461 " 13 4335 " The Feankfoed Arsenal Combiitatioh" Fuze, 15 Sec- onds, Model 1894, eor Sheapnbl of Field-guns. This is a time and percussion fuze (Fig. 46). It weighs 17^ oz. The time element is contained in the front part of the bronze body (a) of the fuze,and the percussion element in the rear part. The time-plunger {b) has five lugs {h) which hold the plunger in position above the firmly fixed steel fir- ing-pin (c) after the safety-pin has been withdrawn; these lugs are broken by the shock of discharge. The safety-pin 100 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGBT ARTILLERY. (J) passes through a hole in the upper part of the plunger, and it and the lugs are protected by the brass cap which is pierced to allow the insertion of the safety-pin. By this arrangement the plunger and its lugs are -entirely protected from any blow that may he received on the nose of the fuze. The priming composition is contained in the n- base of the plunger (at i), and is protected by a disk of tin- foil. The compressed powder-ring (q) is held in a groove in the body of the fuze by a brass ring, and four holes {p) per- mit the flame from the composition (i) to ignite it. The cone (d), made of an alloy, is held in place by a brass clamping-nut {h) and two brass pins (Z). A lip (m) pmLD-ABTILLERY. 101 On the base of the cone fits into a corresponding groove in the fuze-body and presents the premature ignition of the powder (o) iu the fuze-chamber. .A groove in the cone contains the time-train (e), which communicates througli a brass tube (n) with the powder in tlae fuze-chamber (o). The brass cone-cover (/) is pierced with holes numbered from 1 to 15. The holes lie immediately over the time- train and correspond to seconds of graduation. The spaces between consecutive holes are sub-divided into six parts, and countersunk at the points of division so that the fuze may be cut to sixths of a second of burning. A brass pin projects from the body of the fuze and fits into a slot in the cone-cover ; it fixes the latter in position and, together with the brass cup on top, also serves to hold the cover in place. The flame from the powder in the fuze-chamber com- municates with the bursting-charge of the shell through the grooved surfaces of the primer, plunger-sleeve, and bot- tom closing-screw. The opening into the fuze-chamber through which the charge is put is closed by the screw. A conical hole in the fuze-body immediately opposite this screw permits the in- sertion of a steel pin for the purpose of screwing the fuze into the shell. The percussion element consists of a brass primer {t) having three vents through which the flame may pass from the composition to the powder in the fuze-chamber. On the side towards the flring-pin the composition is cov- ered first with a tinfoil cup and then with a copper re- straining-disk, which is separated from it .04 of an inch both for safety and to prevent the firing-pin pressing against the composition during flight. On its opposite side the primer is covered with a tinfoil ring and a paper disk. 102 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. The bottom of the fuze is covered first by a paper and then by a tinfoil disk. The primer, plunger-sleeve, and bottom closing-screvr have their sides grooved longitudinally {r, r, r) to allow the flame from the powder in the fuze-chamber to pass to the bursting-charge of the projectile. With the exception of this difference in the plunger-sleeve the plunger is the same as the one in the Frankford Arsenal base percussion- fuze "C," model 1894. TO USE THE TIME-FUZE. Pierce the time-train cone at right angles to the axis and through the division in the cover corresponding to the de- sired number of seconds. Then remove the safety-pin be- fore inserting the projectile in the bore of the piece. A fuze-cutter is issued by the Ordnance Department for nse with the fuze. The Pbankeoed Arsenal Base Pekcussion--fuze " C," Model 1894, eoe Field-gun Shell. A ^ B _l * ' 'in iil 7^. Fig. 47. Fig. 48. This fuze weighs 4.88 ounces and consists of a brass body (a) which contains the complete plunger. The head of FIELD-ARTtLLEBt. l03 the body is closed by a brass cap-screw (6) which con- tains a brass primer {d) that is filled with the composi- tion (m) ; and the cap-screw is closed by a brass closing- screw (c). c and d have holes through them, as indicated, for the passage of the flame from the primer to the burst- ing-charge of the projectile. The head is coTsred by disks of paper and tinfoil. The face of the composition {m) nearest the plunger is covered by a disk of tinfoil (e) and a copper restraining- disk (/). The Plunger consists of a steel firing-pin (i), firmly fixed in a brass igniter plunger-spindle {h), and this spindle fits in a brass igniter plunger-sleeve {g) which has a groove {t') on its lower interior surface. A split brass safety-ring (/), which holds the igniter plunger-sleeve in the ' safety position, is slipped over the lower end of the spindle, and then the spindle-sleeve, containing two grooves (s and t), is slipped on and firmly secured by spreading the lower end of the spindle. The inclination of the groove (s) determines the resist- ance of the safety-ring, which, in this fuze, has the mini- mum and maximum limits of 142 and 160 lbs. respectively. (It was formerly 15 lbs.) When the piece is discharged the plunger-sleeve over- comes the resistance of the safety-ring and carries it to the rear; the diameter of the ring is slightly increased daring its passage along the spindle, and when in the proper posi- tion for so doing it fits partly in both grooves {t and f), binding sleeve and spindle firmly together. The point of the firing-pin now projects beyond the plunger-sleeve and the fuze is armed. When the projectile strikes, the com- plete plunger is thrown forward, the point of the firing-pin pierces the resti-aining-disk and ignites the composition. Fig. 4? shows the position of the parts before the piece is discharged, and Fig. 48 during the flight of the projectile. 104 A HANDBOOK FOR LIQBT ARTILLERY. RANGE TABLE FOR Shrapnel, 13.5 pounds. Sight Elevation. Variations. Time of Flight. Range. Angle. Differs from Shell. Range, 1 minute elevation. Deflection, 1 division hor. scale yards. 500 600 700 800 900 deg. min. 13 20 27 35 43 min. yards. 13 18 12 12 feet. 4.4 6.8 6.1 7.0 7.8 seconds. .97 1.18 1.40 1.63 1.87 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1 1 1 1 52 2 12 22 33 1 2 3 3 5 11 11 11 10 10 8.7 9.6 10.4 11.3 12.2 8.11 2.36 8.68 8.89 3.16 1500 1600 1700 1800 1900 1 1 2 2 2 44 55 7 19 S3 6 6 7 8 9 9 9 9 8 8 13.0 13.9 14.8 15.7 16.5 3.44 3.73 4.08 4.32 4.68 2000 2100 2200 2300 2400 2 2 3 3 3 45 59 13 28 43 10 11 11 12 13 7 7 7 7 7 17.4 18.3 19.1 20.0 20.9 4.93 5.85 5.57 5.90 6.83 2600 2600 2700 2800 2900 3 4 4 4 5 58 14 29 44 1 14 16 17 17 19 6 6 6 6 6 21.7 23.6 23.5 24.4 25.8 6.56 6.90 7.24 7.58 7.92 3000 3100 3200 3300 340O 5 5 5 6 18 35 58 9 28 20 21 22 23 25 6 6 6 5 6 26.1 87.0 87.8 28.7 89.6 8.26 8.61 8.96 9.32 .9.68 3500 3600 3700 3800 390O 6 7 7 7 8 47 6 25 45 5 26 27 28 30 32 5 5 5 5 5 30.5 31.3 38.8 33.1 33.9 10.04 10.41 10.78 11.16 11.54 4000 4100 4200 4300 4400 4600 8 8 9 9 9 10 25 44 3 24 44 5 33 33 33 .34 31 34 5 5 5 5 6 5 34.8 35.7 36.5 37.4 38.3 39.2 11.92 12.30 18.68 13.06 13.45 13.84 FIELD-ARTILLBB.T 106 3.2 INCH B. L. RIFLE. Muzzle velocity, 1685 ft. -sec. Fuze Scale. Fall. Change in Height of Burst, Terminal Divisions at Variation 1 minute Inclina- Velocity. which to cut in range. elevation Angle. tion, 1 time-fuze.* 1 subdiv. yard in— units. sixths. yards. feet. deg. min. yards. f. s. 4 80 A 37 93 1426 1 78 46 76 1380 1 1 75 66 61 1335 1 3 73 1 6 53 1292 1 4 71 1 19 44 1251 2 67 .9 1 33 37 1218 2 1 67 1 45 33 1176 2 3 67 2 1 28.6 1142 8 5 62 2 17 25 1110 3 63 2 34 28.6 1082 3 2 58 1.3 2 52 20 1066 3 4 58 3 11 18 1084 3 5 58 3 30 16.6 1014 4 1 55 3 50 16 995 4 3 55 4 12 13.5 978 ■4 5 62 1.7 4 34 12.5 962 5 1 52 4 67 11.5 946 5 2 62 5 21 10.5 920 5 4 60 6 45 ■ 10 915 6 60 6 11 9 901 6 2 49 2.2 6 38 8.5 887 6 4 49 7 6 8 874 7 49 7 34 7.5 862 7 2 49 8 '4 7 860 7 4 49 8 35 6.5 839 8 1 48 8.6 9 7 6 829 8 3 48 9 39 6 819 8 5 48 10 12 5.6 810 9 1 47 10 46 5.6 801 9 3 47 11 21 5 792 9 5 45 3.0 11 66 4.5 783 10 1 46 12 32 4.6 775 10 4 45 13 9 4.6 767 11 44 13 48 4 769 11 2 44 14 28 4 761 11 5 44 3.5 15 8 3.5 744 12 1 44 15 49 3.5 737 12 3 44 16 31 3.5 730 12 S 43 17 14 3 723 13 2 43 17 58 3 717 18 4 43 3.9 18 43 3 711 * These numbers correspond to a time of flight which is generally less than the tabulated time of flight by an amount required to cause the shrapnel to burst at a point within a distance of 75 yards short of the target. 106 A HANDBOOK FOB LiOHt ABTILLEBf. RANGE TABLE FOR Shell, 13.5 pounds. Jump : 20' at 1°. 30' at 10°. 1 Variations. Bange. Sight Elevation. Kanee, 1 minute elevation. Deflection, 1 divi- sion faor. scale. yards. degrees. minutes. yards. feet. 500 13 14 4.4 600 19 13 5.2 700 26 12 6.1 800 34 12 7.0 900 42 12 7.8 1000 51 11 8.7 1100 11 9.6 1200 9 11 10.4 1300 18 10 11.3 1400 38 10 12.3 1500 38 10 13.0 1600 49 10 13.9 1700 2 9 14.8 1800 3 11 9 15.7 1900 3 33 9 16.5 2000 2 35 8 17.4 2100 3 48 8 18.3 ■ 2200 3 2 8 19.1 3300 3 - 16 7 20.0 3400 3 30 7 20.9 2500 3 44 7 21.7 3600 3 58 7 22.6 2700 4 12 7 33.5 2800 4 27 7 24.4 2900 4 43 7 35.2 3000 4 58 6 26.1 3100 5 14 6 27.0 3200 5 30 6 27.8 3300 5 46 6 28.7 3400 6 g 6 29.6 3500 6 21 6 30.5 3600 6 39 6 31.3 3700 6 57 6 32.2 3800 7 15 5 33.1 3900 7 33 5 33.9 4000 7 52 5 84.8 4100 8 11 5 85.7 4300 8 30 5 36.5 4300 8 50 5 37.4 4400 9 10 5 38.3 4500 9 31 5 39.2 FIELD-ARTILLEB Y. 107 3.3-INCH B. L. RIFLE. Muzzle velocity, 1685 ft. -sec. Fall. Time of Flight. Angle. Inclination 1 yard in~ Velocity. secoDds. deg. min. yalrds. f. s. 0.96 36 95 1450 1.17 45 76 1408 1.39 54 64 1366 1.61 5 53 1836 1.84 16 45 1287 2.07 38 89 1250 2.33 41 34 1215 3.57 55 80 1183 2.82 3 9 27 1151 3.09 3 35 24 1131 3.36 3 41 21 1094 3.64 3 59 19 1070 3.92 3 17 17 1048 4.21 3 36 16 1029 4.50 3 56 15 1011 4.80 4 17 13 994 5.10 4 38 13 979 5.41 5 11 964 5.73 5 33 11 949 6.04 5 47 10 935 6.86 6 11 9 928 6.69 6 37 9 913 7.02 7 3 8 901 7.35 7 30 8 891 7.68 7 58 7 881 8.01 8 37 7 871 8.85 8 56 6 861 8.69 9 36 6 851 9.03 9 57 6 841 9.87 10 29 5 832 9.71 11 1 5 838 10.06 11 34 5 814 10.41 13 8 5 806 10.77 12 43 4 798 11.13 13 18 4 790 11.50 13 54 4 783 11.87 14 31 4 774 13.35 15 9 4 766 12.63 15 47 4 758 18.02 16 26 3 750 13.43 17 5 3 743 "^v i08 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. ) 'tt Fig. 49. CHAPTER III. 3.6-inch Rifle, etc. 3.6-inch Mortar, etc. Weights and Dimensions of Foreign Artillery. S.e.-INCH B. L. RIFLE, MODEL 1891 (REVISED). Material steel Totallength 7.79 feet Calibre 3.6 inches Weight 1181 pounds Grooves 36 „ . .. - .a. (1 turn in 50 to Twist of nflmg j ^ ^^^^ ;„ 35 ^^^^^^^^ Axis of trunnions above ground.. 3.56 feet Powder-chamber cylindrical Vent axial Preponderance 31 pounds. Muzzle velocity 1550 ft. -sec. Maximum range for shrapnel . . . 7430 yards This gun is similar in construction to the 3.2-inch (revised November 11, 1893). NoMEircLATUKB. — ob, locking-shoulder and recess; c, conical gas-check seat; d, cylindrical powder-chamber ; e, connecting slope for seat of rotary band ; /, slope from no lands to maximum lands. SIGHTS. Similar to those of 3.2-inch gun. AMMUNITIOK AND FUZES. The ammunition differs only in weight and dimensions from that described for the 3.2-inch gun. Fuzes are the same. FIELD-ARTILLEB T. 109 Powder-charge 4.1875 pounds U. F. sphero-hex. Weight of shell, filled 20 pounds Bursting-charge, shell 14^ ounces Weight of shrapnel, complete 20 pounds Bursting-charge, shrapnel 4 ounces Total number of balls 218 Total number of individual pieces.. 280 CARRIAGES, LIMBERS, CAISSON'S, COMBINED BATTERY- WAGON AND FORGE, ARTILLERY-WAGON. The carriage for this gun weighs 1300 pounds. The first 25 carriages were made with the double-screw elevating device, and the second 25 with the first form of lazy-tongs, and were intended for the 3.2-inch gun. They have been changed for 3.6-inch guns by cutting out the upper-front transom under the trunnion beds leaving only enough metal on each side to hold the eyebolts of the forked radial bar for the elevating device, and .cap squares with eyebolts have been substituted for the old cap squares with chin and eyebolts. The double-screw elevating device on the 85 carriages now having them are retained ; but all others will have a form of lazy-tongs, operated by bevel gears and a crank handle at the side, like that of the double screw ; otherwise the carriage is similar to that of the 3 2-inch gun already described. The limber-chests will probably be fitted for 36 rounds of ammunition; which is the only difEerence between limbers, caissons, etc., used with 3.2- inch and 3.6-inch guns. HARNESS, ETC. See page 150 et seq. 110 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 3.6JNCH B. L. RIFLE. Shrapnel. 20 lbs. Muzzle velocity, 1550 ft.-sec. 6=1.03. Log C=.17559. Elevation. Deflection, 1 Division Horizontal Scale. Range. Angle. Differs from Shell. Range, 1 Minute Elevation. Time of Flight. Yards. Degrees. Minutes. Minutes. Yards. Feet. Seconds. 600 18 12 4.4 1.04 600 26 12 5.2 1.27 700 34 1 11 6.1 1.50 800 44 1 10 7.0 1.74 goo 54 2 10 7.8 1.98 1000 04 3 10 8.7 2.24 1100 14 3 9 9.6 8.50 1800 24 2 9 10.4 2.76 1300 34 2 8 11.3 3 03 1400 46 3 8 12.2 3.31 1600 1 58 4 8 13 3.60 1600 2 10 4 8 13.9 3.88 1700 2 22 4 8 14.8 4.17 1800 2 36 7 7 15.7 4.45 1900 2 49 7 7 16.5 4.76 2000 3 03 8 7 17.4 5.06 3100 3 16 .9 7 18.3 6.38 2200 3 31 10 7 19.1 6.69 2300 3 46 10 7 20.0 6.00 2400 4 01 10 7 20.9 6.31 2600 4 16 11 6 21.7 6.63 2600 4 82 12 6 22.6 6.96 2700 4 49 13 6 23.5 7.28 2800 S 06 14 6 24.4 7.61 2900 6 24 16 6 86.2 7.95 3000 5 41 16 6 26.1 8.38 3100 5 59 17 6 27.0 8.62 8200 6 18 19 6 27.8 8.97 8300 6 37 20 5 28.7 9.31 3400 6 56 21 6 29.6 9.64 3500 7 16 22 5 80.5 9.98 360O 7 37 24 5 31.8 10.81 3700 7 58 26 5 8^.2 10.69 3800 8 19 27 5 33.1 11.04 3900 8 41 88 4 83.9 11.35 4000 9 02 29 34.8 11.70 4100 9 24 30 35.7 12.08 4S00 9 46 32 36.5 12.48 4300 10 10 .34 37,4 12.81 4400 10 .33 87 38.3 13.16 4500 10 58 41 39.2 13.57 FIELD-ABTILLEB T. Ill 3.6-INCH B. L. BIPLE. Shrapnel, 20 lbs. Muzzle velocity, 1550 ft.-sec. (!=1.03. LogC=. 17559. Fuze-scale. Change in Height of Burst, 1 Minute Eleva- tion. Fall. Ter- minal Veloc- ity. Divisions. Varia- tions in 1 Sub^lV. Angle. Inclina- tion, 1 Yaid In-; Units. 1 1 1 1 Sixths. 6 1 2 4 5 Yards. 75 73 71 68 67 Feet. .4 Degrees. 1 1 1 Minutes. 48 58 03 15 28 Yards. 88 66 55 46 39 Ft.-sec. 1345 1307 1270 1336 1804 3 2 % 2 3 8 4 5 1 65 64 62 60 59 .9 1 1 8 8 2 41 56 11 87 44 84 30 26 83 21 1173 1144 1117 1092 1069 3 3 4 4 4 3 4 8 3 58 57 56 55 55 1.3 3 3 3 4 i 08 20 40 00 80 19 17 16 14 13 1043 1030 1013 998 983 4 5 S 5 6 S 1 3 5 S4 53 58 52 61 1.7 4 5 5 5 6 41 03 85 48 12 12 11 10.5 10 9 969 955 942 989 917 6 6 7 7 7 2 4 2 4 50 50 49 48 48 2.3 6 7 7 7 8 37 03 29 56 24 8.5 8 7.5 7 7 905 893 882 871 860 8 8 8 9 9 2 4 1 3 48 47 47 46 45 2.6 8 9 9 10 lO 52 28 51 23 55 6.5 6 6 5.5 5 850 840 830 821 812 9 10 10 10 11 5 1 3 5 1 44 44 44 43 43 3.0 11 18 12 13 13 28 02 37 13 49 5 4.5 4.5 4 4 803 794 786 778 770 11 11 18 18 13 13 3 5 I 3 2 48 48 41 41 41 40 3.6 4.0 14 15 15 16 17 17 27 05 45 24 07 58 4 3.5 3.5 3.5 3 3 762 765 748 741 734 727 112 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERY. RANGE TABLE FOR 3.6-INCH B. L. R. Shell, 20 lbs. Muzzle velocity, 1 550 ft. sec. c = .93. Bursting-charge, 14J oz. Log C= .21996. Ele- vation, Variations. Time of Flight. Fall. Bange. Range, 1 Minute Elevar Deflection, 1 Division on Hori- zontal Angle. Inclination 1 Yard in— Terminal Velocity. tion. Scale Yards. o / Yards. Feet. Sec. o / Yards. Ft.-sec. SOO 18 18 4.4 1.08 41 84 1364 600 86 11 5.2 1.85 51 67 1329 700 35 11 6.1 1.48 1 02 55 1296 800 43 11 7.0 1.72 1 13 47 1263 90O 52 10 7.8 1.96 1 85 40 1233 1000 01 9 8.7 2.80 1 Is" 35 1203 1100 11 9 9.6 8.45 1 58 31 1175 1800 28 9 10.4 2.70 2 06 27 1149 1300 32 9 11.3 2.96 8 81 24 1123 1400 43 8 18.2 3.84 8 37 82 1098 1300 1 64 8 13.0 3.58 2 53 20 1079 1600 2 06 8 13.9 3.80 3 11 18 1060 1700 2 18 8 14.8 4.08 3 89 16 1048 1800 8 89 8 15.7 4.37 3 48 15 1086 1900 8 48 8 16.5 4.66 4 07 14 1011 aooo 8 55 7 17.4 4.96 4 27 13 997 2100 3 07 7 18.3 5.26 4 48 18 984 8200 3 81 7 19.1 5.56 5 09 11 971 S300 3 36 7 80.0 5.87 5 30 10 959 8400 3 51 7 80.9 6.18 5 52 9.5 947 2B00 4 05 6 81.7 "T.49~ 6 15 9 935 8600 4 80 6 22.6 6.80 6 38 8.5 984 2700 4 36 6 83.5 7.11 7 02 8 913 2800 4 52 6 84.4 7.48 7 27 7.5 903 2900 5 08 6 85.2 7.75 7 53 7 898 3O0O B 85 6 26.1 8.08 8 20 7 888 3100 5 48 6 27.0 8.40 8 47 6.5 872 3800 5 59 6 87.8 8.78 9 15 6 863 3300 6 17 6 28.7 9.05 9 44 6 854 3400 6 35 5 29.6 9.38 10 13 5.5 845 3500 6 54 6 30.5 9.78 lo" 43 6 836 3600 7 13 5 81.3 10.06 11 14 5 887 3700 7 38 5 38.8 10.40 11 45 5 819 3800 7 58 5 33.1 10.74 12 16 4.5 811 3900 8 13 5 33.9 11.08 18 47 4.5 803 4000 8 33 5 34.8 11.42 13 25 4 796 4100 8 54 5 35.7 11.77 14 01 4 788 4800 9 14 5 36.5 12.11 14 37 4 78] 4300 9 36 5 37.4 18.44 15 13 3.6 774 4400 9 56 5 38.3 12.76 15 60 3.5 768 4500 10 17 5 39.2 13.08 16 87 3 768 FIELD-ABTILLER T. 113 3.6-lNCH B L FIELD-MORTAR, MODEL 1890. (REVISED NOV. 11, 1893.) ICJ Fig. 50. Metal steel Total length 3.05 feet Calibre 3.6 inches Weight 345 pounds Grooves 30 Twist of rifling \\'^g'^,_ Powder-chamber. . . . cylindrical Vent axial Muzzle velocity 650 ft. -sec. Maximum range. . . . 3450 yards It consists of a single piece of steel, the trunnions being forged solid with the piece. The bree5h mechanism. Fig. 51, is generally similar to that of the field-guns, except that the Freyre obturator is used, and in the locking arrangement the lever-handle is 114 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLERT. replaced by a bolt [a) wliich is turned by hand. This bolt operates the locking-stud on the left side of the block, and its handle bears also a vent-shield (/,) which keeps the vent closed until the breech is locked. THE CARKIAGB JOB S-G-INCH B. L. MOBTAR, This carriage, Fig. 53, is of cast steel and in one piece, and consists of a frame complete with transoms and soles. It is 39^ inches long and weighs 275 pounds. The axis of the trunnions is 14 inches above ground, and the piece can be fired at any angle between and 60 degrees. At the centre of the front transom is bolted the elevating- clamp, which embraces an arc bolted to the under side of the mortar. The lever on the left side of the carriage turns a sliaft, which causes the clamp to take hold of the arc when the elevation has been given. A pintle-fork is attached at the front end of the car- riage, and a ring on the side of either cheek to which the ends of the restraining rope are fastened. NOMENCLATUEB OF 3.6-INCH MOBTAB-CAEEIAGB.— Car- riage-fraiiie; elevating-arc; elevating-arc bolt ; elevating-arc guide-pin ; double hook ; double-hook pin ; double-hook bracket; double-hook bracket-pin ; cap-square ; cap-square keys; cap-square chain eye-pin ; pintle-fork; pintle-fork bolt : elevating-arc jaws; shaft for jaws; lever for shaft; bush- ing for shaft; nut for shaft; screw for bushing; separator; separator-bolt and nut; screws for pointing. FIELD ARTILLERY. 115 PLATFORM FOE 3.6 MOETAK. Yellow pine or oak. Weight complete, 300 lbs. This equipment consists of one wooden platform, one cast-iron pintle-block, eight stakes, one anchor-stake, two handspikes, and one l_ pointing-scale. The Ol [UJ platform consists of two side-rails, 3-inch, into which are framed and bolted eleven deck- planks, the latter se- cured to each other by dowels. A 4 X 3-inch piece is bolted to the rear deck-plank by three bolts. Wrought- iron straps, bolted i nto cross-pieces, embrace the side-rails. The pintle-block is fastened to the front of the plat- form by four wrought- iron bolts. The pintle- fork on the carriage embraces the pintle. E ® o o iir Pig. 53, forming the centre of motion of the traversing carriage. The platform is held in position by stakes, two on either side; those in front passing through square wrought-iron rings attached to eye-pieces bolted to the front end of the platform. A brass socket, in which works the brass pivot at the end of the pointing-scale, is placed at a suit- able point in the axis of the platform. The anchor-stake, 4 ft. long, is driven in front of the platform. Around the anchoi'-stake, and held in position by the two pins passing through the stake, is wound the middle portion of the 116 A HANDBOOK FOB. LIGHT ABTILLEBY. restraining rope, the ends of which fasten to the rings in the cheeks of the carriage. The rope is given five feet slack for recoil. The Pointing-scale. — This is made of hard wood, gradu- ated on one side, the unit of the scale being one thousandth of the range, and each division one five hundredth of the ffi rmfr i ■piT^i'TTTTTTlTTTTTTTTfJT^^^^^ Fig. 54. range. A brass index-slide moves with friction along the scale and is clamped by a screw when regulated. For refer- ence-marks a brass screw is placed at the end of each cheek of the carriage, and the scale is so arranged that it can be applied to either cheek. The carriage admits of a motion around its pintle of about 15° on either side of the axis of the platform. THE GXrHTNER'S QUADRANT. TJsed in giving elevation. The arc is 45°, but by apply- ing different sides an elevation of 90° can be given. The Fig. 55. least reading is one minute, which is given by the setting of a sliding level on a slightly curved arm. FIELD-ARTILLERY. Ill The setting to any given degree is made by moving the arm by hand, which is done by pressing back the head of the arm to release it from engagement with the notches on the interior of the arc, then moving the arm to the required position and allowing the spring to react. AMMUNITION. The full charge of powder is 16 ounces, sphero-hex. (U. F.). The projectiles are those used with the 3. 6 gun and have already been described. The charges, required to cover all ranges from 400 to 3350 yards with angles of elevation between 15 and 45 degrees, are four in number. These charges are made up of three cartridges containing 4, 6, 10, and 16 ounces respectively. The Fuze for Shrapnel is the Frankford Arsenal point- combination fuze, model 1894, burning 38 seconds and weighing 19.75 ounces. The time-train of this fuze is arranged to be cut at intervals of \ second. The Fuze for Shell is fuze M, model 1894. It is identical in construction with fuze C (see page 103), except that a portion of the plunger-spindle is reduced in diameter to lessen the friction of the spring-ring in arming on account of reduced charges. It is distinguished from the fuze by two grooves across the flat of the base. This fuze is designated for separate transportation, to be assembled with the projectile at or near the firing-ground, and is not to be transported fixed in the projectile. 118 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. RANGE TABLE FOR 3.6-INCH B. L. MORTAR. Common Shell (Cast Iron). SHEli, filled and fuzed, 20 lbs. Bursting-charge, 14.5 oz. Time Fall. Charge and InitialVelooity Kange. Elevation. of Flight. Angle. Inclina- tion, Terminal Velocity. 1 Ft. in- Yards. Deg. Min. Sec. Deg. Min. Feet. Ft.-sec. 400 15 27 4.76 16 00 3.5 266.5 4 ounces; 500 80 04 5.98 21 06 2.6 264.3 277.5 ft.-seo. 600 25 44 7.45 27 06 2.0 262.3 700 33 25 9.43 34 69 1.4 269.5 750 45 UO 12.00 46 66 40 0.9 266.5 Angles > 45°. . . 700 55 08 13.91 52 0.6 271.2 600 14 04 5.36 14 47 3.7 336.0 700 16 48 6.38 17 48 3.1 332.9 6 ounces ; 800 19 48 7.45 80 56 8.6 329.7 900 23 10 8.63 84 37 2.2 32!'.0 357.5 ft. -sec. 1000 87 16 10.00 29 05 1.8 325.0 1100 32 87 11.67 34 42 1.4 322.9 1200 45 00 15.32 47 48 0.9 324.9 Angles > 46° -j 1100 56 13 17.97 58 66 0.6 339.3 1000 61 20 18.96 63 50 0.5 331.5 1100 14 10 7.32 15 17 3.7 439.4 1200 15 45 8.10 17 06 3.3 435.0 1300 17 84 8.91 19 08 2.9 430.7 1400 19 07 9.74 21 02 2.6 427.2 10 ounces; 1500 20 59 10.63 23 14 2.3 424.1 492.0 f t.-sec. 1600 83 00 11.57 85 38 2.2 420 8 1700 85 13 12.59 28 07 1.9 418.0 1800 27 44 13.72 31 01 1.7 415.5 1900 30 46 15.03 34 31 1.5 413.3 2000 34 41 16.67 38 58 1.2 412.5 810O 45 00 20.63 49 52 0.8 417.6 ( 8000 53 60 23.16 57 41 0.6 428.8 Ancles > 45° J. 1900 56 45 24.29 61 22 0.5 427.7 1 1800 59 50 85.11 64 10 0.5 431.0 2000 15 29 10.53 17 44 3.1 637.9 8100 16 30 11.18 19 02 2.9 632.9 2200 17 33 11.85 20 21 2.7 528 4 2300 18 39 12.64 21 44 2.5 624.3 2400 19 49 13.26 23 14 2.3 519.8 2500 81 02 14.00 24 46 2.2 516.1 16 ounces; 8600 82 19 14.78 26 22 8.0 512.9 660.0 f t.-sec. 270O 23 43 15.61 28 11 1.9 509.4 8800 85 12 16.49 30 02 1.7 506.2 8900 26 49 17.42 .32 W, 1.6 603.8 3000 88 38 18.45 34 18 1.5 501.7 3100 30 38 19.60 36 49 l.S .500.2 3200 33 21 81.02 40 00 1.2 499.2 3300 36 43 88.78 43 51 1.0 601.0 3363 45 00 26.75 52 42 0.8 510.4 ■ 3300 48 59 28.47 66 43 0.7 616.2 3200 58 40 29.99 60 10 0.6 523.3 Angles > 45° 3100 55 22 31.01 62 35 0.5 689.1 3000 57 85 31.73 64 21 0.5 538.6 • 2900 59 19 32.37 66 34 0.4 547.7 MBLD-ARTILLMRY. 119 RANGE TABLE FOR 3.6-INCH B. L. MORTAR. Shrapnel, filled and fuzed, 20 lbs. Bursting-charge, 4 oz. Number of balls, 218. Weight of each ball, 171 grains. Fuze -scale. FaU. Charge and Initial Ve- locity. Ele- Time Termi- Bange. va- tion. of Flight. Divisions. Varia- tions in Burst, 1 Sub- Angle. Inclina- tion, IFoot nal Ve- locity. div. in — Yards. e / Sec. Units 5ths Yards. <■ / Feet. Ft.rseo. 4 ounces ; 277.5ft.-seo. 400 15 29 4.76 4 a 18 16 06 3.5 265.2 500 20 21 5.95 S 4 17 21 10 2.6 263.4 600 26 03 7.50 7 1 17 27 15 2.0 260.3 700 34 27 08 9.61 9 1 17 36 01 1.4 258.3 600 14 5.38 5 1 22 14 55 3.8 333.8 700 17 01 6.41 6 1 22 17 57 3.1 330.0 6 ounces ; 800 20 OS 7.52 7 2 22 21 20 2.6 326.9 357.5ft.-sec. 900 23 34 8.73 8 8 22 25 09 2.1 324.4 1000 27 84 10.07 9 4 21 29 35 1.8 322.2 1100 33 12 01 43 11.82 11 3 21 35 30 1.4 320.1 1000 6.62 6 2 29 13 49 4.1 439.0 HOC 14 19 7.38 7 1 29 15 36 3.6 434.0 1200 15 66 8.17 8 29 17 26 3.2 429.0 1300 17 36 8.99 8 4 28 19 23 2.8 425.1 10 ounces; 492.0ft.-sec. 1400 19 23 9.85 9 3 28 21 23 2.5 421.2 1500 21 19 10.75 10 3 28 23 46 2.3 417.5 1600 23 26 11.72 11 3 28 26 16 2.0 414.0 1700 25 47 12.77 12 3 27 29 03 1.8 410.8 1800 28 26 13.92 13 4 27 32 08 1.6 407.8 1900 31 41 15.36 15 1 27 35 53 1.4 405.0 2000 36 14 12 45 17.22 17 27 41 00 1.2 401.3 1900 10.02 9 4 35 17 01 3.6 532.2 2000 15 46 10.68 10 2 35 18 20 3.2 626.. ■! 2100 16 49 11.35 11 1 35 19 42 2.8 521.2 2200 17 55 12.04 11 4 34 21 07 2.6 516.5 2800 19 05 12.75 12 3 34 23 37 2.4 513.3 2400 20 19 13.50 13 8 3( 24 12 2.2 507.4 16 ounces: 660.0ft. -sec. 2S00 21 37 14.28 14 34 25 52 2.1 503.7 2600 23 00 15.11 15 33 27 38 1.9 500.1 2700 24 29 16.00 15 4 33 29 33 1.8 496.7 2800 26 07 16.94 16 4 33 31 38 1.6 493.6 2900 27 58 17.96 17 4 33 33 58 1.5 491.0 3000 30 05 19.12 19 33 36 36 1.3 488.9 3100 32 33 20.46 20 1 33 39 36 1.2 488.1 3200 35 41 28.10 22 33 43 18 1.1 487.6 3276 45 00 26.54 26 2 33 53 22 0.7 500.3 120 A HANDBOOK FOR LIQBT ARTILLERY. FORBIGN FIELD-ARTILLERY. GERMANT. There is practically only one gun, viz., the 3.46-inch. The horse-artillery gun, carriage, and limber, are all lighter than in the field-artillery. Model 1891 weighs 970 lbs. The weights behind the teams are: H. A. gun, 3996 lbs.; F. A. gun, 4276 lbs.; caisson, 5036 lbs. No cannon- eers are carried on the carriages in horse-artillery. Muzzle velocity, 1400 ft.-sec. The Common Shell weighs 15^ lbs. (bursting-charge, 6 oz.), and splinters into about 170 pieces. A proportion of the shells are filled with wet gun-cotton, having a dry gun- cotton primer, to be used, as a rule, against men under cover. The Shrapnel contains 262 bullets with bursting-charge down the centre, weighs 17.7 lbs., and can be burst up to 3500 yards range. The number of tounds carried per gun in a battery is 135. The percussion-shell has been aban- doned, and shrapnel, high explosive shell, and canister only are used. The fuze is a combination time, and percussion- fuze. There are 20 carriages in a battery— 6 guns, 9 caissons, 4 store-wagons, 1 forge-wagon, A battery carries 9 shovels and 2 pickaxes. FRANCE. The Horse-artillery Gun.— Calibre, 3.14 in. ; weight, 8.4 cwt.; muzzle velocity,1600 ft.-sec. ; shrapnel with 2-oz. burst- ing-charge in head, 13.8 lbs. "Weights behind the teams, including men carried: gun, 4251 lbs.; caisson, 4424 lbs. The ammunition per gun with battery is 142 rounds. The Field-artillery Gun.— Calibre, 3.54 in.; weight, 8.4 cwt. ; muzzle velocity, 1500 ft.-sec. ; shrapnel with bursting- chai'ge in head, 19 lbs. Weights behind teams, including the men carried: gun, 5248 lbs.; caisson, 5404 lbs. FIELD-ARTILLERY. 121 There are 142 rounds of ammunition per gun with bat- tery. A steel shell filled with 3 lbs. of cresylite is contemplated, of which about 75 will be carried with the battery. There are 6 guns, 9 caissons, 1 store, 1 forge, and 1 forge- wagon in a battery. The field-artillery gun now being introduced has a calibre of 2.95 inches, and fires a projectile weighing in the vicinity of 12 pounds. AUSTRIA. The Horse-artillery Gun.— Calibre, 3.14 in.; weight, 5.3 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1365 ft.-sec; ring-shell, 9^ lbs.; shrapnel, 10.27 lbs. Weights behind the teams : gun, 3440 lbs. ; caisson, 4287 lbs. No detachments are carried on the carriages. Ammunition cari'ied per gun with battery: ring-shell, 84; shrapnel, 54; canister, 8; incendiary shell, 6; a total of 152 rounds. There are 18 carriages in a battery, 6 guns. The Field-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 3. 54 in. ; weight, 9.5 cwt, muzzle velocity, 1440 ft.-sec; ring-shell, 14.1 lbs. shrapnel, 15.6 lbs. Weights behind the teams: gun, 5040 lbs. ; caisson, 4134 lbs. Ammunition per gun with battery : ring-shell, 70 ; shrap- nel, 45; canister, 8; incendiary shell, 5; total, 138. There are 33 carriages in a battery, 8 guns. E0SSIA. The Horse-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 3.4 in.; weight, 7 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1350 ft.-sec; common shell, 14 lbs.; shrapnel with bursting-charge in base, 15 lbs. Weights be- hind the teams: gun, 3635 lbs.; caisson, 3543 lbs. Ko cannoneers on carriages. 122 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. Ammunition per gun with battery: common shell, 61; shrapnel, 60; canister, 9; total, 130 rounds. The Light Field-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 3.4 in. ; weight, 8.6 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1450 ft.-sec; common shell, 14 lbs.; shrapnel with bursting-charge in base, 15 lbs. Weights behind the teams same as in horse-artillery. Ammunition per gun -with battery, 150 rounds. The Heavy Field-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 4. 2 in. ; weight, 12 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1223 ft.-sec; common shell, 25.9 lbs. ; shrapnel, 27. 5 lbs. Weights behind the teams, includ- ing detachments : gun, 4268 lbs.; caisson, 4686. Ammunition per gun with battery, 108 rounds. Horse-batteries consist of 6 guns, field-batteries gen- erally of 8 guns, 24 carriages to each battery of 6 guns. Russia has 5 regiments, 4 batteries each, of field-mortar batteries. Calibre of piece, 6 in.; weight of shell, 60 lbs. Each battery consists of 6 mortars, 18 carriages, and 6 carts. ITALY. Horse- and Light Field-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 3.75 in. ; weight, 5.8 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1400 ft.-sec; common shell, 9.4 lbs.; shrapnel with bursting-charge in base, 9.8 lbs. Weights behind the teams : gun, 3498 lbs. ; caisson, 3650 lbs. No detachments are carried. Ammunition per gun with battery: common shell, 24; shrapnel, 112; canister, 6; total, 142 rounds. Heavy Field-artillery Gun. — Calibre, 3.5 in.; weight, 9.2 cwt.; muzzle velocity, 1480 ft.-sec; common shell, 14.7 lbs.; shrapnel, 15.3 lbs. Weights behind the teams, including detachments carried : gun, 4268 lbs. ; caisson, 4686 lbs. Ammunition per gun with battery: common shell, 28; shrapnel, 96; canister, 6; total, 130 rounds. All batteries have 6 guns and 15 carriages, viz., 6 gun- FIELD-ARTILLERY. 123 carriages, 6 caissons, 1 forge, 1 baggage-wagon, 1 forage- wagon. GREAT BRITAIN. The 9-pdr. and 13-pdr. M. I. Guns. — Horse and light artillery are being replaced by the 12-pdr. B. L., the weight behind teams of horse-artillery being a little less than that of field-artillery. Calibre of 12-pdr. B. L., 3.0 in.; weight of piece, 784 lbs.; muzzle velocity, 1710 ft.-sec. ; common shell and shrapnel, Vi\ lbs. Weight behind teams: guns, 3684 lbs.; caissons, 3796 lbs. Ammunition per gun with battery: common shell, 20; shrapnel, 80; canister, 8; total, 108. Besides these there are 2 star-shell per gun. All batteries have 6 guns and 19 carriages all told. 124 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. CHAPTER IV. Wheel. Carriage. Limber. Caisson. Battery-wagon and Forge. Artillery-wagon. Harness. Water-cart. Revolvers. Hunting-knife. THE ARCHIBALD WHEEL. Diameter 57f inches. Width of tire 2f " Weight of wheel 200 lbs. The nave-box (a) is made of aluminum-bronze. It fits over the axle-arm (c) and has groove for lubricant, as indicated. The nave (5) of malleable iron. The spokes, 16 in number (s), are made of oak or hickory. Fig. 56. The felloes, 8 in number, are made of oak or hickory. The tire is made of steel, ^ inch thick. The bolts, clips, linch-pins, and washers are made of metal. FIELD-ARTILLERY. 125 The large nut on outside of nave-box is splined to the box. The linch-washers have a stud which prevents their turning with the wheel. The inner extremities of the spokes are put together by a powerful radial pressure, which subjects them to a stress many times greater than they are likely to receive. To Replace a Box and that Portion of the Hub Attached. — Unscrew and remove front hub-band; take off hub-nuts, and drive out old box. Eeplace box, and screw on the front hub-band, replacing hub-nuts. To Replace a Spoke. — Kemove tire and felloe on the in- jured spoke; take out only the bolt that passes through the injured spoke; saw off this spoke as close as possible to the hub and bore or dig out the spoke; drive in the duplicate spoke as far as possible, and arrange the tenon at the felloe so that the tire may press the spoke about one eighth of an inch farther into the hub, and after the tire is on put in the hub-bolt. THE 3.2-INCH FIELD-aUN CARRIAGE. NOMENCLATUKE, Wheel (1) consisting of tire; felloes; spokes; nave-box; nave-box flanges; nave-bolts and nuts. Linch-pins (5); linch-washers (5); axle (6); shoulder- washers (7); brake-eyes and straps (8); axle-plates (9); flasks (10); upper front transom (11); lower front tran- som (12); middle transom (13); trail-box transoms (14); rear transom (15); lunette (16); lunette-plate (16); trail- plate (16); trail-handles (17); cap-squares (18) ; chin-bolt (19) ; eye-bolt (20) ; eye-bolt key (20) ; eye-bolt key-chain (20); trail-box (21); trail-box lid (21); trail-box lid-hasp (21); trail-box turnbuckle (21); sponge-bucket compart- ment (22); wheel-guard (23); handspike attachments, front and rear (24); handspike-socket (24); hand-spike 126 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 80cket-pin and key (34); handspike (24); handspike-clasps (34); long sponge-toggle and plate (35); short rammer and sponge attachmeHt (36); short rammer and sponge- clasps (36); short rammer and sponge-clasp locking-catches (26); sponge-bucket toggle-hole (27). I'IG. 58. FIELB-ARTILLEB Y. 127 Axle-seats (3), consistiBg of seat-plate, guard-rail, guard- rail standard, guard-rail catch, guard-rail hinge-pin, guard- rail locking-latch. Bow-brake (2), Pig. 59, consisting of shoe-piece (a), bow- springs (4) (J), bow-spring nuts and bolts (4) (c), attach- ment-socket {d), and the attachment consisting of clevis (e), clevis-bolt and nut (/), loeking-lever (g), locking- bolt and nut (h). The attachment-socket has a rect- angular longitudinal mortice in which the tang of the clevis is placed. This tang has a slot, the lower part of which ends in a hole having the same diameter as the locking-bolt. The locking-bolt has bearings on each side of the mortice, and the part in the slot has two opposite rectangular grooves. When the bolt is in the hole with these grooves perpendicular to the slot, the clevis is locked; but when turned until the bottoms of the cuts are in prolongation of the slot sides, the tang of the clevis can be drawn out until stopped by the other end of the slot. The Elevating Device (4), Fig. 60, consists of frame and double lazy-tongs. The Frame consists of (2) side-levers (c), pivot-bolt and separator {d), transom-bolt and nuts in rear, (2) eye-bolts, elevating-screw (/), cross-head elevating-screw nut, crank- handle {g). The Lazy-tongs consists of (4) long arms (a), (4) lever- arms {a), (4) short arms (a), upper assembling-bolt, (2) assembling-bolts, short, (2) assembling-bolts, long, central journal-bolt (e), lower journal-rod (6) and (2) bearing- boxes, (2) eye-washers (for strap k), and the necessary nuts and wfighers, 128 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. The front end of the frame is attached to the carriage axle-plates, just in rear of the middle transom, by two eye- bolts which form the pivot. The rear end is attached to the elevating-screw by the cross-nead elevating-screw nut, which moves back and forth Fig. 60. in the grooves in the side-levers in rear of the transom- bolt. The crank-handle on the elevating-screw is located just in front of the trail-box. The double lazy-tongs (of two cells, the upper twice the size of the lower) are enclosed in the frame which fur- nishes bearings, at about the middle of the side-levers, for the central journal-bolt. The lower journal-rod has fixed bearings in the two bearing-boxes which are bolted to the flasks of the carriage. The gun rests on the upper assembling-bolt, which has eye-washers for the breech-strap. Any motion of the elevating-screw handle raises or lowers the frame, and this, carrying with it the central journal- bolt, opens out or closes the lazy-tongs cells, FIELD-ABTILLER T. 129 The Double- screw Elevating Device, Fig. 60ff, is used on 35 of the carriages for 3.6-inch guns. It consists of a hollow exterior screw (a) (having an exterior right-hand thread and an interior left-hand one) in which works an interior screw (c) to whose trunnioned head is attached the guide-strap (s), the arms of the strap being secured by nuts to the prolongations of the upper bolts that secure the middle transom. This insures rotation of the elevating de- vice in a plane passing through the axis of the carriage. The bronze nut (6) in which a works is arranged on trunnions between the cheeks of the carriage, and has the hand-wheel (d) (or in some cases a large gear-wheel) so fixed to it that the latter can be rotated but has no motion of transla- tion. A groove (e) is cut on the screw a, and a key on the hand-wheel fits this. Where the large gear-wheel is used motion is obtained by a small gear-wheel, axle, pinion, and hand-crank on the right of the trail. /e -a. Fig. eOa. DBSCEIPTIOBT OF CARRIAGE FOR 3.2-IlfOH GUN. The carriage is made of steel. Its track, like that of the other vehicles, is 60 inches. The principal parts are the two flasks, connected by transoms, and the lunette ; the two axle- plates, upper and lower; the axle-tree; the wheel-brakes; the wheels; the elevating apparatus; and the two seats. Each flask is formed by riveting together two plates with curved margins; and the trunnion-beds are reinforced by bars of steel, which are enclosed between the margins of the flask-plates and riveted to the.m. There are three front 130 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. transoms, upper, lower, and rear, in the vicinity oi the trunnion-beds and axle-plates, and three trail-transoms at intervals between these plates and the lunette, the latter being riveted on. Trail-handles are on either side of the trail near the lunette. The lunette, lunette-plate and trail- plate are formed of one piece of metal. The axle-plates, two in number, which accurately envelop the solid steel axle, are riveted together. The shoulder-washers are octagonal in form; to each is fitted a collar containing a stout eye, to which the brakes are attached. These collars have projections that embrace the axle-plates above and below to prevent turning of the axle within the plates. Linch-washers have a stud to keep them from revolving with the wheel. Double-bow Spring-brakes, with a device for detaching them when necessary, are used. They are carried in a ver- tical position by means of the button on the lever and the groove on under side of axle-seat guard-rail. The spring- lever operates the locking-bolt in the end of the brake near the hook, so that the brake may be available in going up or down hill. Axle-seats are placed on either side of the carriage. Un- derneath the left seat a section of picket-rope is carried. The Elevating De-ice is of the lazy-tongs pattern, and is actuated by a handle on top of the flask. A leather strap is secured to the top part of the elevating device, and is used for strapping down the breech of the gun to avoid pounding. Wheel, Archibald, height 57| inches, weight 200 pounds. The Handspike, made of hickory, is sawn lengthwise into halves, and the wood thus removed replaced by ^V-inch sheet iron, the whole riveted together and bound by iron bands. It is permanently attached to the flask, and when not in use is folded over on it and locked by the handspike-clasps. The Short Sponges and Eammers are carried between the cheeks, between the upper and lower front transoms; FIELD-ABTILLBBT. 131 grooved bronze ferrules in rear of the sponge-heads serve for the seats of the support and the clasps which hold them in place. By means of the bronze hooks on the staff, one of which is movable, it is hooked to the right guard-rail when firing. The Axle-seats are attached at the shoulder-washers to the axle-plates and bolted to the flasks. The Long Sponge-staff is hinged near the middle, so that when folded the rammer-head is placed behind the sponge. It is carried on the left side of the carriage (the sponge- and rammer-heads under the axle-seat resting on the axle-plate), held by a toggle about midway of folded length. The Tool-box is placed between the flasks, and has ample space for all tools required, and for tube-pouches, priming- wire, and gunner's gimlet. By means of a hasp and turn- buckle the lid is fastened to the side of the transom. In rear of the tool-box is an open compartment in which the sponge-bucket may be carried when empty. A hole be- tween the seats of sponge and rammer provides for carry- ing the bucket, when filled, by its toggle. Chin- and eye-bolts secure the cap-squares. Wheel-guards are bolted on either side of the trail. Weight of carriage and brakes, 1166 pounds. Weightof carriage complete, with equipment, 1197 pounds. Fig. 61. LIMBER OF 3.2-INCH FIELD-GUN CARRIAGE. (See Figs. 63 and 63.) NOMENCLATURE. Wheels; axle; linch-pins; linch-washers; shoulder-wash- ers; understraps (axle). 132 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. The fork («) ; the fork-brace ; the hounds (Jc) ; splinter- bar (/). Foot-boards {m), front and rear; foot-board latch; pole {b); pole-fernile; pole-pad (/); pole-pad bolt and nut; pole- prop; pole-bolt; pole-prop eye; pole-prop strap; pole-stop; bushing for pole-bolt hole; ueck-yoke stop {g). Double-tree (A) ; double-tree chains and staples; double- tree hooks end; double-tree stay-hooks; double-tree bolt (t) ; double-tree bolt-strap; double- tree bolt-brace. h- CEC 3 L > V Cs. 1^^ Fig. 62. Single-trees; single-tree-eye-band; single-tree hooks. Oil and grease compartment: pintle (c); pintle-key (d); pintle-key chain; pintle-key chain eye-plate; pintle brace- rods; hound brace-rods; primer- and obturator-boxes (w); primer- and obturator-box lids; primer- and obturator-box lid-chains; ammunition-chest staple; ammunition-chest keys and chains. The ammunition-chest (I), consisting of lid, handles, hasp, turnbuckle, paulin-straps, packing— metallic, pack- ing — wood. FIBLB-ABTILLEB Y. 133 Neck-yoke: body of wood; metal parts are: 1 centre eye-sleeve; 3 centre eye-'sleeve rivets; 3 eye-bands; 2 eye-band rivets; 2 band-rings; 2 pole-strap eye-loops; 2 pole-strap eye-loop rollers; 2 martingale-staples; neck-yoke pads (leather). THE LIMBER. Weight with neck-yoke 957 pouuds Weight complete, without ammunition 1057 Weight complete, with ammunition 1780 Length from end of pole to muzzle of gun, limbered. . 26.5 feet Distance between centres of axles 8.75 The limbers for the carriage, caisson, and battery-wagon are in every respect the same, except that the two boxes for primers and obturators are omitted on the battery- wagon limber, and its chest is difEerently arranged inside. Fig. 63. The limber essentially consists of two wheels, Archibald patent (same as for carriage), one wrought-steel tubular axle, linch-pins and washers, shoulder-washers shrunk and pinned on, three understraps. The limber-body and connecting parts consist of : The Fork (1) (a).— Central part of body formed of two 134 A HANDBOOK POS LIGHT ARTILLBBT. angle-irons receiving the pole {b) and pintle-body in rear. It passes into and is riveted to' the double-tree bolt-strap which surrounds and supports the pole. It carries, riveted to it between the flanges, the foot-brace and pole-stop, to which is pivoted the pole-prop hook. In rear of foot- boards is the staple for securing the ammunition-chest. The fork is attached to the axle by axle-straps. The Two Hounds {k) form the side-rails, and are angle- irons attached to the body by axle-straps. To these on each side in rear of the axle are bolted the primer- and obturator- boxes (k). The Splinter-bar {j). — Angle-iron. Unites the fork and hounds in front of foot-boards. Foot-boards (2), Wood (m). — Rear one riveted to hounds and fork. The front one, to which are riveted thrfee brack- ets, is hinged by two strap-hinges to the rear one, to give access to pole-prop strap, pole-bolt, and compartment for oil- and grease-cans and tool-box. It is provided with a latch for securing, it, when down, to the double-tree bolt-brace. The Pole, Wood (J). — Leather pad (e) on front end. Neck-yoke stop, iron, on under side. The hole in rear and for bolting to the fork is lined with thin brass tubing. It abuts against a plate and is secured by a key. It is partly copper-sheathed. Double-tree (1) {h). — Made of steel. Hooks at either end for attachment of single-trees. Hole in centre for at- tachment to limber by double-tree bolt. Double-tree Bolt-strap (i).— Riveted to fork and sup- ports the pole. Double-tree bolt, bolt-strap, and pole-prop eye one piece. Single-trees (2).— Made of steel with eye for attachment to double-tree hooks; hooks at ends for trace attachment. Oil- and Grease-can Compartment.— A flanged plate of sheet iron under the foot-boards riveted to the fork and right hound. FIELD-AMTILLEHT. 135 Pole-prop* (1). — Permanently secured to the eye on bot- tom of the double-tree bolt-strap. Pole-prop Strap (1). — For holding up pole-prop, near pole-stop. Pole-bolt (1) (e). — Passes through the fork, the flanges of the double-tree bolt-brace and the pole securing it to the fork. Pole-stop and Support (1). — A flaaged piece of plate metal (riveted to fork-flanges) on and against which the pole is supported. Double-tree Bolt-brace (1). — A flanged plate with holes in front for double-tree bolt and through the flanges for pole-bolt. It also forms the catch for the foot-board latch. Pintle (1) (c). — For connecting the carriage-body bolted between the fork-flanges. Pintle-key (1) (d). — For securing the lunette. Pintle-key Chain (1). — For securing the pintle-key to the limber. Pintle Brace-rods (2). — From the rear hound understrap- bolts to the rear pintle-body bolt. Hound Brace-rods (2). — From the front pintle-body bolt to the ring-bolt of primer- and obturator-boxes. Primer- and Obturator-boxes (2) (»). — Two water-tight cylindrical boxes with screw-lids, bolted through the bot- toms to the axle, and by a ring-bolt to the hounds, for carrying unbroken boxes of primers and spare ' obturators. Ammunition-chest, Wood {I). — Ironed, with corrugated- iron plate on back. It is covered with duck, and the lid is secured, when down, by hasp and turnkey. Three com- partments: end ones for projectiles, 31 in eachj middle for 44 cartridges and two haversacks. The packing divisions for projectiles are of cast bronze. * A corrugated sheet-metal prop will hereafter be attached to the neck-yoke stop. It will fold up under the pole, partly enveloping it, and be secured by a hook on the prop. 136 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. OTS GUN- AND CAISSON-LIMBBES CAN BE CARRIED: Two paulins. Two spare obturators, or two or more (depending on size) boxes of primers, or one obturator and one or more boxes of primers. One oiler, one tool-box, one wheel-grease can with spatula. One pole-prop for end of pole(now replaced by sheet-metal prop.) One section of picket-rope (can be used for a prolongs) with metal terminals for connection with other terminals (34 feet long ; 3-incb rope). Three or four knapsacks. One breech-sight. Two haversacks. On and strapped to chest-lid ; ordinarily not carried on cais- son-limbers. In watertight cylindrical boxes under the chest; ordinarily not carried on caisson-limbers. In compartment under the foot- boards ; wheel-grease can only ordinarily carried on caisson- limbers. ( Under foot-boards, left-hand side, j between chest and axle. On the foot-boards. One of these sections is carried for and with each carriage, and ordinarily, for gun-carriage and limber, coiled under the left seat of gun-carriage ; for the battery- wagon and forge, in the wagon or on top of it fastened to rail- ing, in the folding forage- rack, or coiled around the middle rail near the vise, as may be most convenient ; and for caisson, on its limber foot- boards, or on caisson as above detailed, On the foot-boards. Knapsacks are carried in the artillery- wagon. Carried in its leather case in one of the foot-board compart- ments. A spare one may be carried in one of the caisson- limbers. In middle-chest compartment on top of cartridges ; ordinarily carried in the gnn-limber chest. FIELD- ABTILLMBY. 137 The tool-box (one for each gun, carried in the compart- ment under the foot-boards of gun-limber) has capacity for the following tools and implements: One screw-wrench. One iron nut-wrench, 12 inches long. One 1-inch cold-chisel, 8 inches long. One 8-inch bastard-file. One hand-hammer, 12i-inch handle. One small steel punch. One vent-punch. 1 These may be carried, if more One gunner's gimlet. > convenient, in the gun-carriage One priming-wire. ) trail-box. Weight of tool-box, 1 pound 13 ounces ; contents, as above, 7 pounds 8 ounces. 138 A lIANDBOOt fOM LJGBT ABTILLEBY. 3.3" GUN, CARRIAGE, LIMBER, WEIGHTS, EQUIPMENTS No. Article. Weight. Total. 1 3.3 B. L. rifle, revised model Lbs. Oz. Lbs Oz. 794 1 Carriage, with brakes 1166 1 a Jointed sponge and rammer, with cover Short rammers and sponges combined, with covers 7 7 15 1 14 8 8 1 Prolonge (section of picket-rope) Primer-poiiclies, 3 Lanyards Limber complete, with neck-yoke 31 14 957 4 1 1 Wheel-grease can and spatula 5 2 9 54 4 3 18 8 2 d 7 a. 13 13 6 4 18 1 Breech-sight 1 Breech-sight pouch 1 Sperm-oiler 1 1 Tool-box, with tools Fuze-punch 3 Piuilins(13' X 12') 3 3 Gunner's haversacks Watering-buckets, canvas - 1 Cushion Projectiles (13. 5 lbs. each) 99 10 42 567 154 3 13 44 44 Cartridges (3.5 lbs. each) Cartridge-bags 723 13 3773 8 fi2S 10 Weight per horse ExTKA Weight for 3.6-inch Gun -CAKRIAQE 1 1 36 3.6-inch B. L. rifle (1181 lbs. weight). . Carriage, with brakes (1300 lbs. weight). Projectiles (30 lbs. each) ' 387 134 153 4 88 Cartridges (4.1875 lbs. each) Total extra weight 678 Total weight 4430 4 738 6 Weight per horse FIELD-ABTILLEB T. THE CAISSON. 139 Fig. 64. Weight of caissou complete, without limber 1396 lbs. Weight of caisson and limber complete, without am- munition 2436 " Weight of caisson and limber ) Light field-battery 46071 " complete, with ammunition y Heavy field-battery 5080 " Length from end of pole to end of spare-wheel axle 24i ft. Distance between centres of axles 8 " Fig. 64a. KOMEKCLATUEE. 1. Lunette, a. Middle rail. 3. Front cross-bar. 4. Foot-board. 5. Pickaxe attachment, front. 6. Ammunition-chest keys and chains. 7. Brake-chain. 8. Side rail. 9. Spare pole. 10. Ammunition-chest. 11. Brake-lever. [dies. 13, Front ammunition-chest hau- ls Pickaxe attachment, rear. 14. Axe and spade board-irons. 15. Middle rail. 16. Brake eye-strap. [dies. 17. Rear ammunition-chest han- 18. Ammunition-chest keys and chains. 19. Spare-pole stirrup. 20. Spare-wheel axle-bolster. 21. Spare-wheel axle- washer. 22. Spare wheel. 23. Spare-wheel axle. 24. Toggle.. 140 A HANDBOOK FOB LIQBT ARTILLERY. The limber of the caisson has already been described. The caisson. Fig. 64a, consists of one wrought-steel tubular axle and two Archibald wheels (57i in.), same as for lim- bers, the caisson-body, and connecting parts, viz. : The Middle rail (central part of body formed of two augle-irons) receives the lunette in front and spare wheel ill rear, and is attached to the axle by an understrap, and to the side-rails by front and rear cross-bars, with connec- tions stiffened by brackets, and the strength at axle in- creased by middle-rail braces. The Side-rails, which are attached to the axle by under- straps and joined to the middle rail by the front and rear cross-bars. The Foot-board is fastened to the middle and side rails with brackets to incline the surface of the board. Floor-rods, passing through middle and side rails, be- tween rear chest and rear cross-bar. Two Road-brakes complete, and attachments for imple- ments and spare parts. The lever road-brake now supplied is similar to the ordinary wagon-brake, and so arranged that each side may be operated separately. The shoe is applied in rear of the wheel, and the brake-lever stands upright inside the wheels, opposite the front side of the rear ammunition-chest. The caisson body carries two ammunition-chests same as for limber. ON THE CAISSON CAN BE CARRIED: A Spare Wheel, which fits upon an iron axle-arm attached to the rear, end of the middle rail, or a spare pole. Two long-handled shovels. P i' f ^y suitable attachments underneath. One spare pole, ) Two spades, ] Two axes, [ ^^*^^^° «1^««<^«- FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 141 Four watering-buckets, canvas. One or two lanterns. Two paulins, on chests. One manoeuvring-handspike, right side, along the side- rail. One section of picket-rope, coiled around spare-wheel axle-bolster, or around floor-rods and rear cross-bar. Two extra boxes of ammunition can also be carried, one on each side of spare-wheel axle, resting on the floor-rods and lashed on. STOWING OF CAISSOir IMPLEMENTS. Long-handled Shovels. — The concave faces of the blades are toward and resting against the axle, under side, the shovel-points being passed into staple-straps in rear of the axle and the shovel handles afterward into catches on the front cross-bar, against which the ends of handles rest. The Pickaxes, which must be put on before the shovels, are carried beneath by fixtures attached to both middle and side rails. The ends of the handles are brought to- gether, the pointed halves of the blades overlapped, one in advance of the other (if the spare pole be on, this must be done fflJow the pole); handle-ends are then passed into a broad strap of sheet metal depending from the middle rail, and at the same time the outer blade-ends into brack- ets or shelves on the side-rails. In this position the over- lapping blades should be under a catch and immediately in front of a bracket or shelf on the middle rail, which is to support the picks, and to get them into which they should be pressed up against the spring and toward the axle until the spring falls behind them. This spring has, toward the axle, a long branch on which to place the hand when pressing up the spring to remove the picks. The Axes and Spades are carried between the chests. A 142 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. board is there, permanently riveted to the side-rails at each end. Within the rails, on opposite sides, are slots, into which the blades are placed vertically, the halves resting on top of the board. The spade-blades, spade-handles crossed, are placed on the board, one at each side, between the helve of one and the blade of the other axe, concave face toward the axe-blade, the ends of spare blades against the outer branch of the upright metal stops fastened to the board-ends ; the handles of the spades are then forced down until the ends rest on top of the axes. The Canvas Buckets are carried in left compartment under limber foot-boards. The Lanterns. — Lanterns are carried in canvas bags hung across the spare-wheel axle-bolster. They hang below the floor-rods and do not swing. The picket-rope section, manoeuvring-handspike, and spare pole or spare wheel are carried as already indicated. Spare wheels, spare poles, and manmuvring-handspikes are not considered part of the regular caisson equipment. In war-time it is proposed to carry on each spare caisson a spare wheel, on the left caisson of each platoon a spare pole, and on the right caisson of each platoon a spare handspike. In horse-artillery the front chest of each caisson-body should be removed to bring the gun-team and caisson-team loads to an equality and give space for forage. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 143 CAISSON, WEIGHTS AND EQUIPMENT. Article. Weight. Total. Caisson complete, with brakes and neck-yoke Axes, handled Pickaxes, handled Shovels, long-handled Spades, short-handled Paulius Water-buckets Lanterns with Cranston attachment Prolonge (section of picket-rope) . .■ Cushions Grease-can and spatula Projectiles (13i lbs. each) Cartridges (3.5 lbs. each) Cartridge-bags Lbs. Oz. ■"10 15 8 10 109 8 3 4 5 8 15 8 87 8 5 8 1701 463 8 4 Total weight Weight per horse with above equipment, For horse-artillery deduct 1 chest, filled " " " total weight " " " weight per horse For 3.6 ammunition : Projectiles (under the supposition each chest will contain 36 rounds).. Cartridges Cartridge-bags that 2160 477 6 7 3 Total weight Weight per horse. , The weight per horse is increased : By adding 1 spare handspike 0.93 lbs. " " 1 spare pole 4.75 " " " 1 spare wheel 33.66 " Lbs. Oz. 3316 8 319 13 3171 4 4607 8 768 909 8 3698 616 5 3644 8 5080 13 846 13 144 A UAMBBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. COMBINED BATTERY-WAGON AND FORGE. immw, Pig. 65. Weight empty, including limber 8081 lbs. Weight complete 2731 " This consists of one limber complete, same as gun-carriage limber except that the primer- and obturator-boxes are omitted, and the packing of the chest is adapted to securing the smith's tools and the forge instead of ammunition, and one metal body with Archibald wheels and tubular steel axle, same as for caisson except that the attachments for implements are omitted, while attachments are provided for anvil and sledge in front of the wooden body on the middle rail. The vise is mounted on the front CTid of the middle rail, and the attachment for the lunette-prop is under and continuous with the attachment for the sledge. The body (the entire top of which is covered with canvas) has three compartments. Two lids (one opening upward on either side and forming part of the top) open into one containing grindstone and stand-closets packed with stores and spare parts for the repair of the battery; and lids at the front end, opening into the other two, which contain chests of saddler's, carpenter's, and wheelwright's tools, all of which are so arranged that any one can be taken out without disturbing the others. A folding forage-rack in rear and a rail around the top provide space for carrying forage. The brake is the lever road-brake. FIELD-ABTILLEB Y. 145 Fig. 65a. NOMENCLATURE. 1. Lunette-prop. 2. Lunette. 3. Vise. 4. Middle rail. 5. Sledge. 6. Attachment for sledge lunette-prop. 7. Anvil. 8. Anvil key. 9. Anvil-key nut. 10. Anvil-key chain. 11. Brake-chain. 12. Brake-shoe. 13. Brake-lever. 14. Side rail. 15. Wagon body, and 16. Brake eye-strap. 17. Lid. 18. Middle rail. 19. Wagon-body rail. 20. Rack. 21. Rack-chain. caepenter's and wheelwright's chest contains: 1 brace with twelve assorted bits. 1 12-in. drawing-knife. 1 20-in. hand-saw. 1 26-in. rip-saw. 1 hand-axe. 1 claw-hammer. 4 framing-chisels (i, 1, li, 2 in.). 3 framing-gouges (i, 1, li in.). 1 12-in. screw-wreuch. 1 jack-plane. 1 smoothing-plane. 1 spoke-shave, 1 2-foot rule. 10 assorted brads and awls, con- tained in handle. 1 trying-square. 1 Chesterman - Sheffield linen tape-line. 1 scribing-awl. 12 assorted saw-flies (4 and 6 in.) 1 10-in. wood-rasp. 1 10-in. wood-file. 1 oiler. 1 8-in, oil-stone. 146 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 1 gauge. 1 patent auger-handle. 1 10-in. compass. 3 file-handles, Iron (4-in. flat,4-in. 1 table-vise. round, and 5 in.). 1 pincers. 2 small canvas bags for small 1 wooden mallet. stores. 6 auger-bits (i, h f, 1, li in.). Weight of chest empty 55 lbs. Weight of contents, as above 47i " Total 103J " THE saddler's CHEST CONTAINS: 1 round knife. 1 cutting-nippers. 1 shoe-knife. 1 riveting-hammer. 1 draw-gauge. 1 edge-lool, No. 3. 6 assorted stitching-awls, han- 1 mle, 2-foot, wood. died. 1 oil-stone. 1 rivet-set, 3 holes. 1 pliers, large. 1 revolving punch (4 tubes, Nos- 1 driving-punch. No. 5. 4, 5, 6, 7). 1 stitching-horse, complete. 1 claw- tool. ■ 3 small canvas bags for small 1 6-in. compass. stores. 1 creaser, wood. Weight of chest empty 50 lbs. Weight of contents, as above 29 " 8 oz. Total 79 " 8 " THE EORGE-CHEST CONTAINS: • 1 portable " Empire " forge com- 1 12-in. flat bastard-file. plete, modified for army use. 1 round hand-punch. 1 hand-hammer, haudled. 1 hardy. 1 riveting-hammer. 1 12-in. screw-wrench. 1 smith's tongs (11 in.). 1 2-foot rule, wood. 1 tongs for J-in. iron. 1 square, steel. 1 tongs for i-iu. iron. 1 oiler. 1 chisel for hot iron, handled. 1 6-in. iron file- handle. 1 chisel for cold iron, handled. 1 small wrench for portable 1 fore-punch and creaser, ban- forge. died. 1 fire-rake. 1 hand Qold-chisel. 1 fire-shovel. FIELD-ABTILLEBY. 147 3 small canvas bags for nails and 1 pritchel. small stores. 1 16-in. sboeing-rasp. 2 smith's leather aprons. 2 shoeing-kuives. 1 sole-leather sboelng-box and 1 toe-knife. the following farrier's tools, 1 shoelng-pincers. viz.: 1 clinching-iron. 1 shoeing-hammer. 1 nail-punch. Weight of chest empty 150^ lbs. Weight of contents, as above. Forge complete 61-J " Tools, etc 39J " Total 351 " STOWIITG OF IMPLEMENTS, ETC. In Limber-chest. — Middle compartment contains portable forge, forge-implements, and part of tbe tools and shoe-box. Right-hand compartment contains horseshoes. Left-hand compartment contains remaining tools and small stores, such as horseshoe-nails, small bolts, nuts, etc., to carry which two small canvas bags are provided. Lim- ber-chest is locked, and key carried by blacksmith. The Coal is carried in the large canvas bag, capacity 3 bushels, on the foot-boards, lashed to the chest-handles by stout cords permanently attached to the bag, one of them being the cord by which the mouth of the bag is drawn together and secured. When empty, the bag is carried inside the chest. Further description regarding the stowing of the body part is unnecessary. 148 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. FORGE AND BATTERY- WAGON, WEIGHTS AND EQUIP- MENTS. No. Article. Weight. Total. For^e and battery-wagon complete, with brakes and neck-yoke, but Lbs. Oz. Lbs. Oz. 2081 Set blacksmith's and farrier's tools complete 39 4 61 55 47 50 29 50 33 10 100 5 50 18 7 1 5 5 6 54 15 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 13 8 # Coal-baff Tool-chest, wheelwright's, com- plete , Set tools, wheelwright's, complete.. Tool-cheat, saddler's, complete. . . . Set tools, saddler's, complete Jackscrews. Vise Hammer-sledge Anvil Battery-wagon lunette-prop Grindstone, flanges, shaft, and crank, complete Grindstone-frame complete Can for coal-oil Can for sperm-oil Grease-can and spatula 3 4 3 Lanterns with Cranston attachment Water-buckets (2 canvas, 2 gal. iron) Paulins 1 Prolonge (section of picket-rope). . . Total weight 649 12 3730 12 Weight per horse without stores. 455 3 MELB-ABTILLEB T. THE ARTILLERY-WAGON. 149 Fig. Weight complete, 1868 pounds. This wagon, on the canvas cover of which is painted its name and the designation of the battery, is made of white oak, and is for carrying the knapsacks, ammunition for small-arms, spare small-arms, and spare intrenching tools of the battery. It has the same track as the other artillery- carriages, and the axles are self-oiling, one filling lasting a month. The capacity of the interior is for 120 knapsacks, weigh- ing about 3000 pounds. The rear wheels are 57f inches in diameter; the fore wheels are smaller, in order to turn under the body of the reach. The driver's seat is a lock-box of three compartments, the two end ones being for spare revolvers and revolver- cartridges. The middle compartment is for the following articles, viz. : 1 wheel-grease can and spatula; 1 self -oiling axle-grease syringe; 1 hand-hammer; 1 wrench. 150 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBY. On the rear of the wagon is carried a 35-gallon water- keg, fitted with bronze screw-bung and a spigot. Under the body of the wagon and above the reach and rockers are carried the spare double (1) and single (2) trees, and the following intrenching-tools, viz.: 2 long-handled shovels, 2 spades, 2 pickaxes, 2 axes. To the foot-board is attached a dash-board lamp, which when not in use may be carried in the compartment under the driver's seat. A boot to protect the driver is also provided. The wagon has a double cover; the first, of water-proof canvas, covering the top only; the second, of cotton duck, extends down the sides and far enough in rear to lace at the ends. A stout canvas cover in rear of the driver's seat prevents the load from being thrown to the front. No special place is provided for the two canvas water- buckets, which should be carried where they can readily be gotten at. To fill the axle with oil remove the screw-washers and fill the spindles by means of the axle-grease syringe. THE WATER-CART. Nothing of this kind is supplied; but battery com- manders can readily improvise one for field marches and encampments and find it exceedingly useful. Obtain two good substantial wheels and an axle; attach shafts; build a suitable framework thereon to sustain a large barrel, which should have a faucet in the rear end and an opening for filling it on top. LIGHT-ARTILLERY HARNESS. The harness is made of black leather, black buckles, and without ornaments other than black leather rosettes. In connecting the principal parts of the harness and in attach- FIELD-ARriLLBR T. 151 ing the horse to the limber hooks, hooking into rings or links only at the point where a depression is made in the ring or link, are used. The Bridle (a) is similar to the regulation cavalry bridle except that it has black buckles and black rosettes. The coupling-rein of the off horse can be lengthened or short- ened as desired, and has a snap-hook for attaching the end to a ring on the saddle of the near horse. The lash end of the reins of the off horse passes through a roller on the pommel of his saddle and falls to the left, convenient to the driver's hand, so that by pulling it the horse is set back in his harness directly to the rear. The Halter is of leather, with leather halter-strap. The Saddle. NoMEKCLATURE. — (A) pommel; (5)cantle; (C) side-bar; (Z>) quarter-straps, front, spi- der; {E) quarter-straps, rear, spider; {F) quarter-strap ring or spider-ring; {G) cincha; {H) cincha-strap; (J) cinchar ring; {K) stirrup-loop; {L) stirrup-strap; {M) stirrup-tread; {N) stirrup hood; (P) rings; (R) cantle-staple; {S) saddle-bag stud; {aa) {bb ) coat-straps or thongs; {ii) cincha-ring safes. The regulation McClellan sad- dle, with saddle bags ip), Fig. 68, is used. Some batteries are sup- plied with fair-leather seats which Fig. 67. are to be preferred to black leather ones. Leather-covered wooden stirrups for officers; enlisted men use brass stirrups. Saddles of horses in harness have a pommel-ring to which 152 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGBT ARTILLERY. the collar-strap {v) is hooked ; and saddles of wheel-horses have, securely fastened to them, cantle-hooks {k), which serve to hold the single-trees {%) when detached from the double-tree. These hooks can be removed and attached to another saddle, if necessary, in the field. A loop is placed on the hair cincha to support the martingale {n). There are three sizes of cinchas, viz., 16-inch, 18-inch, and 20-inch. Fig 68. The Draught-harness.— This consists of the locking- collar (c), with hames permanently attached. The trace- tugs {d), permanently attached on either side of the collar, terminate in a ring (e), through which the toggle (/) of the trace passes. The trace {g) is made of two thicknesses of leather and has a D ring at either end to which chains are attached. The front chain (/) is short with a toggle at the end. FIELD-AltTlLLEB Y. 153 The rear chain {h) is 24 inches long with a hook at the end; each link has a depression in it over which the hook can pass. Mogul springs {l) are used on the trace-chains of wheel-horses. The trace-chains («/) of lead-horses terminate in a ring which passes over the toggle of the trace in rear; the hook- end is then passed through the ring at the end of the trace and hooked in any link of the chain. The Breeching. — In this connection it should be stated that the neck-yoke (o) is attached to the wheel-horse by means of a breast-strap (?•) which passes through the ring on the neck-yoke and hooks on either side of the collar to a ring. The breeching consists of a broad breech-strap {m), supported by hip-straps {s, s'), with rings at either end; a back-strap {t), with crupper {t') attached, hooks to the saddle, and also has a loin-strap {u) for supporting the traces. The martingale {n), of heavy leather with folded edges, is attached to the neck-yoke (m) by means of a cinch-strap sewed to a ring in its front end. It passes' between the fore legs of the horse and through the loop on the cincha, and the D ring at its rear end should be near the middle of the horse's belly. Attached to the ring on either end of the breech-strap is a side-strap (s") bearing a hook which hooks into the D ring at the rear end of the martingale. The martingale and side-straps, being under the body of the horse and connected with the breeching and neck-yoke, the horse is not only held up, but uses his weight and strength to the best advantage when holding back. 6 Fig. 69. 6', breech-strap; s", side-straps; n, martingale; m, neck-yoke. 154 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT AtlTtLLBBY. The breech-strap, hip-strap, side-straps, martingale, and breast-strap are omitted on lead-horses. The blanket is of wool, dyed scarlet. The dress saddle-cloth is of heavy cotton canvas, bright scarlet, bound with black leather. It is easily cleaned by scrubbing with soap and water. The leg-guard, whip, watering-bridle, surcingle, nose-bag, and when required lariat and picket-pin. Surcingles are of three sizes, viz.: No. 1, 76^ inches; No. 2, 84 inches; and No. 3, 96 inches. The collar now used is a hinged steel locking-collar. This steel collar, weighing about 15 pounds, consists essen- tially of two plates, pressed in U shape, hinged together at the top, and closed at the bottom by a spring latch. One side of the plate is fitted to the animal's shoulder ; the other side carries the trace-hooks, under which are placed U-shaped plate-springs, which are held in place by the same bolts as are the trace-hooks. All parts of the collar and its fittings are put together with bolts, and can be quickly taken apart when necessary, the only tool needed being the wrench that accompanies each collar. The parts of the collar that rest on the neck and shoulders are galvanized, which prevents galling in warm or wet weather, and conduces to the healing of sores. The collar is opened by pressing a spring latch at the bot- tom, and is thus easily put on and taken off without fore- ' ing it over the horse's head. The collar being such an important part of the harness, directions for fitting it are given as indicated in the circular of the Steel Horse Collar Company, of Fitchburg, Mass. Collar-sides, pads, and connections are made in different sizes to suit the number of collar. All the other parts will fit any collar. MELD-ARTILLEBY. DESCRIPTION OF PARTS OF COLLAR. 165 BuckTe latch. Buckle springs Fig. 70. and the bolts for top connection, bottom of collar, exten- sion, and trace-plate. The table of dimensions at the top of next page gives the largest size to which each number of collar can be ad- justed. Each collar can be made 1^ inches shorter and 1:;^ inches narrower than the dimensions given. Sizes 5 and 6 are used in the TJ. S. service. To shorten the collar, take out the bolt that fastens the ex- tension to collar-side, and press the extension down into the collar-side one or two holes as desired, and replace the bolt. 150 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. DIBECTIOlfS FOE FITTING COLLARS. TABLE OP DIMENSIONS. Width Width Length of Collar. % Down from Top. at Widest Part. No. Inches. Inches. Inches. 1 164 5f 74 2 18 5i 8 4 19i 6 8f 5 31 74 9i 6 32i 74 9i 7 24 8 10 The width is changed at the top by using the different pads and connections. Each pad has its own connection, which forms the hinge at the top of the collar. The collar is taken in at the bottom by shifting the bolt that holds the buckle in the side having the three holes. Each pad, connection, and collar-side has the number de- noting its size stamped upon it. Any reference to the collar-side hereafter will mean collar-side and extension put together, which form the collar-side complete. When it is necessary to put a No. 3 pad, the largest size, in the top of the collar, and adjust the bottom to the mid- dle or smallest size, the collar-sides will have to be bent at the top under the eye enough to allow the collar to close easily at the bottom, and when the reverse is wanted the collar-sides can be straightened. In making these irregular changes be particular to get both sides of the collar the same length, so that it will close at the bottom. The sides can be easily twisted to make them come to- gether evenly. When it is necessary to bend the ends of the pads to make them fit closely to the collar-sides, use a wooden mallet. If a hammer is used, it will break the zinc on the galvanized parts. FIELD-ABTILLEB T. THE ARTILLERY-WAGON HARNESS. 157 The same as regular artillery harness, omitting the sad- dles and substituting a back-strap, and replacing the curb- reins and Qoupling-reins. by a set of regular driving-reins. A four-in-hand whip is also used with the harness. •HARNESS WEIGHTS. No. Article. Halter Bridle Coupling-strap Collar Breast-strap Martingale Traces, with chains and mogul springs Saddle complete. . . , Saddle-bags, pair of Breeching complete Crupper Blanket Leg-guard Whip Total Watering-bridle . Surcingle Nose-bag Grand total Horse-brush and cur- i^ycomb weigh 1. 33 Lariat and picket-pin weigh 3.09 lbs. Wheel. Near. Off. Lbs. Oz 2 6 3 15 1 14 1 4 10 8 17 10 4 10 5 4 4 3 3 11 13 69 1 1 13 1 3 71 15 Lbs. Oz 3 6 10 14 4 10 8 17 10 4 10 5 4 4 3 66 4 1 13 1 3 69 3 Lead. Near. Off. Lbs. Oz. 3 6 3 15 11 4 16 14 4 10 Lbs.Oz. 3 6 3 10 15 58 13 1 13 1 3 61 10 11 4 16 14 4 10 3 8 4 3 59 6 1 13 1 3 63 4 COLT'S REVOLVER, CALIBRE .45. This revolver is retained, for the present, for light bat- teries, and experiments are now being made to ascertain if ft shorter barrel can not be advantageously used. 158 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. NoMENCLATUEE. — {A), barrel; {B) frame; (5') recoil- plate; (C) cylinder; {DD) centre-pin; {D') centre-pin bushing; {E) guard; {F) back-strap; {G) hammer; {H) ■ mainspring; (1) hammer-roll and rivet; (J) hammer-screw; (^) hammer-cam; ^i) hand and hand-spring; {M) bolt and screw; (N) trigger and screw; (0) hammer-notches; {/') firing-pin and rivet; {Q) ejector-rod and spring; {Q') ejector-tube; {R) ejector-head; {S) ejector-tube screw; {T) short guard-screw; {U) sear and bolt-spring (combined) and screw; (F) back- strap screw; (PF) mainspring-screw; (X) front sight; [Y) centre-pin screw. The two back- strap screws just behind the hammer, the stock, the long guard-screw, gate, gate-catch screw, gate-spring, and gate-catch are not shown in < m Fig- 71. IP fM^ To Load. — Hold the revolver in the left hand, muzzle downward; half-cock it with the right hand and open the gate. Insert the cartridges with the right hand, close the gate, and bring the hammer to the safety-notch. Keep it there until the revolver is fired. To Ejectthe Cartridge-shells. — Hold the revolver in the left hand, at the half-cock, and with the gate open. Eject the shells with the ejector, pushed by the right hand, turning the cyl- inder with the thumb and ^i»- '''I- ' fore finger of the left hand. To Dismount the Revolver.— Half-cock the revolver, loosen the centre-pin catch-screw, draw out the centre-pin, open the gate, and the cylinder can then be withdrawn. FIELD-ABTILLEB T. 159 To remove the ejector, turn out the ejector-tube screw, then push the front end away from the barrel, and pull it towards the muzzle. The stock can be removed by turn- ing out the two back-strap screws just behind the hammer, and that at the bottom of the strap. Kemove the main- spring and guard: the parts of the lock can then be readily separated. The centre-pin bushing should be pushed out for cleaning. To remove the gate, turn out the gate-screw in the lower side of the frame (hidden by the guard); then the gate-spring and catch can be withdrawn and the gate pushed out. To Assemble the Revolver.— See the directions for dis- mounting, which should be followed in inverse order. The mainspring is most conveniently mounted by turning in the screw part way, and then swinging around the front end of the mainspring until it bears against the under side of the friction-roll. The cylinder-bushing should be frequently removed for cleaning. Dimensions and Weights.— The following table gives the principal dimensions, weights, etc., of the revolver : DIMENSIONS. Totallength 13.5 inches. Length of barrel 7.5 " Diameter of bore 0.445 " Grooves — number 6 " twist, uniform, one turn in (left-handed) 16 " depth, uniform 005 in. WBIOHTS. Total weight 3.5 lbs. Weight of powder- charge 28 grs. Weight of bullet 230 " Initial velocity 730 ft. -sec. The cartridge-case is metallic centre-fire, and resembles in its construction the rifle cartridge. Bapidity of Fire. — Eighteen rounds in one minute and fifty-four seconds, beginning and ending with chambers empty. 160 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. Range, yds Inches PENETBATION IN WHITE PINE. .... 50 100 150 200 250 3f 34 34 2| 24 300 3i COST OP AMMUNITION. Ball cartridges f 10.00 per 1000 Blank " 8.30 " " PABTS OP COLT'S REVOLVER. Components. Price. Mainspring $0 10 Trigger 10 Bolt 10 Hand 10 Hand-spring 02 Stock 35 Long guard-screw (2), Ic.ea. 02 Short guard-screw (2) " 02 Back-strap screw (3) " 03 Hammer-screw 05 Trigger-screw 04 Bolt-screw., 02 Centre-pin screw 02 Ejector-tube screw. ...... . 02 Gate-catch screw 01 Mainspring screw 02 Sear-spring screw 02 Sear-spring 02 Screw-driver 10 Revolver complete , . $12 50 PRICE-LIST OP COMPONENT Components. Price. Frame $4 10 Recoil-plate '. . 05 Gate 55 Gate-spring ... , 01 Gate-catch 01 Barrel 1 60 Front sight. 05 Cylinder 1 60 Centre-pin 18 Centre-pin bushing 20 Ejector-tube. 1 05 Ejector-rod 17 Ejector-head 25 Ejector-spring 07 Hammer 55 Hammer-cam 01 Hammer- roll 02 Hammer-roU rivet 01 Firing-pin 05 Firing-pin rivet 01 Guard 50 Back-strap 30 ALLOWANCE OF AMMUNITION. Each enlisted man and oflBcer of a battery is allowed for revolver practice ammunition to the value of $1.00. Each battery is allowed 5000 rounds of blank ammunition. Battery commanders will keep a permanent record for each calendar year of the amount of ammunition expended at each target practice. Ammunition not expended at the end of the year (De- cember '31) is no longer available. HUNTING-KNIEE. A model, having a blade 12 inches long, and similar in shape to the regular bowie-knife, is now under considera- tion by the War Department, FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 161 CHAPTER V. Care and Fitting, etc., of Harness. Care of Carriages. Care ol Guns. Care of Ammunition. Guard Orders. CAEE OF PAINTS, OILS, AND PAINT-BEUSHES. Faints, Turpentines, Oils, Lacquers, etc., are kept in a room separate from other stores, preferably a cellar. The floor should be covered with several inches of fine sand, which should be renewed occasionally. Sawdust should never be used for the floor. Volatile Oils, such as kerosene or benzine, must never be kept stored in a room with other oils and paints, but in such place that the least possible danger will arise in case of fire. Paint-brushes, when new, and before using, should be wrapped with strong twine and soaked in water. After using they should be cleaned with spirits of turpentine and put away in a vessel containing water, in order to keep them pliable. PAINTS, LAOQUEKS, ETC. Waterproof Paint. — A solution of pure india-rubber in linseed-oil, ground with pure graphite into a thick, elastic, smoothly flowing paint. Flexible Paint for Canvas. — Dissolve 3^ pounds of yellow soap in \^ gallons of boiling water. Grind while hot with any good oil-paint. Varnish for Harness. — India-rubber, ^ pound ; spirits of turpentine, 1 gallon. Dissolve enough to make it a jelly; then take equal quantities of good hot linseed-oil and the 162 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT AliTILLEBT. above mixture, incorporate well over a slow firoj and it is ready for use. Linseed-oil Varnish. — Boil any quantity of linseed-oil for an hour, stir in until dissolved 4 ounces of powdered rosin to each pound of oil; then add 1 ounce spirits of turpen- tine to each pound of oil; cool and strain. It is cheap, a good preservative of wood, and stands hot water well. Lacquer for Iron Ordnance. — Coal-tar (of good quality), 2 gallons; spirits of turpentine, 1 pint ; the turpentine to be added in small quantities during the application of the lacquer. The surface of the metal must be first cleaned with a scraper and a wire brush, if necessary, and the lac- quer applied hot, in two thin coats, with a paint-brush. Lacquer for Bright Ironwork. — Boiled linseed-oil, 80.5 parts; litharge, 5.5 parts; white lead ground in oil, 11.35 parts; pulverized rosin, 2.75 parts. Add the litharge to the oil; let it simmer over a slow fire for three hours; strain it and add the rosin and white lead ; keep it gently warmed, and stir until the rosin is dissolved. Apply it with a paint-brush. Lacquer for Brasswork. — Alcohol (95j^), 2 ounces; seed- lac, 1 ounce. Put in glass for six days, exposed to the light; shake well once each day. Apply with brush while work is hot. To Attach Leather to Metal. — Coat the metal with a hot solution of glue and the leather with a hot solution of nut-galls. DIKECTIOIirS FOE CLEANING MOULDY LEATHEK. First. Wash thoroughly in soap-suds with a brush, so as to remove all dirt and mould. Second. Sponge with clean water, and before the leather dries apply with a sponge tied to a handle a solution of ammonia and water in equal parts, using 4 Fs. ammonia. Third. Apply, when dry, a coat of leather blacking. (A FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 163 good blacking can be made by placing in 5 gallons of best cider vinegar i pound of pulverized nut-galls, 2 pounds of copperas, 1 pound of iron filings or chips, and letting it stand for five days before use, stirring carefully from time to time.) Fourth. After the leather is dry apply a good coating o£ oil — 1 part of kerosene and 4 parts of neat's-foot. Apply freely so as to soften the leather, and let it dry sufficiently. Fifth. Brush the pieces well, and put on with a sponge a thin coat of gum tragacanth, dissolving i pound of gum in 1 gallon of warm water. After drying the leather should be repacked, if desired to store it. Harness in use which becomes hard from perspiration or from being wet should be washed, oiled, and rubbed as above, without applying the, solution of ammonia, or of blacking unless the leather has become reddish. CAKE OF HARliTESS. The estimated life of a set of artillery harness is seven years. Harness, after being used, must be carefully wiped and cleaned; if possible, this is done before taking it off the horse; otherwise it is put in good order at the earliest prac- ticable moment, and covered with the sack. Straps and leather parts generally are kept soft and supple; trace- chains and iron parts free from rust. Collars and saddles ^ill be aired and kept perfectly clean. The greatest care must be exercised in keeping the collar where it bears against the horse in perfect order. Harness should be oiled two or three times a year if necessary. The best oil for this use is neat's-foot oil, the unctuous property of which is particularly suitable for preserving the suppleness of the leather ; this oil contains no siccative part, and may be used unpurified. Four pints and a half 164 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. will oil the harness of a team of three pairs. To keep it from becoming rancid, use 1 part kerosene to 4 parts neat's-foot. Before iising the oil every part of the leather must be perfectly cleaned and washed, without letting the water soak deeply into the leather ; while still damp blacken with dye those places which have become red ; when the leather begins to dry, oil it, spreading the oil on with a sponge or thick, soft brush. When neat's-foot oil cannot be had, pure fish-oil may be used, but it must be carefully ascertained that it does not contain any siccative matter, which would make it injurious. Other oils may be usefully employed, as whale-oil, when they can be gotten pure ; this is not easily done, it being hard to detect the frauds. Vegetable oils are very hurtful. As good oil cannot always be had, a mixture of three quartei's of melted lard and one quarter of whale-oil may be used in emergencies; it should be spread over the leather with a piece of woollen cloth, and well rubbed in. Blacking for harness and dressings are given under "Mountain Artillery," p. 61. The prepared harness-oil manufactured at Eock Island Arsenal is packed in tins 4^ X 4i X 8^ inches, each containing 6 pounds of oil. Twenty-five tins are packed in a box. Kerosene is good for cleaning rust from iron parts, and then use sperm-oil. To paint metal parts, use asphaltum paint. Before applying care should be taken that every particle of rust is removed; then give two light coats, allowing plenty of time for the first coat to dry. Colgate's black harness soap and Frank Miller's harness soap No. 2^, are excellent for keeping harness clean and soft with little trouble, Frank Miller's harness soap and asphaltum paint can be obtained from the Ordnance Department. mBLD-ARriLLERY. 165 Eecent orders from the War Department forbid the use of any dressings other than those furnished by the Ord- nance Department. In the field there will not usually be much time or many materials available for cleaning harness. Rust should be cleaned o£E ironwork with sand, kerosene, etc., the iron- work being then oilea. Leather should be kept soft and pliable by having a small quantity of soft soap, if proper oil be not on hand, worked into it, mud and sweat being first removed with as little water as possible. The blanket must be kept clean, and folded to lie per- fectly smooth on the horse's back. Inspect the collar and see that its bearing surface is free from dirt, dried hair, etc., before putting it on the horse, and at every opportu- nity. The necessity for repairs will be reported imme- diately, and the repairs will be made by the saddler at the earliest practicable moment. In garrison harness is wiped off after each drill, and is carefully cleaned once a weak. A good driver should clean his harness thoroughly in from 1 to 1^ hours, especially if provided with a trestle on which to spread it out. First remove all dust and dirt with a damp cloth, disconnecting all of the parts for that purpose. Then apply either soap or dressing with a sponge, wetting the sponge with water when using the soap. Harness-pegs. — Harness-pegs for each pair are arranged i-n the walls of the harness-room or in the heel-posts of the stalls. There should be three pegs for each double set of harness, the upper one for the pole-yoke, with the martin- gales attachedj the bridles, and collars; the next for the off harness, and the lower one for the near harness. ARRANGEMENT OF HARNESS ON PEGS. On the Upper Peg. — First, the pole-yoke, with the mar- tingales attached, next to the post or wall; then the bridle 166 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGBT ARTILLMS.T. and collar of the near horse; then the bridle and collar of the off horse, in the order named. On the Middle Peg.— The off harness; the traces, which are detached, are hung over the peg close to the heel-post; the saddle, with its attachments over ^e seat, is placed on the peg. ^ On the Lower Peg. — The leg-guard is slipped over this peg, and the near harness is placed on it, as described above for the off harness. Bach hair-pad is placed on top of its saddle. The saddle-cloths, being designed only for occasions of ceremony, are kept wherever directed by the battery com- mander, and issued when it is intended to use them. TO HAKNESS IN GARKISOlir, WHEEL. Collar. — Bach wheel-driver puts on and locks the collar of his off horse. Pad. — He puts on the hair-pad, and also the saddle-cloth if it is to be used. If the saddle-blanket is used instead of the hair-pad, it will be folded and put on as described. Saddle. — He puts on the saddle, with its attachments, taking care not to displace the pad or blanket, adjusts and secures the girth, buckles the collar-strap to the saddle, and then adjusts the breeching and buckles the crupper. Traces. — He takes the traces from the peg, passes tliem through the loin-loops, attaches the rear ends to the single- tree, which is hanging on the cantle-hook, and then the front ends to the collar, beginning with the off trace; the near trace will be laid on the saddle while attaching the other. Bridle. — He puts on the bridle and secures the coupling- rein to the manger. He then passes the reins through the roller. Collar. — Each wheel-driver begins to harness his near PlBLD-AttflLLBltT. 167 horse, as prescribed for harnessing the off horse, at the command " Collar." Pad, etc. — Same for the near horse as for the off horse, omitting the directions for the coupling- rein and roller. Yoke. — The wheel-driver puts on his leg-guard, and then, going to the front of his horses, backs them out of the stall, places them side by side, facing the exit, and beginning with the off horse attaches the near yoke by means of the breast-straps, then passes the martingales between the fore legs and through the standing loop on the cincha, and attaches the hooks at the end of the side-straps to the martingale D ring, and then stands to horse. To back out his pair, the wheel-driver unfastens the coupling-rein, then stands with his back to the manger, takes the reins of the near horse in his right hand and those of the off horse in his left hand near the bit, and backs the pair into the gangway. In single stalls, separated by partitions, each horse must be backed out by himself. Harness, Lead and Swing. — The lead- and swing-drivers harness in the same manner as wheel-drivers, with such omissions as are required by the difference in the harness. The traces are passed through the loin-strap loops, the front ends attached to the collars, and they are then trussed by bringing the rear ends forward and passing the toggle through the ring. The lead and swing pairs are not turned around nor backed into the gangway after harnessing unless it is intended to lead out. TO UNHARNESS. Unyoke. — Beginning with his near horse, each wheel- driver detaches the hooks at the end of the side-straps from the martingale-ring and draws the martingale from the standing loop on the cincha; he then unhooks the 168 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLERT. inside end of each breast-strap, detaches the neck-yoke, and hangs it up on its peg. Unbridle. — He uncouples his horses, leads them into the stall, secures the coupling-rein of the off horse to the manger, unbridles his near horse, puts on the halter and ties the halter-strap to the manger, hangs up the bridle, and takes off his leg-guard and places it on the peg. Collar oflF. — He unbuckles the collar-strap, detaches the front ends of traces from the collar, removes the collar and hangs it on its peg. Traces off. — He unhooks the traces from the single-tree, takes them off and hangs them on their peg. Unsaddle. — He unbuckles and frees the crupper, disen- gages the girth, places the breeching and then the girth on the saddle, takes off the saddle and places it on its peg with the saddle-pad on top. Unbridle. — Bach wheel-driver unfastens the coupling- rein, unbridles his off horse, puts on the halter, ties its strap to the manger, and hangs up the bridle. Collar off, etc. — The off harness is taken off in the same order as the near harness. TO UKHAEIS^ESS IN THE EIBLD. Without Harness-racks. — The pole-prop is placed under the end of the pole; the single-trees are left attached to the double-trees ; the wheel-traces are unhitched from the collars only, and laid over the chest from front to rear, or on the foot-board; the collars of the wheel-team on top of the limber-chest (paulins having been removed) next to the rail on the near side, the swing-collars in the middle, and the lead-collars next to the other rail ; the collar of the off horse is placed on top of that of the near horse of the same team; the remainder of the harness is placed on the pole, that of the near wheel-horse next to the double-tree and as close to it as possible, next that of the off wheel-horse, both nBLDARTILLEBT. 169 in the order laid down for the wheel-harness; the traces of the lead- and swing-harness (folded once) are laid over the pole; then on top of them the saddles, with the attach- ments over them, so as not to rest on the ground. The neck-yoke is placed on the footboard. To Hook the Single-tree. — Hold the single-tree with the eye down and against the side of the cantle-hook; then push it sidewise far enough so that the eye will pass over the cantle-hook ; then let the single-tree fall to the rear. This can be done from either side. To Fold the Saddle-blanket. — The blanket, after being well shaken, will be folded into six thicknesses, as follows: Hold it well up by the two corners, the long way up and down; double it lengthwise (so that the fold will come between the "TJ"and "S"), the folded corner (middle of the blanket) in the left hand; take the folded corner between the thumb and fore finger of the right hand, thumb pointing to the left; slip the left hand down the folded edge two thirds its length and seize it with the thumb and second finger; raise the hands to the height of the shoulders, the blanket between them extended; bring the hands together, the double fold falling outward ; pass the folded corner from the right hand into the left hand between the thumb and fore finger; slip the second finger of the right hand between the folds and seize the double folded corner; turn the left (disengaged) corner in and seize it with the thumb and fore finger of the right hand, the second finger of the right hand stretching and evening the folds; after evening the folds grasp the corners in the hands and shake the blanket well in order to smooth the folds; raise the blanket and place it between the chin and the breast; slip the hands down half-way, the first two fingers outside, the other fingers and thumb of each hand inside; seize the blanket with the thumbs and first two fingers; let the part under the chin fall forward; hold the ITO A HANDBOOK FOR LIGBT ARTILLERY. blanket up, arms extended, even the lower edges, seize the middle points between the thumbs and fore fingers, and flirt the outside part over the right arm ; the blanket is thus held before placing it on the horse. To Put on the Blanket. — Approach the horse on the near (left) side, with the blanket folded and held as just pre- scribed; place it well forward on his back, tossing the part of the blanket over the right arm to the right side of the horse, still keeping hold of the middle points; slide the blanket once or twice from front to rear to smooth the hair, being careful to raise the blanket in bringing it for- ward; place the fore finger of the left hand on the withers, and fore finger of the right hand on the backbone, the blanket smooth; it will then be well forward, with the edges on the left side; remove the locks of the mane that may be under it. To Saddle. — Place the pad or blanket on the horse as previously explained ; seize the pommel of the saddle with the left hand and the cantle with the right; approach the horse on the near side from the direction of the croup and place the centre of the saddle on the middle of the horses bach so it will fit close to it; let down the cincha-strap and cincha; pass by the horse's head to the off side, adjust the cincha and straps, and see that the pad or blanket is smooth; return to the near side by the head, raise the pad or blanket slightly under the pommel-arch so that the withers may not be compressed; take the cincha-strap in the right hand, reach under the horse and seize the cincha- ring with the left hand, pass the end of the strap through the ring from underneath (from inside to outside), then up and through the upper ring from the outside; if necessary, make another fold in the same manner. The strap is fastened as follows : Pass the end through the upper ring to the front; seize it with the left hand; place the fingers of the right between the outside folds of MELD-ARTILLERT. Ill the strap ; pull from the horse with the right hand and take up the slack with the left; cross the strap over the folds, pass the end of it, with the right hand, underneath and through the upper ring back of the folds, then down and under the loop that crosses the folds, and drs^ it tightly; weave the end into the strands of the cincha-strap, between the rings. Another method of fastening the cincha-strap is as fol- lows: Pass the end through the upper ring to the rear; seize it with the right hand ; place the fingers of the left between the outer folds of the strap; pull from the horse with the left hand and take up the slack with the right; pass the end of the strap underneath and draw it through the upper ring until a loop is formed; double the loose end of the strap and push it through the loop and draw the loop taut. The free end should then be long enough to conveniently seize with the hand. Having fastened the cincha-strap, let down the right stirrup, then the left. The surcingle is then buckled over the saddle and should be a little looser than the cincha. The cincha when first tied should admit a finger be- tween it and the belly. After exercising for a while the cincha will be found too loose and should be tightened. To Put on the Curb-bridle. — Take the reins in the right, the crownpiece in the left, hand; approach the horse on the near side, passing the right hand along the neck; slip the reins over his head and let them rest on his neck; take the crownpiece in the right hand and the" lower left branch of the bit in the left hand, the fore finger against the mouthpiece; bring the crownpiece in front of and slightly below its proper position; insert the thumb of the left hand into the side of the mouth above the tush; press open the lower jaw; insert the bit by raising the crownpiece; with the left hand draw the ears gently under the crownpiece, 1Y2 A HANDBOOK Fon LIGHT ARTlLLBttY. beginning with the left ear; arrange the forelock; secure the throat-latch and then the curb-strap, taking care not to set them too closely. The moutlipiece, which should fit the width of the hoik's mouth, rests on that part of the bars directly op- posite the chin-groove; the curb-strap will then lie in the cliin-groove, without any tendency to mount up out of it on the sharp bones of the lower jaw. This position of the mouthpiece will be attained for the majority of horses by adjusting the cheek-straps so that the mouthpiece will be one inch above the tushes of geldings and two inches above the corner teeth of mares. The throat-latch should admit four fingers between it and the throat; this prevents any constriction of the wind- pipe or pressure on the large blood-vessels. The curb-strap or chain, which should be of width to fit the chin-groove, — not over three fourths of aninoh, — should fit smoothly the chin-groove, and be loose enough to admit one or two fingers when the branches of the bit are in line with the cheek-strap. If the bridle be put on over the head-stall, the hitching- strap, if not left at the manger or picket-line, will be tied around the neck. The hitching-strap may also be arranged as follows : Loop it two or three times through the ring so that the loop may be about 8 inches long; wind the strap several times around the loops and draw the end tightly through them. FITTING HARNESS. The bridle and saddle are fitted as prescribed. The Collar, when adjusted, should admit the flat of the hand between the lower part and the throat, and the fin- gers between the sides and the neck. A short collar chokes a horse by pressing on the windpipe; a narrow one pinches FIELD-ABTILLEBY. 1Y3 and rubs the neck. A broad collar works aboiit and galls the shoulders. The Back-strap, when adjusted, should admit the breadth of the hand between it and the horse's back. The Collar-strap should not be tight; otherwise it would pull the saddle forward on the withers. The surcingle, when used, should be buckled on the near side of the near horse and on the ofE side of the off horse, less tight than, and over, the girth. The Breech-strap should be adjusted so that when the horse is pulling there will be a space of about four inches between the breech-strap and the horse's quarters. Tha Hip-strap should be of such length that the breech- strap will be a little below the point of the buttocks, or about 12 or 15 inches below the top of the dock. The Loin-straps should be adjusted so that the wheel- traces, when in draught, will be straight and without down- ward pull on the loops that support them. The loin-straps of swing- and lead-horses should raise the traces about six inches above the stifle-joint when in draught. In this position the line of the traces from front to rear will be straight, and the loops of the loin-straps will support the traces without drawing them up. The Side-straps should be so adjusted that when the horse is sitting back (stopping the carriage) no strain comes on the collar; the action should be performed by the horse sitting back into the breeching and thereby checking the momentum of the carriage by means of the side-straps, martingale, and neck-yoke. This is the most important adjustment of all. The Traces. — The length of the traces must depend in a great measure on the size of the horse and his stride. For the wheel-team the rule is to allow about 14 inches from single-tree to hindquarters, and for swing- and lead-teams one yard from nose to croup when in draught. The traces 1T4 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. Bhonld be adjusted so that the line of traction will be un- broken from the single-tree to the collars of the leaders, and this rule will regulate, in some measure, the length of the loin-straps, the matching of the horses, and arrange- ment of the pairs as wheel, swing, and lead pair; this should be such as to make the waste of force as small as possible. All front trace-chains are permanently fastened to the traces, and have a toggle at the end. All rear trace-chains have a ring at one end and a hook at the other; the hook is passed through the D ring at the end of the trace, and hooked back into any desired link. By this means the length of the trace is adjusted, and the rear trace-chain need not be removed except for cleaning. CAEE OF CAEEIAGES. In garrison carriages must be kept in the gun-sheds. In the field they should be parked, if possible, on dry ground, furrows being cut, if necessary, to prevent the accumulation of water around them. They should be covered with the paulins. Every carriage should be carefully examined each day after marching into camp, and every defect and damage then noted and corrected as soon as possible. Everything in the way of cleaning, adjustment, etc., should be looked to, so that the carriages may be ready as soon as possible to turn out again in perfect order. To keep wheels in good working order, they should be slightly greased after each day's march, and any old grease which has worked out at the shoulder of the axle scraped off. In garrison this is done each drill-day by the can- noneers while the drivers are hitching up, first wiping them off with cotton waste and then applying a little grease or sperm-oil. When it is necessary to remove a wheel, it should never be thrown upon the ground, nor the point of the axle allowed to rest upon the latter. The elevating- FIELD-ABTILLERT. 176 gear should be kept cleaned and oiled, and also the trun- nion bearings, as far as may be without dismounting the gun. Should the elevating-screw fail to work freely, it must be examined, and if the threads are indented on the edges they must be carefully filed down. In long marches a little grease should be placed on each pintle-hook, so that the lunette may work freely on it. Grease for Carriage-wheels. — Hog's lard softened, if fresh, by working it. If this cannot be procured, tallow or other grease may be used; if hard, it should be melted with fish-oil. About one pound of grease is required for four wheels. Those fittings of carriages upon which, on account of friction, etc., paint cannot be kept should be well oiled to prevent rusting; this is also necessary with linch-pins, keys, etc., to keep them free from the liability of jamming. Bright parts are kept in good order by applying with a brush or cloth a mixture of 1 pound of white lead and \ pound tallow or lard heated and mixed together. It is easily removed with a cloth and a little turpentine. Leather strapping must be kept soft and pliable. Cotton waste and Putz pomade are supplied for keeping bright parts in good order. Articles carried in the boxes require examination to see that they are perfect. Sponges which have been in use ought to be washed and dried as far as possible, the covers not being pat on until quite dry. Painting Carriages. — Wooden parts, and the correspond- ing parts of the steel carriage, are painted olive-color; the other parts black. Whenever there is an appearance of rust under the paint of the steel gun-carriage, it should not stand until the annual painting, but be cleaned off at once and repainted. Before painting a carriage it must be dry, thoroughly 176 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. crean, and free from grease. It will not be necessary to scrape off the old paint where it is sound and firm, but all blisters, perished paint, and. rust on ironwork must be scraped off. Where the wood is bare of paint, it should have three coats. This patching should be done before the final coat is put on. One coat is sufficient for the annual painting. To remove old paint, use a paste of soda and quicklime, equal parts, made by dissolving soda in water and then adding lime. Apply with a brush, and after a few minutes wash off with hot water. Wash with vinegar or an acid solution before repainting to remove all traces of the alkali. Sponges, rammers, and handspikes are not painted. In taking a battery in hand for repair it should first be stripped of all the stores, the whole of the strapping and fixed leather taken off, and the carriage thoroughly washed. All metalwork requiring repairs should be attended to at once ; also canvas and leather work. The paint is supplied by the Ordnance Department. CARE OF GUNS. Paint for Field-guns.— This quantity will paint 25 guns. It comes in tins marked No. 1 and No. 2, and is furnished by the Ordnance Department. PIKST COAT. Venetian red 1| pounds Oxford yellow or French yellow ^ pound Graphite 6 ounces Liquiddryer 1 pint Japan gold-size \ •• Turpentine spirits 1 quart To be well ground and strained before using. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 177 SECOND COAT. Venetian red 1^ pounds Oxford yellow or French yellow ^ pound Graphite 6 ounces Sugar of lead 2 " Liquid dryer ^ pint Japan gold-size 1 " Varnish (copal outside) 1 quart Turpentine spirits , | pint To be well ground and strained before using. All grease must be carefully removed from the gun before application. The paint should be allowed at least 48 hours to harden after the first coat before applying the second, and twice that long (96 hours) after the second coat before handling. Gruns should ordinarily be painted once a year. It is in- jurious to the mechanism to frequently dismount it, as the parts are dented by being dropped, screw-threads injured, etc. They should at all times be kept in good order and free from rust and dust, particular attention being paid to the breech mechanism. Animal oil should not be used; fish-oil and cosmoline are best. The use of lard-oil is in- jurious, and in cold weather forms a stiff wax over all parts. Cotton waste and cosmoline are supplied for this purpose by the Ordnance Department, and the cosmoline should be freely used in the bore, breech, and on breech mechanism. Bright, parts are preserved by applying with a brush or cloth a mixture of 1 pound white lead and ^ pound tallow or lard-oil heated and mixed together. It can easily be removed with a cloth and a little turpentine. Machine-guns. — Keep in dry storehouse, covered .and well oiled with a mixture of equal parts of sperm-oil and kerosene-oil. Every two or three days they should be wiped off, a rag passed through the barrels, and fresh oil applied. The use of emery cloth or scouring material must be avoided. 178 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. THE CARE OF AMMUNITIOlir. Ammunition for field-pieces is put up in wooden boxes so painted as to indicate their contents, viz.: for shell, black; for shrapnel, red; for canister, light drab. The kind of ammunition is also marked on the end of the box, and the place and date of manufacture on the inside of the cover. Each box contains ten projectiles. Projectiles, except bands and fuzes, are painted as follows : Shrapnel, with Point-charge. — Body black; head ver- milion. Shrapnel, with Base-charge. — Body, from band to in- clude I of head, black; remainder of head and part of body in rear of band, vermilion. Canister. — Wholly black. Shell (Cast-iron). — Body, including \ length of head, black; remainder of head, next to point, vermilion. The fuze-holes should be stopped with tow or cotton waste, and the projectiles should be kept under cover in a dry place. Oare should be taken in handling projectiles to avoid injuring the bands. Projectiles for field-guns are now issued, charged and fuzed for service, from the arsenals. Shells of field-mortars should not be kept charged. This is done as occasion requires when firing, and the greatest care must be taken before inserting the fuze that the threads of both fuze and fuze-hole are perfectly free from dust, grit, and powder; and when assembled the fuze must be screwed tight home. Powder. — When made cartridges are not supplied, the powder is in wooden barrels, or in barrels of corrugated metal with bronze screw-caps, each containing 100 pounds. On the heads are stencilled the number of the barrel, the name of the manufacturer, year of fabrication, kind of powder, the mean initial velocity and pressure per square inch on the pressure-piston. Each time the powder is FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 179 proved the initial velocity is marked below the former proof-marks, and the date of trial opposite it. Barrels of different kinds of powder are piled separately, and, besides being recorded in the magazine-book, each parcel is marked with a card showing the kind and the entries and issues. In the magazine the barrels are placed on their sides, generally three tiers high, or four tiers if absolutely neces- sary. Small skids are placed on the floor and between the several tiers, and the barrels chocked at intervals to pre- vent rolling. The tiers must be so arranged that the marks can readily be seen and any particular kind reached. There should be an unobstructed space of several yards square at the door, and this space, as likewise, the alleys> should be covered with carpet or matting. The magazine is provided with a well near the door ; into this the sweepings are put; they should never be swept out at the door. For the preservation of the magazine it is of the greatest importance to keep unobstructed the circulation of air under as well as above the flooring. The magazine should be opened and aired only in dry, clear weather, when the temperature of the air outside is lower than that inside of the magazine. It should not be opened in damp weather if it can be avoided. The ventilators must be kept free, and no shrubbery or trees allowed to grow near so as to screen the building from the sun. The yard should be of sand or clay and well drained. The moisture of a magazine may be absorbed by chloride of lime kept in an open vessel and renewed from time to time. Quicklime is dangerous, and should not be used. Candles in lanterns are used for light- ing the magazine. !No one should enter without first removing his shoes or putting india-rubbers over them. No cane, sword, or anything which might occasion sparks must be carried in, 180 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLEBT. Barrels of powder must not be rolled in transportation ; they should be carried in handbarrows, or in slings made of rope, canvas, or leather. All implements used in the magazine or on the barrels should be of copper or wood. The barrels must never be repaired in the magazine. When it is necessary to roll them for the better preservation of the powder and to prevent its caking, it is done with a small number at a time on boards in the yard. Neither loaded shells, fireworks, nor composition for fireworks, fuzes, nor friction-primers, etc., will be stored in a magazine with powder. Shells should be filled in the fill- ing-room of the service-magazine. Transportation of Powder. — In wagons. The barrels of powder must be packed in straw, secured in such a manner as not to rub against each other, and the load closely cov- ered with canvas. SuflScient guard should accompany the train to prevent all fire or smoking near the wagons. No camp-fires should be allowed near the park. On railroads each barrel should be tightly boxed and packed so as to avoid friction ; the cars, if practicable, should have springs similar to those of passenger-cars. Fuzes and Friction-primers are kept as far as possible in their original packages, and are stored in the driest and safest place in the storehouse. Filling Cartridge-bags. — The powder is carried in barrels from the magazine to the filling-room. Under no circum- stances will the filling be done at the magazine. Handle powder carefully. Implements required: 1 copper ham- mer, 1 wooden drift, 1 counter-brush, I scoop, 1 counter- scale and weights (brass or copper), 1 filling-funnel, 1 set of powder-measures, cartridge-bags and twine. When the cartridges are to be used with projectiles, each charge is carefully weighed; if for blank cartridges, it is measured. One man holds the bag open and another pours the powder into it through a funnel. The bag is then securely FIELD-ARTtLLERT. 181 tied with twine close to the powder. When filled, each should be marked in pencil, showing kind and weight of powder, and for what piece to be used. Filling Projectiles. — The bursting-charge should be weighed and carefully placed in shell through copper fun- nel, the nose of which should pass below the end of the screw-thread. Then carefully wipe the thread of both fuze and fuze-hole before inserting the fuze. GUARD ORDERS. Battery-guards. — A light battery serving with other troops will furnish its own park and stable guards, police, etc. Both officers and men will be exempt from other de- tails, and the men will not be detailed for extra duty in the staff departments, nor for duty interfering with battery duties, if it can be avoided. A light battery serving with other troops will furnish its own stable and park guard, which will be under the exclu- sive control of the battery commander. Battery Stable and Park Guard. — The pieces, caissons, etc., with their ammunition and stores, as well as the horses, harness, and forage are under the charge of a stable and park guard, consisting of two non-commis- sioned officers and as many privates as may be necessary. This guard will be mounted separately for each battery, and will be under the exclusive control of the battery commander. A lieutenant of the battery is detailed daily, or for such period as the battery commander may direct, as battery officer of the day; the stable and park guard is under his immediate orders and those of the battery commander. It is the duty of this guard to enforce the special regu- lations in regard to the stables, horses, and park. The tour continues for 24 hours, or until properly relieved by a new guard. 182 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. The sentinels of the stable and park guard will be posted and relieved as prescribed in " Light-artillery Drill Kegulations." They wear the sabre-belt without sabre when on post at the stable or picket-line. They are for- bidden to strike or otherwise punish horses. (Between retreat and reveille the sentinels should be armed with loaded revolvers.) The sentinels over the horses or in charge of prisoners receive orders from the stable sergeant, so far as the exer- cise of his duties are concerned. The guard, non-commissioned officers and sentinels, will perform their duties in accordance with the rules pre- scribed for the troop stable-guard. The employment of stable-guards for police and fatigue duties at the stables is forbidden; but this will not prohibit the stable-guard from being required to assist in feeding grain before reveille. (It may be used as a herd-guard during the day.) The stable-guard will attend stables with the rest of the battery and groom their own horses, the sentinels being relieved for the purpose. They will wear stable frocks while grooming, belt outside the frock; after grooming they take off their stable frocks, and the sentinel is again posted. Neither the non-commissioned officer nor the members of the stable-guard will absent themselves from the immedi- ate vicinity of the stables, except in case of urgent necessity and then for no longer time than is absolutely necessary. No member of the guard will leave for any purpose with- out the authority of the non-commissioned officer of the guard. The non-commissioned officer and one member of the guard will go for meals at the proper hour; upon their re- turn the other members will be directed to go by the non- commissioned officer. (With park and stable guard the FIELD-AUTILLERT. 183 guard will be so sent to meals as to leave at the guard-house one non-commissioned officer and one private, exclusive of sentinels on post.) Smoking in stables or their immediate vicinity is prohibi- ted. No Are or light other than the stable lanterns will be permitted in the stables. Stable-guard duty in the field will be performed upon the same principles, with the modifications rendered neces- sary by the changed conditions. Duties of the Battery Officer of the Day. — He has super- vision of the guard, attends all stable duties and such drills and battery roll-calls as may be designated as requir- ing his presence. He should inspect the guard and sentinels during the day and night as often as he may deem necessary. After the new battery officer has visited the guard at guard-mounting and seen that the orders have been cor- rectly turned over, he will report to the battery commander for instructions. Commander of the Guard. — The senior non-commissioned officer of the guard is commander of the guard. The commander of the guard is responsible for the in- struction and discipline of the guard. He will see that all its members are correctly instructed in their orders and duties, and that they understand and properly perform them. He receives and obeys the orders of the battery com- mander and the battery officer of the day, and reports to the last named without delay all orders relating to the guard not given or transmitted by him. He transmits to his successor all material instructions and information relating to his duties. He is responsible for the general safety of the camp as soon as the old guard marches from the guard-house. In case of any emergency occurring while both guards are at 184 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. the guard-house, the senior commander of the two guards will be responsible that proper action is taken. A commander of a guard leaving his post for any pur- pose will mention his destination and the probable duration of his absence to the next in command. Should it become necessary during the absence of the commander of the guard for the next in command to leave the guard, he will designate a member of the guard to take charge and assume the responsibility during his absence. The member so designated will be obeyed and respected accordingly, and will be held responsible for the proper performance of his duties. All prisoners will be thoroughly searched before being allowed to enter the guard-house. The prisoners will be marched under proper guard to the messrhall for their meals; they must be sent to their meals at times when the other men of the battery are not present, and will be allowed the same time as other mem- bers of the guard. The commander of the guard will record upon the guard report the names of all horses taken out during his tour (except under paragraphs a and c, p. 185), stating the authority under which they are taken and their condition when returned. Should officers' horses be returned by an enlisted man, he will inspect them as prescribed. Except in emergencies, the commander of the guard may divide the night with the. next in command, but re- tains his responsibility; the one whose watch it is must be constantly on the alert. The non-commissioned officer receives his orders from his battery commander and battery officer of the day, and when relieved will turn over all his orders to his successor. He instructs his sentinels in their general and special duties; exercises general supervision over his entire guard; MELD-ABTILLBBY. 185 exacts order and cleanliness about the guard-room; pre- vents the introduction of intoxicants into the guard-house or stables; receives by count, from his predecessor, the animals, horse equipments, and all property (both private and public) pertaining" thereto; examines, before relieving his predecessor, all locks, windows, and doors, and should any be found insecure he will report the fact to the bat-, tery officer of the day. He, or the junior non-commissioned officer of the guard, will personally post and relieve each sentinel, taking care to verify the property responsibility of the sentinel who comes off post, and see that the sentinel who goes on post is aware of the property responsibility he assumes. During the day and night the non-commissioned officers will alternate in tours, one of them remaining con- stantly on the alert. That the non-commissioned officer may be more thor- oughly informed of his responsibility, all horses returning, except those from a regular formation, will be reported to and inspected by him. He will then notify the sentinel on post, and see that the horses are promptly cared for. In case of abuse he will promptly report to the battery officer of the day. Should the horse be the private property of an officer, he will report such abuse to the owner. The non-commissioned officer will report any unusual occurrence during his tour to the battery officer of the day_ Horses and other property for which the non-commis- sioned officer is responsible will not be taKen from the stables without the order of the battery commander, with the following exceptions : a. Officers' horses and private property are subject to their own written order. b. Horses authorized for mounted duty or pass may be taken out on a written order of the battery commander. c. No formal order will be required for horses and equip- ments to leave the stable at established hours for cere- 186 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. monies, mounted drill, herding and watering horses. The commander of the guard must be present and satisfy him- self that they are being taken out solely for these pur- d. The horses and equipments of the first sergeant and stable sergeant (unless otherwise ordered by the battery commander) may be taken out by themselves, or on their written order, between reveille and retreat. This privilege may be extended to the other sergeants. e. The battery team will be allowed to leave the stables in the daytime (between reveille and retreat) when the wagoner reports it to be necessary. In case of fire at the stable the commander of the guard will take the necessary precautions in opening or closing the doors, so as to prevent as far as possible the spreading of the fire and make it possible to remove the horses. He will then, assisted by all the available men, commence to lead out the horses, and, if practicable, secure them at the picket-line or other designated place. The non-commissioned ofiftcer will have exclusive control of the lanterns, and will see that they are prepared during the day for lighting at night. The lanterns will not be lighted, filled, or trimmed in the stables, but must be taken to the guard-room, or to such other place as may be designated by the battery commander for the purpose. The non-commissioned ofiacer must answer the sentinels' calls promptly. Sentinel of Stable-guard.— The sentinel in the discharge of his duties will be governed by the regulations for sen- tinels of other guards whenever they are applicable, such as courtesies to oflBcers, walking post in a soldierly manner, challenging, etc.; he will not turn out the guard except when ordered by the proper authority. The sentinel will receive orders from the battery com- FIELB-ARTILLERT. 18Y mander, the battery officer of the day, and the non-com- missioned officers of the stable-guard only. The sentinel will not permit any horse or equipments to be taken from the stables except in the presence of the non-commissioned officer. Should a horse get loose, the sentinel will catch him and tie him up. If he be unable to catch the horse, the non- commissioned officer will be at once notified. In case a horse be cast, or in any way entangled, he will relieve him if possible; if unable to relieve him, he will call the non- commissioned officer. Sentinels are forbidden to punish or maltreat a horse. When a horse is taken sick, the sentinel will notify the non-commissioned officer, who will in turn call the stable sergeant, and see that the horse is properly attended to. In case of firQ the sentinel will give the alarm by step- ping outside the stable and firing his pistol (if he be armed) repeatedly, calling out at the same time, "Fire, stailes, battery — /" As soon as the guard is alarmed he will take the neces- sary precautions in opening or closing the doors, so as to prevent the spreading of the fire and make it possible to remove the horses; he will drop the chains and bars, and, with the other members of the guard, proceed to lead out the horses, and secure them at the picket-line or such other place as may have been previously designated. 188 A BANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. CHAPTER VI. The Horse. How Obtained. Description of. Inspection of. Power of Teams. Weight behind Artillery-teams, iflaits of Artillery. Deutition. Plate of Diseases. Sick Horses. Health and Dis- ease. Veterinary Medicines. Drugs and Doses, and How to Administer Them. Mashes, Poultices, etc. Veterinary Notes, with Symptoms and Treatment of Various Diseases. Stables and Stable Management. Grooming. Feeding and Kinds of Food. Watering. Training Horses. Rules for Treatment and Care of Horses. Destruction of Horses. HORSES. HOW OBTAINED, DBSCRIPTIOlir, ETC. Horses are obtained from the Quartermaster Depart- ment. Submit requisitions, generally in triplicate, stating the color desired, and whether the horse is for lead-, swing-, or wheel-team. The artillery-horse must be sound, free from vicious habits, a square trotter, well broken to harness, and must conform as nearly as possible to the following description ; A gelding of uniform and hardy color; in good condition; from fifteen to sixteeu hands high; weight of the lead- horse not less than 1050 pounds, and that of the wheel- horse not more than 1300 pounds; from four to eight years old; full-chested; shoulders sufBciently broad to support the collar, but not too heavy ; full-barrelled, with broad, deep loins; short-coupled, with solid hindquarters; feet sound and in good order. Long-legged, loose-jointed, long- barrelled, and narrow-chested horses, as well as those which are restive, vicious, or too free in harness, are to be rejected. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 189 SELECTING HOESES. Care must be taken not only that they possess the form and qualities necessary for the work they are likely to be employed in, but also that they are docile and easy-tempered and sound. Form differs according to breed, and upon it depends the fitness of the animal for draught or saddle purposes. For either purpose a horse should walk and trot well. Horses with deeply scarred backs (or, if for harness, shoulders), or which show signs of having been much cut with the girth (girth-galled), should not be selected, if avoidable. If for riding purposes, the withers should be neither too high nor too low, and the shoulders oblique; fore arms long and muscular; chest moderately wide and deep; ribs well arched behind saddle and continued close to haunch; loins broad; hindquarters long, wide, and mus- cular; tail set on as near the level of the croup as possible; limbs from knees and hocks downwards short, wide later- ally, with the tendons and ligaments standing well apart from the bone, and distinctly defined. Neither beneath knee nor hock should they be narrow or abruptly tied in ; knees wide in front, hocks sideways. Pasterns not too long or oblique, inclined out or in, nor yet too upright; hoofs black, if possible, and circular in shape; wall smooth and even from coronet to ground, and not marked by horizontal rings; heels well spread; soles concave and strong; frogs well developed, sound, and firm. The foot in progression should be placed evenly on the ground, neither toe nor heel coming too markedly in contact with it. Coarse-bred horses, with hairy legs and large, flat feetj should never be chosen. Fore limbs should be examined for broken knees, splints, sprains of tendons and ligaments (indicated by thickening, and, if recent, by tenderness on manipulation), ring-bone (an uneven deposit of bony mat- ter around the lower end of the pastern), side-bone (ossi- 190 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. fication of the elastic cartilages on each side of the foot toward the heels), sand-crack in hoof (usually in the inside quarter of fore foot), chronic laminitis (manifested by horse putting heels first to the ground, convex soles, walls hollow in the middle in front, bulging at toe, and made uneven by rings on surface), navicular disease (usually shown by contracted heels, very concave soles, lameness, and digging toes in the ground during walk or trot, wearing the shoe more at point of toe than elsewhere, extending limb forward and elevating heels while at rest), corns (a bruise of sole at the heels, only to be discovered by removal of shoe and paring sole at this part). Hind limbs should be examined for spavin in hock (a bony tumor in front of inside hock, best seen by standing at animal's shoulder and viewing this part of the joint in profile; compare both hocks in this way, and if there is any inequality, and the prominence be hard, it is almost certain to be spavin; lameness or stiffness of the limb is generally present), sprain of tendon inside hock (marked by a swell- ing inside point of hock), curb (a sprain of ligament at back and below point of hock, seen as a more or less prom- inent convex swelling on looking at the hock sideways), sprain of back tendons or ligaments (as in fore limb), ring- bone (as in fore limb). The eyes should be healthy; examine them by moving the finger smartly near the eye, but without touching it, when the animal will wink if it be not blind; for careful examination, inspect the eye in sunlight, then cover with hand for a few seconds to ascertain if the pupil contracts and enlarges; to examine interior of eye, employ a lighted candle in a darkened stable. Examine head behind ears, withers, back, and shoulders for bruises; nostrils for glanders (if there be any dis- charge); turn round suddenly and back the horse to dis- cover if there is sprain of back, and if hindquarters are FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 191 moved firmly and promptly. Inspect skin for mange and ringworm, heels for grease and cracks, and coronets for fistulous wounds. Have him ridden very rapidly for a couple of hundred yards, stopped suddenly, and then place ear in rear of left shoulder to listen if the heart beats properly, and also near the nostril to hear if his breathing is all right. If a hollow cough is present, observe motion of abdomen at flank; should this have a double ascending movement or "lift" in expiration, the animal is broken-winded. In galloping, or when suddenly menaced by a blow of a whip, should a grunt or shrill whistling sound be heard in inspi- ration, the animal should be rejected. If, during rapid motion, a wheezing noise be heard in expiration or inspira- tion, the horse is unsound. Before selection is completed the horse should be ridden if for saddle purposes, or driven in harness if for draught. Every animal will be branded with the letters " U. S." on the left fore shoulder on the day he is received. They are also branded on the left hip with the letter of the bat- tery and the number of the regiment. A complete de- scriptive list will be made of each animal at the time of purchase, which will accompany him wherever he may be transferred. 192 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. Fig. 73. A. Molar teeth. BH. Canine or tush. CI. Incisors. E. Atlas. Q. Orbit. M. Caiiniform cartilage. N. Ensiform cartilage. 0. Coracoid process of scapula. P. Spine. Q. Cartilage. B. Trochanter major. 8. Subtrochanterian crest. T. Trochlea. U. External condyle. V. Patella. W. Hock-joint. 1. Cranium. 2. Lower jaw. 3. Cervical vertebrse. 4, 4. Dorsal vertebrse. 5, 5. Lumbar vertebrae 6, 6. Sacrum. 7, 7. Coccygeal vertebroe. 8. Sternum. 9, 9, True ribs. 10. 10. Cartilages of true ribs. 11. 11 False ribs. 12. 12. Cartilages of false ribs. 13. Scapula. 14. Humerus. 15. Radius. 16. Elbow. 17. Os pisiforme. 18,19, 20, 31, 23, 28. Carpal bones. 34. Large metacarpal bone. 25. Outer small metacarpal bone. 26. Inner small metacarpal bone. 27. 28. Sesamoid bones. 29. Os suffraginis. 80. Os coronse. 31. Os pedis. 33. Wing of the pedal bone. 33, 34, 35, 86, Os innominatum. 37. Femur. 38. Tibia. 39. Os calcis. 40. Astragalus. 41. 43, 43, 44. Tarsal bones. 45. Large metatarsal bone. 46. Outer small metatarsal bone. 47. Inner small metatarsal bone. FIELD-ABTILLEB Y. 193 Fig. 73. Eead. 1. Muzzle. 2. Nostril. 3. Forehead. 4. Jaw. 5. Poll. Neck. 6. 6. Crest. 7. Throttle or -windpipe. ForequaHer. 8. 8. Shoulder-blade. 9. Point of shoulder. 10. Bosom or breast. 11. 11. True arm. 12. Elbow. 13. Fore arm (arm). 14. Knee. 15. Cannon-bone. 16. Back sinew. 17. Fetlock or pastern joint. 18. Coronet. 19. Hoof or foot. 20. • Heel. Body or Middle Piece. 31. Withers. 22. Back. 23, 23. Eibs (forming together the barrel or chest). 24, 24. The circumference of the chest at this point, called the girth. 25. The loins. 36. The croup. 27. The hip. 28. The flank. 29. The sheath. 30. The root of the dock or tail. 31. The hip- joint, round, or whirlbone. 32. The stifle-joint. 33. 33. Lower thigh or gaskin. 34. The quarters. 35. The hock. 36. The point of the hock. 37. The curb-place. 38. The cannon-bone. 39. The back sinew. 40. Pastern or fetlock joint. 41. Coronet. 43. Hoof or foot. 48. Heel. 44. Spavin-place. 194 A EANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. POWEK OP TEAMS. If a horse has to work at speed (as in the case of horse- artillery) he can, as a rule, under service conditions, draw about 600 pounds, or carry on his back about 260 pounds, although in some services he is required to do more. la light field-artillery, where great speed is not expected, this may be increased to about 700 pounds; for heavy field- artillery a further increase may be made. Metcalfe gives: horse-artillery, 650 pounds; light field- artillery, 700 pounds; heavy field-artillery, 850 pounds; and siege-artillery, 1000 pounds; and the English Handbook contains the following table giving a rough estimate of what teams may be called upon to transport: Teams of 4 horses. Teams of 6 horses. Teams of 8 horses. Teams of 13 horses. Horse-artillery batteries. . Field-batteries nwt. 20 to 24 26 to 30 Cwt. 33 to 36 39 to 45 Cwt. Cwt. 48 to 56 70 Batteries of position 5 tons Owing to their interference with each other's motions, the maximum load drawn by teams of horses increases less rapidly than does the number of horses in draught. In /I ,'t b. Jt Fig. 74. 6, breast-strap; c, collar; <*, double-tree; s, single-tree; i, trace. horse-artillery teams 6 horses is the greatest number that can be usefully employed ; in the heavier field-batteries 8 horses are sometimes used, but not when it can be avoided, FIELD-ABTILLER T. 195 as it makes a cumbersome team and a large percentage of the working power of the extra pair is lost. Bad roads, insufficient food, rapid movement for short times, and forced marches require that the weights behind horses should be kept at a minimum consistent with tlie service required. The average weights exclusive of can- noneers of all the principal military powers are: horse-artil- lery — gun-carriage, 634 lbs.; caisson, 727 lbs.;* and field- artillery — gun-carriage, 718 lbs. ; caisson, 796 lbs. GAITS FOR ARTILLERY. The Manoeuvring Gallop is at the rate of twelve miles an hour (352 yards in a minute). This gait is used on occa- sions by horse-artillery, and in great emergencies for very short distances by field-artillery. The Manoeuvring Trot or Trot-out is at the rate of eight miles an hour (335 yards in a minute.) The Canter is at the same rate, viz., eight miles an hour. The Slow Trot is at the rate of from six to six and one half miles an hour, and should be used by light artillery for distances of several miles when necessary to move at a faster gait than a walk. At drills and on road marches it should be considerably employed so that teams may move easily and with un- necessary fatigue when called on to cover long distances rapidly. The Walk is at the rate of four miles an hour (117 yards in a minute). It is the pace usually employed on the line of march for field-batteries, although they move, as does horse-artillery, at an alternate trot and walk, covering about five miles an hour. * Reduced when necessary by removing an ammunition-chest. 196 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. DBNTITIOSr. Age of Horse from One to Nine Years, as Indicated by Teeth (Incisors) in Lower Jaw. — The age of a horse is de- termined by: 1. The character of the teeth, i.e., whether they be temporary or permanent. 2. The period at which they are cut. 3. The condition of the teeth themselves. Temporary or milk teeth are distinguished from the permanent teeth by being smaller, whiter, and having more distinct necks. The fangs are small and have little attach- ment to the gums. The jaws are plump, fleshy, and round, and the teeth are arranged in something like a semicircle. Permanent teeth are larger, broader, wider in the necks and more discolored than milk-teeth. The plumpness and circularity of the jaw is less than in the young colt, and gradually decreases. In old age the teeth are arranged in a nearly straight line. During the first ten months the six incisors appear. At twelve months the teeth show little signs of wear, the cor- ner teeth are mere shells, having no inner walls, and the teeth are close together. At two years the corner teeth have grown up to level of others; the centre teeth are worn. The teeth stand wide apart at necks because of growth of jaw. Shortly before three years old the two centre milk-teeth are shed and replaced by permanent teeth. Shortly before four years old the next two milk-teeth on either side are shed, and permanent ones appear. Shortly before five years old the corner milk-teeth are shed, and permanent ones appear, but as shells only, hav- ing no internal walls. At about six years old the inner wall of the corner teeth has grown up level with outer wall. The tusks appear at about three and one half years, are FIBLD-ARTILLEBT. 19Y matured at six, and then begin to wear away. Usually absent in mares. Between three and five years the marks or cups in the permanent teeth are very plain. At six the marks are well worn in centre teeth. At seven the marks disappear from centre teeth, are well worn in the two next, but plain in corner teeth. At eight the marks have all disappeared, except in corner teeth, in which they are worn. At nine the marks are usually gone from all the incisor teeth in lower jaw. The temporary incisors in upper jaw fall out usually a little earlier than those in lower jaw. The permanent in- cisors in upper jaw are longer and larger than the lower, and the mark is deeper and remains longer than in the lower teeth. Beyond nine years the teeth become angular and foul, the tusks worn, and the age only to be determined accu- rately by much experience and observation. Old horses frequently suffer from uneven and sharp- edged grinders. Their mouths should be occasionally ex- amined, particularly if the animal be ofE his feed, and, if nesessary, the teeth should be rasped off. SICK HORSES. The horses on sick report are in charge of the stable sergeant, who reports daily to the captain for instructions as to their treatment. In garrison the battery ofiBcer of the day inspects the sick horses daily, and records in his guard-report book the names of the horses on sick report, and the treatment they receive. In treating sick horses it is to be observed that very little medicine is ordinarily required, and that unnecessary doses do a great deal of harm. 198 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLBRT. If a horse suBtain an injury, neglect his feed, refuse his water, or give any evidence of sickness, it will be at once reported. No horse on sick report will be taken from the stable or picket-line for exercise or work without permission from proper authority. If there be at any time a suspicious discharge from one or both nostrils of an animal, it must be immediately reported. To prevent contagion to man or beast, an animal that shows any decided symptoms of glanders is to be isolated at once, and confined or tied up in some locality where no other animal can approach him. A glandered horse should be killed as soon as possible. The stall in which he stood is torn down and all the wood- work burned and the ironwork disinfected, or otherwise it is closed and must remain empty until the rack, manger, and every part of the iron and woodwork, as also the vessels used in watering and feeding, and his saddle and bit, have been three or four times thoroughly washed with a 5 per cent solution of carbolic acid or a 1 to 1000 solu- tion of corrosive sublimate; all parts to which the latter has been applied should be thoroughly scrubbed with hot water to remove all traces of the poisonous salt. The appli- cation of a lime wash to all the stalls, after complete disin- fection, will be desirable. Small articles, such as bits, etc., can be disinfected by keeping them immersed for a half- hour in boiling water. AH articles of little value that have been used with a glandered horse, such as halters, bridles, horse-cloths, saddle-cloths, blankets, nose-bags, currycombs and brushes, etc., should be destroyed. Stables occupied by infected or suspected horses should be disinfected daily by washing exposed surfaces with a 5 per cent solution of carbolic acid, and nose-bags, halters, buckets used for drinking-water, etc., should be carefully washed with the same solution or with boiling water. MELDARTtLLBB 7. 199 HEALTH AND DISEASE. Points. Corresponding to the Condition of Health. Disease. 1. Temperament 8 Coat Vivacious. Healthy. Pale and moist. Good. 36 to 40 per minute. 8 to 12 " Warm. 98°.4 to 100°. Dull. Staring. Florid and dry. Bad. 4. Appetite 5. Pulse 50 to 90. 20 to 50. 7. Temperature, external. . . 8. Temperature, internal. . . Cold. 101° to 105°. On entering a stall to determine the state of an animal the temperament and coat are first observed. To examine the membranes, elevate the nostrils so as to obtain a good view of the interior, ascertain the condition of the appetite by observation or a trustworthy source. Take the pulse for a full minute. The best and most usual place to take it is beneath the lower jaw, at a spot corresponding to the swell of the jaw; this failing, as it sometimes does in- cases of extreme weakness, the artery inside the arm, near where the leg joins the body, should be sought for. The number of beats, whether soft or hard, and whether regular or intermittent, should be noted. The respirations are best observed at the flank, an inspi- ration and expiration going to make up one respiration. The external temperature is ascertained by feeling the ears and extremities. The internal temperature is obtained by means of a clinical thermometer. Set the instrument at 98°.4'P., insert it in the dock, and allow it to remain in the body three or four minutes. 200 A tiANDBOOK FOB LIGST ARTILLERY. DISEASES OP THE HORSE. Fig. 75. 1. Caries of the lower jaw. 16. Ring-bone. 2. Fistula of the parotid duct. 17. A tread upon the coronet. 3. Bonyexcrescence or exostosis 18. Quittor. of the lower jaw. 19. Sand-crack. 4. Swelling by pressure of the 20. Contracted or ring foot of a bridle. foundered horse. 5. Poll-evil. 21. Capped hock. 6. Inflamed parotid gland. 22. Malanders. 7. Inflamed jugular vein. 23. Spavin. 8. Fungus tumor, produced by 24. Curb. pressure of the collar. 25. Swelled sinews. 9. Fistula in the withers. 26. Thick leg. 10. Saddle-gall. 27. Grease. 11. Tumor of the elbow. 28. A crack in front of the foot, 12. Induration of the knee. called cow-crack. 13. Clap of the back sinews. 29. Quarter-crack. 14. Malanders. 30. Ventral hernia. 15. Splint. 31. Rat- tail. PIELD-AMTILLERT. 201 VETERINARY MEDICINES. INTERNALLY ADMINISTERED. Medicines that Act on the Stomach and Intestines or their Contents. Cathartics. — Agents that cause purgation : aloes, calomel, Epsom salts, common salt and sulphur, croton, linseed, and castor oils, injections and mashes. Anthelmintics. — Agents that destroy or expel worms: nearly -all cathartics, tartarated antimony, and sulphide of iron. Nauseants. — Agents that induce nausea: aloes and white hellebore. Antacids. — Agents that counteract acidity: soap and the carbonates of lime, magnesia, soda, and potash. Alteratives. — Agents that bring about a healthy state of the system : aloes, calomel, cod-liver oil, sulphur, nitrate of potash. Cardiacs.— Agents that invigorate the system by stimu- lating the stomach: Cayenne pepper, ginger, gentian, cara- way seeds. Demulcents. — Agents that lubricate or sheathe surfaces: glycerine, gum-arabic, linseed, and starch. Antidotes. — Agents that counteract the effects of poisons: depending upon the kind of poison. Medicines that Act upon the Brain, BTerves, and Nerve-centres. Excitants. — Agents that stimulate the brain, nerves, and nerve-centres, and thus increase their energy: alcohol, am- monia, arnica, strychnia. Narcotics. — Agents that are excitants, but whose action is followed by depression of energy: camphor, henbane, belladonna, opium. Sedatives. — Agents that depress nervous power or lower •circulation: digitalis, hydrocyanic acid, tartarated anti- mony, and chloroform. 202 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. Antispasmodics. — Agents that prevent or allay cramps : alcohol, ethers, oil of turpentine, opium. Medicines that Act upon Glands or Glandular Structures. Stimulants. — Agents that act upon the glands generally: calomel, oxide of mercury, iodine and its compounds. Diuretics. — Agents that increase the secretion of urine: copaiba, nitrate of potash, turpentine, resin. Parturients. — Agents that cause contraction of the womb: ergot of rye. Lithontriptics. — Agents that dissolve calculi: hydrochloric acid, the fixed alkalies. Diaphoretics. — Agents that cause perspiration: colchicum, tartar emetic, acetate of ammonia, spirits of nitrous ether. Medicines that Act upon the Muscular Fibre. Tonics. — Agents that act gradually, and permanently improve digestion and nutrition: gentian, the sulphates of iron, copper, and zinc, cascarilla bark, camomile flowers. Astringents. — Agents that cause contraction of muscular fibre : alum, catechu, oak-bark, tannic acid. EXTERNALLY ADMIKISTEKED. Medicines that Act upon the Skin and External Farts by Direct Application. Refrigerants. — Agents that diminish morbid heat of a part : salt and cold water, solutions of acetate and subace- tate of lead. Discutients. — Agents that dispel enlargements: com- pounds of iodine, soap liniment, camphor. Rubefacients. — Agents that cause heat or redness of skin without blistering: liniments of ammonia, tar and turpen- tine, vinegar. Vesicants. — Agents that produce blisters: cantharides, tartar emetic, croton-oil, hot water. MBLD-ABTILLERT. 203 Caustics. — Agents that decompose the part to which applied: carbolic, nitric, sulphuric, and hydrochloric acids; chlorides of antimony and zinc, corrosive sublimate, ni- trate of silver, sulphate of copper, hot iron. Pyogenics. — Agents that induce suppuration of wounds: liniment and ointment of turpentine, black hellebore. Detergents. — Agents that cleanse wounds and skin and excite them to healthy action : acetate of copper, creosote, liniment of sulphate of copper, ointment of chloride of ammonia and nitrate of mercury, sulphur and some of its compounds. Astringents. — Agents that diminish discharge from wounds: alum, sulphate of zinc, acetate of lead. Antiseptics. — Agents that destroy putrid condition of wounds: carbolic acid, salicylic acid, iodoform, charcoal, chloride of zinc, nitrate of potash, permanganate of potash, yeast. Traumatics. — Agents that excite healing in wounds: aloes, myrrh, collodion, oil of tar, resin, solutions of sulphate of copper and zinc. Emollients. — Agents that soften and relax parts : fomen- tations, lard, olive-oil, palm-oil, poultices. DRUGS AND DOSES, AND HOW TO ADMINISTER THEM. The most convenient method to administer medicine is either in the form of a bolus, gelatine capsule, or drench. Before proceeding to give medicine turn the animal uround in stall in a position so that he cannot run backwards. If giving a drench, either hold head up by hand or pull it up by placing halter-shank over some high object, pulling head up; then place horn or bottle inside of mouth. Take plenty of time; induce the horse to move his tongue, instead of pinching his throat and pulling out tongue, as is cus- tomary and wrong in all cases. The tongue must pass back in mouth, or else horse cannot swallow. To give a bolus, 204 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. pull out tongue gently with left hand, keeping the mouth open, pass bolus back over root of tongue with right; by proceeding slowly very little trouble will be experienced. If the animal will eat, medicine in the form of powder (provided it be not very repulsive to the taste) may be given in grain or mash, or dissolved in the water given to drink. Aconite (Tincture). — Useful in cases of fevers and in- flammation. Dose, 15 to 30 drops, repeated every three hours; should be given in one ounce cold water. Alcohol. — Useful as a stimulant; one to three ounces, repeated every five hours, given in eight ounces cold water. Aloes (Barbadoes). — Useful as a cathartic. Dose, six to eight drachms, with two drachms powdered ginger, made into a bolus or pill; only one dose required. Ammonia (Aqua). — Useful as a stimulant. Dose, one half ounce, given three times a day in six ounces cold water. Ammonia (Aromatic). — ^Useful in acute indigestion and flatulant colic. Dose, one ounce every two hours until better. _ Arnica (Tincture). — ^Useful in all cases of bruises and sprains; should be applied frequently. Arsenic. — Useful as a tonic or alterative. Dose, five grains given three times a day in the food. Belladonna (Tincture).— Useful in allaying pains and spasms. Dose, one to two drachms, repeated every four hours. Bromide of Potassium.— Useful as a nerve sedative. Dose, two to four drachms three times a day, given in water. Castor Oil. — Useful as a cathartic. Dose, one pint. Chloral Hydrate — Useful in allaying pain. Dose, one- half ounce every four hours until relief comes. Chloroform. — [Jsefnl as an ansesthetic and anodyne in allaying pain. Dose, one to three drachms given in four ounces cold water. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 206 Digitalis (Tincture). — Useful as a heart stimulant. Also for coughs and colds. Dose, one drachm three times a day. Dovers Powders. — Useful for colds and coughs. Dose, three drachms three times a day in feed. Gentian. — Useful as a tonic. Dose of tincture, one ounce; of ground, one half ounce — in feed three times a day. Ginger. — Useful as a tonic and stimulant. Dose, tincture, one ounce; ground, one ounce — in feed three times a day. Iodine (Tincture). — Useful when applied externally for sprains, hruises, etc. Iodoform. — Useful when applied to galls. Take one part iodoform and three parts sulphur and cover the gall with the powder. Iodoform one part, cosmoline nine parts, makes a good antiseptic ointment. Iron (Sulphate).^Useful for worms and as a tonic. Dose, one half ounce three times a day. Iron (Tincture). — Checks bleeding, when applied exter- nally; is a tonic internally. Dose, one half ounce in water three times a day. Laudanum. — Useful in allaying pain. Dose, one to two ounces, to be repeated every two hours if pain lasts. Lead (Acetate, Sugar of Lead). — ^Useful for wounds, bruises, sprains, and to allay inflammation. One ounce to one quart of water, and apply often. Linseed-oil — Purgative. Dose, ten to thirty ounces. ITitre (Saltpetre, Nitrate Potash). — Is useful in fevers, blood disorders, and sluggish kidneys. Dose, one half ,to one ounce a day. Podophyllin. — Useful in liver disorders. Dose, one to two drachms once a day. ftuinine. — Useful in all debilitating fevers and where there is loss of appetite. Dose, twenty to thirty grains five times a day in pills. Resin — Useful in kidney disorders. Dose, one half ounce three times a day in feed. 206 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. Soda (Bicarbonate). — Useful in cases where an antacid is required. Dose, six drachms three times a day in feed. Soda Sulphate (Glauber Salts). — Useful where a saline laxative is required. Dose, one pound. Santonins. — Useful for worms. Dose, two to four drachms. Sweet Spirits Nitre. — ^Useful for colic and kidney trouble. Dose, one to two ounces in cold water, to be repeated if necessary. Zinc (Sulphate). — Useful for wounds. Add one quart water to one ounce zinc and apply three times a day. Bran Mash. — Place bran in clean pail and pour on as much boiling water as it will absorb; add ^ ounce salt; stir aud then cover over to retain steam until sufficiently cool; add, if on hand, to the bran a pound of well-boiled linseed. Gruel. — Put 1 pound of meal in cold water, place over fire, and stir until it boils; then simmer until thick; per- mit to cool until temperature of new milk; add wineglass of spirits if animal be exhausted. Poultice. — Bran, with a little linseed-oil, steeped in hot water; boiled turnips or carrots; linseed-meal and a little olive-oil. Charcoal Poultice is made by adding linseed-meal to boiling water and stirring until a soft mass is produced; then stir in powdered charcoal and sprinkle some over the poultice when made up. If desired as an astringent, add sulphate of zinc. Mustard. — Add water to 1 pound of mustard until a thick paste ; rub on skin and then wash ofE carefully after 15 or 30 minutes. Apply again in six hours if necessary. Enemas. — Usually water at the temperature of the body, 3 to 6 quarts. Sometimes a little soap is added. Cantharides. — If efEect of blister be too severe, diminish by dressing part with liniment of lead, acetate of lead, and olive-oil; or wash off blister and dress with oil. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 207 Gombault's Caustic Balsam is a most excellent vesicant. Tonics should be given under observation of surgeon and effect carefully watched, especially mineral tonics. Mineral Tonics. — Sulphate of iron, 1 to 2 drachms, with 2 to 4 drachms of ginger; or sulphate of copper, i to 1 drachm, with powdered gentian 3 to 4 drachms; or arsenious acid, 5 grains. Vegetable Tonics. — Quinine, i to 1 drachm, dissolved in a few drops of sulphuric acid, in a pint of water; or oak- barii, 2 to 3 drachms made into a ball with treacle and bran ; or powdered gentian-root, 1 to 2 drachms; or tincture of gentian, 1 to 2 ounces in a pint of water. SYMPTOMS AND TREATMENT OP VARIOUS DISEASES. ABSCESS. Symptoms. — The result of a bruise or blood impurities ; is attended by pain, heat, and swelling, with in time a soft or fluctuating part on its surface from which the hair falls off. Treatment. — Open with a knife at the soft point and free of matter; then hot fomentations or poultices are some- times required; apply twice a day carbolic acid, 1 part; water, 20 parts. BLADDER lERITATION. Symptoms. — Restlessness; frequent straining; protruding penis; passing small quantities of urine at short intervals. Treatment. — Rest; plenty of water and mucilaginous fluids, with -J ounce bicarbonate of soda or potash ; warm rugs over loins; a pint of linseed-oil if laxative is required. BLADDER INFLAMMATION. Symptoms. — Similar to bladder irritation, but more aggravated; considerable fever, indicated by quick pulse; high temperature j arching of back; whisking tail; fre- 208 A HANDBOOK FOB MOST ABTILLEBT. quent straining; passing a few drops of urine at short intervals, generally thickly colored, with ropy mucus and pus, and sometimes blood. Treatment.— If bladder be distended, use gentle manipu- lation and pressure per rectum. This failing, use catheter. Apply hot blanket to the loins, and when removed rub that part with embrocation of oil, 6 ounces; strong solution of ammonia, 1 ounce; and tincture of opium, 3 ounces. Give mucilaginous drinks, such as linseed-tea, hay-tea, etc., and cooling, laxative food. After relieving congestion give ^ ounce bicarbonate of soda two or three times a day in the drink. BOWELS, INFLAMMATION OF (BNTEEITIS). Symptoms.— Similar to those of colic, only there is more distress, and the pain is continuous, and not in paroxysms, as is the case in colic; the body is covered with perspira- tion; pulse quick and small; extremities cold instead of warm, as in colic. Treatment. — Powdered opium, 2 drachms in watery solu- tion; belladonna, 2 drachms; linseed-oil, 1 pint. Following this give 10 drops tincture of aconite and ^ drachm powdered opium in watery solution every two hours. Frequent enemas of tepid water; mustard or very hot water to abdo- men; hand-rub and bandage legs; clothe warmly. Bran mashes and bran gruel for a short time after recovery. Exercise great care and give simple diet for some days. BRONCHITIS, INFLAMMATION OF THE TUBES OF THE LUNGS. Symptoms. — The first day quick breathing, with whist- ling sound on listening at side of chest, or a deeper and more noisy sound at front of chest; pulse harder and quicker than normal ; breathing quickened ; nostril red and inflamed. About second day increased secretion of mucus FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 209 and suppressed cough; pulse decreased in volume and more rapid; breathing hurried; dilated nostril; heaving flank. Treatment.— Place animal in airy box and clothe warmly ; bandage legs; bran mash. If legs be unequal in warmth and coat inclined to stare, give, night and morning, 1 ounce spirits nitric ether, 4 ounces acetate of ammonia, 8 ounces water. If disease unmistakably sets in, give 1 drachm carbonate of ammonia, or ^ ounce sweet spirits of nitre, or sulphuric ether, every 4 to 6 hours. If inclined to drink, ^ ounce nitre dissolved in each half pail of water until the kidneys act freely. Have animal inhale steam from bucketful of boiling water and tablespoonful of oil of turpentine poured over hay. If constipated, 2 ounces Epsom salts, 1 ounce nitrate of potassa, until slight effect is produced. Foment chest with blanket wrung out of hot water, and also sides. After each application slightly stimulate by rubbing with weak ammonia liniment (1 part liquid ammonia sesquicar- bonate to 3 parts olive-oil.) BURNS. Treatment. — Cover with cosmoline, 10 parts, carbolic acid, I part, or with rags soaked in olive-oil to which a little sugar of lead has been added; or dust thickly with starch or flour and cover with cotton-wool; or liniment of equal parts of limewater and linseed-oil (carron-oil). COLIC, SPASMODIC. Symptoms. — The attack usually comes on suddenly; the horse paws, kicks his belly, looks at his flanks, moves about uneasily, throws himself down violently and groans, rolls, lies on his back, jumps up and oftentimes commences eating. The extremities continue warm, and between tlie paroxysms the pulse is normal, 210 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. Treatment. — 1 ounce chloral hydrate in ^ pint of water — repeat in an hour if necessary; or 1 ounce tincture of opium and 1 ounce sweet spirits of nitre in ^ pint of cold water, repeated every half-hour until well; or 1^ ounces opium and 3 ounces alcohol in ^ pint water — repeat in one hour if necessary. Administer enema of warm water in which a little soap is dissolved. Should constipation be the cause, give aloes in solution, 5 to 8 drachms, or 1 pint of linseed-oil. Apply hot blanket to abdomen. Have animal walked about or belly well hand-rubbed, and give \ pint of whiskey, or brandy, or any stimulant in pint of water if drugs be not at hand. In Flatulent Colic, when the bowels are distended by gas, detected by bloated appearance and resonance on per- cussion, give promptly baking-soda, 3 to 4 ounces; if this fails, give carbonate of ammonia in ^-ounce doses every half-hour, or chloral hydrate, 1 ounce in ^ pint of water. Physic with 5 to 8 drachms Barbadoes aloes or 1 pint linseed-oil. Frequent enemas of turpentine, 1 to 2 ounces, and linseed-oil, 8 ounces. Apply hot blankets CONSTIPATION. Symptoms. — Uneasiness; distended abdomen; pulse and respiration nearly normal. Treatment. — Copious enemas of tepid water and a little soap. Dose of linseed-oil, 1^ pints. Sloppy food; slow exercise. COENS. Symptoms. — These bruises of the foot or heel are com- monly caused by improper shoeing, or leaving shoes on too long until they become imbedded. They are usually on fore feet, in that part of the sole included in the angle between the bar and the outside wall of the hoof. FIBLD-ABTILLEBT. 211 Treatment. — If lame and when the spot is pared there be matter, foment and poultice until lameness has disap- peared. Then shoe with bar-shoe resting on frog, the spot being relieved by cutting away horn. CRACKED HEELS (SCEATCHBS). Symptoms. — This is an inflammation of the oil- and sweat-glands of the skin, due to exposure, irritants, mud, filth, cold, washing heels with inferior soaps, cold draughts on heels, standing in slush or snow. Treatment. — Kemove hair; poultice with warm bran and charcoal, and keep clean ; apply ointment— acetate of lead 1 part, lard 3 parts. If sores be deep and painful, put on shoes with high heels. Peed cooling, laxative food. CUEB. Symptoms. — Sprain of the superior straight ligament at the back of the hock-joint. It looks like a swollen knot a few inches below the hock. Treatment. — Reduce inflammation by hot fomentations, and after it has subsided apply biniodide ointment (bini- odide of mercury 1 part, lard 13 parts), or a liniment com- posed of 2 parts of soap liniment and 1 of tincture of iodine. If there be much thickening, blister. DISTBMPEB. Symptoms. — See Strangles. FARCY. Farcy of a speciflc nature is identical with glanders, and is incurable. FISTULA. Symptoms.— Fistula of withers is ordinarily due to badly fitting collars or saddles, or to bruises, 212 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. Treatment.-^ If yery slight, remove all pressure at that point (rest if possible), and bathe with salt water or muri- ate of ammonia frequently. If more advanced, use hot fomentations. If matter forms, make free opening for its escape at lowest point. Treat with solution of sulphate of zinc. When the sore becomes healthy, and the core re- moved, use carbolic dressing and keep clean. Should it break out again, inject the abscess with a solution of sul- phate of zinc 20 grains to the ounce of water every second or third day until entirely healed. FOOT INFLAMMATION. Symptoms. — Brought on by founder, hard driving, lack of moisture to hoofs, indigestion and fevers, punctures, bruises, etc. Manifested by increased temperature of foot, pain on moderate percussion with hammer around the wall of hoof towards clenches and heel (the opposite foot being held up), and firm pressure by pincers around margin of hoof after removal of shoe. Treatment. — After locating the injury remove surround- ing horn freely to prevent formation of, or to give vent to, any matter. Place foot in hot water for one hour, and then poultice. Dress with tar and tow. FOUNDER. Symptoms. — Laminitis, or acute founder, consists of in- flammation of the laminae by which the hoof is attached to the sensitive foot, caused by hard driving, leaving heated horse to stand in snow, standing in cold draughts, too much grain and cold water afterwards. The animal evinces much distress and can scarcely be made to move, and when compelled to stir does so with great difficulty and pain, putting heels of fore feet to the ground and bringing hind feet forward under body. The feet are very hot and intensely painful, and the slightest FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 213 percussion causes great agony. In standing the fore feet are advanced if they are affected (most frequently the case). If they are drawn under the body, the trouble is in the hind feet. Treatment. — Give 1 pint of linseed-oil; remove shoes, then stand in cold water or wet clay most of the time for two or three days, and make cold applications to legs. Poultice if necessary. Then compel animal to take exer- cise on soft, damp ground, at first slowly and for short distances. If tenderness remains after inflammation has passed, blister around coronet, and continue exercise on damp ground. Blister may be repeated every nine days if necessary. Be careful to apply blister (cantharides 1 part,. olive-oil 6 or 8 parts) only on protuberant band which extends for a finger's breadth above the hoof, and not on pasterns. Peed bran mashes and grass. Place bucket of water con- taining ^ ounce nitre near by if animal be feverish, so that he may drink. GALLS (see sorbs). Treatment. — Remove the cause and bathe the spot with Castile soap and cold water as often as possible. If this does not succeed, a root will appear at the centre of the gall, the edges of which will be clear, the sitfast holding only by the root. Pull it out with pincers; bathe fre- quently with cold water. A little oil or grease, free from salt, or carbolic acid 1 part, glycerine 15 parts, may be rubbed lightly on the parts as they begin to heal. When the sore becomes healthy, cleanse thoroughly and apply 1 part iodoform, 3 parts sulphur. If necessary to use the animal, cover with old-fashioned sticking-plaster, after putting on the powder Just indicated. If possible, the collar or saddle should not bear on the spot. 214 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. GLANDERS. Before a horse is destroyed for either glanders or farcy he should, as soon as suspected, be separated from all the other animals, and every precaution taken to prevent the spread of the disease. When the disease is definitely de- termined, destroy the animal at once, burn all articles of clothing, brushes, brooms, etc., and have other articles, equipments, stalls, etc., thoroughly disinfected. Bear in mind that this terrible disease is highly conta- gious, and easily communicated to man. Symptoms. — The three characteristic signs are: 1st. A peculiar transparent, glutinous, and continuous discharge, usually from one nostril, which accumulates and entangles all kinds of filth. This discharge is at first thin and aqueous, but soon assumes the characteristic glary condition, and is generally of a straw-color, but in very late stages becomes more purulent. 2d. Ulceration of the mucous membranes of the nostrils. Before ulceration takes place in the nostrils the membrane of the part usually assumes a dingy leaden or slate color, often in patches, and the other parts highly injected. The ultimate symptom, leaving no doubt of the charac- ter of tlie disease, is the formation of true ulcers in the nostrils. The ulceration usually commences with a small vesicle on the membrane, which after a few days bursts, leaving a small unhealthy ulcer, which has no disposition to heal, but, on the contrary, gradually spreads and deepens. The nostril first afEected by discharge is generally first affected by ulceration. After the formation of ulcers the discharge is often tinged with blood, and becomes offensive. 3d. The submaxillary gland, in the channel formed be- tween the lower jawbones, becomes swollen and painful, but. MELD-ARTILLMRY. 216 as a rule, shows no inclination to suppurate. It soon be- comes hard and firmly attached to the jawbone, and ceases to be painful on the application ol pressure. On any one of the above-enumerated symptoms appearing, at once isolate the animal; have bedding destroyed, and care- fully remove all clothing, stable utensils, etc., from the vicinity of other horses. Place a steady man in charge, and warn him of his personal danger. GREASE. Symptoms. — A diseased state of the skin of the legs, more especially the hind ones, caused by uncleanliness or w%sh.ing with cold water and not properly drying them afterwards. In the early stages it consists of intolerable itching, followed by an inflammation of the sweat-glands, and an ofEensive oily discharge. The heels feel hot and greasy. Treatment. — Trim hair; poultice with warm bran and charcoal for several days, changing twice a day, and clean- ing with sponge and tepid water each time; or apply a flax- seed poultice over which has been poured some lotion con- sisting of sugar of lend ^ oz., carbolic acid 1 drachm, water 1 quart. Then, if animal is not weak, give a dose of purga- tive medicine, and when it has acted apply to the heels a dressing of vaseline 1 oz., oxide of zinc 3 drachms, iodized phenol 20 drops; or equal parts of sulphate of zinc and sugar of lead in water; or carbolic acid 1 part, glycerine 20 parts, applied with a brush and covered with lint and bandage, is good after poulticing. When the frog is af- fected, pare to the quick and dress with dry caustic pow- ders (quicklime, copperas, bluestone) or carbolic acid, and put on tight bandage, the dressing being renewed every day at least. When there is any tendency to inflammation or ulceration of skin of heels in bad weather, dress with lard or tallow, or lard 8 parts and alum 1 part. 216 A EANBBOOE FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. HIDE-BOUND. Symptoms. — The hide becomes tightly drawn over the flesh, and the coat hard and staring. Treatment. — Aloes 1| oz., sulphur 3^ oz., gingfer ^ oz., linseed-meal ^ oz. Make into six balls, and give one night and morning. HOOF-BOUND. Symptoms. — This is the result of some preceding disease of the foot, giving rise to an atrophy of the flesh structures of the foot, allowing the wall to fall in and become contracted. TreatmeEt. — Stand in moist place; apply blistering liquid (powdered cantharides 1 part, olive-oil 6 to 8 parts) to coronet. HOCK-LAMENESS. This applies to a variety of diseases, such as bog- and blood-spavin, bone-spavin, curb, sprained ligaments, etc., all of which give rise to lameness. Treatment. — Eest; hot fomentations to allay inflamma- tion j hand-rubbing and blistering are used according to circumstances. INFLUENZA. Symptoms. — This specific epizootic fever of a low type, associated with inflammation of the respiratory mucous membrane, begins very suddenly with marked fever; great dulness and extreme weakness; headache; limbs stiff and weak; pulse quickened; eyelids swollen and tearful, and, if inverted, appear pink or dark red; disinclination to move; legs swollen ; short, painful cough, beti-aying soreness of throat; difficulty in swallowing; hurried breathing (if breathing hurried and nostrils dilated, inflammation of FIELD-ARTILLEB7. 2lT lungs is to be apprehended); sometimes discharge from nostrils, as in catarrh, or there may be only a thin, yellow- ish, transparent fluid from the nostrils. If bowels are in- volved, the horse exhibits symptoms of abdominal pain. If liver is also involved, the lining membrane of the eyelid will be a yellowish-red hue. Constipation or diarrhoea almost invariably present. Treatment. — Isolate; rest; nurse carefully. Box stall where the temperature should be about 60°; clothe, hand- rub and bandage legs so as to maintain normal temperature. Eub throat and well towards ears with liniment made of soap liniment 2 oz., compound camphor liniment 3 oz., and tincture of opium J oz. (Soap liniment is composed of soft-soap 4 oz., camphor 1 oz., proof spirits 2 pints, solution of ammonia \ pint. Compound-camphor liniment is composed of camphor 1 oz., olive oil 2 oz.) If cough is severe, steam nostrils with bucket of boiling water and tablespoonful of turpentine poured over hay. Should there be constipation without symptoms of bowel complications, give injection of soap-suds and mild dose of Epsom salts, but not otherwise. If diarrhoea be present, do not check unless it increases the debility, and then give starch or flour gruel with an ounce or two of prepared chalk. If abdominal pain be great, apply hot blankets ; same to chest if involved. Quinine in 20-grain doses four or five times a day. Give saline agents, such as \\ oz. sulphate of magnesia; or 1 oz. hyposulphate of soda; or 4 oz. acetate of ammonia with 1 oz. nitric ether, once or twice a day. Gruel of bran or oatmeal with a little nitre therein, or cold water with nitre for drink. Bran mash and scalded oats for food. 218 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGBT ARTILLERY. LAMENESS. Lameness, when in the foot, is indicated by the animal pointing ; in the shoulder by the animal dragging or swinging the limb in a rotary manner. In the majority of cases it is below the knee when in the fore leg, and in the hock- joint when in the hind leg. Examine carefully, and have the animal trotted slowly both towards and from you. If the lameness be in front the animal drops on the well quarter, and throws his head up when the unsound leg is placed on the ground. If lame behind he hitches up the lame quarter, and nods the head when the sound leg is placed on the ground. Then determine location. If in foot, the lameness is more appa- rent on hard than on soft ground. If lame elsewhere, it will be as apparent, and probably more apparent, on soft as on hard ground (except in splint and other exostoses), and is usually some sprain of a ligament between knee and fetlock in fore leg, and in hock of hind leg. (See Corns; Crackod Heels; Curb; Foot Inflammation; Founder; Grease; Hock Lameness; Hoof-bound.) LAMPAS. Symptoms. — Swollen condition of roof of mouth caused by cold, indigestion, or growing teeth. Treatment. — Laxative food, and even a mild dose of laxative medicine if required. Rub mouth with salt or a little alum and water. LARYNGITIS (IKFLAMMATIOK OF THE THROAT). Symptoms. — Sore throat consists of inflammation of head of windpipe, indicated by cough and difficulty in swallow- ing; hot and tender in region of gullet; the least pressure may produce paroxysms of coughing; pulse quick, respi- ration somewhat hurried. MELB-ABTILLERT. 219 Treatment. — Place in box stall where atmosphere is warm and moist; avoid cold air; hot-water fomentations, and rub throat with ammonia liniment (1 part liquid ammonia, 1 part cantharides, 2 parts olive oil,); soft laxative food or grass, no hay ; sponge throat with solution of nitrate of silver 10 grains to 1 oz. of water; steam nostrils every 15 minutes with bucket of boiling water and tablespoonful of turpentine poured over hay. No laxative medicine if avoidable. Use enemas, and if necessary give 2 oz. Epsom salts in a pint of water with two drams of ginger night and morning for several days. Keep temperature of body normal by clothing, and give febrifuges in the form of small doses of ^ dram belladonna and 1 oz. nitre made into a soft ball or dissolved in water. MANGE. Symptoms. — An eruptive disease, very contagious; usual- ly most severe in winter; ordinarily induced by inatten- tion to cleanliness or contagion. Indicated by itching, hair falling off, skin becoming dry, wrinkled, and scaly, with raw spots and cracks over the body. Treatment. — If coat be long it may be necessary to clip it Wash well with warm water and soap; apply paraflBne oil daily and allow to dry; or sulphur and linseed oil well rubbed in; or oil of tar and sulphur 2 oz. each, and linseed oil 1 pint. After treating a few days, use sal soda } lb. to one gallon of hot water to wash ofE body and clean skin. NATICULAR DISEASE. Symptoms. — Consists of sprain of the flexor tendon, or its sheath, as it passes over navicular bone, giving rise to inflammation of the joint. If foot-lameness exists.without apparent cause, animal points fore foot without resting hind quarters, wears away 320 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGST ABTILLEBT. toe, goes up hill sounder than he goes down, feet, as a rule, contracted and hotter than usual, we may suspect navicular disease. Treatment. — Kest; allow frog to bear on ground; cold poultices, or stand in cold water or on clay tempered with salt and water; laxative food. In a week blister around coronet and in hollow of heel. This disease can only be alleviated, not cured. OPHTHALMIA (SOKE ETES). Symptoms. — May arise from undue exposure to sun, cold, wind, dust, etc. Foreign substances usually lodge under the upper eyelid. The eyelids are swollen, tears run- ning down face, with intolerance of light. Treatment. — Bathe with warm water; dress daily witli tincture of opium 3 drams, sulphate of zinc 4 grs., or alum 6 grs. and water 1 oz., and shade eyes with wide bandage suspended from brow-band. Keep in dark stable and avoid using in bright sunlight. If feverish, give bran mashes. Bathe with cold water if unable to obtain warm. PARALYSIS OF HIND QUABTEKS. Symptoms. — Partial or complete loss of voluntary motion of the parts, usually brought on by high feeding and no exercise. Treatment. — 1 dram powdered nux vomica twice a day; good nursing ; easily digested food ; dose of Glauber salts. PHARYNGITIS (sore THROAT). Treatment. — Rub the throat with turpentine liniment (equal parts of turpentine and olive oil). FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 221 PLEURISY. Symptoms. — One side of chest generally affected, espe- cially at first. When independent of pneumonia it gener- ally begins suddenly with shivering; breathing quick and shallow; nostrils dilated; respiration short and quick; regular elevated line or ridge along the lower border of the ribs from the point of the hip to the lower part of the sternum; fever; short, dry, painful cough; sighing grunt occasionally or when turned around ; in early stages if ear be applied to chest a sound like rubbing dry hands together will be heard; pulse hard and wiry, at first about 60, runs to 80, and in bad oases to 100 and over, but not so full and oppressed as in pneumonia; restless and looks at side with anxious eye of pain; paws the ground; does not lie down, but attempts to do so; temperature of extremities irregular. Portions may be cold, others hot. In the second stage the friction sound in chest disappears; cough loose and moist; extremities for a time warm; pulse less frequent, smaller, and weaker; breathing less labored; membrane of nostril loses redness. Treatment. — Eoomy stable free from draughts ; foment with blankets steeped in hot water and wrung out, as in pneumonia; continue this for some time, and when dis- continued rub dry, and after four or five days, when acute stage has somewhat subsided, apply to sides liniment com- posed of* olive oils oz., tinct. cantharides 1 oz., solution of ammonia 1 oz., on alternate days. This liniment is not applied until the pain manifested by restlessness has sub-' sided; clothe body. If legs be cold, hand-rub and flannel bandage. Prom the beginning give the following drench every six hours: solution of acetate of ammonia 3 oz., spirits of nitrous ether 1 oz., bicarbonate of potassium 3 drams, water 1 pint. In the beginning of the attack, if pain so severe as to cause animal to lie down or paw, give 222 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. tincture of opium 2 oz.; raw linseed oil 12 oz.; laxative food; 3 oz. sulphate of soda or 1 oz. nitrate of potassa in a bucket of water to drink, and renew as often as necessary; if constipated, 3 oz. Epsom salts dissolved in water with ^ oz. nitrate of potassa twice a day; or enemas of warm water may be all that is necessary. The treatment during fever and if debilitated is as for pneumonia; in fact the general treatment is the same, except the time of applying liniment. PNEUMONIA. Symptoms. — Usually begins with sudden shivering, fol- lowed by coldness of ears and extremities; other signs of inflammation ; staring coat. The coldness of extremities is a marked sign throughout the disease. Animal uneasy; turns head frequently to chest ; pulse oppressed and quick, generally about 60 at commencement, becomes quicker, and may run to 100, gradually becoming smaller in volume ; temperature rises rapidly, frequently to 104° or 105° P.; cough may or may not be present. In early stages nasal linings paler than usual, but become purplish and then of leaden hue ; respiration disturbed at once; animal persist- ently stands with fore legs wide apart and elbows out; never lies down except for a moment at a time, or in ex- tremis ; head inclined downwards, nose protruded, nos- trils dilated. In early stages a confused humming noise accompanied by a harsh, dry murmur is heard when ear is applied to 'chest; as the inflammation progresses the dry murmur gives way to a moist rattle. Treatment. — Box stall free from draughts ; plenty of fresh air ; blanket body ; rub and bandage legs twice a day; plenty of drinking-water near at all times ; rub affected side with liniment (3 oz. olive oil, 1 oz. tincture of can- tharides, 1 oz. solution of ammonia), and repeat in four or FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 223 five days. If weather not too cold and great care can be taken, first apply closely to chest, every half hour for four or five hours, a blanket wrung out of hot water, and wrap a dry one over it; afterwards rub on the above liniment, and cover closely with a blanket. Do not use mustard. No purgatives, but give laxative diet, scalded oats, bran, and linseed mashes. If necessary, give enemas of warm water three or four times a day. Every six hours give solution of acetate of ammonia 3 oz., spirits of nitrous ether 1 oz., bicarbonate of potassium 3 drams, water 1 pint. If this cannot be done, put 3 drams bi-carbonate of potassium into every bucketful of water he will drink. Give every three hours during fever 1 dram quinine in capsule, or mixed with a little linseed meal and molasses. If much debilitated, 6 oz. whiskey in 1 pint of water every four or five hours. PUEGING. In cases of excessive purging, either from disease or an overdose of medicine, use extract of catechu 1 dram, cinnamon 1 dram, powdered opium ^ dram. This may be repeated two or three times a day, thick wheaten gruel being given at the same time. PUNCTUKBS TKOM SHOEING. Symptoms. ^If inflammation be present, the foot will be very hot, and when standing still the animal continually rests it or moves it about uneasily and is afraid to put his weight on it. If tapped with a hammer on the spot, or if the sole and wall at the part be pressed by pincers, suffering is manifested. Treatment. — Eemove shoe ; pare sole over injury until quite thin; make opening between sole and wall with a small drawing-knife across the track of the nail to relieve 224 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. pressure and form an exit for matter; then put foot in bucket of hot water for an hour or so, and afterwards hot poultice. When lameness has disappeared, reshoe, leaving out nail at injured point and filling up the cavity with tar and tow. QUITTOE. Symptoms. — In all cases in which matter forms in the foot, whether from pricks, corns, or bruises, unless it has free opening to escape by it acts as an irritant, extending in every direction in sinuses, and finally works its way to the coronet, where it bursts and forms a fistulous sore. Treatment. — Foment; apply poultice; when abscess opens, keep washed with carbolic acid. Keep open until internal disease is thoroughly eradicated ; then keep clean with cold water and dress with sulphate of copper, iron, or zinc, 5 grains of either to 1 oz. of water; or carbolic acid 20 drops in glycerine 30 drops, and added to 1 oz. of water. For treads or wounds on coronet between hair and hoof, and when the sore has become healthy in case of quittor, a good treatment is common turpentine and hog's lard, equal parts melted together. Spread on tow and bind on wound with bandage. KIS-GWOEM. Symptoms. — This contagious disease is due to the pres- ence of a parasite in the skin, and is manifested by the hair falling out in circular patches. Treatment. — Dress patches with' blistering ointment (powdered cantharides 1 part, lard 6 parts), or with tar dressing as for mange. EHEUMATISM. A peculiar form of inflammation attacking the fibrous structures of the body. FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 226 Treatment. — Laxative food ; 6 drachms of aloes, 1 drachm of calomel, as a cathartic; 1 oz. bicarbonate of soda, fol- lowed daily by a dose half that amount with ^ oz. nitrate of potash; if these fail, give 3 drachms of iodide of potassium in addition. Foment with hot water to which poppy -heads have been added, dry thoroughly, and apply flannel band- ages. Clothe warmly. Keep quiet. SAND-CEACK. Symptoms. — A split in the wall of the hoof commencing on top near the coronet and extending downward. Treatment. — Apply bar-shoe and use hoof ointment (tar and lard, equal parts, melted together). If the animal be lame, remove shoe and immerse the foot in a bucket of hot water for an hour or two, and then poultice. SCURVY. Symptoms. — Eruptions and itching, often in the bend of the knee, the hock, or mane and tail. Treatment. — Apply ointment (iodide of sulphur 1 drachm, glycerine 6 oz.) ; give carbonate of soda 1 oz. twice a day; -J oz. Fowler's solution of arsenic twice a day. Mild laxative food. SOEBS. Symptoms. — Sores on back, withers, or shoulders are ordinarily due to recent swellings from blows or injuries of some kind. Treatment. — Sulphate of zinc 4 drachms, cold water 1 quart; apply by washing or with wetted bandages. Or first cleanse a healthy sore with soap and water, then apply sulphur 3 parts, iodoform 1 part. 226 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. SPBAIN'S. Sprains consist in an overstretching of a muscle, tendon, or ligament to such a degree as to rupture some of the fibres of which it is composed. They are divided into mus- cular sprains, tendonous sprains, and ligamentous sprains. Muscular sprains usually occur in the powerful muscles of the loins and quarters; they are serious and often per- manent injuries. Tendonous sprains are the most common, and the flexor tendons of the fore legs are most frequently afEected. Ligamentous sprains are serious injuries, and may occur in any of the numerous ligaments belonging to the joints of the body. The principles of treatment are the' same as for tendons. Symptoms. — Sprains of tendons and ligaments are mani- fested by heat, swelling, pain on manipulation, and lame- ness. Treatment. — First reduce the inflammation by rest and constant use of hot fomentations. If the sprain be severe and at the rear part of the fore or hind leg, raise the heel of the shoe on the affected leg an inch or more. All traces of the inflammation having disappeared, apply cold water and linen bandages, and give a little slow exer- cise. Should the swelling show no signs of subsiding, or the lameness continue after long and careful treatment, firing may be considered, but should only be undertaken by a skilful surgeon. The diet should be laxative. SPRAINS OF BACK AND LOINS. Treatment. — Rest; keep bowels open with warm bran mashes and a dose of Glauber salts {\ to 1 lb. sulphate of soda) ; also 1 drachm acetate of potassa twice a day for ten days. Treat externally with hot fomentations, or blister if necessary. FIELD-ABTILLERT. 227 STRANGLES. Symptoms. — Sick and off feed, with possibly slight catarrh and feverish symptoms; abscess forms between bones of lower jaw or elsewhere in the group of lymphatic glands; sore throat; difficulty in swallowing; slobbers; unthrif tiness ; staring coat; loss of condition; dulness and languor. Treatment. — Place in cool box with plenty of fresh air; support strength by nutritious food; all kinds of soft and macerated food are good; if constipated, give laxative food and enemas, but no strong purgative must be used; if neces- sary, ^ pint of linseed-oil, repeated in 24 hours if required. Tonics, such as 20 grains of quinine, or 1 oz. ground gen- tian, or 1 teaspoonful sulphate of iron, three times a day. Bring swelling to a head by a poultice of flaxseed, carrots, or turnips. If sufEocatiou be threatened, a tube must be placed in the windpipe. This should be done by a skilful surgeon. SUNSTROKE. Symptoms. — Manifested suddenly. Animal stops, drops his head, begins to stagger, and soon falls to the ground unconscious. The breathing is with great stertor, pulse very slow and irregular, cold sweats in patches. In heat exhaustion the animal usually requires urging for some time previous to the appearance of any other symptoms; generally perspiration is checked, and then he becomes weak in his gait; breathing hurried or panting; eyes watery and bloodshot; nostrils dilated and highly red- dened, assuming a dark purple color; the pulse is rapid and weak, the heart bounding, followed by unconsciousness and death. Treatment. — Blood-letting is forbidden. Apply ice or very cold water to the head and along the spine for sun- stroke, but in case of heat exhaustion apply cloths wrung out of hot water. 228 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. The following applies to both cases: Give | oz. carbonate of ammonia or 6 oz. of whiskey in a pint of water; injec- tions per rectum, of moderately strong ginger-tea or weak ammonia- water ; brisk friction of the limbs and the appli- cation of spirits of camphor. Repeat stimulants in an hour if pulse has not become stronger and slower. When reaction has occurred and during convalescence, tonics may be given : sulphate of iron 1 drachm, gentian 3 drachms, red cinchona- bark 2 drachms; mix and give in the feed night and morn- ing. SWEESTY. Symptoms. — Consists of a sprain of the muscles covering the outer surface of the shoulder-blade, in consequence of which they become wasted, leaving their place hollow. Treatment. — Feed muscle-making food and give moder- ate exercise. Apply from time to time a mild blister (powdered cantharides 1 part, olive-oil 13 parts.) SWELLED LEGS. Swelled legs are more often due to general debility than to any other cause, though it may arise from lack of exer- cise, wet or filth, or neglected cases of grease or scratches. Treatment. — Hand-rub; bandage the legs; warm cloth- ing; gentle exercise; generous diet if the animal be poor; mild dose of physic in some cases (\ pint of linseed-oil). Vegetable and mineral tonics are useful in some cases. THRUSH. Symptoms. — Arises from neglect and want of use. Man- ifests itself under the form of an acrid, strong-smelling unhealthy secretion issuing from the sensitive frog through the cleft of the insensitive frog; most common in hind foot. Treatment. — Cleanse and keep clean both feet and where FIELD-ABTILLER7. 229 the animal stands. After cleansing foot gently thrust to the bottom of the cleft a piece of fine tow saturated with 1 part carbolic acid, 20 parts water, and then cover with dry tow. Eepeat night and morning for a few days and then dress with calomel and dry tow. Keep frog free from dirt and moisture. URINE, EETEIiTTION OF. Symptoms. — Uneasiness, distress, anxiety of countenance; if relief is not soon obtained, pulse becomes quick and hard, and ultimately imperceptible; stretching out in en- deavor to void urine; lies down and rises up frequently; clammy sweats. Treatment. — Place fresh straw under animal; pouring water may produce sympathetic action; steady pressure of the hand, passed through the anus, on the fundus of the bladder may accomplish result; rub belly, or wash out sheath thoroughly if caused by dirt; 2 ounces sweet spirits of nitre in pint of water, or 1 pint linseed-oil and afterwards opium 1^ drachms, camphor 2^ drachms; repeat in 1 or 2 hours if necessary. If necessary to pass a catheter, the hand well oiled is passed up the sheath, the penis grasped and gently brought forward and held by an assistant; the catheter, well oiled, is then introduced and carefully pushed forward, and when it reaches the perinseum it should be guided forward and upwards by gentle pressure of the fingers. UEINE, NON-EETENTIOK OF. Symptoms. — Besides excessive staling there is extreme thirst, dry skin, rough, staring coat, digestion usually out of order. Treatment. — Change diet; give 1 drachm iodide of potas- sium in 10 oz. water daily between meals. 230 A BANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLMBT. WARBLES. Symptoms.— Recent soft swellings or tumors arising from inflammation of the skin due to friction or undue pressure. Treatment. — Eemove cause by not permitting the saddle or collar to touch it, and treat with salt water. Try to disperse, but if necessary to open it do so fully and touch with caustic. Then use cold-water dressings. WAKTS. Treatment. — When small, remove by scraping surface and dressing with chloride of zinc; if large, remove with knife, and if necessary touch with hot iron. If without appreciable base, apply a paste of sulphur and sulphuric acid until it sloughs and then dress as an ordinary wound. WOEMS. Treatment. — 3 oz. turpentine in a pint of linseed-oil. The most effectual treatment is to administer daily for ten days or two weeks 2 drachms sulphate of iron and then give a dose of physic; change diet; tonic. WOUNDS. Simple wounds demand little attention other than cleanliness. i?¥rs^.— Suppress hemorrhage by cold applications with pressure. If the bleeding be profuse, continuous, and of a bright red color, apply pressure to trunk of artery higher up leg (if leg is injured) than the wound, i.e., apply between wound and heart. Tie a flat web, cord, or handkerchief loosely around the leg, lay a pad formed of another hand- kerchief immediately above the artery, pass a stick through the loop on opposite side of leg to pad and turn it around so as to twist loop tightly. A plug of cotton, tow, sponge, or rag made into conical shape with point of cone toward MELD-AHTILLBRT. SiSl bleeding orifice is also useful; remove clots of blood, apply plug and retain it by rags, tow, etc. In large, gaping wounds the finger or even the closed fist may be efEectually employed until assistance arrives. Cold water, ice, tar, perchloride of iron, felt, wool, spider's web, etc., may all be employed with more or less effect in stopping bleeding. Second. — Eemove all foreign matter, dirt, splinters of wood or bone, bullets, etc., as far as possible, by allowing lukewarm water to stream over wound from the mouth of a vessel; or a piece of sponge or tow may be pressed on some part above the wound so that the water may trickle over it; but the abraded part is not to be touched except in the re- moval of foreign substances by forceps or otherwise. Then use cold-water dressings; apply soothing applications, watery solution of opium, carbolic acid lotion, tincture of arnica, or simple ointment. Hot fomentations may be used after cleansing to reduce inflammation. Compress and bandage are preferable to stitches in bring- ing the parts together; the former to be used after the in- flammation begins to subside, and the latter not until all inflammation has disappeared. The lowest end of the wound must be kept open to per- mit the escape of matter during healing; this is usually accomplished by inserting a piece of dry liiit between the edges of the wound. General treatment is rest and low diet. Third. — During healing-stage dress with carbolic acid 1 part, water 20 parts; or carbolized oil; or bluestone (sul- phate of copper) dissolved in water, 2 drachms to the pint; or tar ointment (tar 1 oz., sulphur ^ oz., lard 1^ oz.) ; or light blister of cantharides (powdered cantharides 1 part, olive-oil 12 parts) to neighboring parts in case of indolent wound. If proud flesh crops out above the surface of the 232 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. wound, remoTe it by applying sulphate of copper or zinc (as aboTe), or nitrate of silver, or alum, in order to keep it below the surface of skin, so that the parts may unite. GENEEAL DIRECTIONS FOR SHOBINGf HORSES. In preparing the horse's foot for the shoe do not touch with the knife the frog, sole, or bars. In removing surplus growth of that part of the foot which is the seat of the shoe use the cutting-pincers and rasp, and not the knife. The shoeing-knife may be used, if necessary, in fitting the toe- clip. Opening the heels or making a cut into the angle of the wall at the heel must not be allowed. The rasp may be used upon this part of the foot when necessary, and the same applies to the frog. N"o cutting with a knife is per- mitted, the rasp alone being used when necessary. Flat- footed horses should be treated as the necessity of each case may require. In forging the shoe to fit the foot be careful that the shoe is fitted to and follows the circumfer- ence of the foot clear around to the heels; the heels of the shoe should not be extended back straight and outside of the walls at the heels of the horse's foot, as is frequently done. The shoe must not be fitted too small and the outer surface of the walls then rasped down to make the foot short to suit the shoe, as often happens. Heat may be used in preparing and shaping the shoe, but the hot shoe must never be applied to the horse's foot. Make the upper or foot surface of the shoe perfectly fiat so as to give a level bearing. A shoe with a concave ground surface should be used. In garrison, at the discretion of the commanding oflBlcer, the horses may be left unshod. Shoes will be fitted and kept ready to be put on the horses. The new Burden shoe called the " easy " has just been adopted as the U. S. service shoe. FIELD-ABTILLSBT. 233 Never use a nail that gives the slightest indication of splitting, a result that may be expected if they be cold- forged. Always use a hot-forged nail. The Putnam nail, hot- forged, is excellent. STABLES AND STABLE DUTIES. Foul air and dampness are the cause of many diseases of the horse; hence the importance and economy of spacious, clean, dry, and well-ventilated stables. Ceilings should be twelve or fifteen feet high, with large ventilators throug?i the roof, and a window or side aperture in each stall, which should be placed well above the horse's eyes. If possible, the building should have no upper story or loft. In stables with a loft, ventilation from the top is always insuflBcient, and there must be side openings well above the horses, so that the draught will pass over their heads. These open- ings must never be closed except on the windward side, to keep out rain or snow. There should be a passageway for feeding in front of the stalls, and so that the horses can look to the right and left. Their heads should never be placed against a partition if it can be avoided. Double stalls should not be less than 4^ feet by 9 feet to each horse; and single stalls should be 5 feet wide. Stalls 6 feet wide and 10^ feet long are greatly to be preferred. Not less than 1200 cubic feet should be allowed to each horse in the stable. A picket-line is established in the immediate vicinity of the battery stable, the horses being tied to a hemp or wire rope or chain passed through the picket-posts. There should be shallow trenches behind the horses to carry ofE rain, the ground on which they stand having Just enough slope to let the water run into the trenches, or there may be a single drain in the centre along the line of the picket- 234 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. posts. Constant attention must be paid to maintaining the ground about the picket-line in good order. Hut Stables. — Eough sheds with clapboard ed roofs are the best; with the litter and some wet earth good walls can soon be constructed around the shed; these walls should be vertical on the inside, but with a good slope toward the outside. Sheds made 30 feet wide can accommodate two rows of horses, their heads being turned toward one another. Plenty of openings must be left for doors by which to remove the horses quickly in case of fire, and drainage must be well attended to. The stalls, or standing-space, should be 5 feet wide and 9 feet long. An excellent shed can be made under the lee of a bank by erecting forked poles, placing connecting pieces, and laying thereon boards or poles and thatching. GEKEBAL RULES EOE STABLE MANAGEMENT. The stable sergeant takes immediate charge of the police and sanitary condition of the stable, picket-line, etc., and is the custodian of the forage and stable property generally. The stable is to be kept thoroughly policed, free from smells, and well whitewashed. There must be no accumu- lation of manure or foul litter inside, or near the doors or windows without. The feed-boxes are washed out fre- quently and kept perfectly clean. The ground about the picket-line is swept daily and all dung, etc., carried to the manure-heap. Except at night, when the horses are bedded down, no manure or urine is to remain in the stalls; the stable police remove it as fast as it accumulates. If practicable, all woodwork within reach of the horses and not protected with sheet iron or other metal is painted with thin gas-tar, to prevent its being gnawed; it should be thoroughly dried before putting horses near it. The FIELb-AMTILLEBT. 235 same precaution must be followed with regard to troughs, picket-posts, and hemp picket-line. Smoking in stables or in their immediate vicinity is pro- hibited. One or more lamps will be hung in each stable, to burn during the night. The horses are stalled according to their positions in the battery, the teams nearest the door being led out first; their places at the picket-line will be in accordance with the same rule. The name of each horse, and that of his rider or driver, are placed over his stall. Clay is the best for earthen floors, as it packs well. Gravel or sandy earth is not suitable. Each man is held responsible for tlie removal of the earth and the levelling of the floor of his stall. The sloping of the floor of stalls from the manger to the heel-post is injurious and uncomfortable for the animal, who stands in an unnatural position, with the fore legs higher than the hind ones. When earthen floors are not level, they give more trouble, as the horse will paw a hollow for his fore feet unless he can elevate his hind legs by backing out of the stall. Whenever the horses go out of the stable, the windows of their stalls are to be kept open, unless necessary to ex- clude rain or snow, or when cold draughts affect the animals in contiguous or opposite stalls. Stable doors are never closed in the daytime except to keep out the wet or to exclude cold winds. If the doors be in a single piece, bars are put across the doorway; if divided in half, it will be usually sufficient to open the upper part. At night, except in very hot weather, they should be closed and locked, communication with the stable being kept up by a manhole. Except in very cold, windy weather, or in very hot 236 A BANDBOOK FOB LtOBT ABTILLBBY. weather, where there is no shade, horses should stand most of the day at the picket-line, as they have better air and are less confined, while the stables become drier and more healthful. In ordinary climates military stables must be kept as cool as possible. If the horses do not stand directly in the draught, the colder the stable the less will they suffer if suddenly called to take the field. For the same reason horses should never be blanketed in the stable except in very cold weather in high latitudes. STABLE DUTY. The captain is responsible for the proper performance of stable duty in his battery. At morning stable-call the cannoneers, assisted by the prisoners, clean out the stalls and police the stable under the direction of the stable sergeant. The bedding is taken up, that .which is much soiled being separated for the manure-heap, and the remainder put on the racks or spread upon the ground to dry. If necessary, the drivers assist after they have done grooming. At evening stable-call the stable is policed as in the morning; the bedding is laid down and fresh straw spread on top of it; the bed must be soft and even, with the thickest part toward the manger. Horses are groomed twice daily, at morning and at even- ing stable-calls, under the supervision of the first sergeant and battery oflftcer of the day. In special circumstances it may be advisable to groom only once, about noon. The grooming is always at the picket-line, except in stormy weather. Each driver, whether on guard or not, grooms his own horses, under the superintendence of his chief of section. Supernumerary horses are groomed by a detail of can- noneers under the direction of a corporal, who is assigned FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 23Y to this duty. In each platoon the horses of the chiefs of section are groomed by a cannoneer, who is permanently detailed, both horses being attached for grooming pur- poses to the section to which the cannoneer belongs. The trumpeters groom their own horses under the direction of the first sergeant. At evening stable-call each man examines and cleans out his horse's feet, and sees that the shoes are in good order. Horses requiring shoeing are reported to the proper non- commissioned officer, who notifies the stable sergeant. Bach horse should be groomed not less than twenty min- utes, beginning with the near horse. If any horses are not properly groomed they will be left at the picket-line, and groomed by their drivers under the direction of a non- commissioned officer of the guard. In garrison, when there are no available prisoners, two or more men, called the stable police, are usually kept at work between morning and evening stable-calls in remov- ing manure, policing generally, feeding, etc. In horse-batteries stable duty is conducted on the same principles, with such modifications as the nature of the ser- vice demands. GEOOMING. Take the currycomb in the right hand, fingers over back of comb; begin on the near side at the upper part of the neck, thence proceed to the ciiest, arms, shoulders, back, belly, fiank, loins, and rump. Then go to the off side, tak- ing comb ill left hand, and proceed as before. The currycomb is applied gently, and is used only to loosen the scurf and matted hair; it is not used on the legs from the knees or hocks downward except to carefully loosen dried mud. Next take the brush in left hand, and change currycomb to right; begin at the neck on the near side, and proceed 238 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. in the same order as in currying, brushing also the parts not touched by the comb; on the oil side take' brush in right hand, currycomb in left. In places difficult to clean apply the brush backward and forward, finishing by leaving the coat smooth. After every few strokes clean the brush from dust with the currycomb. Having done with the brush, rub or dust off the horse with the grooming-cloth, wipe about the eyes and nostrils, and clean the dock. The skin under the flank and be- tween the hindquarters must be soft, clean, and free from dust. Currycombs, cards, or common combs must never be ap- plied to the mane or tail; but the brush, fingers, and cloth are freely used on both. The wisp is used when the horse comes in warm from exercise, and he is rubbed against the hair until dry, from his hindquarters up to his head. FEEDING. In garrison it is recommended that grain be fed at first call for reveille by the stable sergeant, assisted by one or two members of the stable-guard, or men detailed for the purpose. The grain, in a box on wheels, is rolled in front of each stall, when it is transferred to the feed-boxes by allowance-measures. Grain is fed again at evening stable duty as in the morning, but not until after the hay has been distributed and the stable swept up. In camp or on the march grain is fed at morning and evening stables. The men are matched to the forage- wagons or other grain depository, where the non-commis- sioned officer in charge, with an allowance-measure, issues to each in turn. Gruel is very good for horses when tired. To make it, put a double handful of fresh coarse oatmeal in a bucket, add a little cold water, mix well, and add l^ gallons of hot FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 239 (not boiling) water. Stir well till smooth, and give it at the temperature of new milk ; add a wineglass or two of spirits if horse is much exhausted. In garrison hay is fed thrice daily — immediately after ■morning stables, in the middle of the day, and at evening stables ; at the evening feed each animal should have at least one half of his daily allowance. The dust must be well shaken out of the hay before it is put in the mangers. During the short days of winter the feeding at noon may be omitted without injury to the animals. In camp hay is fed at the picket-line morning, noon, and evening; on the march, in the evening only. The occasional use of bran is important for stabled horses. In spring or early summer they should have grass for at least a week or ten days, during which time they ought not to be much worked. Salt should be given at least once a week. When forage cannot be obtained, grazing should be allowed at every spare moment, especially early in the morning when the dew is on the grass. The daily allowance of oats, barley, or corn is 12 pounds to each horse; that of hay, 14 pounds ; the allowance of straw for bedding is 100 pounds a month to each animal. Barley and corn should both be crushed, if possible, when used to feed horses or mules. Good oats weigh about 33 pounds to the bushel, barley about 48 pounds, corn about 56 pounds. Pressed hay weighs about 11 pounds per cubic foot. Good Oats are clean, hard, dry, sweet, plump, full of flour, and rattle like shot. They have a clean and almost metallic lustre. Those in a sample vary but little in size, and are entirely free from smell. The pressure of the nail ought to leave little or no mark on them. The value of an oat depends mainly on its weight per bushel. Dirty oats weigh heavier than clean ones. 240 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. New oats can be distinguished from old by their smell, which is fresh and earthy, and by their taste, which is fresh and milky, while that of the old oat is slightly bitter. New oats are indigestible. Oats one year old are best. Various Defects in Oats — Kiln-dried. — Oats that have been dried to render them hard after they have been damp. They have a loose and shrivelled appearance about the ends of the husks, and are easily recognized by their pe- culiar smell and reddish color. Foxy Oats. — Oats that have undergone a certain process of fermentation from having been stowed in bulk when not perfectly dry. They are unfit for horses, are of a reddish color, and have both bitter smell and taste. Their reddish color is sometimes gotten rid of by subjecting them to fumes of sulphur, which makes them unnaturally white. Damp Oats are objectionable and should be rejected. Continued dampness soon produces softness, mustiness, mouldiness, and sprouting. Dirty Oats. — This can be remedied by winnowing. Hay. — There is a great variety of grasses. The best hay contains a large proportion of the best of these, along with clover and other good herbage, and only a small proportion of the inferior kinds, whilst in the inferior kinds of hay good herbage is nearly entirely wanting, and the inferior grasses predominate. The characteristics of good hay are green color combined with a delicate smell and taste, a presence of flowers in their natural colors, and of a variety of grasses and good herbage (not weeds), and clover of moderate fineness, crisp- ness, and hardness. Straw must be wheat, oats, or rye straw; barley induces disease of the skin. It ought to be long and strong. Horses are inclined to eat wheat straw when new. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 241 WATEEIlir&. Horses must be watered quietly, and without confusion; the manner in which this duty is performed is a good test of the discipline of a mounted command. Horses are to be led or ridden at a walk to and from water, depending upon its distance from the stable. At the drinking-place no horse should be hurried or have his head jerked up from the water. If a stream is used for watering horses from the bank, the level of the water must not be more than 3 or 4 inches below the latter; and if the water is very shallow dams should be constructed to deepen it, as animals drink more rapidly when water is at least 6 inches deep. Mules should be watered higher up stream than horses. When animals will not drink from a stream, they will frequently do so from a bucket with a handful of grass on the water. In the field or on the march the watering is from the most convenient running water; in garrison it is usually from troughs. In warm weather water drawn from a cold well or spring before being used should stand long enough for the chill to pass ofE. The horses are watered under the immediate direction of the first sergeant, but if they are liable to meet those of other commands at the watering-place a commissioned ofiBcer should replace him. During the hot months horses are watered thrice daily — in the morning, at noon, and just before grooming in the afternoon. At other times two waterings are enough, after morning and at evening stables. In very cold weather once a day, at noon, is sufiBcient. It is to be always remembered that .a horse will rarely drink enough very early in the morning. , The daily allowance of water for a horse is six gallons. On the march horses are watered with buckets carried 243 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. on the carriages. The oftener this is done the better, as it is not usually known when another watering-place will be reached. When horses have to make a day's march without water, they will be watered after they are fed, just before leaving camp in the morning. If a mounted command has to march a long distance without water, so that it will be necessary to encamp en rmite, the animals are well fed, but denied water until just before starting, when they are permitted to drink freely. The command marches in the afternoon, and does not en- camp until it has accomplished at least half of the distance, and moves early the next morning to reach water. TRAINING HORSES. Horses are trained by the best horsemen, under the supervision of an oflBcer or non-commissioned officer. It should be carefully impressed upon the men that the horse may be made gentle and obedient by patience, kind- ness, and fearlessness; that punishment is only to be re- sorted to when necessary, and then only administered immediately after the commission of the offense; and that nothing should ever be done to the horse in anger. The restlessness or impatience which frequently arises from exuberance of spirits and playfulness must be care- fully distinguished from that which arises from viciousness or timidity. When restless, the horse should be held until he becomes calm; when submissive after punishment, he should be treated kindly. The men should endeavor to inspire him with confidence, and he should gradually be accustomed to warlike sounds — firing, beating of drums, etc. As one horse is apt to be governed by the actions of another, trained horses that are indifferent to such sounds should be interspersed among the new ones, FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 243 The first object to be obtained in training a horse is to render him gentle. and tractable by progressive lessons. For this purpose all proper means must be employed, such as feeding, handling, patting him, taking up his feet, etc., and the practice of the longe. The practice of the longe is also intended to supple him and teach him the free and proper use of his limbs. It likewise aids in forming his paces and fits him for service iu the battery. The men employed in this most important part of the horse's education must be selected for their natural fond- ness for animals, as well as for their patience, coolness, and intelligence, and should not be changed until the horses are sufiBoiently instructed to take their places in the bat- tery. BRIDLING. A plain snaffle-bridle should at first be used and put on with great care and gentleness. If the horse resists, no violence should be used. He should be turned round in his stall and the instructor should take the end of the halter while the man quiets and encourages the horse. By careful treatment he will soon be accustomed to the sight of the bit and will allow it to be placed in his mouth. The reins will be tied so as to hang loosely on the neck. Cavesson. — The cavesson is a bridle head-stall, to which a nose-band, encircling the horse's head, is added; the lat- ter is adjustable by means of a buckle; the chin-strap has a running ring to which the longeing-strap is attached. When the snaffle-bridle has been properly fitted, the cavesson is carefully put on. The nose-band should be about three inches above the nostrils; if higher, it would partly lose its power; if lower it would affect the horse's breathing. It must not be so tight as to make the horse uneasy. 244 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. LONGBING. This instruction should be begun on a circle from fifteen to twenty yards in diameter. As horses are usually fed, watered, saddled, and led from the near side, they are inclined to lead better from that than the off side. It will therefore generally be found necessary to give two lessons on the right to one on the left. The first lesson to be taught the young horse is to go forward. Until he does this freely nothing else should be required of him. When he obeys freely, he should occasion- ally be stopped and caressed. If the horse hesitates or stands still when he is ordered to move on, he should be encouraged, as such hesitation oftener comes from fear and ignorance as to what is required than from obstinacy or vice. The horse should at first be led around the circle at a walk. A man with a whip (with which at first the horse should not be struck) should follow at a short distance and show the whip occasionally if the horse is inclined to hang back; if this does not produce the desired effect, he should strike the ground in rear of the horse, and at length touch him lightly with the whip until he obeys. After the horse begins to move freely at a walk the man holding the longeing-rein should gently urge him to the trot, gradually lengthening the rein so that it may be scarcely felt, and should go round the circle at an active pace nearly opposite the horse's shoulder so as to keep him out and press him forward. If the horse takes kindly to this lesson, the man holding tlie rein may lengthen it by degrees until he has only to turn in the same spot, the man with the whip being careful to keep the horse out to the line of the circle. Should the horse break his pace, or plunge, the rein should be shaken without jerking it until he returns to the trot. FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 245 The man holding the longeing-rein should have a light and easy hand. For the first two or three days the horse must not be urged too much; if he goes gently, without Jumping or resisting, enough is accomplished. He should be longed to the right, left, and right again, changing from a walk to a trot and back again in each case. He should be frequently halted by gently feeling the rein and speak- ing to him. After a few days of the above practice the horse may be urged a little more in the trot, but the greatest care and attention are requisite to teach him the use of his limbs without straining him. Much harm may be done in this in- struction by a sudden jerk or too forcible pull of the longe. Care must be taken that the lessons are not made so long as to fatigue or fret the horse. At first they should be short and be gradually increased in length as the instruc- tion progresses. At the conclusion of each lesson the horse should be led to the centre of the ring and made much of. The man holding the longeing-rein should take it short in ona "hand, at the same time patting and rubbing the horse about the head and neck with the other; he should then try to bend the horse's neck a little to the right and then to the left by means of the longeing-rein. The bend should be in the very poll of the neck, and this exercise should be repeated at the end of every lesson, cautiously and by slo'vy degrees, until the horse responds easily. This exercise will greatly facilitate the future in- struction of the animal. The running-rein is of great value in teaching a horse to keep his head in a proper position, and affords valuable aid in his first handling. If judiciously used, it saves the rider a great deal of trouble and the horse much ill usage. It is especially useful in controlling horses that are inclined to bolt. It should act directly on the snaffle-bit itself, and is wholly independent of the reins. 246 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. The Running-rein consists of three parts — the chin- strap, martingale, and rein. The GMn-strap, about six to eight inches long, on which is suspended a loose ring, is fastened to both snaffle-bit rings. The Martingale has only one ring; the loop through which the girth passes is made adjustable by a buckle. The martingale is so adjusted that when taut the ring will be on a level with the points of the horse's shoulders. The Rein is about eight and one half feet long; one end is buckled into the near pommel -ring; the free end is then passed through the martingale-ring from rear to front, thence through the chin-strap ring from left to right, thence through the martingale-ring from front to rear, and is held in the rider's right hand. A pull on this rein will act directly on the mouth-piece, drawing it back and some- what downward toward the horse's breast-bone. PEEPAKATOET LESSON TO MAKE THE HORSE TRACTABLE. Before commencing the bending lessons it is well to give the horse a preparatory one in obedience. This first act of submission makes the horse quiet and gives him confidence, and gives the man such ascendancy as to pre- vent the horse at the outset from resisting the means em- ployed to bring him under control. Go up to the horse, pat him on the neck, and speak to him; then take the reins from the horse's neck and hold them at a few inches from the rings of the bit with the left hand ; take such position as to offer as much resistance as possible to the horse should he attempt to break away; hold the whip in the right hand, with the point down; raise the whip quietly and tap the horse on the breast; the horse naturally tries to move back to avoid the whip; fol- low the horse, pulling at the same time against him, and continuing the use of the whip; be careful to show no sign FIELB-ARTtLLBIlT. 247 of angei* nor any symptom of yielding. The horse, tired of trying ineffectually to avoid the whip, soon ceases to pull and moves forward; then drop the point of the whip and make much of him. This repeated once or twice usually proves sufficient; the horse, having found how to avoid the punishment, no longer waits for the application of the whip, but anticipates it by moving up at the slightest gesture, BENDIKG LESSONS. These lessons should be given to the horse each day so long as the snaffle-bit is used alone; but the exercise should be varied, so that the horse may not beqome fatigued or disgusted. The balance of the horse's body and his lightness in hand depend on the proper carriage of his head and neck. A young horse usually tries to resist the bit, either by bending his neck to one side, by setting his jaw against the bit, or by carrying his nose too high or too low. The bending lessons serve to make a horse manageable by teaching him to conform to the movements of the reins and to yield to the pressure of the bit. During the lessons the horse must never be hurried. To Bend the Horse's Neck to the Right. — Take a position on the near side of the horse, in front of his shoulder and facing toward his neck; take the off rein close up to the bit with the right hand, the near rein the same way with the left hand, the thumbs toward each other, the little fingers outward ; bring the right hand toward the body, at the same time extend the left arm so as to turn the head to the horse's right. The force employed must be gradual and proportioned to the resistance met with, and care must be taken not to bring the horse's nose too close to his chest. If the horse moves backward, continue the pressure until, finding it im- 248 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. possible to avoid the restraint imposed by the bit, he stands still and yields to it. When the bend is complete, the horse holds his head there without any restraint and champs the bit; then make much of him and let him resume his natural position by degrees, without throwing his head around hurriedly. A horse, as a rule, champs the bit when he ceases to resist. The horse's neck is bent to the left in a similar manner, the man standing on the ofE side. To Eein in. — Cross the reins behind the horse's jaw, tak- ing the near rein in the right hand and the ofE rein in the left, at about six inches from the rings; draw them across each other till the horse gives way to the pressure and brings his nose in. Prevent the horse from raising his head by lowering the hands. When the horse gives way to the cross-pressure of the reins, ease the hand and make much of him. SADDLING. This should be done at first on the longeing-ground. One man, facing the horse and taking the snaffle-reins in both hands near the bit, should hold him while another places the saddle on his back. If the horse shows no un- easiness or resistance, let down the cincha-strap and cincha; fasten the cincha-strap loosely at first, and tighten it afterwards by degrees. Care must be taken not to make the cincha so tight as to cause uneasiness to the horse. If the horse resists or is restless, remove the saddle and let him see and smell it; he will then generally allow it to be placed; if necessary, strap up a leg until the horse is sad- dled. The longeing is then continued with the horse saddled. MOUNTIN-G. When the horse becomes accustomed to the saddle, he should be mounted. Two men should assist the man who FIELD-ARTILLERT. 249 is to mount. The man with the longe, facing the horse and taking the snaffle-reins in both hands near the bit, holds his head rather high and engages his attention; the second man bears down on the off stirrup at the proper moment to keep the saddle even when the third man mounts. The man who mounts proceeds with caution, stopping and caressing the horse if he shows any uneasi- ness; after being seated the man pats the horse a few moments, and without attempting to make him move, dis- mounts with the care and gentleness exercised in mount- ing. This is repeated several times, until the horse sub- mits without fear. The rider then mounts, takes a snaffle- rein in each hand, and feels lightly the horse's mouth; the man with the longe leads the horse forward and after- wards loDges him to the left, and then to the right, at a walk ; if the horse shows any disposition to kick or plunge, the longe is shaken to engage his attention and to keep up his head. After a few turns the rider dismounts, the horse is fed from the hand, patted, and dismissed. These lessons are continued until the horse can be mounted and dismounted without any difficulty; and when he can be made to go forward, to the right and left, to halt and rein back by gentle application of the aids, the longe is dispensed with. The horse is now exercised in the riding-hall or open manage, the lessons for young horses not exceeding three quarters of an hour. The horse is ridden on the track first at a walk, then at a slow trot, and afterwards the trot and walk are alternated, care being taken to turn the corners squarely; the horse is next marched to the right and left, halted and reined back to accustom him to obey the bit and the pressure of the legs. When he is obedient to the snaffle, the horse is equipped with the curb-bit. The bit must have rings at the ends of the mouthpiece for snaffle- reins, or a bit-bridoon must be used in order that the horse 250 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLBRY. may be accustomed by degrees to the action of the curb- bit. The first iustruction given to the horse with the curb- bit is bending the neck and reining in, dismounted; he is then mounted and exercised in the riding-hall or open manage as before described, and receives the bending and reining lessons mounted. BENDISrS LESSONS, MOTJlirTED. The horse is now equipped with a curb-bridle. To Bend the Horse's Neck to the Right. — Adjust the reins in the left hand; seize the right rein with the right hand well down; draw it gently to the right and rear until the horse's head is brought completely around to the right, in the same position as in the bend dismounted. When the horse champs the bit, make much of him, and allow him to resume his natural position. The horse's neck is bent to the left in a similar manner. To Rein in. — Lower the bridle-hand as much as possible, turning the back uppermost; with the right hand, nails down, take hold of the curb-reins above and close to the left hand and shorten them by degrees, drawing them through the left hand, which closes on the reins each time they are shortened. When the horse resists much and holds his nose up, keep the reins steady; do not shorten or lengthen them; close the legs to prevent the horse from backing; after remain- ing perhaps a minute or more with his nose up and his jaw set against the bit he will yield, bring his nose in, and champ the bit; make much of him, loosen the" reins, and after a few seconds rein in again. This exercise gives the horse confidence, and teaches him to arch his neck and bring his head in proper position whenever he feels the bit. Most young horses are afraid of the bit, and they must FIELD-ARTILLERY. 261 never be frightened by sudden jerks on the reins, lest they should aiterwards refuse to stand the requisite pressure of the bit. A certain amouut of bearing is necessary to induce the horse to work boldly and well, as well as to apprise the rider of what the horse is going to do. In reining in, some horses rest the lower jaw against the breast; to counteract this, press both legs equally and force the horse forward to the bit. Some horses will not work up to the hand; that is, will not bear the bit at all. Such horses are unfit for the ser- vice. Whenever, without an apparent cause, a horse resists or is restive, the bit, saddle, and equipment should be carefully examined to see if any part hurts or irritates him. BEAEIN'G. Should the horse rear, the rider must yield the hand when the horse is up, and urge him vigorously forward when he is coming down; if the horse is punished while up, he may spring and fall backward. Use the running-rein with a rearing horse. KICKING. This can be prevented by holding the horse's head well up and closing the legs; if necessary, they are closed so much as to force the horse forward. SHYIITG. This sometimes results from defect of sight and some- times from fear. If from fear, the horse must be taken up to the object with great patience and gentleness, and be allowed to touch the object with his nose. In no case should a horse be punished for timidity. The dread of chastise- ment will increase his restiveness. 252 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. TO ACCUSTOM THE HOESBS TO FIRING. Station a few men at a little distance from and on both sides of the stable-door, and cause them to fire pistols as the horses are led into the stable to be fed ; for the same object a gun may be fired during the hour of feeding. If a horse is nervous, he may be put on the longe and fed from the hand and petted each time the pistol is discharged ; or he may be thrown, care being taken not to discharge the pistol so as to burn him or injure him in any way. The horses should be trained to be steady under the fire of the pieces, and also under pistol-firing by the cannoneers on the chests and by the drivers from their teams. SWIMMING HOESBS. The horses are at first equipped with the watering-bridle, and are without saddles. The reins are on the horse's neck just in fi'ont of the withers, and knotted so that they will not hang low enough to entangle the horse's feet, care being taken to have them loose enough to permit the horse to push his nose well out, so as to have entire freedom of the head. The horse should be watered before putting him into the stream. When the rider gets into deep water, he drops the reins, seizes a lock of the mane with the up-stream hand, allows his body to drift ofE quietly to the down-stream side of the horse, and floats or swims flat on the water, guiding the horse as much as possible by splashing water against his head, only using the reins when splashing fails. The horse is easily controlled when swimming ; he is also easily con- fused, and it is therefore necessary that the rider should be gentle and deliberate. The rider must be cautioned that the horse is easily pulled over backward by the reins when swimming, and also that he may plunge when he touches bottom. When the horse touches the bottom at the land- FIELD-ARTILLERY. 253 ing, the rider pulls himself on the horse's back and takes the reins. The rider may also be required to swim, holding the horse's tail, allowing the horse to tow him. After the man and horse have gained confidence, the rider may be required to be seated on the horse while swimming. As the extra weight presses the horse down and impedes his movements, the rider should hold his knees well up to lessen the resistance, and steady his seat by holding on to the mane or pommel of the saddle. The men are instructed, in crossing running water, to keep their eyes fixed on the opposite bank. The practice of swimming gives horses confidence in deep water when in harness. Streams deep and wide enough to swim one and even two pairs of a team have been crossed by light artillery in our service. BREAKING IN THE YOUNG HOBSE TO HARNESS. The harness should be put on the horse in the stable with caution, and at first without the traces, so that in the event of the horse jumping about they will not hang about his legs and frighten him. The horse should then be fed in his harness, and after standing for some hours be walked about in it. When the horse has thus been fed and walked about, and has become reconciled to the harness, the traces should be attached, and a rope tied to the rear end of each ; a man then takes the ends of the ropes, and the horse is walked about, the man holding the ropes, taking care that the traces do not rub against the sides of the horse in the beginning, but accustom him to them gradually. When the horse has become accustomed to the pressure of the collar and traces, he may then be hitched in with a steady horse. At first the utmost caution should be ob- 254 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLEBT. served and a foreleg held up, if necessary, while the traces are being fastened, and no noise or shouting should be permitted. After being hitched in, the horse should be permitted to stand still for some minutes before the car- riage is started, and it should be put in motion by the other horses. The horse should be left to himself and not be required to draw at first; all that should be demanded of him is to move forward quietly. MANAGEMENT OF VICIOUS HOUSES. A vicious or refractory horse maybe thrown. He is thus made to submit to control without exciting his resentment, or suffering any other physical pain than that resulting from his own resistance. During the operation the man acts with deliberation, speaks with a kind voice, and never uses harsh treatment. TO THROW THE HORSE. The method explained is a modification of the one gen- erally known as "Earey's Method." The horse is equipped with a watering-bridle and surcingle. The surcingle is buckled securely but not tightly around the horse's body just back of the withers. The man is provided with two strong straps. No. 1 is about ten feet long and one inch wide, and has a loop or iron ring at one end. No. 2 is about three feet six inches long and from one and one half to two inches wide ; one end has a strong buckle and two keepers (one on each side of the strap). In the absence of straps as specified, the halter-strap may be sub- stituted for No. 1, and the stirrup-strap for No. 2. The horse is taken to an open space, preferably covered with turf, free from stones, etc., to prevent injuring the horse's knees. Pass the free end of No. 1 through the ring and make a slip-loop; raise the horse's off forefoot, FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 255 and place the loop around the pastern ; see that the loop has no twist in it ; let the foot down, draw the strap taut, and pass the free end over the horse's back from the ofE side and under the surcingle from front to rear, the free end hanging down on the near side. Pass the free end of No. 3 through the inside keeper and make a slip-loop; raise the near forefoot and place the loop around the pastern, with the buckle outside, and make it snug; raise the heel against the forearm, pass the free end of the strap, from the in- side, over the forearm, and buckle the strap sufiBciently tight to hold the leg in this position. Let the bridle-reins either hang down or place them on the neck ; they may be caught hold of at any time after the first plunging is over. It is important that the off forefoot be kept from the ground after the horse first raises it, and this will be better accomplished if both hands are used at strap No. 1 dur- ing the first plunge. The man takes his place behind the surcingle on the near side of and close to the horse, the left foot in ad- vance, and grasps securely with the left hand the free end of No. 1, and, if the strap is long enough, makes a turn with it around the left hand, the right hand grasping it loosely, forefingers close to the surcingle, back of the hand against the horse's back. Quietly and gently urge the horse forward; the instant he raises his foot, pull the strap with the left hand, bring the off heel against the fore- arm, the strap slipping through the right hand, which should be kept in place, but which grasps the strap as soon as the foot is suflSciently raised, and holds it firmly; make a turn with the strap around the right hand, and take both reins in the left hand on the near side of the horse. The horse is now brought to his knees; bring the horse's nose well to the left and raised, placing the right shoulder and arm against the horse's side, thus indicating to him that he i@ to lie on his right side. A horse of a stubborn disposi- 256 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. tion may remain in this kneeling position for some time, and tins he should he allowed to do until he is willing to lie down of his own volition. No force will be used to push the horse down. Prom this kneeling position the horse may rear and plunge, but as he moves so should the man, maintaining his relative position to the horse, and a firm hold of the long strap, in order to deprive the horse of the use of his right foreleg. In most cases, after remaining in this kneeling position for a short time, the horse will lie down. The man maintains his hold of the strap and reins until the horse is quiet and shows no immediate dis- position to attempt to rise; or he has the strap and reins so placed that he can grasp them directly the horse attempts to get up. To dispel his fears and reconcile him to his unexpectedly assumed position, he should now be petted, spoken to in a kindly tone of voice, and generally made much of. When he becomes quiet and ceases to struggle, the man should pass around him, handle his feet, and straighten out and rub his legs. If the horse shows no inclination to rise be- fore being told to do so, the straps may be unfastened and removed, but so long as the eye shows a wild, startled ex- pression the straps should not be removed. The eye is the true index of the horse's feelings and disposition, and if closely observed will always betray his intentions. When he has remained in the lying position for a short time after the straps have been removed, and he no longer struggles or attempts to rise, or if he attempts to rise and cannot be prevented from doing so, the man sliould raise his horse's head a little with the reins and command : " Up! " When the horse gets up, he should be made much of and given to understand that he has done what was required of him. It will be advantageous to throw the horse three or four times at each lesson, but the throwings should not follow each other in rapid succession, in order to avoid the FIELD-ABTILLEBY. 257 overfatigue and constraint which might incite the horse to insubordination and resistance. I It will be found that horses of a peculiarly wilful and stubborn disposition will not lie quiet after the straps have been removed. To ovei-come horses of this class, the long strap should be made fast to the left fore foot so that both knees will be secured in a bent position. The horse need be no longer held, but will be allowed to struggle. He may rear, or plunge, or assume a kneeling position, but whatever he may do no restraint should be put upon him. After finding tliat all his struggles are of no avail, and that the only result attained by them is suffering to himself, he will succumb and quietly lie down. When, from his ceas- ing to struggle when handled, and from the appearance of his eye, there is reason to believe that the horse has yielded, the straps may be gradually loosened and removed. Two or three lessons properly administered in this way will con- quer the most stubborn horse. After a stubborn horse has been thrown several times, it may happen that he will not permit his fore leg to be strapped up, and will resist by rearing, plunging, striking, or kicking. In such cases another strap, " No. 3," may be necessary. This is a strong leather surcingle about three inches wide in which two iron rings, about two feet six inches apart, are securely fastened. The leather girth is secured so that the rings will be about the middle of the horse's sides. Two long straps, " No. 1," are used. One is placed on each front pastern without raising the foot. The free ends of the straps are run through the rings on the surcingle so that they can be used as a pair of driving- reins. These straps are held by one man in rear of the horse, while another, approaching the horse on the near side, attempts to raise his left foot. The instant the horse rears, strikes, or plunges he is brought to his knees by the man holding the long reins; after this is repeated several 258 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. times the horse will allow his foot to be strapped up. Should the horse stand, or refuse to move, the whip may be used. These means may be used to break horses of rearing, plunging, or bucking under the saddle. In this case the surcingle is dispensed with; the rider holds the straps and exerts sufi&cient force when the horse is refractory to bring him to his knees. The same means may be used to discip- line horses which refuse to carry double, the man in the rear holding the straps. TO BEEAK THE HOESE OF KICKING. The horse is thrown and one end of each of the long straps is made fast to the bit-rings; the other ends are passed through the rings on the leather surcingle and secured to the hind pasterns. When thus secured, all means should be resorted to in order to make the horse kick, and this should be repeated until he no longer strug- gles or attempts to move his hind legs under any provoca- tion whatever. TREATMENT AND CARE OF HORSES. Horses require gentle treatment. Docile, but bold, horses are apt to retaliate upon those who abuse them, while per- sistent kindness often reclaims vicious animals. A horse must never be kicked in the belly, or struck about the head with the hands, reins, or any instrument whatever. Never threaten, strike, or otherwise abuse a horse. Before entering a stall speak to the horse gently, and then go in quietly. Never take a rapid gait until the horse has been warmed up by gentle exercise. Never put up a horse brought to the stable or line heated, but throw a blanket over him and rub his legs, or walk FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 259 him until cool. If he is wet, put him under shelter and wisp him against the hair until dry. Never feed grain to a horse, or allow him to stand uncov- ered, when heated. Hay will not hurt a horse no matter how warm he may be. Never water a horse when heated, unless the exercise or march is to he immediately resumed. A few mouthfuls of water, however, will do no harm, and should ordinarily be given him. Never throw water over a horse coming in hot, not even over his legs or feet. Never allow a horse's back to be cooled suddenly by washing or even removing the blanket unnecessarily. To cool the back gradually, the blanket may be removed and replaced with the dry side next the horse. At least two hours' exercise daily is necessary to the health and good condition of horses ; they should be marched a few miles when cold weather, muddy ground, etc., prevent drill. Horses' legs will be often hand-rubbed, particularly after severe exercise, as this removes enlargement and relieves or prevents stiffness. In mild weather the sheath will be washed out once a month with warm water and castile soap and then greased; during the cold season the intervals between washings should be longer. Sore backs and galled shoulders are generally occasioned by neglect. The greatest pains will be taken in the fitting of the saddles and collars; the men must never be allowed to lounge or sit unevenly in their saddles. Every driver should keep a pair of soft leather pads, stuffed with hair, about six inches by four ; the moment any tenderness is noticed in a horse's shoulder, the pressure is removed by })laoing these pads under the collar above and below the tender part. 260 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. DESTRUCTION' OF HOKSES. Occasions arise rendering the destruction of horses nec- essary. The following instructions will enable one to arrive at a point directly over the summit of the brain, and which when fired upon will cause in- stantaneous death. Draw a line, A A, horizontally across the fore- head from the upper margin of one zygomatic ridge to the other, and from its central point, B, measure vertically upward on the forehead 3|^ to 4^ inches. The point, D, thus obtained is directly over the brain-cavity. Before firing, the horse should be induced to lower his head, Fig. 76. which is easily accomplished by placing a little food upon the ground, the muzzle of the weapon being Drought directly over the spot indicated. It is a mistake to suppose that the star, or curl, is over the brain-cavity, for it is generally below the cavity. MELD-ABTILLEBT. 261 CHAPTER VII. Organization of Artillery. Composition of Light Batteries. Equip- meat. Equipment and Clothing for Marches. Marches. Selec- tion of Camps. Maliing Camp. Breaking Camp. Allowance of Wagons. ORGANIZATION OP ARTILLERY. Aetillekt troops are divided into light artillery and heavy artillery. To the light artillery belongs the service of the batteries which manceuvre with troops in the field. The light-artillery batteries include horse-batteries, in which the cannoneers are mounted on liorsebaek; field- batteries, in which the cannoneers march by the side of their pieces, or are mounted on the ammunition-chests, axle-seats, and off horses; and mountain-batteries, in which the pieces may be transported on pack-animals. Machine-batteries are designated, according to their equipment and model of gun, as horse, field, or mountain, Gatling, Gardner, etc., batteries. The 3.3-inch gun is used in both field- and horse-bat- teries; the 3.6-inch gun is used in field-batteries only. A field-battery equipped with the 3.3-inch gun is called a light field-iattery ; one equipped with the 3.6-inch gun is called a heavy field-hatter y. A battalion of artillery con- sists of two, three, or four battei-ies, and is commanded by a field-officer of artillery. The heavy artillery of an army in the field consists of those batteries which serve the siege- and position-guns, and the artillery-ammunition and supply trains. 262 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLBBY. The light artillery of an army corps consists of divisional artillery and corps artillery. The Divisional Artillery consists of a battalion of from two to four batteries, is an integral part of the division, and is commanded by a field-officer who has a staff consist- ing of an adjutant (lieutenant), sergeant-major, quarter- master-sergeant, and chief trumpeter. The Corps Artillery consists of two or more battalions; it is composed of field- and horse-batteries in suitable propor- tions, and is commanded by a colonel who has a staff con- sisting of an adjutant (lieutenant), a quartermaster and commissary (lieutenant) sergeant-major, quartermaster-ser- geant, and chief trumpeter. All the artillery attaclied to an army corps constitutes an artillery brigade. A battalion of horse-artillery is attached to and is part of each divi- sion of cavalry. In smaller commands a battery may be attached to an infantry or cavalry brigade. The proportion of artillery is from three to four guns to one thousand men. The chief of artillery of an army or corps is a brigadier-general, and is on the staff of the commander of the corps. The corps artillery is under the orders of the brigadier-general, chief of artillery, and lie also assumes control of the divisional artillery in action when ordered to do so by the corps commander. The field-officer commanding the divisional artillery is the chief of artillery of the division, and is on the staff of the division commander, but he will encamp with the divi- sional artillery. COMPOSITION OF LIGHT BATTERIES. A battery consists of a fixed number of pieces and caissons of a combined battery-wagon and forge, and an artillery-wagon, together with a sufficient number of offi- cers, men, and horses for the efficient service of the bat- tery. flELB-ARTtLLEli T. 263 Organization of light Batteries. — A battery is main- tained on one of the following footings : 1, for instruction; 3, for war. Instruction. War. 6 Guns, 6 Guns, 4 Caissons. 9 Caissons. Field-battery. fl i i !P i 5 O s n O g n Captain 1 1 Commanding the platoons and caissons. Lieutenants . . . 3 4 Staff-sergeants. 3a 3 3b 3 a. First sergeant, stable and veterinary sergeant. Sergeants Corporals 6 9c 6 3 6 15d 6 9 b. First sergeant, quarter- master and stable and Artificers 4e 5f 5 veterinary sergeants. Trumpeters... 3 3 3 3 c. Six gunners and three caisson corporals. Guidon Wagoner Drivers 1 24 1 48 1 1 48 1 4 96 d. Six gunners and nine caisson corporals. Cannoneers . . . 36 84 e. Two blacksmiths, one Supernumer- saddler, one machinist. ary drivers. . 8 Spare horses . . 4 16 /. Three blacksmiths. Range-finders. 3 3 one saddler, one ma- Total 4 84 66 5 175 144 chinist. The machinist should be conversant with the construction and mechanism of the gun, and competent to make the ordinary repairs it may require. The men should, be intelligent, active, and muscular, and not less than five feet five inches, nor more than six feet, in height; very large men are specially undesirable. 264 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLMBT. The great majority should be men accustomed to horses; a suitable proportion must be mechanics. If a public horse be allowed to each subaltern, the number of horses in the above table will be proportionately increased. The battery-wagon and forge and the artillery- wagon, when not horsed, must be kept with the battery and equipped with the proper tools and stores. When a battery on the instruction footing is ordered to march, it must be supplied with additional horses necessary to horse all the carriages. In horse-batteries, in addition to the number of horses above described, ten saddle-horses (including one spare horse) are required for each gun detachment. EQUIPMBSTT. In garrison the first sergeant, quartermaster-sergeant, stable and veterinary sergeants, and chiefs of section are armed with the sabre, and the caisson corporals, trumpeters, guidon, and drivers also, when specially directed. In the field the first sergeant, quartermaster-sergeant, stable sergeant, and chiefs of section are armed with the sabre and revolver; all other men are armed with the revolver and knife. In preparing for a march or field service the kinds and quantities of supplies required will depend on the duration and character of the work. Having determined what is required, divide the work of preparing for service among the officers and non-commissioned officers immediately in charge, and then carefully superintend the work your- self. Attention is called to the following points : Eations, forage, medicines, veterinary medicines, instru- ments, and bandages, leather and spare parts for repairs to harness, carriages, etc., horseshoes, horseshoe-nails, blacksmith's, saddler's, and carpenter's tools (if there be FIBLD-ARTILLBBY. 265 no battery-wagon and forge), field-desk, with a supply of blanks, paper, envelopes, pens, ink, and pencils, the neces- sary company-books, and a book of telegraph blanks, ammunition (shell, shrapnel, canister, cartridges, fuzes, fuze-cutters, friction-primers, lanyards), oil for harness, cosmoline for guns, equipment and clothing for each man, number and kind of tents, Sibley stoves, axes, hatchets, mauls, scythes, sickles, buckets, spades, shovels, pickaxes, wagon-tongues, coupling-poles, hame-strings, open links, odometer, rope, axle-grease, picket-rope, light jacks, lan- terns, matches, cooking utensils, personal outfit. COOKING UTENSILS. PACK IN BOX A. PACK IN BOX B. 75 150 75 150 Article. Men. Men. Article. Men. Men. Dishpans 2 3 Coffee-boiler.... 1 2 Coffee-mill 1 1 Camp-kettles — 4 6 Bread-knives... . 2 2 Water-buckets.. 2 3 Meat-knives.... . 2 2 Dipper 1 1 Steel . 1 1 Hash machine... 1 1 Cleaver . 1 1 Saw . 1 1 1 axe, 1 spade, 1 shovel, tied to- Forks, carving. . 2 3 gether and fastened to outside Forks, spit .... . 2 2 of box. Spoons, long. . . 2 2 Put the camp-kettles inside the Can-openers . . . . 2 2 coffee- boilers. Ladles . 2 2 Frying-pans . 2 2 Small rations Vinegar-keg, 1, Dutch ovens. 2, or Buzzacott oven, 1, for 75 men; double the number for 150 men. One of the boxes may be large enough to contain the Buzzacott oven. In order to pack it put in the top in- verted, and then invert the body of the oven and set it in- side the top. EQUIPMENT AND CLOTHING FOR MARCHES. OFFICEKS' CLOTHING, EQUIPMENT, ETC. An oflBcer's equipment usually consists of sabre, revolver, and ammunition, and a good binocular-glass. He should 266 A SANDBOOE FOR LIQMT ARTILLERY. also be provided with a compass, watch, knife, and note- book and pencil. A small watch so fitted in a leather strap that it may be worn on the wrist is recommended as very convenient. The clothing and bedding carried will depend on the climate and the character of the march. The following list contains about everything one requires: 1 water-bucket. 1 dipper. 1 quart cup, tin. 1 washbasin, rubber. 1 small looliing-glass. 1 lantern, witli oil or candles for same. 1 small oil-stove, fitted in box. 1 oil-can. 5 gals. oil. 1 tin matchbox. Box of matches. 1 or 3 folding-chairs 1 folding-bed. 1 folding-table. 1 rubber blanket. 1 small strip carpet. 1 pillow. Necessary bedding. 1 pair trousers, extra. 1 blouse, extra. 1 pair shoes. ^ doz. shoestrings. 1 pair overshoes. 1 pair slippers. 1 pair gauntlets, extra. 1 campaign hat. 1 overcoat. 1 rubber coat. 2 pairs drawers, extra. Sticking-plaster, lint, safety-pins, tin of mustard-leaves, and a few simple remedies in case of dysentery, diarrhoea, constipation, etc. 2 undershirts, extra. 2 flannel shirts. 4 pairs socks. 4 towels. i doz. handkerchiefs. 1 sponge, in oil-silk bag. Packages of toilet-paper. 1 portfolio, with pens, ink, paper, envelopes, and stamps. 1 hold-all, containing comb, brush, clothes-brush, scissors, soap (in soapbox), toothbrush and tooth-powder, shaving materials. 1 housewife, with needles, thread and buttons. Pipe, tobacco, and fuzees. 1 piece stout cord. 1 tape-measure. 1 pocket-map. In Cold CliAate. 1 buffalo or felt-lined overcoat. 1 fur cap. 1 pair fur gloves. 4 pairs woolen socks. 1 pair felt boots. 1 pair high arctic overshoes. Extra bedding or sleeping-bag. FIBLD-ABTILLEBY. 267 If messing alone, 1 tin kettle, 1 frying-pan, 2 baking-pans (small), 1 wire gridiron, 1 corlsscrew, salt- and pepper-boxes, 1 can-opener, 1 small meat-knife, 1 iron fork (long), 1 iron spoon (long), 1 small soup-ladle, 3 plates, 3 tin cups, 3 spoons, 3 teaspoons, 3 knives, 3 forks, tablecloths and napkins, and such stores as one may wish. EQUIPMENT AND CLOTHING FOE ENLISTED MEN. Equipment for Each Enlisted Man. — One hnnting-knife, one pistol, one holster, one pistol-cartridge belt (woven), one screwdriver, one canteen, one cup, one meat-ration can (knife, fork, and spoon), and for each cannoneer one haversack. Clothing for Each Enlisted Man. — Two blankets, one rubber blanket or poncho, one overcoat, one campaign hat, one pair of leggings, two blouses, two pairs of trousers, two dcirk blue flannel shirts, two knit undershirts, two pairs of drawers, two pairs of shoes, three pairs of socks, two towels, toilet articles, and stable-clothing for those requiring it. The extra articles will be carried as follows: By Mounted Non-commissioned Officers, Trumpeters, and Guidon.— J)&rk.-\A\xe flannel shirt, undershirt, drawers, socks, and screwdriver, in saddle-bag, ofE pocket. Mess-kit, in saddle-bag, near pocket. Blouse, trousers, and shoes, in knapsack. Overcoat, rolled and strapped on the cantle of saddle. Nose-bag, on ofE side of cantle, the strap passing around and under the overcoat. Canteen and cup (cup on canteen-strap) strapped to near pommel-ring. By Drivers. — Dark-blue flannel shirt, stable-clothes, and shoes, in saddle-bag, off pocket, near horse. Mess-kit, in saddle-bag, near pocket, near horse. Blouse, trousers, and screwdriver, in the saddle-bag, off pocket, off horse. Undershirt, drawers, and socks, in saddle-bag, near pocket, off horse. Overcoat, rolled and strapped on cantle, near horse. Nose-bags, one on each side of off horse, the strap passing around the cantle and under the overcoat. Canteen and cup (cup on canteen-strap) strapped to near pommel- 268 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. ring, near horse. Watering-bridles, currycombs, brushes, and halters, in the nose-bags. By Cannoneers. — Blouse, trousers, and stable-clothes, in knapsack, fl.ap side. Underwear, shoes, and screwdriver, in knapsack, bottom side. Mess-kit, in haversack, worn on left side of person, or carried in wagon. Overcoat, strapped on knapsack. Canteen and cup (cup on canteen- strap) worn on right side of person. The blankets, folded in section bundles, are carried in the wagons. The knapsacks are carried in the wagons. If there be an artillery- wagon with the battery, all the men have knapsacks and haversacks, which are utilized as prescribed for cannoneers. When the Army of the Potomac crossed the river in October, 1863, each oflBcer was responsible for his own out- fit; each man carried five days' short rations in his knap- sack and three in his haversack, one half shelter-tent, his blanket or overcoat, one change of underclothing, and his arms and ammunition. To Roll the Overcoat. — Turn one sleeve wrong side out, fold the overcoat right side out along middle back seam, sleeve laid straight, sleeve wrong side out underneath. Fold cape twice from side to side, lay it on coat, collar to collar. Turn edges of coat in so as to make sides par- allel, and to measure 13 inches wide at shoulder and 16 inches at bottom. EoU from collar down to within SO inches of bottom, turn up bottom and pull one thickness of skirt over the roll, making all snug. MARCHES. The " general," sounded one hour before the time desig- nated for marching, is the signal to strike tents, load wagons, pack animals, and send them to the place of assembly. FIELD-AMTILLEBT. 269 The execution of marching orders must not be delayed. If the commander is not with the troops when they are to march, the next in rank puts the column in motion. When a march is in prospect, it is well to go out daily, for a week or ten days previously, for a couple of hours' march. This will harden the horses' shoulders and discover what corrections are to be made. The average march for field-artillery on good roads is from 15 to 20 miles a day; horse-artillery, 25 miles. A single battery, when the march is a long one, will do well to trot occasionally; so doing shortens the road and greatly relieves man and horse. If the country is undulat- ing, the platoons should march with considerable distance between them, and the trot should be taken up by each in succession on arrival at the level ground where the pre- ceding platoon began to increase its pace. The walk should be resumed in the same manner. When marching with other troops, these liberties cannot be taken, and the walk is, with rare exceptions, the gait used. In rapid marches the slow trot alternates with the walk. When the services of artillery are urgently needed, it may be required to trot four or five miles without breaking the gait. Long marches or expeditions should be begun moder^ ately, particularly with new horses. Ten or twelve miles a day is enough for the first marches, which, on good roads, may be increased to 20 or 25 miles when necessary, after the horses are inured to their work. Should the march be continued for a long period, at least one day in seven should be devoted to rest. It is also important that the horses and equipments be thoroughly inspected at least once a week. On ordinary roads horse-artillery with cavalry marches usually at the rate of 4 or 5 miles an hour. Field-batteries, by themselves, can march 3| to 4 miles an hour on a good road, but on heavy or hilly roads, or when 270 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. the battery forms part of a column, the rate of progress will depend entirely upon circumstances. Should a long march be made, the horses should be fed on the road; ordinarily watering will be sufficient. In very hot weather frequent watering will be advisable. To keep horses in condition, it is essential that they should be in no wise stinted of water. No matter how warm a horse is six to ten swallows of water will not hurt him. Always march with a feed of grain; if not used on the road, it enables the horses to be fed as soon after arriving in camp as desirable. Horses should be arranged in teams, as far as possible, so as to be of uniform pace in fyalking, and of similar disposition. On long marches it may be advisable to change the near and off horses days about. Drivers should be required to ride off horses during part of each day's march; and, unless the entire battery be dismounted by order of the captain, all mounted men and cannoneers will ordinarily be per- mitted to mount and dismount at will when the battery is moving at a walk on level ground. Cannoneers of field-batteries should always walk up and down hill. The care of horses on the march is one of the most im- portant duties of an artillery officer; by constant attention on the part of the captain, chiefs of platoon, and chiefs of section many horses that would otherwise be disabled for months may be kept in serviceable condition. The men must not be allowed to lounge in their saddles, which leads to galls, and the drivers should be made to pay continual attention to their driving, and see that every horse does his fair share of work. The lead-drivers of each team must keep their distance from the team in their front; swing-drivers must keep the traces to their front stretched, and the wheel-drivers those to their front. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 271 Have the wheels greased daily, and oil the bearing of the lunette on the pintle-hook. Grease on the soles of horses' hoofs prevents snow from balling. On starting from camp the first two miles should be made at an easy walk; a halt of from 10 to 15 minutes should then be made ttf allow the men to relieve themselves and to rearrange harness, after which a halt of from 5 to 10 minutes is made at the end of every hour for the pur- pose of adjusting harness, tightening girths, etc. When troops march for the greater part of the day, a halt of about an hour is usually made about noon. At each halt pole-props will be let down; collars unlocked and thrown back on the saddle or withers, and cleaned if necessary; saddles replaced if they have moved ; cinchas tightened if necessary, and horses' feet examined. The march is usually in column of sections; when prac- ticable, it will be in column of platoons at close intervals; but the front of the column must not be frequently dimin- ished or increased, as this unavoidably adds to the fatigue of the horses, particularly of those in rear. The column of platoons should not be used when it fills the road from side to side so as to prevent the passage of carriages, stafE- orderlies, etc. A non-commissioned officer may be sent forward to re- connoitre the road or ground that the battery is to pass over. The distance of two yards between carriages is main- tained, except in bad or diflScult ground, when it may be increased to four or more yards. The strictest attention should be paid by the chiefs of platoon and of section to the preservation of distances, which should not be increased more than is absolutely necessary. The leading guide should maintain a slow and steady walk, and under no circumstances is a carriage to move at a trot without the 272 A EANBBOOK FOB LIGHT ABIILLEBT. orders of the battery commander; when necessary to close up, it should be done at a quick walk ; no practice is more fatiguing to horses and injurious to their shoulders than t'he alternate trotting and walking so often seen at the rear of a column. If the leading carriage is temporarily stopped for any cause, the rear carriages should, if practicable, draw up alongside each other, in order to avoid or diminish as much as possible any check to the column. Chiefs of platoons must never be permitted to leave their platoons to march at the head of the column; when not marching at the rear of their platoons, they will halt fre- quently to see that their carriages are well up and march- ing properly. Chiefs of platoon and of section, without waiting for express instructions, give such orders as may be necessary for helping horses out of difiBculty, for the passage of ob- stacles, etc.; the cannoneers assist at the piece or caisson as may be required. A small bunch of bale-wire, in lengths of from one to two feet, if carried by each chief of section in his saddle- pouch, is very useful for temporary repairs erf harness. If the ruts be very deep, the carriages quarter the road, unless it be very narrow and sunken; in this case the horses will be left to themselves and not hurried ; a skil- ful driver can help his horses greatly, particularly the wheelers. When water-call is sounded, the chiefs of section, under the supervision of the chiefs of platoon or of the first sergeant, have the watering-buckets taken off the carriages, and their horses watered without confusion. When water is very scarce, the nostrils may be sponged, which gives great relief, particularly in hot weather, when it is not pos- sible to let the horses drink. Toward the close of- the march an officer or non-com- FIELD-ARTILLERY. 273 missioned officer may be sent forward to select a camp- ground. The last two miles or more should be made at a walk, and the horses brought into camp without excite- ment. Upon the arrival of the battery in camp damages must be repaired without delay, horses shod, wheels and pintles greased, etc. On the march artificers and cooks should always ride, or be mounted on the chests; if fatigued from marching, they cannot be expected to work efficiently after getting into camp. The march of larger bodies of artillery is conducted on the same principles. A long column cannot move as rapidly as a small one, and at the same time preserve equal order; an allowance is therefore made for every column proportionate to its length. "When the roads are good, or even tolerable, the artillery is always obliged to wait for the infantry, which is attended with much additional fatigue to the horses, from having the harness so much longer on them. Likewise, when the roads are at all bad, artillery can only keep up with cavalry; when the latter are marching at the ordinary rate, by forc- ing their horses too much and wearing them out very rapidly. When, therefore, there is no danger, the artillery should be allowed to march by itgelf so as to regulate its own rate of march. Chiefs of section should carry nippers in their saddle- pouches to cut wire fences if necessary. ACCIDENTS TO CARTIIAGES. When an accident happens to a carriage, it is pulled out of the column, if possible, so as not to interrupt the march ; otherwise the carriages in rear pass it by the most conven- ient flank, and close to proper distance. The disabled carriage resumes its place as soon as the damage is re- 274 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. paired. If the road be narrow, it must fall into the first interval it finds, and regain its proper place as soon as the ground permits. If a field-piece is disabled, the can- noneers left to repair it, who cannot be carried on the limber-chest, mount on the axle-seats and ofE horses when- ever the piece takes the trot to regain its place. If a caisson is disabled, the caisson corporal and the men neces- sary to repair it are left with it. When a piece and its carriage are overturned, it is better to disengage the piece by letting the breech rest on the ground, or on a block of wood, and then raise the muzzle with a handspike while the cap-squares are taken off; the carriage is then righted and the piece mounted. To right the carriage without disengaging the piece, de- tach the limber, secure the cap-squares, and lash the breech to the stock ; place the middle of a rope over the nave of one wheel, pass the ends of it downward between the lower spokes of that wheel, then under the carriage, through the corresponding spokes of the other wheel, and then upward over the wheel and across the top of the carriage to the side where it was first attached. The ends of the rope and the wheel to be raised are then manned and the carriage pulled over, two men being required to steady the trail. If necessary, the ends of the rope may be fastened to the limber, and horses used to assist in righting the carriage. Light carriages may be righted by hand without using a rope. . To Eemove a Gun and Carriage; Carriage Disabled. — Dismount the gun; remove the horses and run the limber over the gun, so that the breech may be towards the pole and the trunnions under the pintle-hook; place a hand- spike in the bore and raise it; sling gun with prolonge; carry prolonge in rear of one trunnion, and in front of the other, round the pintle-hook, and pass the end forward; take a half -hitch round the breech and secure firmly around FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 275 the fork, bearing down on the muzzle until the breech is secured. Keplace cap-squares; remove wheels; turn over carriage and place it on the limber-chest. This is done by having trail, pointing towards the limber, lifted up from the front. Place wheels, dish down, on top of carriage, and lash all firmly together, the trail being lashed to a handspike in the bore of the gun. If the caisson be present, place the carriage on it, re- moving the spare wheel and raising the carriage, trail first, from the rear. To Disable a Field-gun.— Open the breech-block and then break it with a heavy hammer; or load the piece, close the breech without locking it, and fire the piece ; or place two or three blank cartridges in the gun, close and lock the breech-block, ram in from the muzzle a ball of clay or sod-, then unlock the breech-block and fire; or fire a shotted gun with its muzzle against the chase of another. Guns of the Krupp system may be temporarily disabled by carrying off the breech-block, or breaking off its handle. ASCENTS. After pulling up a short, steep hill the horses should be halted to recover their wind. When this cannot be done, they will move very slowly. In going up a difficult hill the carriages may be halted to rest the horses by bringing them across the declivity and locking the limbers or chocking the wheels, or by putting on the brake to the rear; for this purpose it may be ex- pedient to start the sections or platoons from the bottom in succession, leaving a distance of 20 or 30 yards between the different portions of the column. If the draught be so difficult that the teams are liable to stall, the carriages in rear are halted, and the lea4- and swing-horses of the rear half of the carriages can be taken out and hitched to the leading half; when these have been 2Y6 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. taken through, -all the horses, except the wheel, will be taken back, and the rear carriages brought up. As it is very hard to make the horses pull together, not more than five pairs can be hitched with effect to a single carriage. DESCENTS. The drivers never dismount going down hill; the wheel- driver holds his near horse well in hand, and his off horse very short. Two cannoneers may be mounted on each gun-carriage and caisson to apply the brakes. In the ab- sence of instructions from higher authority the chief of carriage directs whether the brakes are to be applied to a particular wheel or to both. The brakes are easily applied and removed, and a Judicious use of them will save the horse much fatigue and prevent sore necks and shoulders. If the descent be very steep, the sectional picket-line may be used by the cannoneers to hold back; in this case the wheel-horses only remain hitched to the carriage, the others being led in rear. MOVING ALONG DECLIVITIES. If a carriage have to move along a declivity so steep that a slight jolt may overturn it, the wheels are locked, the sectional picket-line fastened to the top of the upper wheel and held by two or three cannoneers, who march on the upper side of the slope. DITCHES. If the ditch be wide and deep, the prolonge is fixed and the handspike turned over on the flask and secured, the team is halted on the edge, and the piece run by hand close, to the limber, which then moves slowly until the piece reaches the bottom of the ditch, when it moves quickly until the piece is out. If the ditch be deep FIELD-ARTILLERY. 277 and narrow, it may be necessary to cut down tHe edges and hold back with the sectional picket-line; should the trail sink into the ground in passing over, it is disengaged with a handspike or by fastening a prolonge to it. In passing shallow ditches, drains, or deep furrows the carriages must cross them obliquely. MOVING OVEK MARSHY GROUND. Each carriage moves at a distance of 10 to 12 yards from the one preceding it to avoid having to halt; officers or non-commissioned officers are posted at the worst places to instruct the drivers how to conduct their teams. The horses must pull freely and quicken the gait; if the ground be very miry, it may be necessary to assist with sectional picket-lines, or even to use them alone, the teams crossing separately. CROSSING FORDS AND STREAMS. If the ford be not well known, it must be examined and the dangerous places marked before the carriages attempt to cross. If the water be deep and the current strong, great care is necessary. The men are instructed to keep their eyes fixed on some object on the opposite bank which marks the place of exit; they must not look at the stream, and they move rather against the current, so as to better resist its power. If the ford have a bad bottom and the banks be difficult, the teams are strengthened by adding pairs; an officer or non-commissioned officer is posted at the entrance to regu- late the distance between carriages and to instruct the drivers how to proceed; a second officer or non-commis- sioned officer is posted at the exit to direct the drivers how to leave the ford. The management of the team is the same as in crossing 2T8 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGBT ABTILLERT. marshy ground ; the horses must not be allowed to halt or trot either in passing the ford or leaving it, unless the stream be neither deep nor very rapid; in this case the carriages may be halted to let the horses drink, or at least to give them a mouthful of water. Upon reaching the opposite bank the leading carriages are halted after they have moved far enough forward to leave room for the carriages in rear. If the chests be not water-tight and are at the usual height of two feet and ten inches above the ground, a ford deeper than two feet four inches cannot be crossed without danger of wetting the ammunition. If the chests be water-tight or means have been taken to raise them high enough, a depth of SJ feet may be safely attempted. When the ford is deeper than this, the cannoneers must carry over the cartridges, fuzes, and primers in the pouches, which they hold above the water. The chests are some- times removed and taken over in boats. In crossing streams that cannot be forded, when there are no bridges, the horses are swam, and the carriages and harness crossed on rafts, etc. PASSAGE OF MILITARY BRIDGES. At the entrance of the bridge the lead- and swing-drivers dismount and lead their pairs. A distance of 12 yards is taken between the carriages, and the gait is free and de- cided; the drivers keep the carriages as near the middle of the floor as possible. If the flooring be wet, battens should be nailed across it to keep the horses from falling. If the bridge begins to rock, the passage of the column is suspended. In passing over a flying bridge all the drivers dismount and hold their horses; the lead- and swing-horses should be taken out and led onto the bridge or boat; the brakes MMLD-AM'tLLmr. 279 should be applied to the rear, so that the carriage cannot be run back. PASSAGE ON ICE. Ice 3 or 4 inches thick will bear infantry. Ice 4^ inches thick will bear light guns or cavalry. Ice 6 inches thick will bear heavy field-guns. FACING A BATTERY TO THE BEAR ON A NARROW ROAD. All the carriages are moved close to one side of the road, and the pieces and caissons unlimbered and brought about; the limbers then take their places in front of their car- riages by an about, and the carriages are limbered up; if there be not room for the limbers to execute an about, the horses are taken out. If the road be so narrow that the limbers cannot pass the carriages, the trails of the pieces and the stocks of the caissons are carried around until perpendicular to tlie road, and are then placed against the bank, the wheels being run close to it; on an embankment, or a road with ditches on each side, the carriages are run as close to the edge as pos- sible, the wheels chocked or locked, and the trails and stocks held up while the limbers pass. THE ODOMETER. The odometer registers the number of revolutions of the wheel to which it is attached. The distance measured by the odometer is not exact, owing to the slip of the wheel. To Bead the Odometer. — Lift the reading-circle from its box and note the number on the inner wheel to the left of the zero; this will be the first two figures of the reading, and the number on the outer wheel to the left of the pointer will be the next two. To Measure a Distance with the Odometer. — Tie the case by its straps to a spoke close to the hub of a hind wheel of any vehicle attached to the command. Upon starting read 280 A HANDBOOK FOB LIQST ABTILLEB7. the odometer and record the reading. At the end of the course again record the odometer-reading. The difference between the two readings multiplied by the circumference of the wheel will give the distance passed over. And in general, the difference between any two readings, multiplied by the circumference of the wheel which bears it will give the development of the path traversed by the wheel be- tween the points at which the readings were taken. CAMPS AND CAMPING SELECTION OF CAMPS. Avoid camping or bivouacking in graveyards. Get as far to windward of them as possible. Avoid ground that has been encamped on before, and if obliged to camp near it go to windward of old site. Avoid all rivers with marshy banks, and marshes of every description. If obliged to camp with a small force for a day or two near a marsh, if possible place yourself so as to have a hill or even some rising ground or woods between you and it. In camping near a stream cross it before making camp if possible and select a rise of ground near by. Low ground is unhealthy. All brushwood should be avoided, as also forests lately cut down. A grass country with a sandy or gravelly subsoil is best; land with a clayey subsoil is damp. There should be good natural drainage, and the location should be near fuel, water, and the road. LAYING OUT THE CAMP. Having fixed on the general plan of a camp, lay out the lines the tents are to occupy, and drive pegs to mark the position of the tent-poles or the centre of each tent. For wall-tents the distance between tent-poles of adjacent tents should be at least 20 feet. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 281 CAMPING. On arriving in camp park the battery with sufficient intervals to allow each horse at least a yard and a half on the picket-line, and have the wagons take positions most favorable for unloading. The sections of picket-rope are usually stretched along the spare wheels of the caissons by cannoneers under su- pervision of the gunners. Then the cannoneers, while drivers are unharnessing, etc., are told off into detachments, each under a non-com. officer when necessary, for unloading wagons, pitching tents, obtaining wood and water, and preparing latrines. The drivers as soon as dismounted are directed to un- hitch, and if the animals are sufflciently cool they should be watered and fed. Examine feet, sponge eyes and nostrils, remove harness, and tie to picket-line. As soon as the harness has been removed pass the hand carefully over the horse's shoulders and back, and if there be any indication of a hard lump it should be at once hand-rubbed. Horses should be per- mitted to roll if backs be dry, as it is very restful to them. Leave blanket, secured by surcingle, on horse's back until dry if necessary. After two hours sound stables, at which the battery and platoon commanders should be present, and let the men get to work on their horses; a good rubbing-down is all that is necessary, without the elaborate grooming required in garrison. Collar-galls and girth-galls should be kept wet with salt and water, and saddle-galls have a cloth wetted in the same manner kept on them. Or wash the galled spot and then cover it with a powder formed of 1 part iodoform and 3 parts sulphur. When the animal has to be used, cover it after dressing with a piece of old-fashioned sticking-plaster. Should a riding- or draught-horse get a sore back, he 282 A HANDBOOK FOE LIGHT ARTILLERY. may be used as an off leader or swing-horse. The saddle should be removed and the crupper connected to the collar by a back-strap. Breast-harness may be used on. a horse with a collar-gall. As a rule, horses should not be unharnessed at night in the presence of an active enemy; they should be tied closely together, tails to the wind, and should be shifted day or night to prevent their being head to the wind. To TTnharness in the Field. — If harness-racks be not used, the pole-prop is placed under the end of the pole; the single-trees are left attached to the double-trees; the wheel- traces are unhitched from the collars only, and laid over the chest from front to rear, or on the foot-board; the collars of the wheel-team on top of the limber-chest (paulins having been removed) next to the rail on the near side, the swing-collars in the middle, and the lead-collars next to the off-side rail; the collar of the off horse is placed on top of that of the near horse of the same team; the remainder of the harness is placed on the pole, that of the near wheel- horse next to the double-tree and as close to it as possible, next that of the ofE wheel-horse, and then the swing- and after that the lead-harness, both in the order laid down for the wheel-harness; the traces of the lead- and swing-har- ness (folded once) are laid over the pole; then on top of them the saddles with the attachments over them, so as not to rest on the ground. The neck-yoke is placed on the foot-board. Figs. 77 and 78 represent the ordinary methods of en- campment. These methods are modified to suit the cir- cumstances and nature of the ground. First Method.— The battery is parked with 15 yards interval between carriages. The extra caissons, the bat- tery-wagon and forge, and the artillery-wagon are in a third line behind the caissons. The harness of each team is arranged on the carriage. MELD- AR 7 ILLBR Y. 283 * * * The picket-line is 15 yards in rear of the caissons ; it is either stretched between posts about 6 feet high or between caissons, or laid on the ground and secured by pins. When the ground picket-line is used, the end pins should be at least 1 inch in diameter and 3 feet long, and to lessen the danger of their being pulled up no horse should be tied nearer than 12 feet from them; a sufficient number of smaller pins, about | of an inch in diameter and 2 feet long, are used between the end pins to keep the line straight and prevent it from swaying. The pins should be of iron with steel heads and points. The horses are secured to the ground-line by hobbles, or by hitching-straps if long enough to prevent constraint to the horses. The ground picket-line should not be used unless the earth is sufficiently firm to hold the pins securely. The men's tents are pitched in line, about 30 yards in rear of the picket-line ; the first ser- geant's tent covers the carriages of the right section; the Jeft guard-tent covers the carriages of the left section; the tents of . each section are in the order of their pieces in perk, and are closed to the centre, or to the right, so as to have a vacant space between the guard-tents and the tents of the left section. The men's kitchens are in line, 10 yards in rear of the guard- tents, which may be faced to the right, so that No. 1 overlook the kitchen. PICHETLINE. BO DDDDDD f,rs. iTS CAPTi n m 'V i i i k i Mf/vs am 0/;eiC£ffS SINKl Fig. 77. can 284 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERT The ofiBcers' tents are in line, 30 yards in rear of the bat- tery tents ; the captain's tent on the right, covering that of the first sergeant. The officers' kitchens are 10 yards in rear of their tents. The baggage-wagons are in line 30 yards in rear of the officers' tents. The sinks are 50 yards in rear of the wagons; the officers' sink on the right, the men's sink on the left. When time permits, the rows of tents are ditched, and a shallow ditch 8 inches in depth made around each tent ; and these should lead into other and deeper drains or gut- ters by which the water will be conducted away from the tents. No refuse, slops, or excrement should be allowed to be deposited in the trenches for drainage around tents. On arriving in camp sinks should be dug at once, unless the march is to be resumed on the following morning; the sinks are concealed by tents or brush when practicable, and must be covered daily with fresh earth. A small sink should be dug near the kitchen as a receptacle for all cook- ing refuse; the old kitchen sink should be filled up and the earth well rammed down over it, and a new sink opened every two or three days. Paulins are used to protect the guns, carriages, and har- ness, and also to serve as cover for the men when necessary. The paulin is 12 feet square, is provided with double cords at each corner and at the middle of each side. Bach car- riage has two paulins, which are carried on the limber- chests. For protection of material the paulins are placed over the carriage as follows : Tie a corner of one of the paulins over the muzzle, pull the canvas over the gun- wheels and tie diagonal corner to the flask, tie a corner of the second paulin to the flask, pull the canvas over the wheels of the limber and tie the diagonal corner to the pole in front of the harness. The caisson is covered in a sim- ilar manner by its two paulins. FIELD-ABTILLER T. 285 Second Method. — The baggage- wagons may be in line with the pieces, the interval between the left baggage- wagon and nearest piece being about 50 yards; the guard- tents half-way between the pieces and the baggage- wagons, facing to the rear; the forage-pile between the guard-tents and baggage-wagons; the men's kitchens in line with the third line of caissons, and covering the left baggage-wagon ; the officers' tents on a line perpendicular to the men's tents, facing them, and on the prolongation of one of the baggage- wagons; the officers' kitchen in rear of the officers' tents, and on the prolongation of the right baggage- wagon. If the forge-fire is to be lighted, a special place is assigned ii i i ii i i i i ± £"■"'*" a HCKCT LIHt. ODDimilDSlOIDCID 6i ■ I i„. ^i&- aAmfMffc/itM. emea^sM^ Pig. 78. the battery- wagon and forge, sufficiently removed from the ammunition-chests for safety. In a horse-battery two picket-lines may be used instead of one, the second line being 15 yards in rear of the first. 286 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. ENCAMPMENT OF A BATTALION OF LIGHT AETILLBRY. Oq approaching the site previously selected for the en- campment of the battalion the adjutant assembles the guidons, and conducts them to the camping-ground, and establishes each one at the point where the lead-team on the interior flank of his battery is to rest. After all are es- tablished he returns to the column, and indicates to eacli battery commander how and where his battery shall be parked. The guidons are established with a distance between them of 94 yards (when there are two lines of carriages with 6 horses each, and the picket-line is in rear of the park), the guidon of the second battery in the column of march that day being placed at the head of the line, and so on, the guidon of tlie leading battery being last. The tent of the battalion commander is at a point 60 yards from the line of guidons, and on a perpendicular line passing 17 yards in rear of the second guidon, for an encampment of 2 or 3 batteries; and in a corresponding position in rear of the third guidon for an encampment of 4 batteries. When the captain commands "Front ! " after parking his battery, the guidon moves 75 yards to the rear and 30 yards to the flank, and plants his flag. This point estab- lishes the position of the captain's tent. The battery-officers' tents are on a line, at intervals of 5 yards, facing the interior flank, the captain's tent being nearest the guidon. The officers' mess-tent, of the batteries to the right of the battalion commander, is 10 yards in rear of the tent of the lieutenant on the flank. For batteries to the left of the battalion commander it is 10 yards in rear of the tent of the captain. Officers' kitchens are flve yards in rear of mess-tents. In each battery : FIELD-ABTILLERY. 287 The picket-line is 15 yards in rear of the line of car- riages. The tents for the enlisted men are 30 yards in rear of the picket-line, that of the first sergeant being on the interior and the guard-tent on the exterior flank. The cooks' tent is next to the guard-tent, the other tents being equally distributed along the line. The forage is 15 yards from the exterior flank, on the prolongation of the picket-line. The sinks are 90 yards from the forage, on the prolon- gation of the picket-line. The kitchens are on the line of the tents and 30 yards from the guard-tent. The tents of the battalion commander and staff are arranged, at intervals of 5 yards, on a line facing the interior flank. The mess-tent is on the flank nearest the front of the park, and the tents of the adjutant, quartermaster, and surgeon are on the other flank of the tent of the battalion commander. Non-commissioned stafE-ofiBcers' and orderlies' tents are on a line 15 yards in rear of the staff-tents. The cook-tent is 5 yards to the rear of the outer flank of the mess-tent. The staff-wagons are on a line 15 yards in rear of the non-commissioned staff tents, the forage- and guard-tents being near either flank. Officers' sinks are on a line 60 yards in rear of the staff tents. The position of the kitchens may be varied, depending on the direction of the wind and lay of the ground. If the camp be established for more than a few days, the batteries will be parked in positions corresponding to the ones they occupy at battalion formation. 288 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. BIVOUACS. The men bivouac at a convenient distance in rear of the park, each detachment opposite its section; the guard is on one flank and to the leeward ; the cook-fires are near the guard. If necessary, the picket-line may be stretched through the hind wheels of the carriages of the third line, but whenever practicable the picket-line should be stretched along the ground or between trees or posts. A simple shelter may be formed by driving two forked sticks into the ground, with a pole resting in the forks, and branches laid resting on the pole, thick ends upper- most, at an angle of 45 degrees, and the screen completed with smaller branches; or a shelter of canvas or a blanket may be similarly made. Bach man should strew his sleeping-place with dried leaves, etc., and place over it any articles such as bags, saddle-cloths, etc. A small hollow should be scraped in the ground just where the hip would rest. TENTS. The Hospital Tent, complete, weighs 215 lbs., and con- sists of one tent, 100 lbs.; one fly, 33 lbs.; one set tent- poles, 60 lbs. ; 18 large and 28 small tent-pins, 23 lbs. Its dimensions are: length of ridge, 14 feet; height, 11 feet; width, 14^ feet; height of wall, 4^ feet. Authorized allowance, 1 for battery sick. The Conical Wall-tent, complete, weighs 128 lbs., and consists of one tent, 76 lbs.; one tent-pole and tripod, 32 lbs.; 48 tent-pins, 20 lbs. Its dimensions are: height, 10 feet; diameter, 16^ feet; height of wall, 3 feet. Authorized allowance, 1 to 20 foot or 17 mounted men. The Wall-tent, complete, weighs 97 lbs., and consists of one tent, 43 lbs.; one fly, 15 lbs.; one set of poles, 25 lbs.; 10 large and 18 small tent-pins, 14 lbs. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 289 Its dimensions are: length of ridge, 9 feet; height, 8^ feet; \rtdth, 8 feet 11 inches; height of wall, 3 feet 9 inches. Authorized allowance, 1 to captain, 1 to 2 subalterns. The Common Tent, complete, weighs 51 lbs., and con- sists of one tent, 36 lbs.; one set of poles, 15 lbs.; 24 pins, 10 lbs. Its dimensions are: length of ridge, 6 feet 11 inches; height, 6 feet 10 inches; width, 8 feet 4 inches; height of wall, 2 feet. Authorized allowance, 1 to 6 foot or 4 mounted men. The Shelter-tent (2 halves) weighs a little over 5 lbs., and the 8 pins 1^ lbs.; total, 6.5 lbs. Bach half is 67 inches by 65 inches. Authorized allowance, 1 to each officer, 1 to 2 enlisted men. The Hospital Tent will accommodate comfortably six patients. It is pitched by eight men, after the manner de- scribed for pitching the wall-tent. The Conical Wall-tent is provided with a hood, and will comfortably accommodate ten men, and may be made to hold twice that number. To pitch the tent, four men are required. No. 1 procures tent; No. 4 tripod and pole, which he opens; Nos. 3 and 3 each 24 pins and a maul, which they place near front and rear of tent respectively. Nos. 2, 3, and 4 unroll the tent and spread it out upon the ground near where it is to be pitched, top of tent at its centre. No. 1 drives a pin to mark the door of the tent, and then measures with the tent-pole directly backward, and drives a pin at that end of the pole; No. 4 places the tripod opened out flat, with ring over the last pin driven (the centre pin), and lays the pole on the ground, pin-end at centre pin. All bring the canvas over the tripod until its centre comes to the centre pin and door at the front pin, when No. 2 slips the wall-loop at one end' of the door 290 A MANDBOOE FOB LIGHT ABTILLBBY. over front pin, and fastens the rope of the flap to the same pin. Nos. 1 and 4, commencing at rear and front tf tent respectively, and working to the right and left, scatter the pins and pull out the guy-ropes. Nos. 2 and 3 take each a maul, and, commencing front and rear respectively, work right and left of the tent, driving the guy-pins, placing them about one yard from the edge of the tent, each on a line with a seam. As the pins are driven Nos. 1 and 4 place the ends of the guy-ropes over them, working on their respective sides. When the pins are set. No. 3 crawls under the canvas, slightly raises the tent, and places the pin of the pole through the plate attached to the chains at the top of the tent, and, raising the pole, sets it in the ring of the tripod; No. 3, having from the outside placed the hood over the pole-pin, enters the tent by crawling under, and assists No. 3 in raising the tripod, which being done Nos. 1 and 4 tighten the guys; they then scatter the wall- pins. The tent having been secured, Nos. 3 and 3 now take their posts outside and drive the wall-pins, working as before, No. 3 toward the right rear and No. 3 toward the left front; Nos. 1 and 4 straighten the tent and fasten the hood-guys. A Wall-tent will accommodate four men; preferably three if there be sufficient canvas. The rectangle marked by the pins for guy-ropes has a front of 18 feet and a depth of 14 feet. It is pitched by four men. Nos. 1 and 2 bring ridge and upright" poles, unfasten them, and place ridge-poles as directed by the non-commissioned officer. They then place the upright poles in position on the ground, usually on the side opposite that from which the wind is blowing. Nos. 3 and 4 bring tent, unroll it, and all now open canvas and place it in position for pitching; No. 1 working in rear. No. 2 in front, fix the ridge-pole and tent, tapping with a maul, if necessary, to drive the uprights home. The fly, if used, is now placed in position FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 291 over tent, and the centre loops are secured over front and rear pole-pins, which have been previously driven by Nos. 3 and 4. All draw bottom of tent taut and square, the front and rear at right angles to the ridge, and fasten it with pins through the corner loops; then, stepping outward two paces from the corner pins and one pace to the front (or rear), each securely sets a long pin, over which is passed the extended corner guy-rope. The tent is now raised and the poles set in position. The other pins are then driven and the guy-ropes properly secured. A Common Tent should not be made to hold more than three men. It is similarly pitched. In pitching common or wall tents care must be taken that the door is tied up, and that it is properly squared and pinned to the ground at the door and four corners be- fore being raised. A Shelter-tent merely affords cover for two men. In assigning men to tents bear in mind that the crowd- ing of men in tents for sleeping purposes is highly injuri- ous to health. In pitching the tents disturb the ground inside and around as little as possible. Do not allow absurd notions of order and regularity to cause tents to be pitched in hollows, which are frequently met with in the best sites, when, by moving the tent perhaps a few feet one way or another, a good position for it might be found. In camps of position, when tents are used, it is advisable to supply planking for the men to lie on, these planks to be removed and aired every fine day. If boards cannot be had, use any sort of tarpaulin or waterproof sheet that can be obtained. If straw be plentiful, issue enough to make good thick mats for the men to lie on. They are easily made and most comfortable. They should be hung up to dry every 292 A HANDBOOK FOB, LIGHT ABTILLEBY. day. They should be 3 inches to 4 inches thick, 6 feet long, and about 3^ feet wide. Pukets abaitt i^abave the. Fig. 79. Every morning, except when it rains, have the sides of tents rolled up all around, and in fine weather strike tents frequently; it is good practice for the men; they should regularly pack them up as if for a march. This is also ad- visable as a sanitary measure, so that the ground where the tent usually stands can be well dried by the sun. Blankets and bedding should be frequently aired and exposed to the sun. Do not permit grass or green leaves to be used for beds in tents, but use straw when it can be obtained. Each tent should be thoroughly swept out daily, and at night properly ventilated, the walls being raised if the weather permits. TO STEIKE A TENT. The men take their posts and first remove the wall-pins and then all the guy-pins on their respective sides, except FIELD-ARTlLLERT. 293 the four corner pins of the square tents, or the quadrant- pins of the conical tents. Standing at their respective posts, they remove the cor- ner, or quadrant, guys from the pins and hold the tent until the signal for striking is given, when the tent is lowered to the side indicated. The canvas is then rolled up and tied by Nos. 1 and 4, while Nos. 2 and 3 fasten the poles, or tripod and pole, to- gether, and collect the pins. HEATING TENTS. The Sibley stove, for conical and wall tents, weighing about 19 pounds, is issued by the Q. M. Dept., and is very necessary in cold weather. It is easily put up and requires very little fuel. For ordinary weather an officer can make himself very comfortable by means of a small oil-stove, one or two wicks. Have a box in which it fits exactly made for transporting it, and take along a tin of oil. CAMP COOKIJS^G. A field-kitchen is easily made by digging a long trench for the fire, its width not being sufficient for the kettles, which are placed on it, to drop into it, and covering up between them with stones and clay, that the fire, fed from the windward end, may draw right through. A chimney, formed with the sods cut off the top of the trench, can be built at the other end to increase the draught. Three such trenches meeting under one chimney form a broad-arrow kitchen. The centre trench is traced in the direction from which the wind is blowing, the other two making angles of 40 to 45 degrees with it. The width of the trenches is 9 inches, reduced to 6 inches when they pass under the base of the chimney, and widened at their mouths to produce a draught. The depth is one foot at 294 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. the base of chimney and 14 inches at the other end, or one foot throughout if the ground falls at the mouth of the trench. A field-kitchen is easily made of two logs rolled nearly together in the direction of the wind, and the fire kindled between them. The Buzzacott field-oven is excellent, as is also the or- dinary Dutch oven. They are furnished on requisition by the Quartermaster's Department. To Make Field-ovens. — Take any barrel (the more iron hoops on it the better), the head being out; lay it on its side, having scraped away the ground a little in the centre to make a bed for it ; or if there is a bank near excavate a place for it, taking care that the front end of the barrel is at least 6 inches back from the foot of the bank. Cover it with a coating of about 6 or 8 inches of wet earth or thick mud, except at the open end, which is to be the mouth of the oven. Pile up some sand or earth to the thickness of about 6 inches over the mud, arranging for an opening 3 inches in diameter being left as a flue (to increase the draught) to lead from the upper side of the barrel, at the far end, through the mud and earth. This flue is only left open when the fire for heating is burning; when bread is put in, it should be covered over. Form an even surface of well-kneaded mud at the bottom within the barrel to form a flooring to place the bread on. Light a fire within the barrel and keep it up until the staves are burnt, and the oven is then completed. When required for use, heat it as if it were an ordinary oven; draw out ashes; put in bread, and close the mouth with pieces of board, tin, or iron. The Subsistence Department issues an excellent pam- phlet on army cooking. DKIN-KING-WATEE. The water should be well tested, and persons living near by questioned about it. FtELD-ARTILLERT. 295 Filters.— Two barrels (Fig. 80), one inside the other, having a space of from 4 to 6 inches clear all round between ©, mtered. Water d.d/.VidiUereet Water >-' TeHbrated/^)Umv Fig. 80, them filled with layers of gravel, sand, and charcoal, form an excellent filter. The inside one, without a bottom, rests on three stones placed in layers of sand, charcoal, and coarse gravel. The water flows into the space between the barrels and forces its way through the gravel, charcoal, and sand into the inner barrel. Or they may be placed as in Fig. 81 and connected by a pipe. a. Gravel T}. Coarse sani' cQummL ilteredj Water UhJilieredr^. Water Fig. 81. If the water is from a small spring gushing up out of the earth, perforate the bottom of the outer barrel with a number of holes, and leave the bottom to the inner barrel, which should be pierced with holes round its sides near the top. In both these filters draw ofE the water by a pipe running through the outer into the inner barrel. Allow eight pints per man in hot and six in temperate climates for cooking and drinking, and a similar amount 296 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLBBT. for washing. In stationary camps allow 5 gallons per man for all purposes. LOG HUTS. Good huts to last for years are quickly made of logs placed one over the other, being notched half their re- spective thicknesses at the angles so as to fit one into the other. Moss is driven into the interstices. A roof is put on of split logs, gouged out in the centre, so that each is like a long curved gutter. A layer of these is placed side by side, with the hollow side uppermost, one end resting on the ridge-pole, the other on the walls. A second layer is put over them with the hollow side down. A large split log, well hollowed out, is used as a ridge-piece. Cowdung mixed with water and well plastered over mud walls or floors renders them hard, tough, and less subject to injury from weather. A thin coating of this applied every day to the earthen floors of huts adds much to the appearance of cleanliness. In planning huts give sufficient width for two rows of beds and a passage down the centre. A width of at least 6 feet should be allowed for each row of beds, and the pas- sage may be from 2 to 4 feet wide. BKEAKING CAMP. Ordinarily camp should not be broken before daybreak, as horses rest better from midnight until dawn than at any other hour. Ample time should be left after a seasonable reveille for the men to breakfast, horses feed, and the wagons to be packed. Do not permit packing, pulling tent-pegs, or any noise before reveille. Men should be permitted to rest until the last moment. Immediately after reveille have drivers and such other FIELD-ABTtLLBBT. 29 Y men as may be required feed and groom under supervision of the battery officer. The grooming should consist in merely rubbing off the horses, and seeing that shoulders, backs, and parts under harness are in good condition and perfectly free from dirt. It is a mistake to groom too much in the field. It is dis- tasteful to men, and does not improve the horses. The other men should pack up, remove tent-pegs, and fold tents. Then breakfast. After breakfast let the men complete their packing and attend to personal require- ments. Or tents may be left standing until after break- fast, depending on weather or other conditions. Drivers water and harness ; cannoneers pack wagons and fill in sinks. Part of the cannoneers should be detailed to assist the drivers if required. In packing the wagons it is well to have one or two men in the wagon who understand the work. Articles least required should be packed first. Those required by the cooks should be packed so that they can be easily gotten at immediately on reaching camp. When the camp has been cleared, an officer should ride over it carefully, and see that all tent-pins have been removed and no articles forgotten. Signals far the performance of the various duties should be sounded by the trumpeter at prescribed hours. WAGONS. On field marches two six-mule teams will readily carry the baggage and ten days' rations of a battery (enlisted strength as now authorized, viz., 75). If grain is to be transported, two more six-mule teams will be required. Battalion commander and staff, one four-mule team. Medical department, one ambulance and possibly one four-mule team. A good six-mule team in the best part of the season will 298 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. haul a load of 4000 pounds, marching with troops. It will haul 1400 short rations of provisions— bread, coffee, sugar, salt, and soap — and eight days' rations of forage for the six mules. REMARKS ON PACKING WAGONS. The reserve rations should be placed in first, as they are not required to be taken out unless specially ordered. Then should come the tools and any heavy packages, and on top the men's and officers' baggage. The blankets should be rolled up together by tent-loads or section-bundles. All grease, oil, and dubbing should be slung under the wagons. The packing of the supply-wagons depends upon the nature of the supplies. Care must be taken that bags con- taining grain or biscuits are properly secured, and that, if fresh meat is carried, it is not exposed to the sun on the march. Tents are kept in separate wagons if possible, in order that they may be left behind when ordered without disarranging the other stores. In packing tools care must be taken to prevent their rattling on the march. The following information obtained from orders of Army Commanders during the Civil War may prove useful: General McClellan, August 10, 1862, allowed three wagons to each battery, and they carried nothing but forage for teams, cooking utensils for the men, hospital stores, small rations, and officers' baggage. At least one half of the wagons carried grain. Captains and lieutenants were allowed a shelter-tent each, and to every two enlisted m^n a shelter-tent. Men carried no baggage except blankets and shelter-tents, and officers' baggage was limited to blankets, a small valise or carpet-bag, and a reasonable mess-kit. General Rosecrans, November 20, 1862, allowed each battery as many wagons as there were guns in a battery. FIELD-ARTILLEBY. 299 General Sherman while marching from Atlanta to Savannah allowed each battery one wagon. General Grant, February 23, 1865, for each battery: for personal baggage, mess-chests, cooking utensils, desks, papers, etc., one wagon; two wall-tents for oificers; shelter- tents, one for every two enlisted inen. The allowance of forage was: horses, 6 lbs. hay, 14 lbs. grain; mules, 6 lbs. hay, 12 lbs. grain. On a march the grain ration was 10 lbs. The following extract gives the minimum allowance with which the commands in the Department of the Missouri were equipped and supplied in 1885 for 20 days' field service: Transportation for field- and staff-officers' baggage and supplies, medical supplies, engineer and signal equipments and appliances to be according to strength of command or nature and importance of service. To a battalion of two companies, 1 four-mule ambulance. The allowance of transportation per company is as follows : To one troop of cavalry, with an average field strength of 2 officers, 50 men, 3 teamsters, and 2 packers, 3 six-mule teams, 10 pack- and 2 riding-mules. To one company of infantry with an average field strength of 2 officers, 40 men, 1 teamster, and 2 packers, 1 six-mule team, 8 pack- and 2 riding-animals. Included in above allowance is: 1 pack-mule per com- pany for officers' supplies, and 1 pack-mule per company or per one hundred men for medical supplies. Supplies to be carried in wagons per company are 20 days' field rations per man (55 and 43 with companies). 100 rounds of ammunition per soldier (50 cavalry and 40 infantry). 250 lbs. officers' baggage and supplies. 1 wall and 1 common tent. 10 days' grain (6 lbs. per day per animal). 300 A HAIWBOOS: Jfoa light artillebt. Ufensils for each company mess not to exceed 130 lbs. for cavalry and 100 lbs. for infantry. Horseshoes, nails, tools, and medicine for cavalry-horses not to exceed 150 lbs. To each soldier or civilian employ^, 3 blankets and 1 extra suit of undergarments, compactly rolled in one piece of shelter-tent. Whenever the amount of rations or grain varies from the above, the weight to be carried per wagon may be in- creased or diminished, but should never exceed 4000 lbs., and If possible should be less than 3500 lbs., per wagon. When obtainable on line of march, full forage will be allowed all animals, the cost to be regulated by the contract rates at the nearest military post. To be carried on the person or horse: 1 overcoat, 1 piece of shelter-tent, 50 rounds rifle or carbine and 24 rounds of revolver ammunition. Supplies to be carried on pack-mules for one company will be : 10 days' field rations (three-tenths bacon) per man (55 and 43 with companies); 100 rounds of ammunition per soldier. The utensils for each company must not exceed 75 lbs. for the cavalry and 50 lbs. for the infantry. The weight per load per aparejo must never exceed 350 lbs., and should, if possible, be less than 200 lbs. When marching with pack-train, to be carried on person or horse: 1 blanket, 1 piece shelter-tent, 50 rounds of rifle or carbine ammunition, and 34 rounds of revolver ammuni- tion. On leaving a military post when service is anticipated where it is impossible to use wagons, the loads for pack- trains, as a rule, will consist of only grain suflBlcient to keep the mules in full strength until required to make forced marches. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 301 CHAPTER VIII. Transportation. By Rail. By Sea. Embarkation. Care of Ani- mals. Food for Animals. Diseases of Animals on Shipboard. Disembarkation. TRANSPORTATION OF ARTILLERY. TO EMBARK AND DISEMBARK ARTILLERY AND ARTILLERY STORES — GENERAL RULES. When artillery and its stores are to be shipped for an ex- pedition, prepare first a list of all the articles, stating their number, weight of each, and the total weight of each kind. Furnish the quartermaster with an exact return of the command, showing number of officers, enlisted men, and* animals and weight of baggage; also a copy of the order directing the movement. In estimating the weights allow double for that of bulky articles which occupy much space without weighing much. Divide the total quantity to be transported among the vessels, and make statements in duplicate of the articles on board each vessel, one of which lists should go with the vessel and the other with the officer shipping the stores. The articles must be divided among the vessels accord- ing to the circumstances of the case; but as a general rule everything necessary for the service required at the moment of disembarkation should be placed in each vessel, so that there will be no inconvenience should other vessels be de- layed. If a particular kind of a gun is necessary for any opera- 302 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. tion, do not place all of one kind in one vessel, to avoid being deprived of them by any accident to it. The pieces and caissons are brought to the wharf or shore and unlimbered, and the chests and wheels taken off; each set of implements is strapped together, the washers and linch-pins being put in a box; the harness is tied and labelled in sets; if the voyage is to be short, the harness for each horse may be tied up in its blanket. The battery- wagon and forge is unlimbered, and the limber-chest taken off, as well as the spare parts outside of the wagon. All the chests are distinctly marked, so that it can immediately be seen where they belong. The pieces are first lowered to their places between- decks, the place for dismounting them depending upon the manner of embarking; then the carriages, limbers,- im- plements, and wheels; the harness is placed (regard being had to its preservation) where it may be of easy access. The box of washers and linch-pins is under the special charge of a non-commissioned oflQcer. . The battery-wagon and forge, with its limber and limber- chest, is stowed separate from the battery, but where it will be accessible. Sponges, rammers, and intrenching-tools should be united in bundles or boxes. The contents of each box, barrel, or bundle should be distinctly marked upon it. The boxes should be made small so that they can bo easily handled. The position of the different articles in each vessel is noted in a column in the list on board. Place the heaviest articles below, beginning with the guns, then the carriages, limbers, ammunition-boxes, etc. Boxes of ammunition should be in the driest and least ex- posed part of the vessel. Articles required to be disembarked first should be put in last, or so placed that they can be easily got at. FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 303 If the disembarkation is to be performed in front of the enemy, some of the pieces should be so placed that they can be disembarked immediately with their carriages, im- plements, and ammunition; also the tools and materials for throwing up temporary intrenchments on landing. When there are several vessels laden with artillery and stores for the expedition, each vessel should have on each quarter and on a single masthead a number that can be easily distinguished at a distance. The same numbei- should be entered on the list of supplies shipped in each vessel. The commander can then know exactly what re- sources he has with him. Some vessels, distinguished by particular signal, should be laden solely with such powder and ammunition as may not be required for immediate ser- vice of the pieces. If it is necessary to reship or leave any articles on board the vessels, care should be taken to note them on the list. Boats of proper capacity must be provided for the dis- embarkation, according to the circumstances in each case. It may be necessary to establish temporary wharves on trestles, or to erect shears, cranes, or derricks. EAILKOAD TRANSPORTATION". The most suitable car for carrying horses, especially in warm weather, is the " slat stock-car," built of slats and open all around, but tight in roof. Another kind, known as the " combination car," is made with five doors on each side and one at each end, which may be closed tight for stores, or with iron grates when carrying horses. These are suitable for either warm or cold weather. Both kinds are usually from 38 to 30 feet long, 7 feet 9 inches wide, and 6 feet 8 inches high, inside measurement. Each car will carry 16 artillery or 18 common horses or mules. Be careful to have floors sanded to keep horses from slipping down, 304 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. Loading cars with horses at night should be avoided. The battery should be drawn up in the most convenient position for loading; and during the operation of loading quiet and order must be maintained. Dismount; let the men fall out of ranks if necessary and then reform, and have personal equipment, etc., placed on the ground; unhitch; unharness and tell ofE the horses to the cars, cannoneers assisting drivers. Station a non-commissioned officer and one private at the door; the former to superintend the work and the latter to count in a loud tone the horses as they enter. Two more privates should be present to assist in putting horses in position, etc. After horses are loaded all assist in loading the material. The battery is then reformed, retake equipments, etc., and the men are told ofE to cars. The horses should be driven or led in, following one an- other as closely as possible, but should not be tied. They should be alternately led to either end so as to fill up the middle of the car last, and should stand alternately head and tail. If the journey is to be continued beyond 18 or 20 hours, the horses will require to be watered and fed. Nose-bags are generally used for the grain. If the drivers are attentive, they, by taking advantage of the short halts made by the train, can feed grain and hay quite easily by hand. Half-rations will be sufficient under any circum- stances. Before placing the horses on the cars they should be thoroughly groomed and cooled; they should have nothing more on them than their halter head-stalls. They should be fed before being loaded, as it tends to keep them quiet. If the journey is to continue for more than 36 hours, the horses should be unloaded every 24 hours, and should be watered, fed, groomed, and exercised before being loaded on the cars again. If there are stockyards near by, the horses should be turned loose in them for exercise. On FIELD-ABTILLEBY. 305 long journeys, run all night and until about 10 a.m., then unload at a convenient place, and water, feed, and groom ; give the horses gentle exercise, and water and feed again so that the horses can be reloaded about 4 or 5 p.m. to re- sume the journey. Horses are best loaded and unloaded from a stock-chute, but where this convenience is not available and there is no platform a ramp or chute may be improvised, using for it planks about 13 feet long and from 3 to 3 inches thick, depending on the strength of the wood. A ramp should be about 4 feet wide, with the planks firmly fastened together with transverse battens. These battens furthermore prevent the horses from slipping. A strong trestle or crib of logs supports the end of the ramp next the car, while the other rests on the ground and is secured from slipping by strong stakes. An intermediate trestle or a support of logs should be placed to prevent the planks from springing with the weight of the horses. Three or four posts of suitable height are set in the ground on each side, to which side-rails are lashed or spiked for the purpose of keeping the horses from stepping ofE. A board should be placed on each side to prevent the horses' feet from slipping over the edges of the plank. When planks are not procurable, a ramp of earth, supported by means of logs or stones on the end next the track, may be constructed. The cars are brought up in succession to the ramp to be loaded or unloaded. In the fifild, where no chute or ramp is to be found at the place of unloading, material ready prepared for construct- ing one should be carried with the train. After loading the horses enclose the harness in sacks, each marked with the designation of the horse, team, and carriage to which it belongs. Artillery-carriages are carried on platform or flat cars. These cars are generally from 38 to 33 feet long by 8 feet 306 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. wide. When properly loaded, cars of 30 feet will carry two tield-guns and two caissons complete. To load them, the carriages are unlimbered and the spare wheels removed from the caisson; the body of a caisson, its stock to the rear, is run to the front end of the car and its stock rested on the floor; another rear train is run forward in like manner until its wheels strike or overlap those of the first, when its stock is rested on the floor. A limber is then placed on the car with its pole to the front, resting on the rear train; the second limber is backed on and its pole held up until a gun, trail foremost, is run under it; the trail of the gun is rested on the floor and the pole of the limber on the gun-carriage. The other gun is run on in the same manner, and its trail rested on the floor under the first gun; a limber is next run on and its pole rested on the last gun; the remaining limber is run on with its pole under the preceding limber. All of the carriages are pushed together as closely as possible and firmly lashed to each other and to the sides of the car; the wheels are chocked by pieces of wood nailed to the floor. When the carriages are liable to chafe each other, they are bound with gunny-sacking or other stuff. A side-platform, such as is found in depots, is the best for loading. The carriages are flrst run on to a spare car; from this they are crossed over on planks to the one upon which they are to be carried, and arranged on it as already described. When there is no side-platform, the carriages are run up at the end of the car by means of way-planks. Twenty-four thousand pounds is considered a safe load for one car on a good track. Baggage, harness, forage, etc., are usually carried in box-cars. These cars have the same dimensions as heretofore given for those carrying horses. The passenger-car of average size will seat 60 men, but a small car will seat only 50. Allowance must be made for men's equipments, and if the journey is of any distance FIELD-ARTILLERY. 307 each maa should have a full seat. Then by arranging the seats the men can extend themselves for resting or sleeping. The men must be provided with cooked rations for the whole trip. Each car must be liberally supplied with drinking-water, lights at night, and all other conveniences, to make it unnecessary for the men to leave them during stoppages of the train. The "tourist sleeper" carries 48 men. It is provided with bunks (and some cars with cook- ing-stoves) and should be used for long journeys when obtainable. Guards should be detailed and so stationed on the train to preserve order both when in motion and during stop- pages. The arrangement of the • ordinary artillery -train will be: 1. Cars with material necessary for disembarking. 2. Horse-cars. 3. Baggage-cars, loaded with forage, harness, etc. 4. Oars for material. 5. Oars for officers and men. The size of the train will vary, depending on grade, curv- ature, and speed. TEANSPORTATIOK OF AETILLEET-HORSES BY SEA. Transports for horses should be especially prepared for the purpose; as a rule, the larger the vessel the better is she adapted for the conveyance of horses. Ventilation is of primary importance, the safety and condition of the horses mainly depending upon their having plenty of fresh air; large air-ports or scuttles are indispensable, and wind- sails down every hatch to each deck should be insisted upon. If time permits, fixed air-shafts should be pro- vided for each deck. The ventilation of steamers may be assisted by using the donkey-engines for this purpose. The stalls are preferably between-decks, never, if it can be avoided, in the hold; should horses be put on the spar- 308 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLERT. deck, nothing will be stowed on the stall-sheds. Stalls should be about 6J feet long, 28 inches wide; tail-boards fastened to the rear posts, and padded as low as the hock; breast-boards and side-boards fitted in grooves about 4 feet from the floor, the first padded on the inner side and upper edge, the latter on both sides; the floors of the stalls set on blocks that the water may pass under them ; four slats across each floor to give the horses foothold. Troughs should be made to hang with hooks, so as to be easily removed. Before embarkation the side-boards are removed, and replaced as each horse is placed in his stall. Horses, in all cases, should stand athwart-ship; in this position they better accommodate themselves to the motion of the vessel. When on the upper deck, they should face inward ; this for the reason that the spray will not strike them in their faces, and, besides, when facing each other in this manner they will sufEer less from fright and ner- vous excitement. All stalls, hitching-hars, or whatever other arrangement for securing horses, must be strong beyond any possibility of giving way. The living force exerted by a row of horses, as they swing with the motion of a ship in a heavy sea, is very great, and it is better to have no securing arrangements whatever than to have those that, by giving way, will wound and injure the animals in the wreck. If the transport is to be used in very inclement weather, the spar-deck, over the horses, should be covered. Canvas stretched over a secure frame is better than boards, as the latter in a severe storm might be carried away, and its wreck would cause disaster among the horses. During heavy weather horses sometimes become ex- hausted and fall. The best thing that can be done in such cases is to back out the horse on each side, so as to give the fallen horse plenty of room. The fallen horse should be FIELD-ARTILLERY. 309 protected from rain and spray by a paulin, and great care and tenderness exercised toward him; otlierwise he is very liable to perish. The horses may be fed from nose-bags, but it is better to have for each one a small trough, sus- pended to the hitching-bar by means of two iron hooks passing over the bar. The troughs are moved out of the way when not in use. Hay can be fed by tying it up tightly in bundles with rope-yarn and fastening the bundles to the hitching-bar. It may also be fed in small quantities by hand, and the more attention the horses receive in this way from the men the less fretful and uneasy they become. When the embarkation takes place from a wharf, and the vessel is not too high, it is best to use gang-planks and lead the horses on board. The gang-plank leading up from the wharf to the gunwale should be about 20 feet long by 10 wide, and be made very strong. This width admits of its being used for gun-carriages. It should be provided with ropes at the corners, rollers, side-rails, and boards upon the sides to prevent the horses from getting their feet over the edges. Another similar gang-plank, but not so long, leads from the gunwale to the deck, the two being securely fastened together by their ropes. These gang-planks should be carried by the vessel, ready for disembarking. Every provision for this latter operation should be thoroughly looked after before starting on the voyage. When it is not practicable to use gang-planks, the horses are hoisted on board by means of a sling and lifting- tackle. Horses should be kept without food and without water for several hours before being put on board, as they are liable to be injured if slung with full bellies; they will also become sooner reconciled to their new quarters, and take quicker to their feed on board, when these measures have been adopted. 310 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. Sling.— This is made of stout web, or double N"o. 1 canvas. It is 5 feet long and 3 feet wide, secured at each end by a stick of strong wood 3 inches in diameter. The sides are bound with strips of canvas doubled, thus making the edges four thicknesses. Loops of 4-inch rope are attached to each stick. The loop attached to one stick is 9 inches long; that attached to the other is 3 feet 11 inches, and has an iron eye, 3 inches inside measurement, fixed in the end. Breast- and breech-ropes (3-inch), 9 feet long, are fixed to each side, and are tied together when the sling has been put under the horse. The slings should be tested by an excess of weight. A donkey-engine is used for hoisting. Five men are required to sling a horse quickly and well. One man holds the head-guy, which is attached to a neck- collar; two men, one on each side of the horse, pass the sling under his belly ; both then hold up the ends over his back, passing the long loop through the shorter one and hooking on the eye of the former to the lifting-tackle, con- tinuing to hold up the sling until the horse's legs leave the ground; another man stands at the breast and fastens the breast-rope, while the fifth stands at his rump and fastens the breech-rope. The officer superintending commands: "Hoist away! " The first man slacks away at the guy-rope, holding it just sufficiently taut to keep the horse's head steady. When hoisting, no delay should be permitted; it should be done in the shortest time compatible with safety. At the commencement, after a certainty that all is right, it should be done rapidly, to raise the horse and free him from surrounding objects before he has time to do any injury by kicking. After attaining the necessary height, he is carefully and steadily lowered to the deck. Care should be taken to have two or three careful, active men stationed to seize the horse and prevent his plunging until the slings are removed. While one holds him by the fflBLb-ARTlLLMltt. Sll head-gtall another rapidly unhooks the tackle-purchase, and two others let loose the breech- and breast-bands or ropes. When the horses are to be lowered through a hatch to a deck below, the combings of the hatch as well as stanchions about it should be well padded. As an additional precau- tion, a head-collar should be provided, with a large pad on top, to prevent injury should the horse strike his head against the deck-beams when lighting on his feet. To ascertain the number of horse-stalls that can be con- structed on any deck, first mark off a space of three feet all around the ship's side for a passage to be kept clear behind the stalls, and a similar .width alongside all hatchways or other obstructions; then divide the running length of the space left by 38 inches; this will give the number of stalls in each row. When the clear width of beam between the inner sides of any deck is 36 feet or more, three rows of stalls may be constructed, the passage between the rows where the horses are to stand h«ad to head being not less than 6 feet, and between those that stand tail to tail not less than 54 inches. Horses should not be placed near boilers, etc., as the heat is liable to make them sick. There must be ten per cent of spare stalls, and there must also be at least one loose box, constructed near a hatchway, to admit of a sick horse lying down. Bach stall is numbered, the side-boards, breast-boards, mangers, etc., being marked with the number of the stall to which they belong. For some hours before sailing hay should not be given at all; otherwise, if the horses are seasick, it will remain un- digested in the stomach, and possibly cause colic or blind staggers. CARE OF HORSES AT SEA. For the first few days on shipboard food is to be given rather sparingly, and bran is to form a large portion of it; 312 A SANDBOOK FOB LIQECT ARTtLLERT. but after the horse becomes accustomed to his new situa- tion, and his appetite increases, he should be more liberally fed. A bran mash, or oats and bran mixed, is to be given to him every other day. The spare stalls admit of the horses being shifted, rubbed down, their feet washed, and the stalls cleaned out every day that the weather permits. Hand-rubbing the legs is of the greatest consequence to the comfort and well-being of the horse, and is to be practised, if possible, every day or whenever the horses change stalls. Horses are to be slung in smooth weather, and allowed to stand on their legs in rough and stormy weather. In smooth weather they will rest their legs and feet by throwing their whole weight into the slings. To sling a horse in rough weather, whereby he is taken off his feet, would only have the effect of knocking him about with the roll of the ship. Horses standing accommodate themselves to the motion of the vessel. They are not to be placed in the horse-hammock until they have been at sea for a week, as some would only be made uneasy by the attempt to do so. The hammock is to be placed around the centre of the horse's belly, and then the breast-band and breeching fas- tened to the required length and degree of tightness. When everything is in readiness, and not before, the horse is quickly raised until all, or nearly all, of his weight is off his legs. He will very soon learn the relief the ham- mock affords him, and will not be slow in availing himself of it by throwing his weight into it. With some horses it is necessary to use great quickness in making the ropes fast before they throw their whole weight into the hammock. When the horses are between-decks, too much attention cannot be paid to the constant trimming of the wind-sails so as to insure plenty of fresh air. The wind-sails should be well forward, and extended down within two or three feet of mELD-ABTILLEBT. 313 the deck. When a horse between-decks becomes ill, and the weather is at all fine, he should be removed to the upper deck, where the fresh air and change will probably soon bring him right again. Besides the ordinary grooming utensils for stable service, there should be a plentiful supply of stable-brooms, hoes, and shovels for cleaning out the stalls, and baskets or other light vessels for removing the manure. The ship must be well lighted, and the guards attentive; seasick men must not be intrusted with this important duty. Disinfectants, such as chloride of lime and zinc, carbolic acid, copperas, powdered gypsum, etc., should be freely used, and, upon embarking, the artillery commander will see that they are supplied. Should any contagious disease appear, the horse or horses attacked will be promptly thrown overboard, and the pre- cautions taken as prescribed under the head of Sick Horses. The feed-troughs and the nostrils of the .horses are washed every morning and evening with diluted vinegar. Water is allowed at the rate of six gallons a day per horse, and one gallon per man. During the voyage the artillery commander will make it his especial duty to act in harmony with the master of the vessel. There must, of necessity, be divided authority and responsibility. Order and neatness among the men and cleanliness with the horses are to be looked after by the commander of the troops. In attending to these duties care will be observed not to interfere needlessly with the duties of the crew nor with the belongings of the ship. Officers are always to be furnished with cabin accommo- dations, and the men with proper messing arrangements. This should be specified in the charter, and should be clearly understood by all parties previous to setting out on the voyage. The fitting up of the vessel is generally done by the 314 A MANDBOOK FOR LIGHT AliTlLLSMY. Quartermaster's Department, but the commander of the artillery to be embarked will, as the one most concerned, give his special attention to see that the work is thorough and complete. DISEMBARKING. When this can be done at a wharf, the operation is sim- ply the reverse of embarking. When wharf accommodations are not available, arrange- ments will have to be made for transferring the men, horses, and material from the vessel to the shore. Bridges may be made of pontoons, or of trestles and pontoons com- bined, and the horses and material carried ashore on these; canal-barges may be used and towed close to shore by light- draught steamers, from which horses and material can be landed by a gang-plank ; by lashing two of the canal-barges together, placing the boats some 13 feet apart, and throw- ing a false or additional deck over the whole, a platform is formed, about 40 feet long, capable of holding all the pieces and caissons of a six-gun battery, or from 40 to 50 horses. A raft of this kind should have a strong railing around it. In disembarking horses the same precautions are neces- sary as when embarking them. For some days after a long voyage they should be led about at a walk, and no weight put on their backs unless it is absolutely necessary. The disembarkation of horses by swimming is more easily effected than their embarkation by the same method, as their instinct assists in bringing them ashore. The horse should be lowered in the sling over the side of the vessel, without fastening the breast-strap or breeching. When the tackle is unhooked, the sling opens and is at once slipped from under. In sipooth water a horse can easily swim half a mile. When the deck of a vessel is low, say not over 10 feet, FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 315 and there is a gangway, the horses may be backed off into the water without slinging. This method should never be resorted to if it can possibly be avoided; it is liable to strain and injure the animal, and it is said to injure his pluck and make him shy about entering water. 316 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. CHAPTER IX. Machine-guns. The Hotchldss Revolving Cannon. The Qatling Gun. The Gardner Gun. The Maxim Gun. The Metallic Carriage for Machine-guns. HOTCHKISS REVOLVING CANNON. Fig. 82. Theeb are two sizes for field-artillery, viz. : light and heavy, both having the same caliber. DESCKIPTION. Light. Calibre inches 1.45 Length of gun <• 454 Height of trunnions above tread. . " 35 Length of gun-barrel " 39.1 Number of barrels 5 Weight of each barrel pounds 30.8 Length of rifled bore inches 24.7 Number of lands 12 Pitch of rifling degrees 6 Weight of gun complete pounds 495 Heavy. 1.46 70.4 43.4 50.1 5 79 43.4 13 6 1045 FIELD-ARTILLER Y. 317 The gua consists of five main parts: the group of barrels, the breech-piece, the mechanism, the frame, and the attachments. THE GROUP OF BARRELS. The five barrels are assembled around a main shaft by being secured in two bronze assembling-disks. Both disks are bolted to the main shaft, so that barrels, disks, and shaft revolve together. The main shaft goes into the Hotchkiss R. C Rotating Device. Fig. 83. i=& breech-piece, and has screwed and bolted to its end a heavy steel pin-wheel, which connects the barrel-system with the mechanism. THE BREECH-PIECE. This is a cast-iron block, the front half solid and pierced with the channels necessary for feeding, loading, firing, and extracting ammunition, and the rear half hollow to form a chamber for the mechanism, with guideways and journals for its movement and support. In the upper front face a cha,nnelway is cut from the loading-hole around 318 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. almost to the firing-point, the bottom being inclined so that as the cartridge moves along it during the revolution of the barrels it is pushed forward and close home. The forward face is reinforced at the firing-point by a steel face-plate countersunk in it, through which the firing- pin hole is pierced. The seat for the pin-wheel is in the rear face of the solid part. This pin-wheel can only be mounted on the main shaft after the end of the latter has been inserted in its journal; and in order to put the locking- pin of the pin-wheel in place it is necessary to have a hole pierced radially from the outside of the breech-piece. This hole is kept constantly closed by a tap-screw. The rear end of the breech-piece is closed by a bronze door, hinged at the bottom, and secured by a screw-bolt at the top. On the outer sides of the breech-piece shoulders are cast to form seats for the shafts of the frame. As the worm-shaft does not extend completely across the chamber of the breech-piece, a small journal-seat is cast just to the left of the centre of the chamber. In the right lower corner of the chamber is a guideway for the firing- bolt; on the left side is a slotway for the extractor; a small journal is pierced through the side for a cog-wheel, which is held in place by a keep-pin. In the left upper comer is a guideway for the loading-piston. THE MECHANISM. The work of the mechanism consists in revolving the barrels, loading, firing, and extracting. The revolution of the barrels is a simple gear movement. The loading and extracting are reciprocal movements; that is, while a cartridge is being pushed into one barrel an empty cartridge-case is being drawn from another. The firing is accomplished by the firing-bolt, which is drawn backward by its cocking-arm pressing on the cam of the worm-wheel, and then thrown violently forward by the FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 319 mainspring, when the arm drops from the end of the cam. The piece has the ordinary trigger arrangement. In order to keep the cartridges from crowding down upon the loading-piston a small feed-gate is hung loosely in the feeding-hole. In the forward movement of the piston a small nib at its forward end catches behind the gate and lifts it up, thus cutting ofE the feed. THE FKAME AKD ATTACHMENTS, The group of barrels and the breech-piece are bound to- gether by the frame, and the whole system is supported by the trunnions in a forked pivot. The frame is a light bronze casting, consisting of two hollow side-bars connected by two hollow cross-bars. The forward one is journalled for the forward end of the main shaft, and the rear one is in line with the trunnions. A half-ring spans the shaft over the forward assembling-disk to form a seat for the front sight. The rear ends of the shafts are bolted in seats in the side of the breech-piece. The trunnions form part of the casting of the frame. The right forward cap-square bolt has a lever for clamping the piece at any desired elevation. The pivot rests in a socket, in the side of which is a clamp for fixing the gun in any desired direction. The feed-trough holds about eight cartridges. The Rear Sight consists of a bar having its right edge arranged with alternate notches and points for sach 100 yards or other unit. These notches and points are so arranged as to allow for the natural drift of the projectile. The bar is hinged at the bottom to lie flat on the breech- piece when not in use. The Front Sight is of the ordinary steel-point pattern, THE ACTION OE THE MECHANISM. Suppose the crank to be in continual motion. A cartridge is placed in the introduction-trough, the pis- 320 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. ton pushes it into the barrel, the barrels begin to revolve, and the cartridge is carried on until it arrives before the firing-pin, held in the solid part of the breech, and which has, in the- meantime, been retracted by the action of the cam. As soon as the cartridge has arrived in position the barrels cease to revolve and the primer of the cartridge is struck by the firing-pin and discharged; the revolution of the barrels begins again, and the fired cartridge-shell is carried on until it comes to the extractor, which in the meantime has arrived up to the barrels, and the cartridge- head rolls into it. As soon as the head is laid hold of by the extractor the barrels again cease to revolve, and during this period the cartridge-shell is withdrawn and dropped to the ground. During every stoppage of the barrels the gun is supplied with a new cartridge, the firing and extraction are also performed, and a continuous but slow fire is kept up. Supplying the gun in this manner with single car- tridges, about thirty rounds per minute may be fired. DISMOUNTIIfG AND MOUNTIITG THE MECHAITISM. To Dismount. — 1. Open the breech-door by unscrewing the door-bolt. As the mainspring presses against the door, one hand should be pressed against the door to keep it from flying open. 3. Withdraw the firing-bolt by pulling straight out. 3. Detach the mainspring by first turning it completely over and then withdrawing its keep-pin. 4. Take out the thumb-screw which secures the extract- or-crank to the worm-axle. 5. Withdraw the worm-axle by pulling straight out on the crank ; and as the extractor-crank and worm-wheel slip ofE, remove them. 6. Pull out the extractor. 7. Pull out the loading-piston, FIELD-ARTILLERT. 321 8. Unscrew the keep-pin of the cog-wheel and take the latter out. This completes the dismounting of the mechanism. To Mount. — Proceed in the inverse order, bearing in mind that in inserting the loading-piston it must be pushed in to its extreme forward limit, as marked by arrows on its forward end and on the rim of the feeding-hole, before the extractor is inserted. Also, in inserting the worm-axle the most convenient position is with the feather up, so that the extractor-crankwill mount when it is turned arm down and to the rear. This is not necessary, but is convenient in assembling. To Dismount Completely.— 1. Turn the barrels until the arrow on the rear assembling-disk marked "Dismount" is opposite the arrow on the right upper quarter of breech- piece. 3, Enter a punch in the hole in the breech-piece and back out the keep-bolt of the pin-wheel. 3. Unscrew and take out the pin-wheel. 4. Unscrew the four bolts which secure the frame to the breech-piece. 5. Slip the breech-piece off to the rear. 6. Eemove the group of barrels from the frame. Mounting is done in the inverse order. Start the pin- wheel on before pushing the breech-piece entirely into place. In driving in the keep-pin of the pin-wheel be careful that it is close home so as not to grind in the jour- nal. Also, before dropping the keep-pin in turn the bar- rels until the arrow marked " Mount " is opposite the one on the breech-piece. CARE AND CLBAKTlfG EEQUIEED. Apply the rules given for mountain-artillery, page 4. In scrubbing out the barrels it is always best to turn the S22 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. one to be scrubbed to the extractor-hole, as this position gives the most room for thorough work and the water does not slop into the breech-piece. Elevate the gun slightly and put the water-bucket under the extractor-hole. When cleaned and mounted, pour a little oil in the oil- holes and revolve the mechanism a few times to spread it on the bearings. AMMUHTTIOir. The ammunition is similar to that used in breech-loading small arms, and consists of the projectile, to the base of which is crimped a metallic cartridge-case containing the powder-charge, and being provided with a percussion-cap for centre-fire. The charge of powder is loaded into the brass case and shaken down, and on the top of it is placed a felt lubricating-wad, which leaves sufficient end to the case to allow it to be crimped to the base of the projectile. The projectiles consist of cast-iron shell, steel shell, and canister. The nose of the first is truncated to give a seat for the nose fuze; that of the second comes to a sharp point, and its fuze is in the base. The canister consists of a thin drawn brass case, almost hemispherical at the head, filled with hardened lead balls packed in sawdust. Weight of shell, empty Oz. " " " loaded " Bursting-charge. " Number of fragments Weight of canister Lbs. Number of bullets ' Weight of cariiidge-case, empty Oz. " " powder-charge " Total weight of cartridge complete, shell Lbs. " " " " case " Light. Heavy. 14.4 16 16 19 0.7 0.8 15 15 1.35 1.85 38 28 3 3.4 3.8 3.8 1.4 1.7 1.6 1.75 FIELD-ABTILLEB T. THE CARRIAGE. 323 Diameter of wheel Inches. "Weight " " Lbs. Width of tread Inches. Weight of carriage without shield Lbs. " shield Weight of gun, carriage and limber fully equipped Light. Heavy. 45.2 55.1 99 187 47.3 60.3 550 990 330 383 2113 3487 The trail is formed of two brackets connected by bolts and two transoms, and having a gun-metal rest for carry- ing the trunnion-saddle, the rear ends being connected -by the trail eye-piece, made of cast steel. The brackets di- verge at the trunnions, the axle is of steel, and the wheels have metallic naves and tires. The gun-traversing arrangement, giving 4° deflection to the right or left, consists of a cast-steel saddle with trunnion-bearings, and works in the gun-metal rest riveted ' to the brackets. The elevating and traversing arrangem,ent consists of a steel ball-and-socket elevating-screw working in an oscillat- mg bearing; this bearing, and with it the elevating-screw, can be traversed right and left by means of a small hand- wheel on the left side of the trail, and this causes the 324 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. trunnion-saddle with the gun to pivot around the centre of the saddle. On the right side of the trail there is a compressing- handle to lock the elevating-screw, so as to make it immov- able during firing and whilst travelling. The handspike, of iron tubing, is hinged to the trail. The brake is of the following description: Each axle- arm has a screw cut on its extremity; this carries a nut forming a conical cap, partly enveloping the inner side of the wheel-nave, which is also conical, to fit the inside of the cap; and has a crank-arm by which it can be revolved on the axle. When screwed up, this cap grips the cone of the nave of the wheel until the latter is imhiovably locked by the friction of the cones. A shield, of three parts, made to fold together, thus forming seats for two men, is sometimes provided. It is of steel plate three sixteenths of an inch thick. The carriage carries the following implements: A sponge on the right bracket, and two handspikes beneath the trail; in the tool-box (which is between the brackets) are car- ried the feed-trough, hand-crank, rear sight, screw-driver, oil-can, reserve mainspring, reserve firing-pin, hammer, punch, and a universal wrench. THE LIMBEE. Light. Heavy. Weight of limber empty Lbs. 605 913 " " " loaded •• 1067 1452 Number of rounds in Umber 300 300 The limber is formed of four futchells,— the outside ones of flat steel, the inside ones and the splinter-bar being of angle-iron,— a platform-board, and a foot-board of oak. The axle is of hollow wrought iron; wheels same as for carriage. The futchells and splinter-bar are all riveted together, and the cast-steel limber-hook is riveted in between the inside FIELD-ARTILLBBY. 325 futchells; the axle is secured to the bed by three becar- ings. The pole lets into an iron frame and is held by two bolts with threads and nuts. The single-trees, of metal, are hung to eye-plates under the ends of the brackets. The ammunition-chest is made of steel plate and carries 300 rounds in two compartments, one of which holds 100 rounds packed in ten steel feed-cases ready for rapid firing. The limber carries the following implements : A set of intrenching-tools, axe, water-bucket, traction-rope, cushions for seats, etc. THE CAISSON-. Light. Heavy. Weight with limber empty Lbs. 1430 2409 loaded " 3091 4356 Number of rounds HOG 1100 Fig. 85. The caisson (Fig. 85) consists of the limber, which is identical with the gun-limber, and the caisson- body, carry- ing two ammunition-chests similar to those of the limber. It is of steel and iron, with brakes like those on the car- riage. There are two foot- boards, and it has arrangements for carrying the spare wheel, intrenching-tools, spare pole, single-trees, and other accessories. 326 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTtLLERT. RANGE TABLE FOR LIGHT FIELD-PIECE. Angle of jump, 4'. Charge, 2.8 oz. Mean weight of projectile^ 1 lb. Initial velocity, 1319 ft. -sec. 1 B^ean Deviation. ■s-a a 3 °3i^ o i "3 \& 1 ^1 4^ i 1 > 1 P s 5 1 Ft. g 09 M In. CO O ! f-i 1 II Yds. Yds. o ' Yds. Sec. o ' In. Yds. Yds. Yds. Ft. 100 06 0.01 0.3 11 1234 0.058 0.008 33.8 0.06 0.07 li 300 17 0.04 0.4 34 1161 0.164 0.007 31.3 0.13 0.14 ^M 300 39 0.09 0.6 38 1091 0.381 0.010 30.5 0.19 0.33 217 400 43 0.16 1.0 53 1037 0.406 0.014 19.8 0.25 0.30 150 500 56 0.37 1.3 1 09 987 0.543 0.018 19.1 0.32 0.39 118 14 600 1 10 0.43 1.7 1 28 944 0.679 0.023 18.5 0.43 0.49 90 700 1 25 0.64 2.0 1 49 906 0.824 0.027 18.0 0.50 0.57 74 800 1 43 0.87 3.4 3 13 874 0.989 0.032 17.5 0.55 0.65 68 900 1 59 1.3 3.7 3 37 843 1.154 0.037 17.1 0.63 0.79 53 1000 3 16 1.6 3.1 3 05 819 1.319 0.042 16.7 0.70 0.90 46 67 1100 3 35 3.0 3.4 3 35 796 1.504 0,054 16.5 0.79 1.03 40 1200 2 55 2.5 3.8 4 07 775 1.698 0.067 16.3 0.89 1.1 36 1300 3 16 3.3 4.3 4 42 756 1.902 0.079 16.0 0.99 1.3 33 1400 3 38 3.9 4.5 5 30 741 2.116 0.093 16.0 1.05 1.4 39 1500 4 00 4.7 4.9 5 59 736 2.331 0.104 15.9 1.1 1.5 36 184 1600 4 34 5.7 5.4 6 30 711 3.565 0.120 15.9 1.3 1.7 1700 4 49 6.7 5.8 7 13 695 3.808 0.136 15.9 1.4 1.9 1800 5 15 7.9 6.3 7 56 683 3.063 0.152 15.9 1.6 2.1 1900 5 42 9.4 6.7 8 31 670 3.334 0.168 16.1 1.6 3.4 2000 6 10 11.0 7.1 9 14 659 3.601 0.184 16.5 1.7 2.7 387 2100 6 39 13.7 7.6 10 00 650 3.877 207 16.9 1.8 3.0 2300 7 09 14.7 8.0 10 48 641 4.181 0.239 17.3 3.0 3.3 3300 7 4C 16.8 8.5 11 39 632 4.487 0.252 17.6 3.3 3.6 340(1 8 12 19.3 |9.0 13 31 623 4.804 0.274 18.1 3.4 4.0 2500 8 46 33.0 |9.5 13 34 613 5.14( 0.297118.7 3.5 4.6 701 FIELD-ABTILLERT. ' THE GATLING GUN. 327 Fig. 86. The following description applies more particularly to the model of 1883, which differs in some of its details from previous models. The 1-inch and .45-inch calibres are now in service ; and contracts have been made for supply- ing .30-inch calibre. The Gatliug gun consists of a number of breech-loading rifled barrels, B, grouped around a shaft, ^S*, to which they are parallel. The 1-inch lias six barrels; smaller calibres eight and ten. Each barrel is fired only once in the revolution of the group. ^aS" G Fig. 87. The breech-ends of the barrels are screwed into a disk or rear barrel-plate, P', which is fastened to the shaft, and 328 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. the muzzles pass through another similar disk, P, called the front barrel-plate, on the shaft; the shaft projects beyond the muzzles, and extends backwards for some distance behind the breeches of the barrels. Directly behind the barrels a carrier-block, C, is fas- tened to the shaft, and in its exterior surface semi-cyliudri- cal channels are cut, which form trough-like extensions to the rear of the cartridge-chambers of the barrels, and are designed to receive and guide the cartridges while they are thrust into the barrels, and guide the empty cases while they are withdrawn. Behind the carrier-block the shaft carries, rigidly attached, the lock-cylinder, L, in which guide-grooves are formed, which are parallel to the barrels, and in which slide long breech-plugs or locks having a forward and backward motion of their own, and by which the cartridges are thrust into the barrels. They also close the barrels until after discharge, and then extract the cases. Fig. 88. Each plug, or lock (Pig. 88), contains a spiral mainspring, h, acting on a firing-pin, a, by which the charge is fired, so that -the plug performs all of the functions of a gun-lock, as well as of a breech-plug, b' is the head of firing-pin (which engages in R, Fig. 89) ; c is the lug for groove; d is the hooked extractor which engages over the cartridge- head; and e is the guide-rib for the lock. The lock is a rebounding one, the intention being that the firing-pin shall not project beyond the face of the block until, on FIBLD-ARTILLEBT. 329 being released from the cocking-piece, ib flies forward aud discharges the cartridge. The shaft, S, to which the group of barrels and both the carrier-block and the lock-cylinder are rigidly attached, is free to turn on its axis, the front end being journalled in the front part of the frame, and the rear end in a diaphragm in the breech-casing. The gearing by which the shaft is revolved consists of a toothed wheel, G (Pig. 87), fastened to the shaft, and worked by an endless screw, W, on a small axle, S', which passes transversely through the case at right angles to the shaft, and is furnished outside the case with a hand- crank, K. The crank may be worked from the side, or it may be attached to the rear end of the main shaft, giving in the first position a rapidity equal to about 800 shots per min- ute, and in the latter 1300 per minute. The rear end of the main shaft terminates in a screw, which is covered by a knob or cascable, which is turned when the crank is to be attached for rapid fire. The cartridge-carrier block is covered above the frame by a semi-cylindrical shell, which is provided at the top with an opening of suitable size and shape to permit a single cartridge to fall through it into one of the channels of the carrier-block, which it overlies. There is a trough extending upward from this opening and forming a hop- per, in which feed-cases can be placed. Beneath the carrier-block everything is open, to allow the cartridges or shells which are withdrawn by the ex- tractors from the barrels to fall to the ground. Within the cylindrical breech-case attached to the frame a heavy ring, not quite the length of the lock-cylinder, is fastened to the case and diaphragm, which nearly fills the space between the inside of the case and the cylinder. Portions of the inside of this ring are so cut away as to leave a cam 830 A MAIWBOOK FOB LIOBT ARTILLEBT. projecting from the inner surface of the ring, having two helicoidal edges inclined to each other, and united by a short, flat plane. Against these edges the rear ends of the locks continually bear, there being room enough for the locks to lie loosely within the parts of the ring which arc cut away. Each lock is held back against the cam by a lug projecting laterally from the end of the lock, and entering a groove formed at the base of the cam, in the thin part of the ring. A device for throwing the cocking- piece in and out of gear, worked by a knob on the right of the breech-casing, permits the gun being used for drill purposes without snapping the locks. When the arrow- head points to the front, it is in position for firing. With the head pointing to the rear it is out of ac- tion. On the left of the breech-casing, just under the hopper, is a movable section with three wedge-shaped prongs, which keep the cartridge-cases in the grooves of the carrier until they are ejected. It is called the shell-guide. The gun can be unloaded of any cartridges not fired by removing the feed-case, opening the hopper, and reversing the motion of the crank. The locks can be removed and inserted without taking ofE the cascable-plate; and the absence of one or more plugs does not affect the working of the gun, except to diminish the intensity of the fire. For each lock removed one un- exploded cartridge falls to the ground at each revolution of the gun. The gun is encased in a frame which has trunnions, and is mounted in the ordinary way, like a field-piece. The screw for elevating and depressing the breech works in a nut attached to the trail of the carriage in the usual way. In the model of 1883 the trunnions of the gun are placed two inches below its centre, and the elevation and depression are given by means of an arc connected at both FIELD-ARTILLER 7. 331 extremities with the gun, which may be elevated 74° or depressed 78°. A lateral movement is given the gun by means of a hand- lever which fits into a squai'e mortise cast on the under side of the breech-casing. On top of the breech-casing is a spirit-level placed par- allel to the axis of the piece, and on the right side of the cascable-plate is another at right angles to the first. Fig. 89. ACTIOH OF THE MECHANISM. In Fig. 89 cd, c'd' are the developments of the right- and left-hand sides of the elliptical groove; cc' and dd' are de- velopments of the circular arcs. 332 A BANDBOaK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. When the crank is rotated, it causes the shaft with the barrels, carrier-block, and lock-cylinder to rotate in the casing. The bolts, held by the guides in the surface of the lock-cylinder, also rotate with the barrels and other parts, but by the bearing of the bolt-lugs in the elliptical grooves in the barrel-casing the bolts on the right-hand side are forced to move forward, dc, towards the barrels, and those on the left to move backward c'd'. When each bolt in this rotation reaches the "loading- flat," a cartridge drops from the feed into the groove in the carrier-block, in front of the bolt. As the rotation con- tinues the bolt pushes forward until, on reaching the " fir- ing-flat," the cartridge has been completely inserted and the barrel closed. During this motion a groove on the jight-hand side of the casing, B, catches the head of the firing-pin and retains it, thus compressing the spiral main- spring and cocking the firing-pin. A continuation of the rotation causes the firing-pin to pass out of this groove; and the action of the mainspring drives the pin forward and fires the cartridge. The motion continuing, the bolt is withdrawn by the left-hand groove, c'd', and as it moves backward the empty case is drawn out by the extractor on the bolt. THE FEED. The Bruce Feed (Fig. 90).— This is a gravity feed con- sisting of an upright bronze standard, a, having two grooves in it. Below the grooves is a fixed mouth, c, and below this a wheel, d, having its axis to one side of the mouth and turning freely on this axis. When in use, the feed is inserted in an opening in the barrel-casing directly over the carrier-block, e. The paper box containing the cartridges (tlie top being removed) is placed in the fixed standard with the heads of the cartridges FIELD-AMTILLEB Y. 333 in the grooves of the to the rear. The heads engage swinging-piece, b, and the pa- per box may then be pulled off. As each cartridge strikes the wheel it causes the latter to revolve and present a new groove for the reception of a cartridge. The cartridges delivered to the wheel are in turn carried around by it and deposited in the grooves of the carrier-block. The cartridges in one column of the feed becoming exhausted, the weight of those in the other column causes the swinging- piece to rotate sufficiently for them to be fed to the piece. The Accles Feed (Fig. 91) con- sists of a brass drum the dis- tance between whose heads slightly exceeds the length of the cartridge to be used. The inside of the head is grooved in a spiral form- ending at the mouth of the drum. The cen- tral j)art of the spiral is removed and replaced by the axis of a set of radial arms which rotate about this axis. The cartridges are inserted through the mouth of the drum into the spirals with the heads to the rear. When in use, the drum, a, is placed in - position, with its mouth, c, down and over the grooves in the carrier-block, d. FrG. 90. 334 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEB7. Projections, e, on the outer edges of the grooves in the block engage in the outer extremities, f, of the radial arms, i, of Fig. 91. the drum so as to cause the latter to rotate when the crank is turned; and the arms, bearing against the cartridges, force them along the spirals towards the opening in the drum, whence they are delivered to the grooves in the car- rier-block. The Latest Improved Feed (Pig. 93) has but a small sur- face exposed to fire, is cheap, light, and independent of gravity, so that it may be used at any angle. Long strips (Fig. 93) of tip or any cheap flexible metal FIELB-ARTILLER T. 335 have tongues, a, punched in them, one end of the tongue being left attached to the strip and the other separated. «= «=' ffji crj (.czj ^<=z\ C3 «=? <=z>. cj -ciri 1:3 riLe=:^:;c ;&. Q n n a- JJ i Pig. 92. These tongues surround the cartridge and hold it in place on the strip. The small rectangular slots, h, are punched (o) (o) ipXJp) (oj (.0) (oj € Pig. completely through, and in these slots fit the rims of the cartridge-cases. A hopper (a, Fig. 93) is hinged to the frame which sup- 336 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. ports the gun just over the carrier-block, and has in it an opening, h, through which the strips, with the cartridges down, are fed. This opening is narrow in front and wide in rear to prevent the cartridge being introduced wrong end to the front. Below the opening, l, is a shelf, c, so shaped as to guide the cartridges and strips into the open- ing. Above the shelf is a flat spring, d, which presses the cartridges down as they pass through the opening. A wedge, e, projects from the opposite side of the hopper, and, acting on each cartridge in turn, forces it out of the strip, the tongues, a, bending downward into the recess provided for them. The carrier-block,/, is provided with projections which act like the teeth of a wheel upon the cartridges, forcing the strip to the right. When in use, a strip containing cartridges is pushed into the opening, b, of the hopper. The crank is rotated and the strip is forced to the right through the hopper. This action brings each cartridge in succession against the point of the wedge, e, which forces the cartridge out of its hold on the strip by bending downward the tongues, a, and the cartridge is deposited in the groove of the carrier-block, the empty strip passing to the right. Before Firing the Gun. — The following points should be attended to: The adjuster-nut should be at its proper position, viz., with the marks in line with each other. The safety- cam (cocking-switch) should be set to fire arrow-head on knob pointing forward. The shell-guide should be in its place and the hopper locked down. Never turn the crank quickly while the lock-plug is out. See that the safety-cam is turned out of firing position when the gun is being worked without cartridges. Precautions to be Observed. — (a) Never lay the cover FIELD-ABTILLERT. 337 upon the ground, as it is liable to pick up sand and dirt, ■which may derange the working of the parts. {b) A partially filled feed-case should not be put back into the anamunition-cLest without being filled up, as the cartridges may become inverted and jam the gun, (c) If the gun jams, remove the feed-case at once, open the hopper, and reverse the crank until all the cartridges are taken out. This will be found to save time, unless the cause of the jamming is evident and in the immediate vicinity of the hopper. {d) See that all the parts are kept well oiled to prevent friction and scouring. THE CABEIAGB, MODEL 1883. The carriage is made of metal; the axle of steel without any axle-body; the wheels are of the Archibald pattern; and the trail of two plates of mild steel, reinforced on top and connected by five transoms. A gunner's seat is hinged to the top of the trail. The oscillatiiig-lever, when not in use, is carried between the trail-plates. The elevat- ing-arc is held in place by a binding-screw, and is worked by a bronze handle. The field of oscillation is limited by two stop-pins in front of the swivel. They permit of about 50° of lateral movement, and the gun can be held at any point of this arc by a binding-screw, the handle of which is on the left cheek. On each side of the gun, and fastened to the axle, is an ammunition -chest of steel for carrying feed -drums and cer- tain tools. These chests are lined with wood, and running through the middle, separating the compartments for feed- drums, are blocks of wood' with recesses in their tops for the following tools; 338 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLEBT. Left Chest. 1 cain-extractor. 1 riveting-hammer. 1 oil-can. 1 screw-wrench. 1 sight, left. Right Chest. 1 crank-handle for gun. 1 drift. 1 lock screw-driver. 1 T screw-driver 1 pin-wrench. 1 sight, right The lids of these chests are fastened with hasps and tui-nbuckles. They can be locked with the ordinary pad- lock. A wiping-rod of brass is fastened to the under side of the stock. THE LIMBER. T^e limber is principally of metal. The axle and wheels are the same as in the carriage. The limber-chest and lid are of Bessemer steel re- inforced by angle-irons. The interior of the chest is divided by steel plates into three compartments for cai-ry- ing ammunition. The centre one is subdivided by wooden partitions for carrying feed-drums. The lid is fastened in the same manner as those on the axle-chests. The following is the capacity of the limber-chest : Bight and left compartments, 132 packages, each of 20 cartridges 5280 cartridges 4 feed-drums of 104 cartridges each 416 " Front centre compartment, 38 packages of 20 car- tridges each 760 " These with the four feed-drums in the axle-chest. . . 416 " "Would give 6872 Weight of piece 337 lbs. Weight of gun-carriage with chest and tools, without feed- cylinders 594 Weight of limber and chest 754 " " ammunition and chest 230 " " one wheel 106 <' " feed-cylinder (filled) , 24^ FIELD-ABTILLEB Y. 339 The 0.45-in-ch Gatling Gun Mounted on a Gavalet- CAET. DESCRIPTION OF THE PIECE. Designation. Extreme length of piece Leugth of barrel , Length of breech-casing Length of feed-case Cartridges in each case , Cartridges in each chest Gun (weight) Total weight of gun, carriage, and implements, Kumber of barrels Number of horses to draw (good I'oads) Number of horses to draw (bad roads) No. 40 960 10 1 3 Lbs. 144 935 Inches. 35.5 18 8.5 20.35 The 1-inch Gatling. DBSCKIPTION OF PIECE. Designation. No. Lbs. Inches. Extreme length of piece Length of barrel Length of breech-casing Length of feed-case Cartridges in each case , Cartridges in each ammunition-chest Total number of rounds for each gun Grun (weight) Total weight of gun, implements, carriage, and limber Number of barrels Number of grooves Depth of grooves Twist: one turn in six feet. Preponderance Number of horses for each piece Number of horses for each caisson 13 472 3593 68.15 33 31.5 14.5 315 1008 3368 110 0.01 For field service each piece is accompanied by one caisson. 340 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. Nomenclature oe the 0.45-inch Gun (1883). Components. — Adjustable-screw nut; barrels (10); breech-casing; breech-casing screws (6); bushings (10; cartridge-carrier; cartridge-shell ejector; cartridge-shell ejector-screws (3); cartridge-shell extractor-block; car- tridge-shell extractor-block screws (2); cascable-plate ; cock- ing device; crank; crank -latch; crank-shaft; diaphragm; dowel-pins; extractor-hooks (10); firing-pins (10); front cap; main shaft; oscillating-thread nut and washer ; rear- guide nut; rear plate for barrels; rear sight; worm; worm- gear; rear-sight screws; front plate for barrels ; front sight; front-sight screws; gas-collar; gun-frame; hopper; hopper- hinge; hopper-hinge pin; hopper-hinge, screws (2); hopper- latch; hopper-latch screws; lock-cylinder; lock-cylinder screws (2); lock-extractor; lock-extractor screws; lock- extractor sleeve; lock-extractor sleeve-screws (2); lock- mainsprings (10); lock-nuts (10); lock-tubes (10); spiral cam; spiral-cam screws (2); trunnions (2); washer for front end of main shaft, Appendages.^Ad justing screw-wrench; brass wiping- rod; clamp for worm-gear; feed-cases, straight (48); lock screw-driver; pin-wrench; rear-guide nut-wrench; shell- driver; small screw-driver; T screw-driver. The Carriage.— ^Shafts; eye-bolts and straps (6); splin- ter-bar; step; hounds; assembling-bolts; prop; foot-board ; floor; bed; bed-plate; clamp-screws (2); ammunition- chests (2); chest-handles (2); lid; lid-latch (2); corner- plates; angle-irons; tool-box; tool-box latch; tool-box straps and hinges; guard-plate; linch-pins (2); washers (2). Gatling Gun, Short Barbel, Model 1875. instructions for dismounting. 1. Turn the crank, and as each mark on the rear barrel- plate comes opposite the mark on the front of hopper re- move the locks by means of the lock-plug. FIELD-ABTILLERT. 341 2. Remove screws and take off the cascable-piate. 3. Remove screw from left end of crank-shaft and take off oscillating-screw. 4. Remove worm steady-pin "by tapping the small pin until it is loose, then turn the crank backwards and remove with fingers, and take out the crank-shaft, worm, and sleeve. 5. Remove screw from rear end of main shaft and take ofE worm-gear. 6. Remove the adjusting-screw cover and take out the adjusting- screw and set-nut. 7. Remove clamp-stop from elevating- screw clamp and screw out the clamp. 8. Screw in the elevating-screw as far as it will go, then lift the elevating-screw and its sleeve by the handle clear of its seat and out of the traversing apparatus, allowing the front end of barrels to drop down slowly as far as they will go, and remove traversing apparatus by sliding to the left. 9. Remove screws and take o£E breech-casing, 10. Take out hinge-pin and remove hopper. 11. Remove screws which secure lock-cam cylinder to breech-casing, remove lock-cam cylinder, and take out cocking-cam piston and spring. 13. Take group of barrels out of frame (one man holding sleeve on front end of main shaft to prevent dropping) and remove sleeve. 13. Take out screw from lock-cylinder, back out steady- pin which holds rear-guide nut, and remove the nut. (The nut works on a left-hand thread.) 14. Take off lock-cylinder and carrier-block. INSTEUCTlOlfS FOR ASSEMBLING. 1. Replace carrier-block and lock-cylinder. 2. Replace rear-guide nut, and put in steady-pin and lock-cylinder screw. 342 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLERT. 3. Eeplace sleeve (small end to the front) and place group of barrels in frame, 4. Eeplace cocking-cam piston and spring, place lock- cam cylinder in interior of breech-casing, and put in screws. 5. Eeplace hopper and put in hinge-pin. 6. Eeplace breech-casing and put in screws. 7. Eeplace traversing apparatus; place head of elevat- ing-screw in its seat in traversing apparatus, and put ele- vating-screw with sleeve in place. 8. Screw in elevating-screw clamp as far as it will go and put in clamp-screw. 9. Eeplace adjusting-screw with set-nut and put on cover. 10. Eeplace worm-gear and spline-screw. 11. Eeplace sleeve, worm, and crank-shaft, and put steady-pin in worm. 13. Eeplace oscillating-screw and put screw in left end of crank-shaft. 13. Eeplace cascable-plate and put in screws. 14. Eeplace locks according to numbers on front of locks and rear barrel-plate 15. Eeplace lock-plugs. Gatliitg Gun, Long Barbel, Model 1883. instructions for dismounting. 1. Eemove hinge-pin and take ofE hopper. 2. Eemove lock-plug by turning to the right and take out locks. 3. Turn off the adjuster-knob by pressing down the catch and turning the knob to the left, or pressing down the catch and turning the crank in the same direction as when firing. 4. Eemove the worm-cover, pull out the crank-shaft split-pin, and remove washer from left end of crank-shaft; FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 343 hold one hand under worm-cover hole and draw out the crank-shaft to the right. In this operation the worm will fall through the worm-cover hole, and should be caught' in the hand. 5. Take o£E the cascable-plate. To do this, first see that the cocking-switch is in the firing position, which is indi- cated by the arrow pomting forward. Then turn out the cascable-plate screw, and turn the plate to the left until the arrows on the plate and casing meet; hold one hand under worm-cover hole to receive worm-gear, and pull the plate off to the rear. 6. Take out the lock-cam. First pull the cocking-switch outward, turning it to the right until it snaps in the notch, the arrow pointing downward; the cam can now be pulled out, using the cam-extractor, or the fingers of both hands. 7. Take out the shell-guide. INSTEUCTIOKS FOE ASSEMBLING. 1. Put in the shell-guide. 2. Put in the lock-cam, then turn the cocking-switch so that the arrow points forward. 3. Put on the cascable-plate. Be sure that the gear is inside the worm-cover hole, and turn the plate and gear until the grooves on the latter meet the splines on the main shaft; then push the plate into place, and turn to the right until the arrows on plate and casing meet. 4. Put in the crank-shaft and worm (countersunk-end of the latter to the right) and secure with washer and split- pm. 5. Screw on the adjuster-knob; turn it up as far as pos- sible, and then back until lines on catch and ratchet meet. 6. Put in locks as numbered on front of locks and rear barrel-plate, and put in lock-plug. 7. Put on hopper and replace hinge-pin. 344 A HANDBOOK fOS, LIGHT ARTILLBBY. SrOMBlfCLAXUBB OF THE l-INCH GUN. In View. — Main shaft, around which the barrels are clustered; front plate, which supports the front of the barrels; rear plate, which supports the rear end of the barrels; barrels; gun-frame; trunnions; gun-face; front sight; rear sight; breech-casing; breech-casing screws; cas- cable-plate; hopper; ejector; cartridge-carrier; crank; ele- vating-screw; elevating-screw box; elevating-screw bed; elevating-screw handle; wiping-rod (brass); ejecting-rod (iron); lock; lock-tube; lock-hammer; lock-spring; firing- pin; extractor. Within the Breech-casing. — Lock-cylinder; rear-guide nut; cocking-ring; cocking-ring clamp; spiral cam; dia- phragm; diaphragm-plug; gear-wheel; pinion; rear-cam screw. TO TAKE THE GUN APAET. The piece is first dismounted and placed with its casing resting on blocks. Mounting and dismounting are best accomplished by means of a gin. In case of necessity, it may be mounted and dismounted as a field-piece, care being taken to place blocks of wood to receive the gun-frame and to prevent injury to the front sight, or to the barrels. The operations of taking apart are executed in the fol- lowing order : 1. Block up the frame and barrels. 2. Eemove the hopper. 3. Kemove the cascable-plate. 4. Take out the steady-pin; then turn the crank down- wards and remove the crank-shaft in that position. 5. Kemove the rear sight, and take out the large gear- wheel. 6. Take out the rear plug in the diaphragm, and then gently revolve the gun until a lock presents itself on a line FIBLD-ARTILLBRT. 345 with the hole in the diaphragm, through which one lock after another is taken out. 7. Take out the breech-casing screws, and remove the casing by drawing it off to the rear. Care is taken in this operation to have the lock-cylinder and gun supported, so as to keep the axis of the main shaft parallel to the top of the frame. This is necessary to prevent the rear end of the gun from dropping when the casing is removed. 8. Eemove the pin from the large nut on the main shaft in rear of the locks, and take this nut off by turning it to the right; then remove the lock-cylinder and carrier from the main shaft. The spiral cam need not be taken out of the casing in order to take the gun apart. TO ASSEMBLE THE GUK. 1. Put the main shaft in its place through the plates which hold the barrels, and then put in their proper places the carrier, lock-cylinder, and large rear nut. The latter should be screwed up tight and have .the taper-pin put through the nut and shaft. 2. Place the gun within the frame, and let the front end of the main shaft rest in the hole designed for it in the front of the frame. When the gun is in this position, the cocking-ring should be shoved over the lock-cylinder and left for the time loosely around the carrier. 3. Let the breech of the gun be slightly raised, when the breech-casing can be shoved over the lock-cylinder to its place; then screw the casing to the frame, putting, in the meantime, the cocking-ring in its proper place. Eevolve the gun to the right or left so that the places for the locks will come on a line with the hole in the diaphragm, through which one lock at a time can be inserted in its proper position; afterwards the screw-plug should be inserted to close the hole. 346 A HANDBOOK FOR LIOET ARTILLERY. 4. Put on the cog-wheels, replace the crank-shaft, pin- ion, and steady-pin. Put on the rear sight, and screw on the cascable-plate and hopper, and the gun is ready to be mounted. The piece is mounted on a 3-inch gun-carriage widened between the cheeks to receive it. The ammuni- tion-chests are arranged for twelve trays. For field service each piece is accompanied by one caisson. THE GAEDNER GUN (CAL. 0.45"). Fig. 94. Weight of gun 143 lbs. " " " and can-iage 502 " Shots per minute 357 This gun consists of two breech-loading rifled barrels, a (Fig. 95), (chambered at the rear to admit a flanged centre- fire metallic cartridge), having their axes in the same hori- zontal plane enclosed and supported in a bronze casing. The two openings in the front part of this casing are for the circulation of air to keep the barrels cool. The barrels are without motion, and are loaded and fired by tlie action of the breech mechanism, which is contained in the rectangular rear part of the casing. This is closed at the top by a hinged cover, c, which is firmly locked in position by screwing up the cascable. PIELD-ABTILLER T. 347 a. barrels. e e'. cams. i. cocking-cam. 6. casing. t. ejectors. j. cooking-lever. c. breech-cover. g. feed. I. feed-valve lever. d. locks. h. main spring-compressor, v. feed-valve. Fig. 95, Fig. 96. Motion is given to all the parts by the cams (a. Fig. 96), which are attached to the three steel disks, b, at opposite 348 A HANDBOOK FOB. LIGHT ARTILLWBY. extremities of a diameter, and the whole is rotated around an axis, c, by means of a crank, d. The parts abc form the main crank, which is supported in Journal-boxes that are locked into the body of the rear case as shown in Fig. 95. Fia. 97. The Lock (Fig. 97) in form resembles the letter U, having an extension from its side which contains the firing-pin, h; the mainspring, i, whose ends abut against the collar, Jc, on the firing-pin, and the sector-sleeve, I, which slides over the firing-pin; the sector or spring-compressor, n; the extractor, b; the sear, e; and the sear-spring, j. The U part of the lock, that works under and around the cam, is curved at the inner front to correspond with the outer circle of the cam, the ofl&ce of the curved front being to hold the lock in position for firing. The circular firing-pin is flattened a portion of its length near the front end, to allow it to pass under the extractor, by which it is held in position. It extends from the head of the lock through the mainspring and sector-sleeve, terminating in a head, m, for locking into the sear. The sear, e, pivoted in the centre of the lock, holds the firing-pin securely, and pre- vents it from touching the cartridge until it is released from its hold by the action of the cam, when the lock is in its extreme forward position. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 349 The sector or spring-compressor, n, hinged in a recess of the lock, and engaging, by means of gear-teeth, with the sector-sleeve, I, has its arm, g, forced against the safety- stop, 0, as the cam advances, thus compressing, through the medium of the sector-sleeve, the mainspring, and hold- ing it tense until released by action of the sear. The lock-heads serve as breech-plugs, and receive the recoil when the cartridges are fired. Each lock carries a hooked extractor which rides over and catches the flange of the cartridge, when the lock is forced forward, and when the lock retreats withdraws the empty shell until it comes within reach of the ejector, by which it is positively thrown out. The ejectors, ff, hinged to the case, are driven by projections on the sides of the locks which give them positive movements to eject the empty shells. The Feed, resembling the Bruce feed but without the wheel, is fixed to the casing in rear of the barrels. Below the feed-guide the casing has two holes for the passage of cartridges, and below the holes is the feed-valve, which slides at right angles to the barrels when driven by the forked-shaped lever which receives its motion from the bolts as they move forward. OBSEKVATIONS. 1. If the crank be turned before the feeding of the cartridges is commenced, the first few will fall irregularly and check the working of the gun. 2. Be careful to reclamp firmly the swivel and pointing- lever after pointing. 3. To oscillate the gun without changing the elevation, unclamp the swivel and turn the gun back and forth from right to left by means of the pointing-lever, regulating the amplitude of the vibration by the oscillation-stop head. 4. When the firing is discontinued, turn the safety-ci-ank 360 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT downwards and to the front, until the crank-stop drops into its front recess in the casing. 5. This gun may be fired by turning the crank backward. NOMEKCLATURE OF THE GUN". In and about the Casing. — Lock (lock-frame; lock-frame heads; lock-frame truck; locking-lever; locking-lever pins; locking-lever stop-pins; firing-pin; firing-pin rack; main- spring; sear; sear-pin; sear-spring; sear-spring pin; ex- tractor); casing (body); casing (cover); cascable; cascable- screw; rear sight and pinion; rear-sight guide; lock-cam; lock-cam recoil-plates; lock-cam journal-boxes; perforated plate; perforated plate cartridge-support; shell-starter; cocking-cam; cocking-cam screws; hand-crank; hand-crank pin; hand-crank handle; ejector; ejector-pins; lock-guide; cartridge-guide; feed-valve; feed-valve slide; feed-valve seat; feed-valve lever; feed-valve lever-screw; feed-valve lever-slide; feed-guide; feed-guide catch; feed-guide car- tridge-stop; front sight; mainspring-compressor; lever and compressor locks; compressor-guide; safety-crank; safety- crank stop; safety-crank stop-spring; safety-crank shaft, safety-crank shaft-lever and pins; front-sight spring; bar rels; front barrel-plate; front barrel-plate pin; rear barrel- plate; rear barrel-plate pin. About the Carriage. — Swivel (the brass casting connect- ing casing and carriage); swivel and casing pivot-pins, swivel and casing pivot-pin, ring, chain, and lock pin- swivel-clamp; swivel-clamp screw, gunner's seat; swivel clamp screw-collar; swivel and carriage pivot-bolt locks, swivel and carriage pivot-bolt lock-lever; swivel and car- riage pivot-bolt lock-lever i-ing and chain; elevating and pointing-lever; pointing-lever pivot-pin ring chain and lock-pins; pointing-lever clamp, lock-chain; pointing-lever clamp-screw; oscillation-stop, trail handspikes, oscilla- tion-stop traversing-screw; oscillation-stop limit-screw. FIELD-ABTILLEBY. 351 Implements, etc. — Wiping-rod; T scvew-driTer; lock- wrench; headless shell-extractor; packing-case; shell-driver; hammer; drifts; breech-casing cover (leather). THE OABEIAGE. The distinctive feature of the carriage is the arrange- ment for oscillation, the lateral movement being regulated by a clamp, which compresses, or allows to expand, a metallic ring concentric with the pivot around which the gun moves. The lever for elevating or depressing, as well as giving the oscillation, is peculiar to this gun. THE LIMBER. The limber-chest is opened in rear by a lid, which falls down, and is held in place by jointed braces, thereby serving as a shelf. When down, it exposes a series of drawers six in number, and two recesses for implements. In these drawers the ammunition is carried in the original paste- board packages. Each drawer has a capacity for 45 pack- ages or 900 rounds, thus giving to each limber 5400 rounds. IN^STKUCTIOKS EOE DISMOUKTIKG. 1. Unscrew the cascable and raise the breech-cover. 3. Remove the locks. To do this, turn the crank until one of the lock-cam recoil-plates is uppermost; rotate the corresponding lock about the recoil-plate until it is vertical, and draw it out at front. The other lock may be removed in the same manner. 3. Remove the ejectors directly by their pins. 4. Remove the lock-cam, raising it vertically by means of its journal-boxes. 5. Turn out the feed-valve and valve-lever screws, and remove valve, valve-slide, lever, and lever-slide. G, Drive out the safety-crank pin, and remove crank, 352 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. 7. nrive out the safety-crank shaft and remove the spline. XO DISMOUNT THE LOCK. 1. Drive out the extractor-pin, and remove the extractor. 2. Unscrew the lock-head hy means of the lock-wrench. 3. Uncock by pressing on the sear, and turn the cooking- lever to the rear; drive out the cocking-lever pin, and re- move the lever. 4. Draw out the firing pin, remove the rack, and unscrew the mainspring. 5. Drive out the sear-spring pin, and remove the spring. 6. Drive out the sear-spring, and remove the sear. 7. Drive out the truck-pin, and remove the truck. INSTKUCTIOWS FOB ASSBMBLHSTG. 1, Put in safety-crank shaft and spline. 3. Put in safety-crank and crank-pin. 3. Eeplace the feed-valve, valve-slide, lever, and lever- slide, and the feed- valve and valve-lever screws. 4. Replace the lock-cam, lowering it vertically into place by its journal-boxes, with the oil-holes in journal-boxes on top. 5. Replace the ejectors. 6. Replace the locks. For this purpose each of the lock- cam recoil-plates must be uppermost, in succession. 7. Lower the breech-cover and screw up the cascable. TO ASSEMBLE THE LOCK. 1. Replace the truck and drive in the truck-pin. 3. Replace the sear and pin. 3. Replace the sear-spring and pin. 4. Screw on the mainspring, replace the rack with notch towards head of firing-pin. 5. Replace cocking-lever with its front tooth in front FIELD-ABTILLEB Y. 353 ispace on rack, put in lever-pin, and cock by turning cock- ing-lever to the front. 6. Turn the firing-pin so that its flat is parallel with the extractor-slot, and screw on the lock-head by means of the lock-wrench. 7. Replace the extractor and extractor-pin. THE MAXIM AUTOMATIC MACHINE-GUN. Fig. 98. Weight 50 lbs. Calibre Small arms ammunition Bapidity of Are 600 to 650 shots per minute The gun consists of two parts, viz., the recoiling and non-recoiling. -^=w^ Fig. 99. 354 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. Fig. 100. The Recoiling Part is the barrel and its extension. The barrel is an ordinary rifle barrel with a breech-sleeve to which is secured the extension. The extension of the bar- rel consists of two vertical steel plates, between which the lock and the gear connected therewith operate on guides and bearings. *'^^~"" Fig. 101. The Lock bears a vertically sliding piece, D (called the carrier), on its fore end, and does not differ materially from that of an ordinary pistol. It is secured by a divided screw to the connecting-rod, B, of a crank, E, the shaft of which passes through the plates. There is also a handle FIELD-ARTTLLERT. 365 to the shaft on the right side of the gun outside, and a curved arm to the crank. The Trigger, F, immediately in rear of the mainspring, M, is actuated by the rod, 8, which is operated by the lever, L, having at its upper end a double button. Press- ing this button draws back the rod and releases the ham- mer, G, and firing-pin, H. In rear of the gun is a catch, which when down prevents the lever being pressed for- ward. The Non-recoiling Portion consists of the gun-case and the water-jacket. This portion is mounted on trunnions, and has attached traversing, elevating, and depressing gear, and is provided with handles and sights for aiming and the double button for firing. On the right side of the gun-case is a solidly attached resistance-piece, G. The curved crank-arm. A, is at a small distance from it when the gun is in a firing position, to avoid escape of gas to the rear and fouling of the chamber. On the left side of the gun-case is a strong spiral spring the rear end of which is connected, by a chain and fusee, with the crank- shaft, and the fore end is connected to the gun-case by means of the spring-case; this spiral spring is to bring back the barrel after the recoil and to work the crank; the working strength of the spring can be adjusted by means of the screw at the fore end. The water-jacket surrounds the barrel and is fitted with three openings, one for receiving the water, one for drawing it off, and the third for letting off the steam ; the first two are closed by screw-plugs, the third is always open. Both ends of the water-jacket are fitted with stuffing-boxes and glands; these guide the barrel and prevent the escape of water. In the feed-box, on top of the gun, are two movable pawls and two stationary ones. The movable pawls are con- nected by a lever to the barrel and are so adjusted that the 356 A HANDBOOK FOB LI&ST ABTILLEBT. barrel on recoiling moves them from left to right; by means of a spring they engage behind the next cartridge in the belt, and thus the cartridges move on automatically towards the chamber; when the barrel returns after the recoil, the pawls place the cartridge, still in the belt, immediately above the chamber. OPEEATION OF THE MECHANISM. Cocking the Lock. — As the look is brought away from the breech, by the action of the crank, the connecting-rod throws down the hammer, thereby pulling back the firing- pin and compressing the mainspring, which causes the short arm of the trigger to engage under the lug of the hammer, and thus the lock is cocked and cannot act until the trigger is pulled clear of the lag on the hammer. The safety-sear, V, pressed down by a small spring, engages in the upper part of the firing-pin as it is drawn back by the action of the hammer; the firing- pin cannot move forward until this sear is raised; this is done by the connecting- rod, after it rises above the horizonta,l, thereby securely closing the breech with the lock. Operation in Firing. — In starting the gun the breech mechanism is operated by hand to insert the first cartridge in the barrel. The gun is then fired by pressing the firing- button. On the explosion of the cartridge the barrel and the gear connected therewith recoil about the distance of one inch. During the recoil the crank-arm comes in con- tact with the resistance-piece, K, and throws over the crank, bringing the end of the crank-handle onto the spring-buffer. The curve on the crank-arm is so arranged that the crank gets an accelerated movement by which the lock is thrown back clear of the breech and far enough for the carrier to extract the empty case from the chamber and a cartridge from the belt. The turning of the crank winds the chain attached to FIELD-AKTILLEBT. 357 the spiral spring round the fusee, thus extending the spring. As the lock goes backwards the carrier is pressed down by its spring, and when in its lowest position the new cartridge is opposite the barrel and the empty case oppo- site the ejecting-tube. The action of the spiral spring now brings back the bar- rel and its extension to their normal position; it also unwinds the chain from the fusee, thus turning the crank to its normal position, which throws the lock forward; as the lock moves forward it pushes the new cartridge into the barrel and the empty case into the ejecting-tube, Q. During the last one sixteenth of an inch of the forward travel of the lock the carrier is raised by the carrier-levers, which are actuated by the lugs on the fore end of the con- necting-rod, and when it arrives at its highest position it is held by a spring. CARETIKG AMMUNITION'. Belts, each holding 350 rounds, are carried in boxes for which there are receptacles on the different carriages. From four to six belts may be carried with each gun. In preparing the belts the cartridges are pushed in until about -J inch of the brass case of the cartridge comes through the belt, or until the ends of the bullets come in line with the ends of the projecting brass strips. TO LOAD AND FIRE. Pass the end of the belt through the feed-box from right to left, seize it as it comes through with the left hand, and turn the crank-handle forward with the right hand as far as the spring-buffer; hold it in that position until the belt has been pulled through as far as it will go, and then let the crank-handle return to the firing position of its own ac- cord. Repeat the operation just described. Now press the double button and firing commences. 358 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLEBT. To unload, it is only necessary to moye the crank-handle forward twice and then press the spring underneath the feed-box, which will cause the pawls to disengage from the belt, and draw out the belt from left to right. CAEE OF GUN. Before using the gun fill the water-jacket through the hole near its end. It holds about 3^ quarts. A water-bag, holding two gallons, is usually carried on the lower ammu- nition-box under the axle of the gun-carriage. Oil thoroughly the packing in the stuffing-boxes and see that the barrel goes close home forward. When the firing is completed, clean the working parts and oil slightly, and draw ofE water from the water-jacket. Two locks are provided with each gun. CAEEIAGES. A tripod weighing 47 lbs. for mountain service. This is sometimes fitted with an axle and two light wheels, and is provided with a light limber, the long leg of the tripod forming the trail. A cavalry-carriage weighing complete 1115 lbs. An infantry-carriage weighing complete 641 lbs IKSTEUCTIOSrS FOE DISMOUNTING. 1. Press the spring-catch and open the cover. 2. Eemove the feed-box by lifting it up out of the gun- frame. 3. Eemove the lock; to do this, turn the crank-handle, which brings back the lock from the barrel, and disengage it from the guides; now let the crank-handle go slowly backwards and at the same time lift the lock upwards; the lock will rise, and when in this position one eighth of a turn will detach its divided screw from the threads on the connecting-rod, when it can be lifted out. 4. Press the spring-box forward and lift the three lugs mELD-ARTILLERY. 359 out of their respective pins, then disengage the spring from the chain and remove the box with the spring. 5. Drive out the pin, and remove the double-button lever with the spring and cup. 6. Drive out the handle-block pin; start the handle- block by slight blows with a mallet or piece of wood from beneath, lift it out of the gun-frame, and remove the rod. 7. Remove the two small slides by sliding them back out of the gun-frame. 8. Draw the recoiling-frame with barrel out from the gun-frame and water-jacket. INSTKUCTIOlirS FOR ASSEMBLING. 1. Replace the barrel and recoiling-frame. 3. Replace the two small slides. 3. Replace the rod and put the handle-block in the gun- frame; see that the rod enters its seat in the handle-block before driving the block home, and put in the pin. 4. Engage the double-button lever with the rod, and re- place the lever, spring, and cup, and put in the pin. 5. Engage the spring with the chain not wound around, the fusee and replace the spring-box. 6. Replace the lock by screwing it into the connecting- rod until the two shoulders meet, then turn the crank- handle forward, guide lock into its guides, and let the crank-handle go slowly back to its place. 7. Replace the feed-box, with the stud in its seat, in the recoil-frame. 8. Close the cover by pressing the spring-catch. TO DISMOUNT THE LOCK. (See Fig. 101.) All pins enter from right to left. In driving out a pin see that the side of the lock round the pin is well sup- ported. 360 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. See that the carrier is in its highest position ; then re- lease the mainspring by lifting the safety-sear and pulJing the trigger. 1. Take out the pin (1) which secures the mainspring and the clip which keeps the carrier-levers in their places. Eemove the mainspring, clip, and carrier-levers. 3. Take out the pin (3) that secures the sear. Remove the sear. 3. Drift out the pin (3) that secures the hammer. Re- move the hammer. 4. Drift out the tapered pin (4) that secures the safety- sear. Remove the safety-sear and the firing-pin. 5. Take out the pin (5) that secures the piece which regulates the downward position of the carrier and keeps the carrier in its place. Eemove piece and carrier. 6. Remove the cover (6) at the back of the carrier and take out the upper piece and spring; the lower piece is riveted onto the carrier. TO MOUNT THE LOCK. 1. Put the upper piece and spring into their place in the face of the carrier and slide on the cover (6). 3. Place the carrier in its grooves, put in the piece which holds the carrier in its place, and drive in the pin (5) which secures the piece. 3. Put in the safety-sear and the firing-pin; drive in the tapered pin (4) that secures the safety-sear, 4. Put in the hammer, taking care that its point enters the slot in the firing-pin. Drive in the pin (3) that secures the hammer. When tlie pin (3) is in place, upset the point slightly by a few blows of a small hammer. 5. Put in the sear and the pin (3) which secures it. 6. Place the carrier-levers in their places; put in the mainspring, taking care its point enters the slot in the FIELD-ARTILLERT. 361 firing-pin; put on the clip and drive in the pin (1) which secures the mainspring and clip. Note. — There may be a little difficulty in entering the pin (1), but a special tool is supplied, which, being entered from left to right, will hold the clip and mainspring in their places, and then the pin (1) can be driven home from right to left, which, in its passage through the hole, will remove the tool. METALLIC CARRIAGE FOR MACHINE GUNS. This carriage, manufactured by the Ordnance Depart- ment, is designed for any machine-gun ; each kind of gun to be proTided with its own mount adapted to the carriage, which is made of steel. The design includes a spherical shield above and a plane apron below the axle for the protection of the cannoneers. The apron is hinged to the axle and is folded up and keyed to the under side of the trail when not in action. The spherical shield can be removed if desired. The body is the axle, and it and part of tho trail make a chest for ammunition in which 1200 .45-calibre car- tridges, packed in paper boxes, can be carried. Two doors, right and left of trail, on inner side, give access to the cartridge-space in the body, and a door on top of the upper end of trail to the cartridge-space in the trail, the two parts being continuous. Lower down in the trail is a tool-hox to which the trail-seat, when raised, gives access. The top of the carriage makes a convenient table for tools, feed-guides, and ammunition when in action. The shield with aperture and disks are so combined that the gun can be readily pointed without exposure. 362 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. CHAPTER X. Theoretical Gunnery. Definitions. General Principles. Probability of Fire. Burst of Shell. Burst of Shrapnel. DEFINITIONS. INTBBIOE BALLISTICS. Interior Ballistics. — The effects produced on a projectile in the bore of a gun, and on the gun, when subjected to the action of the products of combustion of gunpowder or other explosives. Gunpowder Explosion is the rapid conversion of gun- powder into gases and solids with evolution of heat. Ignition is the raising of the temperature of some point of a grain of powder to 300° C. Inflammation is the spread of the ignition from point to point on the surface of the grain or mass. Combustion is the burning of the grain from the ignited surface, inward or outward, as the case may be. Density is the ratio of the weight of a grain of gun- powder to that of an equal volume of water under standard conditions. It varies from 1.68 to 1.90, i-arely exceeding 1.85. Gravimetric Density is the ratio of a given volume of powder to that of an equal volume of water under standard conditions. Density of Loading is the ratio of the weight of a charge of gunpowder to the weight, under standard conditions, of the volume of water that would fill the powder-chamber. W Its value is 27.68 — , in which W is the weight of the FIELD-ABTILLERY. 363 charge in pounds, and G the volume of the chamber in inches. Initial Air-space is the portion of the chamber in a loaded gun or shell unoccupied by solid matter before firing. The Reduced Length of any volume in the bore of a gun is the height of a right cylinder of the same volume, but with a diameter equal to the calibre of the gun. An Adiabatic Transformation is a change that takes place in the state of a gas within an envelope impermeable to heat, or which occurs in such a short space of time that no heat is received or lost by it. Detonation is exceedingly quick explosion. Slow Powders are those which are not entirely burned when the projectile leaves the muzzle. Velocity of Emission is the ratio of the amount of a unit weight of powder, burned in air in a small increment of time, to the time itself. The Sectional Density is equal to the weight of the pro- jectile divided by the square of its diameter. Spherical Density is the ratio of the weight of the pro- jectile to that of a sphere whose radius is equal to that of the right section of the projectile. Similar Guns. — Two guns are similar when all their hom- ologous lineal dimensions are proportional to their calibre. Similarly Loaded. — When the weight of charge and pro- jectile are proportional to the cube of the calibre, and the grains of powder are alike in form and composition, with diiriensions proportional to the calibre. EXTERIOE BALLISTICS. Exterior Ballistics treats of the motion of a projectile in air after it has left the piece. Trajectory. — The curve described by the centre of gravity of the projectile during its passage through the air. (Figs. 102 and 103.). 364 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERY. Line of Fire. — The prolongation of the axis of the piece. Plane of Fire. — The vertical plane containing the line of fire. line of Sight. — The straight line passing through the sights and the point aimed at. (Figs. 102 and 103.) Plane of Sight. — The vertical plane containing the line of sight. Angle of Sight. — The angle made by the line of sight with the horizontal, (s in Fig. 102.) Line of Departure.— The line in which the projectile is moving when it leaves the gun. .devotion. Pig. 103. Plan. Fig. 103. Angle of Departure.— The angle made by the line of de- parture with the horizontal, {d in Fig. 102.) Angle of Elevation.— The angle made by the axis of the piece with the horizontal (q in Fig. 102. ) FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 365 The Jump. — The difEerence between the angle of eleva- tion and the angle of departure, owing to the movement of the gun at discharge. (/ in Fig. 102.) (The jump of 3.2 in. and 3.6 in. guns varies from 20 minutes at 1 degree to 30 minutes at 10 degrees elevation.) Initial Velocity.— The velocity of the projectile at the muzzle. Bemaining Velocity.— The velocity at any point of the trajectory. Final Velocity.— The velocity at the end of the range. . Range. — The horizontal distance from the muzzle to the point where the projectile strikes. Drift. — The departure of the projectile from the plane of fire. With guns having a right-handed twist it is to the right, and its extent varies nearly as the square of the range. Direct Fire is from guns with service charges at all angles of elevation not exceeding 15°. Indirect or Curved Fire is from guns with less than service charges, and from howitzers and mortars, at all angles of elevation not exceeding 15°. High-angle Fire is from guns, howitzers, and mortars, at all angles exceeding 15°. Front or Frontal Fire is that which is directed per- pendicularly, or nearly so, to the general line of troops fired at. HIGH ANGLE TIRC. HOWlTZERSi ^^ „„eES _,..,— -'1S"«ECT OR CURVCO FIRE. AB0VE18> SWCTFWE. \ '"""■»™)au.CHAR tH ^ CD « tH « CO on t-t 05 iH iH iH tH iH 1-H T-( T-t W G4 w To Preserve White Rope. — Dip when dry into a hath containing 30 grms. (ahout seTen tenths of an ounce) of sulphate of copper per litre (a little over one quart) of water; soak for four days and dry. ^Then soak in a solu- tion of 100 grms. (3.5 oz.) of soap per litre of water. Iron-wire Rope. — Its breaking weight in tons is about equal to the square of the circumference in inches. Steel-wire Rope.— It is from 2 to 2^ times stronger than ii'on-wire rope. Wire rope can be safely worked in field service to one half its breaking weight. To Preserve Wire Rope. — Apply linseed-oil with a piece of sheepskin, wool inside ; or mix the oil with equal parts of Spanish brown and lampblack. If used underground or in water, take mineral or vegetable tar, add one bushel of fresh-slaked lime to barrel of tar, boil it well, and then saturate the rope with the boiling tar. Chains. — Chains, when used in place of ropes, should be examined to see that every link is free from flaws and not too much worn. The chain should have no kinks in it, and each return, when more than one is used, should bear its proper strain. Do not work a chain over a windlass of 394 A BANHBOOK FOR LIGBT ARTILLERY. small diameter ; the iron of the links breaks by bending, not by tensile strength. Lubricate freely. BAFE "WORKING STRAIN FOR FIELD 8ERVICK, AND 'WEIIGHT IN FATHOMS. Circum- ference. Wire Ropes Hawser-laid. Bound-link Crane-chain, Length of Link not Exceeding Five Diameters of the Iron. Iron. Safe Working Strain. Steel. Safe Working Strain. Weight per Fathom. Diameter ■ of Iron of Link. Safe Working Strain. Weight per Fathom. Inches. 1^ li H 2 2i 34 f 3i 34 4 f : Cwts. "io" 131 21i 40 50 60 77 93 109 125 157i 210 348 Cwts. 112 195" 345' 375" 450 545 669 Lbs. '6!94 1.5 3.5 3.5 4.5 5.75 6.5 7.5 8.5 10.75 13.35 17.75 31.5 Inches. ? 1^ Cwg. 15 . 22 82 ■ 45 65 75 92 112 185 157 182 310 340 Lbs. 2.1 4.-88 7.36 10.57 18.0 16.0 31.0 35.0 39.0 86.0 43.0 46.5 58.0 68.5 BLOCKS, TACKLE, ETC. Blocks are of two kinds, made and mortised. A made block consists of four parts: shell, sheave, strap, &ndi bush. A mortised block is made of a single block of wood, mortised out to receive a sheave. Blocks are single, double, or treble, according to the number of sheaves. A Tackle is a purchase formed by reeving a rope through two or more blocks for the purpose of hoisting. PlELD-AttTlLtmr. 395 A Whip is a purchase' made by a rope rove through one single block. A Gun-tackle Purchase is a rope rove through two single blocks, and made fast to the strap of the upper block. The parts of all tackles between the fasts and sheave are called the standing parts. The parts between the sheaves are the running parts, and the part which is taken hold of in hoisting is called the fall. A Whip upon Whip is where the block of one whip is made fast to the fall of another. A LufF-tackle Purchase is a single and a double block, the end of the rope being fast to the upper part of the single block, and the -fall coming from the double block. A luff-tackle upon the fall of another luff-tackle is called luff upon luff. A Watch-tackle or Tail-tackle is a luff-tackle purchase, with a hook in the end of the single block, and a tail to the upper end of the double block. A Single Burton is composed of two single blocks, with a hook in the bight of the running part. Reeve the end of rope through the upper block, and make it fast to the strap of the fly-block. Then make fast your hook to the bight of the rope, and reeve the other end through the fly- block for a fall. The hook is made fast by passing the bight of the rope through the eye of the hook and over the whole. This is a very quick-working tackle and a strong purchase. Used for hoisting entirely. When a very heavy weight is to be raised, the standing part should be attached to the slings by a fisherman's bend instead of to the block. The size of blocks is expressed by the length of the shell in inches. Tackles are also designated by the number of sheaves employed, as twofold (two single blocks), threefold (double and single block), etc. 396 A HANDBOOK FOR LIOBT ABTILLERT. The bight of a hook is the middle of the bend of tlie hook part. Eope should always be stopped up, either with the end or with rope-yarn stops, to prevent its getting into a snarl. When using ropes for hauling, they should never be dragged upon the ground. Before reeving a rope in a block the turn should be care- fully taken out, to prevent twisting when the weight is lifted. This is done by stretching the rope out to its full length, and turning it in the opposite direction to that in which it is laid up until all the stiffness disappears. Blocks should be overhauled very often to see that the sheaves are working properly on the pins, and that they work smoothly. If i;hey do not, turn the pins end for end and rub a little black lead (graphite) on them to lubricate them; also on the sides of the sheaves where they rub against the shell. When hoisting with tackles, they should never be allowed to twist. If they show a tendency to do so, insert a bar in the block or sling, and use it as a lever to hold it straight. It frequently happens that the men cannot apply their full strength in the direction in which it would be most effective. In such cases hook a single block to some object about two feet above the ground and reeve the end of the fall through it, so that the men can add their strength to their weight, and more men can apply themselves. Never trust the suspension of a weight to holding it by the unaided strength of men. If it is possible to get a turn around any fixed object, even in raising or hauling a weight, it is best to take a turn, as all that is gained is then saved. Always select such blocks that the fall will run freely through them, and not ride upon the edges of the sheaves. If it does, it will be certain to cut. The rope should not quite fill the groove on the sheave. In this way excessive friction is avoided. FIELD-ABTILLEB T. 397 The power gained by using tackle is as follows: Two single blocks, or gun-tackle: nearly doubled. Luff-tackle, double and single block: doubled. If the double block is movable, trebled. Two double blocks: power X 3-J. Double and treble blocks : power X 4. Two treble blocks: power X 4-J. Whip upon whip (single Burton): trebled. When one tackle is applied to another, the power obtained is found by multiplying their respective values together. No advantage is gained by using a greater number of sheaves than two treble blocks in one fall. The power is equal to the weight divided by the number of ropes (standing parts) attached to the lower block, or by twice the number of rising pulleys (sheaves). KNOTS, HITCHES, ETC. Thumb-knot (Fig. 108). — Used to prevent the end from unfraying, or to prevent its slipping through a fall. Figure-eight Knot (Fig. 109). — Used to prevent the end from unfraying, or to prevent its slipping through a fall. Fig. 108. Fig. 109. Fig. 110. Fig. 113. Reef-knot (Fig. 110).— For joining two ends of rope or chain together. Singlesheet Bend (Fig. 111).— For joining dry ropes of unequal size. 398 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT AMTILLEBT. Doublesheet Bend (Fig. 113). — Same for wet ropes. Draw-knot (Fig. 113). — Same when it may be required to cast them loose. Bunning-knot (Fig. 114). — Q^o form a loop that will draw taut. Bowline (Fig. 115). — To form a loop at the end of a rope which will not slip. Half-Hitch. — For securing the loose ends of lashings. Two Half-hitches (Fig. 116). — For making fast a rope- end to an object. Clove-hitch (Fig. 117). — Two half -hitches, used for com- mencement and finish of lashings; making fast the end or the bight of a rope to any object. Fig. 115. Fig. 117 Timber-hitch (Fig. 118).— Used on pieces of timber, or in making fast to spars, where the weight will keep the rope taut, FIELDrARTILLEBT. 399 Round Turn and Two Half-hitches (Fig. 119).— For making fast a rope so that the strain shall not jam the hitches. Fisherman's Bend (Fig. 120). — For making fast where there is give and take motion, as when a boat is at anchor. Fig. 119. FiQ. 120. Fig. 121. Lever-hitch (Fig. 121).— For drawing pickets, fixing rounds of rope-ladder, bars to, or loops on, drag-ropes. Man's Harness-Hitch (also Fig. 131). — Loop to pass over at end of rvpe. Fig. 122. Fig. 123. shoulder. To fix a rope with a weight on it rapidly to £i block. 400 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. Cat's-paw (Fig. 123). — At the end or in the middle of a rope for hooking on a block. Blackwall Hitch (Fig. 123).— Simple hitch with pliable rope and fixed weight. Used to transfer the strain from one rope to another, or to secure a tackle to a rope for a horizontal pull. Stopper Hitch (Fig. 124).— To shift the strain off a rope temporarily. Fig. 124. Magnus Hitch (Fig. 125). — For making fast to round spars. Pig. 126. Fio: 127: Sheepshank (Fig. 126).— To shorten a rope without cut- ting it. FIELB-ARTILLEB Y. 401 LASHINGS. Square Lashing (Fig. 127).— Make fast one end (the fixed if there be one) of the lashing-rope to one of the objects to be lashed by a timber- or clove-hitch, or by passing the eye-end of the ro^e under it, bringing it up and passing the other end through the eye ; then, after hauling taut, pass it round the second object, round the first, up again round the second, and down round the first, continuing this until a sufficient number of returns are made, when the whole of the returns are tightened by bringing the end round the returns between the objects two or three times, and making fast with two half-hitches on either of the first returns or one of the objects. If the returns on one of the spars lie in succession out- side the returns first applied, they must lie in succession in- side those first applied on the other spar. Diagonal Lashing (Fig. 128).— Begin with a timber- hitch or running-bowline round both spars and draw them together ; then take three or four turns across each fork and finish with f rapping- turns. Wedges with well-rounded points are often useful for tightening lashings. Sheer Lashing. — The lashing is made fast to the lower spar, above where they cross, with a timber-hitch ; as Fig. 138. many turns are taken around both spars towards the feet as may be necessary to cover the cross, and the end is then 402 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. led around this lashing and both spars where they cross and four or five frapping-turns taken so as to bring them together, and the ends made fast around the upper spar above the cross. Gin lashing (Fig. 129).— The three l^s of the gin are placed so that the centre one is pointing in the opposite direction to that of the others, all being parallel, the upper ends resting on a skid and two inches ap^rt. The lashing is commenced with a clove-hitch on an outside spar and carried over and under loosely and without riding six times. Two frapping-turns are taken in each interval and the whole finished off with two half -hitches round one of the spars. Iron chain is much better than rope for these fastenings. Fishing Spars. — This consists in strengthening spars by lashing others parallel to them. The fishing spars- should be placed against the spar to be fished so that they may take ofE as much strain and be in as close contact as possi- ble. Lashing-ropes should then be applied round all of the spars until they are all firmly bound together. Frapping. — The drawing together the several returns of a lashing so as to tauten it. The rope used for frapping is generally the running-end of the lashing itself; after hav- ing frapped, the end of the rope is made fast by two half- hitches, one around all the returns, the other on half only. BRIDGES. Weight. — Infantry in column of fours when crowded is allowed per lineal foot 560 pounds. Cavalry under same conditions is allowed 700 pounds. Field-artillery in column of sections weighs 400 pounds per lineal foot, so that a bridge built for infantry will carry it. In calculating the strength of parts of bridges the FIELV-ABTILLEBY. 403 live load must be doubled to bring it to dead load if weight is to be applied suddenly. Formula for weight that may be borne safely by a beam supported at both ends and loaded in the centre: W- ^^'^ W being the weight in pounds, I the distance between the points of support, d the depth, and b the breadth, all expressed in inches. S is a, coefficient whose value for different kinds of wood is given in the following table : Ash 3000 Beech 1700 Birch 1900 Yellow Pine. 1100 Larch 1300 Oak 1600 Strength of Round Timber. — The strength of a circular pole is six tenths that of a square beam whose side is equal to the mean diameter of the pole; so that the equation be- comes W = , in which d is the mean diameter. 101 The bridge must be capable of sustaining the weight when crowded; and while the load for infantry is usually distributed, the greatest strain is brought on the balks, or road-bearers, when the gun-wheels are at the centre of the bay; and a balk will only bear half the load concentrated at its centre that it will bear when distributed. Roadway and Approaches. — The roadway may be of planks 1^ to 3 inches for ordinary traffic, or of poles, fas- cines, hurdles, etc. Litter or earth should be scattered over it to deaden the rattle of planks, which is apt to frighten the horses, and preserve the roadway. If heavy loads are to be hauled, planks should be laid longitudinally to form wheel-tracks. Bight feet in the clear will suffice for width of roadway, but nine feet is to be preferred. A hand-rail should be provided, especially if horses are to pass, and rib- bands on either side. At least five balks (road-bearers) 404 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERT. should be used on a bridge nine feet wide. The bays gen- erally run from ten to fifteen feet. A rise in the centre of the bridge, called the camber, is allowed for the subsequent settling. This allowance is usually one thirtieth of the bay. The approaches are very important ; the exit must be fully as good as the entrance, to avoid crowding. If not, care must be taken not to ad- mit troops at the entrance faster than they can pass off. Kamps at either end steeper than one on ten are incon- venient. TRESTLES, PIERS, ETC. Transoms. — They must be sufficiently strong to bear the weight that can be concentrated on one bay, reckoned as distributed load on the transom. On a 9-foot roadway for light artillery, with bays of 15 feet, the transoms should not be less than 9 inches in diam- eter. Trestles are used for bridges across shallow rivers having sound hg,rd beds and not liable to sudden floods; and for gaps, etc. They are not suitable for deep muddy rivers. They may be used in streams 9 feet deep with Velocity of 4 miles an hour; or in deeper streams if the current be less. Two-legged Trestle (Pig. 130). — The standards, transom, and ledger are marked at the proper intervals, the heights of the first having been obtained by a careful inspection, and the lengths of the two latter depending on the width of the proposed roadway. The transoms should be about 3 feet longer than the width of the roadway in the clear, and the standards of the trestle should have a splay outward of six on one. Square lashings must be used. The braces are put on the frame with both butts and one tip on the same side, the second tip on the reverse side; the butts can be lashed simultaneously with the ledger and transom. The frame must then be squared by testing the diagonals. FIELD-ARTILLERT. 406 measuring from the butt of each standard, and the frame must be adjusted until these measurements are equal. The braces can then be lashed at the tips and crossing-point. Fm. 130. If the timber is weak, both legs and transom can be doubled. Ledgers and diagonal braces can be of light material, as little strain is brought upon them; but they should be well lashed. Placing Trestles. — They are most easily placed by hand; but with those with two legs d^j care must be taken that they do not fall over. Each frame should be fastened to either bank; cables or struts may be used. Three-legged Trestles (Fig. 131), two of which are required for a smgle transom, have the advantage of standing with- out bracing, admit of ready adjustment, and utilize light material. They are, however, unsuitable for an uneven bottom, are extremely difficult to place, excepting by hand, and the legs require weighting in water. To make them, lash two legs together by a sheer lashing, open them out and then add the third leg; the trestle must then be up- ended, the feet placed on the angles of an equilateral tri- 406 A HAWDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTtLLERT. angle with sides about half the height, and three light ledgers attached. Fig. 131. Cribs, Gabions, and Fascines.— These are also used for supporting roadways, the two latter are particularly useful for short gaps. LiDibers.-Bridges supported on transoms lashed across the tops of limber-wheels may be used. FRAME BRIDGES. If a trestle bridge is impracticable, owing to depth of gap or stream, unevenness of bottom, or swiftness of cur- rent, a frame bridge may be used. Fig. 133. Single Lock. — This is suitable for spans not exceeding 30 feet, measured between the footing of the frames. IPIELD- ARTILLERY. 407 The slope of the frames when in position must not exceed four on seven. 1st. Prepare footings 18 inches wider apart on one side than the other. They must be correctly squared or the frames will not lock. 2d. Measure the gap and lay out section of it on the ground with a line and pickets, allowing for camber. 3d. Lay out the standards in the section, and chalk- mark them at the proper positions for lashing ledgers and transoms. 4tli. Lash the frames in position on either side of the gap; butts of standards towards the bank, ledger lashed on the top of standards, about two feet from the butts, but posi- tion varied according to nature of footings, transom lashed underneath. The splay of legs in a frame is not so great as in a two-legged trestle, one foot difference between transom and ledger generally sufficing ; the transom of narrow frame 18 inches wider than the width of roadway in the clear between ribbands. Square the frames carefully before lashing the braces; see that the distance apart of the butts corresponds to the footings, broad frame to be 18 inches wider than the narrow. Drive pickets or large piece of timber (bollard) for guys and foot-ropes. 5th. Attach fore and back guys and foot-ropes to each frame, the latter fastened with a timber-hitch round the standards below the ledgers. 6th. Pass across the fore guys, passing those of the nar- row frame between the horns of the broad frame. 7th. Launch and lock the frames. 8th. Send out temporarily two road-bearers and by their means and with the aid of two men working on the crutch of the bridge get the fork-transom in position. 9th. Send out remainder of road -bearers, resting the whole on the fork-transom. 408 A HANDBOOK FOR LIQET ARTILLERY. 10th. Place planks (chesses); rack down; put up hand- rail. ESTIMATE OF TIMBER. Kind of No. of Spars. Length in Ft. Diam . in Ins. Purpose. Bridge. At Tip. Mean. Single- lock (30-ft. Span). 4 1 2 4 4 10 4 34 15 15 15 20 20 20 7 ■■■3"' 3 "io"' 6 4to6 Standards. Fork-transoms. Transoms. Ledgers and shore-tranBOitis. Diagonal braces. Balks. Ribbands. If the stores are at hand and ready for use, 1 non-com- missioned officer and 16 men on each side should complete the bridge in a little more than an hour. Double-lock Bridge. — This is used for spans of 30 to 45 feet. In laying out Ihe section and making the spars for the double-lock bridge it must be remembered that the road-bearing transoms, TT, in this case are not the transoms lashed to the frames, but those which are subsequently lashed on the top of the distance-pieces. The frames are of equal widths. In making the bridge the frames after being launched are held by the back guys a little higher than their ultimate position. The distance- FIELD-ARTILLERT. 409 • pieces are then hauled across, the proper positions for the road-bearing transoms having been previously marked upon them ; these transoms are then sent out and lashed in posi- tion, after which the back guys can be eased off and the bridge allowed to lock ; the roadway is then laid. ESTIMATE OF TIMBER. Diaiu. in In. Kind of No. of Spars. 'irit'' Purpose. Bridge. 4.t Tip. Mean. Double- 4 ' 30 7 Standards. lock 2 ' 25 io Distance-pieces. (40 to 45 3 15 10 Boad-traDsoms. Ft. Span.) 2 15 6 Main transoms. 4 15 4 to 6 Ledgers andshore-transoms. 4r 20 3 Braces. , 15 . 20 6 Balks. ■ 6 20 3 Bibbands. Single-sUng Bridges, used to 50 feet. — The frames for a single-sling bridge have an upper (locking) and lower Stntfl^Sliny Stiffened'- (road-bearing) transom. In laying out the section the frames must be made to lock at such a height as to have at 410 A BANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. least 9 feet of headway between the roadway and the upper transoms. As soon as the spars of the narrow frame are in position for lashing the distance from out to out of its standards at the upper transom must be measured, and the broad frame made of sufficient width to receive them. A snatch-block with a fall rove through it is lashed to the tip of each standard of the narrow frame. The frames having been locked, the fork-transom is hauled into posi- tion by means of the falls and men working in the crutch. The falls are then used to sling the centre transom tempo- rarily into position. The slings are then arranged by men working in the crutch and astride the slung transom, one of the guys being generally used for the purpose ; three or four turns are sufficient, care being taken that they do not ride. The slings, if too long, can be subsequently twisted up with handspikes to give the requisite camber to the roadway. A Treble-sling Bridge has three slung transoms, one being slung from the standards on either side between the JS'Me.&ingStijnma/. fork and road-bearing transoms. The process of con- struction is similar to that of a single-sling. If the frames are very long and heavy, it is well to brace them above as well as below the road-bearing transoms to prevent their getting racked out of shape in launching. The upper braces, if they interfere with the headway, can be removed MELD-ABTtLLER T. 411 after the frames are locked. The great length of the stand- ards in single- and treble-sling bridges, and the heavy trans- verse strains brought upon them by the weight of the roadway, will generally necessitate their being stiffened by ties which should be carried over vertical frames anchored to earth anchorages, or stout bollards on the bank, and twisted up taut with a handspike. Can be used for spans up to 70 feet. ESTIMATE OF TIMBER. Kind of No. of Spars. Length in Ft. Diam. in In. Purpose. Bridge. At Tip. Mean. Single- sling (50 to 60 Ft. Span). 4 3 3 4 4* 10 4 m 15 15 15 18 30 30 6 "3"' '"io" 6 4to6 '■'e" Standards. Road-transoms. Top and fork transoms. Ledgers and shore-transoms. Braces. Balks. Ribbands. * Or 8 if upper braces are used. For a treble-sling bridge standards from 50 to 60 feet long will be required; also additional spars for transoms, road-bearers, and vertical frames. THE STRINGER BRIDGE. If the span does not exceed 25 feet, abutments good, and proper timber near at hand, this bridge can be easily built. Six stringers and fifty flooring-poles, 6 inches in diameter and 12 feet long, will be required. Two axemen to each stringer will fell and prepare them in a few minutes, and while they are being carried and placed in position the axe- men can prepare the poles. Stringers should have i feet extra length. Their diameter will depend on the weight 412 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. TABLE OF TOOLS AND MATERIALS FOU SINGLE- AND DOUBLE-LOCK AND UNSTIFFENED SINGLE-SLING BRIDGES. Descriptions. Single- lock. Double- lock. Single- sling. Axes, pick. . . . Blocks, snatch. ... . , Chisel, brick Hammers, striking. . Handspikes Levers, field-service. Mauls Measuring-rods Shovels Measuring-tapes. .. . TooU. Materials. Chalk, pieces , Lines, Hambro', 150 ft Planks for chesses, 10 ft. X 12 in. X li in Pickets, 5 ft. long, for bollards Pickets, bundles of tracing Racksticks and lashing Foot-ropes, 3 in., 9 fathoms , Guys, 3in., 20 to 30 fathoms Ropes, 2 in., 18 fathoms each Ropes, 2 in., 8 fathoms, for transom-lashings. . . Ropes, li in., 5 fathoms, for ledger- find brace- lashings Ropes, 1 in ., 3 fathoms, for road-bearers Tapes, tracing, 150 ft Yarn, spun, lbs \\\ 2 1 Accor 10 1 Accor 4 8 12 10 1 7 3 1 ding 10 1 liing t 4 8 8 14 20 1 7 4 4 6 1 2 1 6 1 4 1 o span 10 1 o span 4 8 2 8 14 20 to be borne, how distributed, and kind of wood. It is de- termined by the formulas already given. A good rougli rule for calculating the live load which can be borne by rectangular timber of given length and scantling is: For larch safe distributed live load in cwts. (112 lbs.) in which * = breadth in inches, d= depth in inches, L = length of span in feet. FIELD-ARTILLERT. 413 For fir the load may be ^, lor cedar |, for beech, oak, and pitch-pine 3, and for teak J of load of larch. This formula gives a theoretical factor of safety of about 3. The stringers are placed in position by means of jump- ing-poles, each of which should be strong enough to bear the weight of the stringer and a little longer than the hy- pothenuse of the right-angled triangle, the base and per- pendicular of which are respectively three . fourths the width and depth of the chasm. Place first stringer on abutment as a .temporary wall- plate and chock it; slide the second and third over the chasm a little more than one fourth their length for a foot- way; push out one jumping^-pole, butt first, until nearly balanced on wall-plate stringer, and pass the bight of a rope around it a little in advance of its centre of gravity, by means of which a man on tlie footway supports the butt while the pole is being slipped forward until it reaches its proper resting-place (while this is being done the ends of the stringers forming the footway are held down); then placesecond jumping-pole in position;' draw back the two stringers forming footway; cross jumping-poles, lashing them about 3 feet above the level of the abutment, and attach guy-rope long enough to reach across the stream; place stringer in crutch and push forward until nearly bal- anced; then raise end and push so as to throw it forward and cause the other end to rest on the opposite abutment. Four men now cross over on the stringer, steadying them- selves by means of the guy-rope held taut for the purpose, lift the stringer off the jumping-poles, and, with assistance from opposite side, roll the stringer in position. Pull back ]umping-poles and place the other stringers. The flooring is laid as for corduroy roads, and the bridge is finished by pinning on a ribband of poles to hold down the ends of the flooring and erecting hand-rails if required. 414 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT AB.TILLEBT. It is well to cover the roadway with straw to lessen the jolting of carriages. FOEDS, FLYING AND FLOATING BRIDGES. When reconnoitring a river with a view of effecting a passage, observe : the nature of the banks, the nature of the bed, position and depth of fords, strength of current, whether tidal or otherwise, probability and extent of floods. Fords. — The following depths are fordable: For in- fantry, 3 ft. ; for cavalry, 4 ft. ; wagons containing ammu- nition, 2^ ft. Gravelly bottoms are best ; sandy bottoms are bad, as the sand stirs up and increases depth of water. Fords should be clearly marked by long pickets driven into the bed of the river above and below the ford, their heads being connected by a strong rope. It is well to mark the pickets, in order that any rise of the water may be at once evident. The depth of a river is generally most uniform in straight parts; at bends the depth will generally be greater at the concave bank, and lees at the convex. For this reason a river which is not anywhere fordable straight across may be found passable in a slanting direction between two bends. To measure the velocity of a stream, use a light rod weighted at the end so as to stand vertically in the water; note the distance it floats in a given number of seconds; then seven tenths the mean number of feet a second gives the number of miles an hour. Ferries and Flying Bridges. — The simplest form of per- manent ferry consists of ropes stretched across the river by means of which rafts can be hauled from bank to bank. The flying bridge can be used if the velocity of the cur- rent is two miles an hour or more. The current moves the boat or raft across the stream by acting obliquely against its side, which should be kept at an angle of about FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 415 55 degrees with the current. The cable, whose length should be 1^ to 2 times the width of the river, and float if possible, can either be anchored in midstream (in which case the boat can swing between two landing-places), or two cables may be used, one anchored on either bank. Or a cable may be stretched from bank to bank as taut as pos- sible and six feet above the water at the lowest point. The boat (a double-ender) is attached to trayellers, which are small wheels grooved on the circumference to fit the cable on which they ride, maintained in their position by a counterpoise below, to which the stem- and stern-lines of the boat are attached. Long, narrow, deep boats with verti- cal sides, to which leeboards can be attached, are the best for the purpose, and straight reaches of a river the most suitable places for flying bridges. Floating Bridges. — These can be made of boats, barrels, timber, etc. Each pier must have enough available buoyancy to sup- port the heaviest load that can be brought on one bay of the bridge. The length of the piers should be at least twice the breadth of the roadway, for steadiness, and they should be connected together at their extremities by tie- balks or lashings. The waterway between the piers should never be less, and should if possible be more, than the width of those piers. In barrel-pier bridges, or with boats having strong gun- nels and frames, each balk bears on both gunnels of ad- jacent piers; in weak boats they bear on a central beam supported on the keel. The roadway of floating bridges is similar to that already described. Boats. — Open boats should not be immersed deeper than within one foot of the gunnel, and a still larger limit of gafety will be required in rough water or a violent current. 416 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT AUTILLERT. They should be placed "stem on" in the bridge so as to point against the current, and slightly down by the stern; if the river be tidal, they alternate stem and stern. Few boats, except heavy barges, are strong enough for balks to rest on their gunnels. Use a central transom resting on the thwarts and blocked up from underneath to bring the weight directly on the keel. Buoyancy. — This may be determined by loading the boat with unarmed men to such a depth as is considered safe. For bridging purposes the number of men multiplied by 160 gives the available buoyancy in pounds. If the number of men be divided by four, the result will be the central interval in feet at which the boats may be placed in the bridge to carry infantry in fours crowded. KASTS OF CASKS OE BARRELS. Buoyancy of Casks. — The actual buoyancy is given by the formula bc^ — W, in which c is the circumference of the cask in feet half-way between the bung and the extreme end; I is the length in feet, exclusive of projections, meas- ured along a stave; and Tf is the weight of the cask in pounds. The available buoyancy for bridging purposes may be taken at ^ of the actual buoyancy. A safe buoyancy may be obtained by multiplying the content in gallons by 8 J. Knowing the buoyancy of one cask, the number to be united in a raft to sustain any desired load can be readily calculated. Constructing the Float.— Having determined on the number of casks to be united in one float, take one third the number and place them transversely on two poles laid on the ground parallel to each other and one half the height of a cask apart; the casks to be distributed evenly over a distance equal to the width of the proposed bridge, FIELD-ABTILLEB T. 417 bungs up. Lay another pair of poles on the top of the casks, and lash them to the first pair at the ends and be- tween each two casks, and cut off any surplus pole that may project at the ends. Having made and launched three such floats, unite them by lashing a pole across the ends and middle of them, so as to make a large square raft. When enough such rafts are completed, they can be placed, and a roadway built on them. In placing the rafts the sides of the barrels should be towards the current. Floats of casks, when in bridge, should always be rigidly connected with each other at their ends by stringers, which must be lashed to both gunnels of each float; the roadway stringers can then be laid and should rest squarely on both gunnels of each float and should be lashed, especially if there be any sway or for animal trafiic. TABLE OF WEIGHTS, DIMENSIONS, CAPACITY, ETC. Name. Weight. Length of Stave. Bung Diam. Head Diam. No. Gals. Available Buoyancy. Tar Pork Lbs. 50 60 80 80 70 70 Inches. 30 30 34 34 34 34 Inches. m 23 33i 33i 25 25 Inches. 17i 18i ISI 31 21 30 32 45 45 45 53 Lbs. (About). 250 267 Vinegar "Whiskey Kerosene.' Molasses 375 875 375 433 American wine-barrels are about the same size and weight as whiskey-barrels. Eafts. — Eaft bridges may be used in a current not ex- ceeding four miles an hour. Cubic content of a log in feet is equal to the square of one fifth of the mean girth multiplied by twice its length. Weight of timber (dry) per cubic foot: Ash 47 lbs., beech 43, elm 36, fir 32, oak 54, pine 40, poplar 24, sycar 418 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBY. more 37, willow 35. Green timber . is about one fourth heavier. Flotation. — To obtain the flotation of a log, multiply its cubic content by the difference between its weight per cubic foot and the weight of a cubic foot of water (62 J lbs.). Take five sixths of the result for the available buoyancy. To Form a Eaft. — Place the logs side by side, the small ends alternating; strongly secure with rope and, if pos- sible, by cross and diagonal pieces of scantling fastened by spikes or treenails. If it is to be used as a pier, the logs may be placed in two layers to avoid obstructing the water- way. A central transom must be used. The up-stream end of the raft may, with advantage, be convex. Make-shift Anchors.— Two or more pickaxes lashed to- gether; heavy weights, such as large stones or railway irons; the latter are best when bent. Nets filled with stones are particularly good on rocky bottoms. Protection. — ^Arrangements must be made up-stream to protect a floating bridge from damage from floating sub- stances, either by a boat patrol, or by stretching a net, or some intercepting obstacle, across stream. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 419 OHAPTEE XIII. Hasty Demolition. Gunpowder. Dynamite. How Used in Blast- ing. Guncotton. Kack-a-rock. Handling, Transportation, and Storage of High Explosives. Charges for Hasty Demoli- tion. Where and How to Place Charges. GUNPOWDER. Gunpowder is a very intimate mixture of potassium nitrate (nitre), charcoal, and sulphur, and generally con- sists of the following proportions: Nitre, 75 parts; charcoal, 15 parts; sulphur, 10 parts. The following processes are used in its manufacture: (1) Mixing the ingredients; (3) iucorporating or "mill- ing"; (3) breaking down the mill-cake; (4) pressing; (5) granulating; (6) dusting; (7) glazing; (8) second dusting ; (9) stoving or drying ; (10) finishing. Good gunpowder should be composed of hard angular grains which do not soil the fingers, and should have a perfectly uniform dark -gray color. When new, it should be free from dust, and a gramme of it flashed on a copper or porcelain plate should leave no residue or foulness. It should give the required initial velocity to the pro- jectile, and produce not more than the maximum strain upon the gun. When exposed to air of average dryness, it should not absorb more than 0.5 to 1.5 per cent of water. In damp air it absorbs more and deteriorates. Its exploding-point is 560° P. 420 A HANDBOOK FOR LIOET ABTILLEBT. DYNAMITE. Dynamite is composed of a particularly porous siliceous earth (Keiselguhr) impregnated with about 70 or 75 per cent of nitro-glycerine. True dynamite resembles in ap- pearance moist brown sugar. It takes fire at 350° P., and freezes. MATBKIALS I2Sr USB FOR BLASTING. Cartridges. — The regular sizes are from four to eight inches long and from three fourths of an inch to two inches in diameter. They are furnished to order of any required size, packed in boxes containing 25 or 50 pounds, the layers of cartridges being separated by sawdust. To use a small cartridge in a large hole, slit it on the side and press it down into the drill-hole with a wooden tamping-rod. Cartridges may be readily cut into desired lengths. In tamping powder or explosives always use a wooden rammer, never an iron or steel bar. Caps. — The regular cap or exploder is employed. It consists of a hollow copper cylinder about \ inch in diam- eter and from one to two inches long, and contains 15 to 30 per cent or more of fulminate of mercury mixed with other ingredients into a cement, which fills the closed end of the cap. Fuzes. — The double-tape fuze is the best. Single-tape fuze may be used when the ground is only a little wet. Nippers and Pincers. — For cutting the fuze, and after it is inserted in the cap for squeezing the cap tightly around the fuze. .Funnel. — Used in charging with loose powder. DRILL-HOLES, As a general rule drill-holes and charges for dynamite should be comparatively small. In heavy work the holes PIELD-ARTILLEBT. 421 should be large in size and less in number, and the amount of dynamite should be in proportion to the work done. Charging with Cartridges.— The charge must fit and fill the bottom of the bore, and be packed solid. Take a car- tridge as nearly as possible of the same size as the bore, and cut it into sections of about twice or three times the diameter. With a hard-wood rammer, as large as will run freely in the hole, press these sections into the bore-hole one by one with sufiBcient force until each section is driven to the bottom and expanded laterally so as to fill the hole solidly in every direction. If the cartridge is smaller than the hole, slit it lengthwise. Metallic rammers must not be used. Priming. — Cut off squarely the end of the fuze and thrust it into the cap up to the fulminate. If the fuze is too large, scrape it down, and if too small wind it with paper. Then clamp the cap to the fuze with the nippers, being careful not to disturb the fulminate in the cap. If for a wet hole, smear the Junction of the fuze and the cap with bar-soap or the like, to make it water-tight. Now open the end of the cartridge, and with a pointed stick make a hole in the explosive and insert the cap (with the fuze attached) the full length of the cap, and press the ex- plosive firmly about the cap. Next gather the cartridge- paper about the fuze and tie it there strongly with a string, so that the cap cannot be withdrawn from the explosive. Cut off so much of the cartridge as is not needed, and the primer is complete. Thus prepared, place it in the drill- hole and press it with a wooden rod into contact with the charge. Tamping. — This is of great importance. Always tamp if you can, and with the best materials and in the strongest manner. In deep and down holes water is good. A shallow tamp of water amounts to very little. A shallow tamp of sand or clay is better. In driving and packing the 4:22 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLERY. tamp next to the primer be careful not to explode the cap; the first handful of tamp should always be pressed down gently. In fissures or artificial cracks surround the charge with mud, clay, sand, or water, if possible. Explosion of Blast. — In most cases it is better not to cut off the required length of fuze until the hole is tamped. Then cut off at a safe length and fire by igniting with a match or fuzee. If it misses fire, be careful in taking out the tamping not to approach nearer the cap than within two or three inches; then put in another cartridge and fire it. Never pick out the charge. After inserting the primer it is well to put a ball of newspaper or some sub- stance readily recognized on top of it and then the tamp- ing. If then the tamping has to be removed, warning will be given on approaching the primer. To Insure Explosion. — The dynamite must not be frozen ; the fuze must be good and kept in the cap; the cap must be dry and not withdrawn from the explosive. Frozen Dynamite. — Dynamite freezes more easily than water, becomes hard and cannot be properly loaded into bore-holes, and is more difficult of explosion. Keep it where it will not freeze if possible. It must not he thawed hy a fire, but by hot water in an apparatus like a common glue-pot, the dynamite being in the inner vessel and hot (not boiling) water in the outer. Eissler states that there is but one safe way of thawing it, which is to keep it in a kitchen or other room at sum- mer heat, and away from the fire, until it is soft. It is then ready for use. Precautions. — Never attempt to thaw frozen dynamite by toasting, toasting, or baking it. Never put it in heated vessels, or in boilers, or before fires or heated metals. It must not be thawed or heated rapidly, Never put a cap into a charge or primer until you are ready to use it. After it is made never let a primer leave FIELD-ARTILLERY. 423 your hands until it is in the hole. Keep the caps away from the dynamite. Never let them come near each other except when used. Never allow smoking or other fire near the powder or explosive, as it burns rapidly, and especially when loose, and may fire caps incautiously left near by, and thus bring on an explosion. Never use a metallic rammer. Do not get nitro-glycerine on your fingers. It will be absorbed by the skin and give you a headache. Invariably prepare your primer at a distance from your explosive. EACK-A-EOCK. This powerful explosive, composed of a solid and a liquid ingredient, entirely inexplosive when separate, but easily and quickly combined, seems to present undoubted ad- vantages for use in the military service. The solid is potassium chlorate, and the liquid is either " dead oil," or dead oil and bisulphide of carbon in equal volumes, or bisulphide of carbon with 3 per cent of carbon added, or mono-nitro-benzine. General Abbot considered the following the best: Potassium chlorate, 79 parts; mono-nitro-benzine, 21 parts. The potassium chlorate is put up in the form of a car- tridge enclosed in a bag made of cotton or other suitable material. In preparing the charge for use the cartridges are placed in a wire frame, which is suspended from a spring-balance, and dipped in the liquid until a proportion of 3 to 4^ parts of solid to 1 part of liquid is shown by the balance; this requires from 3 to 6 seconds. Or, place the cartridges in a pan containing cells (each cartridge having a corresponding cell and cup) and then 424 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLEBY. pour in each cell its cupful of liquid. As soon as it has all been absorbed remove the cartridges and in ten minutes they are ready for use. If the cartrid^ges be kept, they appear to tend to increased sensibility to friction or percussion. GTJNCOTTON. Compressed Guncotton. — Clippings and other waste from cotton-mills are thoroughly purified from oil and fatty matters by treatment with alkali and extraneous sub- stances removed. The material is then opened up by a carding-machine and cut into suitable lengths. After thorough drying and when quite cold small quantities at a time are immersed in a cool mixture of 1 nitric acid (s. g. 1.53) and 3 sulphuric acid (s. g. 1.85). The excess of acid is then removed and the cotton carefully washed, re- duced to pulp, purified, and compressed into given weights and shapes by a powerful hydraulic press, and weighs 60 lbs. per cubic foot. The disks or slabs can be cut into smaller sizes with a sharp saw or knife without danger, care being taken to press them between boards while so doing to prevent their falling to pieces. It has from 2 to 2^ times the strength of gunpowder for equal weights when the charges are well tamped, ancT 4 times the strength of gunpowder when the charges are un- tamped ; it ignites at a lower temperature than gunpowder, as it may explode at 277" F. and must explode at 400° F.; it is comparatively insensible to shocks — caissons containing dry guncotton have been frequently inflamed by the pene- tration of a bullet from a military rifle, but never exploded,* *-Berthelet says: "Thin disks of compressed guncotton may be pierced by a ball without explosion; but if thickness of disk be in- creased or resisting envelope used an explosion occurs." MEW-ABTILLERT. 4^5 while wet gunootton in a condition for service cannot possibly be ignited by the same means even at the shortest ranges. Wet guncotton is not easily ignited, burns up quietly in the open air, is not sensitive to friction; but if fired by a strongly charged percussion-cap it will explode with great violence. It does not deteriorate when wet and is then perfectly safe to handle. It is therefore stored in a wet state (as it cannot be exploded except by the detonation of other disks of dry guncotton); but it should not be ex- posed to a temperature that will freeze the water in the cakes, if possible. While frost has no effect on dry gun- cotton, it causes a mechanical disintegration of the wet compressed variety. In the field the slabs are carried wet ; the disks dry and packed in hermetically sealed tins. These disks are used as primers, and have attached to them, when used, a ful- minate fuze. To Fire Guncotton, the fuze is cut to the required length and inserted in the hollow end of the detonator, especial care being taken to push it down so as to rest on the quick- match; the tube is then slightly bent to prevent the fuze from being withdrawn. The small end of the detonator is then gently inserted into the primer (the dry disk) so as to fill the entire length of the hole in the latter. If it is loose, a piece of paper or grass must be wrapped round to make it fit tight. The primer must be placed in close contact with the charge to be fired. Care must be taken that no sparks from the fuze can fall on the charge, which might then burn instead of exploding. Bear in mind that a moist primer is certain to cause failure. The charge should be in close contact with the object to be demolished. Transportation. — The handling of high explosives should be done under the immediate supervision of persons thor- 426 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGST ARTILLERY. oughly familiar with the proper methods to be pursued and who will exercise great care and judgment. High explo- sives should be packed in light wooden boxes properly marked. The French have a wagon containing about 350 lbs. attached to a horse-battery accompanying the cavalry division, acting independently, and two such wagons with the artillery-park. Care is taken that they are not placed too near the other ammunition and are in the safest place under careful observation. On a steamer place the explosives in a well-ventilated place remote from the engine. On railways, if the weather be hot, there should be good ventilation and ice in the car, so placed that water cannot reach the explosives. In winter protect from freezing if possible. Packing in straw or sawdust may be useful. Under no circumstances should cases of fuzes be in the same car, or in the vicinity of the explosive. The packages of guncotton should not be exposed to the sun — cover with paulins, put under shade-trees. Storage. — At military posts, in ordinary service maga- zines over which are erected light wooden roofs, so as to insure a draught during hot weather. The usual precautions against fire and for storage of ordinary powder must be taken; and neither fuzes, caps, nor detonators of any kind should ever be allowed in the magazine containing the explosives. Dry guncotton should not be stored in the same magazine with wet guncotton. Before being placed in the magazine the boxes should be given a coat of paint or shellac, to protect them from moisture. They should also be placed on skids and the space between the skids partially filled with sawdust, to absorb a.ny exuding nitro-glycerine. If any powder should be spilled on the floor, or nitro-glycerine exude and be ab- sorbed by the sawdust, it should be removed at once aiid FIELD-ARTILLERT. 427 burned. The boxes should be turned over every month or twO) and if kept long on hand they should be opened and the explosive tested from time to time. When guncotton is received, pour into each package enough water to cover it, or otherwise immerse it. Let the water remain for 15 minutes; then pour it ofE and her- metically close the box. This should be done every three mouths. Packages of guncotton stained brown or yellow, giving off nitric fumes, or showing other signs of decomposition, should be removed and immersed in water. If decomposi- tion be far advanced, they should be removed to a safe place and burned. WHERE AND HOW TO PLACE CHARGES. Masonry or Brick Arch. — Attack the haunches of the arch or the piers. In bridges of a single arch the haunches are the best points, two trenches being dug across the width of the roadway down to the back of the arch. When there is no time for this, the charge should be placed along the crown of the arch. With guncotton untamped use IT" X 5; if tamped with a depth of earth equal to the thickness of the arch, use f T" X B. With gunpowder, if over crown of arch, use IT"" X 5; if behind haunch, ^V X B, In the former case use tamp- ing if possible equal to the thickness of the arch, and in the latter case equal to twice the thickness. The quantity of powder obtained by these rules should be divided into two or more charges placed across the arch. When the bridge consists of a series of arches, and the piers are short and thick, the haunches should be attacked by the rules given in table on next page. If the piers be high and thin, it is better to place the charges against them, as the fall of one pier will involve 428 A HANDBOOK FOB Ll&ST ABTtLLEBT. RULES FOR CALCULATING CHARGES FOR HASTY DEMOLITIONS BY GUNCOTTON OR GUNPOWDER. Charges are ia lbs. : B and T are in feet ; « is in inches. B is length of breach to be made ; y or < is thickness of object to be demolished. Gunpowder is assumed to be roughly tamped with sand-bags, guncotton untamped. If the guncotton is tamped, the charges may be reduced one half. Charges of guncotton must be equal in length to the breach which is to be made. Object Attacked. Brick arch. Brick wall 2 ft. or less. Brick wall over 3 ft. Brick piers. Hard wood in any form, stockade, palisade, single timbers, trees, etc. Do., do., Soft wood -I Breastwork of hori- zontal balks, or earth between sleepers up to 3J ft. thick Heavy rail stockade. Fortress gate Iron plate Field- or siege-guns. Heavier guns First-class iron rail. " steel " Gunpowder isr» 40 to 100 lbs. for, stockade Half the for hard 60 to 80 lbs. per 5 feet 300 lbs. Guncotton. iBT^ 3 lbs. per foot run iBT^ SBT' IJTS charges wood 4 lbs. per foot 71bs.perft. 50 lbs. iBf On chase near muzzle. In bottom of bore, tamped with water or sand. Touching web of rail and near a chair. Fourrailsplaced around the charge will be cut simultaneougly by it. In the presence of an enemy increase above charges 50* to allow for contiugencies. 4 lbs. Jib. 4 oz. Remarks. The length of breach, B, should not be less than the height of the wall to be brought down. In a concentrated charge, or for trees not over 13 in. in diameter in a neck- lace. In auger-hole; when the timber is not per- fectly round, T smaller axis. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 429 the destruction of two arches. The charge should be slightly greater than for a wall of the same thickness. House with Moderately Thick Walls. — Attack portions of walls between the windows, the charges being tamped, and inside the house if possible. Otherwise place outside, or one or two large charges inside untamped. To demolish a building, a sufficient height of wall must be brought down to insure the arches over the doors and windows falling. The length of breach must be equal to this height. With very thick walls cut grooves. To Cut Down Trees. — Place charge in an auger-hole bored horizontally into the tree at desired height. If tree be 1-^ to 2 feet in diameter, use two holes. With a little care they can be bored so as to meet in the centre, in which case one detonator will suffice to fire the charge; with plenty of detonators it may be better to fire one hole first and then a second hole in the uninjured part of the tree, and so on. The tree may be made to fall in any required direction by attaching a rope to the upper branches, and taking the strain on it before firing. The guncotton may be hung around the tree, but this often fails with trees over 13 inches in diameter. A hole may be dug under the roots. Dig down by the side of the tree and then horizontally under the bottom close to the wood, the hole being just large enough for the cartridge. The rules for felling trees apply to timbers of wooden bridges, the uprights of the piers being the best point to attfick. To Blow Down a Stockade 12" X 12".— Use 3 lbs. of guncotton per running foot. The slabs should be threaded together, so as to be in contact, and hung or laid against the timbers at the required level. If gunpowder be used, a charge of 80 lbs. should be 430 A HANDBOOK FOR LIOET ARTILLEBT. allowed for the same stockade when the charge is not tamped; when tamped by having a few sand-bags piled on top, the charge may be reduced to 60 lbs. This would probably make a breach about 6 feet wide. To Demolish a Gate. — Fifty pounds of guncotton hung against the gate by a nail or pickaxe or laid on the ground will suffice. The charge of gunpowder should be 200 lbs., coTered with sand-bags if possible. Destruction of Iron Bridges. — Place charge on lower girders near an abutment, and at a point where the thick- ness of the plates is least. If sections are uniform through- out the length of the bridge, place charge at centre of a span between two piers. When the bridge plate is entirely of iron, place charge on top of beams. Destruction of Railroad Tracks. — To destroy heavy iron rails, a charge of six 3-ounce disks (including primer) should be used. To Destroy a Tunnel. — The crown of the arch or the side-walls should be attacked. The points selected should be some distance inside the tunnel. To Destroy Field- and Siege-guns. — Detonate 1^ lbs. of guncotton on the outside near the muzzle. In heavier wrought-iron guns detonate 4 lbs. in the bottom of the bore, tamping with sand. Heavy cast-iron guns can be burst by firing 1 lb. of gun- cotton in the same position and tamping with sand. FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 431 CHAPTER XIV. Battery Books and Records. Rolls, Reports, and Returns. The Ration. Salt and Vinegar for Public Animals. The Travel- ration. Present Organization of U. S. Light Field-battery. Cost of a Battery of Four 3.3-inch Guns, in Detail. Price- list of Artillery-harness. Price-list of Harness for 1.65-inch Mountain-gun. Price-list of Artillery Accoutrements, etc. Price-list of Horse Equipments. Price-list of Stencil and Mark- ing Outfits. Supply Table of Ordnance Stores for a Battery of Light Artillery for Six Months. Allowance of Ammunition for Target Practice. Standard Supply Table of Veterinary Medi- cines. Tableware and Kitchen Ulensils. Allowance of Cloth- ing, Equipage, Fuel, Lights, etc. Weights of Certain Articles of Clothing and Equipage. Pay Table of Enlisted Men. Summary Court, and List of Punishments. U. S. Signal and Telegraph Code. Penetration of Projectiles. Cover for Field- artillery. Treatment of Sick Men. Tables of Weights, Measures, etc. Tables for Converting Customary and Metric Weights and Measures. Salutes. Camp Furniture and Mess Outfits for OflScers. BATTERY BOOKS AND RECORDS. Sick report book; company clothing book; morning re- port book; guard report book; descriptive and deposit book — all obtained from adjutant-general. Order book; letters received book; index to letters received; letters sent book; index to letters sent; descriptive book of public animals — all obtained from quartermaster-general. Artil- lery practice report book — from chief of ordnance. Bat- tery council book; roster book. 432 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. ROLLS, REPORTS, AND RETURNS. Designation. To Whom Sent. When Made. When Sent. By Whom. Muster roll * of bat- Adjt. Gen. Every month Within 3 days Mustering tery. officer Inventory of effects *i ,. Immediately Immediately Battery of deceased sol- CQm''dr diers. Final statements of II It " II •I deceased soldiers. Certificates of dis- It II It It Post com*dr ability (in dupli- cate). Return of Ord. and Chief of Ord- End of month Within 20 days Battery Ord. stores. nance comMr Return of battery.... Regtl. adjutant II " 3 '* Transcript of orders '* Immediately Immediately »' making tempo- raryappointments . of or reducing N. C. ofBoers at posts not regtl. headqrs. Abstract of battery fund. ** End of quarter Next day " Morning report. Post adjt. EveiT morning Endof.every Before 8 a. m. >( Monthly return of It It First of subse- ** battery (to be returned for file). month quent month Return of battery It tt End of every (( If «« fund (with coun- quarter cil book). Req. for fuel, forage. It ft End of every End of every " and straw. month month Req. for salt and It It II II (t vmegar ** Ration return Estimate of C. and \\ !! On days desig Jan. 1, Apl. 1, nated by C. O. ** E., 6 months' sup- ply. Req. for stationery. July 1, Oct. 1 t. 11 End of every First of subse- *c quarter quent month * Also S copies to the designated paymaster. FIELD-ABTILLER T 433 THE RATION. Article. f Fresh beef, or other fresh meat. Orteltbeef :... Or salt pork Or bacon Or dried fish* Pickled or fresh fish* Potatoes lOrpotatoes ) Ana onions Orpotatoes And tomatoes Or other fresh vegetable .... Sngar Or molasses Or syrup Salt Pepper Flour Or soft bread Or hard bread Or corn-meal Beans or peas Or rice or hominy CofEee, green - Or coffee roasted Ortea Soap Candles (if no oil) Yeast-powder (in the field) — Tinegar J sl » S oz. Lbs. so 22 S IS 3^^ 12 37^ 14 18 56M 16 50 12.8 40 3.2 10 11.2 35 4.8 15 2.4 M .64 giU Igal. .64 2 .04 IB mit 18 16 50 20 621X 2.4 71Z 1.6 5 1.6 5 1.S8' 4 .32 1 .648 2 .24 9i .64 2 .04 qt. Hgal. 1000 1 a Bations. 1 1 1 Lbs. Lbs. I.hs 125 1250 137H 1375 75 750 1819 75 750 tin3 87H 875 "»H 1125 100 1000 80 BOO 20 200 70 700 30 300 15 150 2 gals. 20 gals. 4 40 112^ 2}^ 1125 1234 nm 1125 100 1000 1229 125 1250 15 160 177 10 100 115 10 100 122 8 80 108 2 20 25 4 40 47 1^ 15 16.5 4 40 Igal. 10 gals. 107i mSS n « Barrels. 6.875 3.75 4.9 4.66 .16 5.74 12 .09 * When Meat cannot be furnished. SALT AND TINEGAK FOR PUBLIC ANIMALS. Salt. Vinegar. No. of Animals. Quantity per Week. Quantity per Month, When Necessary. Quantity per Week. 1 Lbs. 1 6 12 Oz. 2 10 4 4 8 Lbs. 3 7 37 75 Oz. 12 12 ■ 8 8 Gals. 1 3 Qts. Pts. 1 Gills. .M 5 3,2 10 2.4 50 100 — 434 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY THE " TKAVBL-EATION." Articles. Per 100 Rations. Soft bread pounds 112^ or Jiard bread pounds 100 Beef, canned pounds 75 Baked beans, 1-pound cans number 33 or baked beans, S-pound cans number 15 Coffee, roasted pounds 8 Sugar pounds 15 Canned tomatoes (after 4 consecutive I of above) pounds 100 Present Organization of Light Field-battery. — 1 captain, 2 first lieutenants, 3 second lieutenants, 1 first sergeant, 6 sergeants, 4 corporals, 3 musicians, 3 artificers, 1 wagoner, 59 privates. Total commissioned 5. Total enlisted 75. Special-duty Men Allowed in a Light Battery. — 1 N. C. 0. to take immediate charge of police, etc., of stable and picket-line, 1 clerk, 1 tailor, 1 cook, 1 assistant cook, when necessary (the head cook is allowed 25 cents per day from company fund); 1 N. 0. 0. (detailed from roster) to super- vise rooms and gun-racks. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 435 COST OF EQUIPMENT (EXCLUSIVE OP AMMUNITION) FOR A FOUR-GUN 3.3-INCH FIELD-BATTERY, WITH COM- BINED BATTERY-WAGON AND FORGE. (Total Cost as herein indicated $17595.71.) Ai'ticles. 4 3.2-inch B. L. steel guns 4 3.2-iiich carriages and limbers (cost of brake included. 4 3. 3-iuch caissons and limbers 1 combiued forge and battery wagon 9 sets artillery-harness for 2 wheel-horses 9 sets artillery-harness for 2 lead-horses in trail-box On bach Carbiagb. 1 pair bow-spring recoil-brakes 1 sponge and rammer, jointed, for bore 2 short rammers and sponges, combiued, for chamber . 1 sponge-cover, bore-sponge 2 sponge-covers, chamber-sponge 1 prolonge (section of picket-rope) 1 combination screw-driver 1 gunners* gimlet 1 gunners' reamer 1 priming-wire 1 vent-punch 1 front sight With bach Cabbiaob-limbbb. I breech-sight, bronze 1 breech-sight pouch 2 gunners' haversacks 2 primer-pouches 2 lanyards, new pattern 1 fuze-punch 1 front-sight cover 1 combined tompion and muzzle-cover 1 breech-cover 1 breech-strap 1 sperm-oiler, rectangular, brass 1 wheel-grease can 1 wheel-grease can knife 2 watering-buckets, canvas, folding 1 tool-box 1 screw-wrench, 12-inch 1 iron nut- wrench, 12 inches long 1 }-inch cold chisel, 8 inches long 1 8-inch hand bastard file 1 hand-hammer, 12i-inch handle 1 small steel punch 1 neck-yoke , 1 doubletree Ssingletrees 2 paulins, 12 X 12 feet, dyed duck 1 cushion, canvas and hair 1 padlock for ammunition-chest Price. Dolls. Cts. 1022 1.516 721 816 170 138 Amount. Dolls. Cts, 4088 6266 2886 816 1535 1249 18 436 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLEBY. COST OF EQUIPMENT (EXCLUSIVE OF AMMUNITION) FOR A FOUR-GUN 3.3-INCH FIELD-BATTERY, WITH COM- BINED BATTERY-WAGON AND SO^Q:^— Continued. Articles. Oh each Caisson-body. 1 manosuvring-haudspike 2 shovels, long-handled 2 sipades, shore-handled 2 pickaxes, handled 2 axes, handled 2 lanterns, with Cranston attachment 1 prolonge (section of picket-rope) 1 spare pole 1 spare wheel* 2paulins, 1^ X 12 feet, dyed duck 2 padlocks for ammunition-chest 2 cushions, canvas and hair With each Caisson-liubbb. 1 wheel-grease can 1 wheel-grease can knife 2 paulins, 12 X 12 feet, dyed duck 1 neck-yoke 1 doubletree 2 singletrees 2 watering-buckets, canvas, folding 1 cushion, canvas and liair. 1 padlock for ammunition-chest On Lihbeb of Forge and Battery wagon. 1 neck-yoke 1 doubletree 2 singletrees 2 paulins, 18 X 12 feet 2 watering-buckets, canvas, folding 1 wheel-grease can 1 wheel-grease can knife 1 canvas coal-bag (3 bushels) 200 pounds horseshoes 50 pounds horseshoe-nails Blacksmith's tools i forge-chest): 1 forge, portable, Empire (modified for army use).. 2 aprons, leather, smith's 1 hammer, hand, handled 1 hammer, riveting 1 hammer, shoeing 1 pair tongs for holding J-inch iron , 1 pair tongs for holding ^inch iron 1 pair tongs, smith's, 11-lnch 1 chisel, handled, for cutting hot iron 1 chisel, handled, foi* cutting cold iron 1 fore-punch and creaser (on one handle) 1 chisel, hand, cold 1 pritchel Price. Dolls. Cts, 75 77 00 55 32 45 48 60 00 65 32 77 45 09 75 40 16 75 29 70 30 ■15 •5 •5 84 50 lit ■a J31 Amount. Dolls. Cts 78 19 * Each caisson is provided with spare-wheel axle, but only two spare wheels are supplied to a four-gun battery. FIELD-ARTILLBRT. 437 COST OF EQUIPMENT (EXCLUSIVE OF AMMUNITION) FOE A FOUR-GUN 3.3-INCH FIELD-BATTERY, WITH COM- BINED BATTERY- WAGON AND FORGE.— CoairaMgat. Articles. Oh Lihbbr of Forge and Batterv-wagon. 1 shoeing-rasp, 16-inch 1 flat bastard file, 13-inch 1 round punch, hand 1 hardie 1 screw-wrench, 12-inch 2 shoeing-knives 1 toe-knife 1 shoeing-pincers '. 1 clinching-iron ' 1 nail-punch 1 rule (2-foot), wood, 4-foId, No. 72, Stanley 1 square, steel 1 ouer, brass ...j 1 shoeing-box, sole-leather 1 flle-handle, iron, 6-inch 1 wrench, small, for forge Iflre-rake 1 flxe-shoTel 2 small canvas bags for nails and small stores 1 padlock (and key) On Body of Forge and Battery-wagon. 2 water-buckets, galvanized sheet-iron 1 prolonge (section of picket-rope) 2 lanterns, with Cranston attachment 1 oil-can, sperm (2i pints) 1 oil-can, coal (3 gallons) 1 grindstone, arbor, crank, and frame (iron), complete.. 1 lunette-prop 2 jackscrews 1 hammer, sledge, medium 1 anvil (100 pounds) Ivise, forge a padlocks (and keys) Saddler's tools (chest): 1 saddler's tool-chest (handled) 1 knife, round 1 knife, shoe 1 draw-gauge 6 awls, stitching, handled (assorted) 1 rivet-set (two holes) 1 revolving punch, four tubes, Nos. 4, 5, 6, and 7 1 claw-tool 1 compasses, 6-inch 1 creaser, wood 1 cutting-nippers, 10-inch 1 hammer, riveting , 1 edge-tool. No. 2 1 rule (2-toot), No. 18,3-fold 1 oil-stone 1 pliers (large), 6-inch Pric e. Amoi rat. Dolls. Cts. Dolls. Cts. 42 42 16 16 07 07 (19 09 40 49 'X> 35 07 07 42 43 ao .10 OR OR ■15 15 4(1 40 or 07 1 50 1 50 m 30 50 50 14 14 28 38 63 62 60 60 1 in 2 20 K 60 8 60 .59 1 1« 50 m 3 20 3 20 16 25 16 25 70 70 9 50 19 no 90 90 ,■) 26 5 35 84 H4 60 1 20 15 15 15 15 90 90 17 17 1 10 1 10 05} 83 25 25 55 55 12 12 12 12 17 1 17 1 ,10 50 .10 SO 13+ 13* 15 15 2 70 2 70 35 35 438 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. COST OF EQUIPMENT (EXCLUSIVE OF AMMUNITION) FOR A FOUR-GUN 3.3-INOH FIELD-BATTERT, WITH COM- BINED BATTERY- WAGON AND ¥0^0^^.— Continued. Articles. On Bodt of Forge and Battery-wagon. 1 driving-punch, No. 5 , 1 stitchiDg-horse, complete , 5 small canvas bags for small stores , Cai*penter's and wheelwright's tools (chest): 1 carpenter's and wheelwright^s tool-chest, handled 1 brace with 13 bits, assorted 1 drawing-knife, IS-inch , 1 hand-saw, fiO-inch 1 rip-saw, 36-inch 1 hand-axe, No. 7 1 hammer, claw 4 chisels, framing— ^-inch, 1-inch, 1^-inch, ^-inch 3 gouges, framing— J-inch, 1-inch, li-inch 1 screw-wrench, IS- inch 1 plane, jack 1 plane, smoothing 1 snokft" shave 1 rule (8-foot), No. 72, 4-foid, Stanley .'.'.'. '.'.'.!!!!!!!!."!!'. 1 ! 10 brad-awls, assorted, with (and contained in) handle... 1 square, trying, 9-inch 1 awl, scribing 12 files, saw, assorted— 4-inch and 6-inch 1 rasp, wood. 10-inch 1 file, wood, 10-inch 1 oiler, brass 1 oil-stone, 8-inch 1 gauge 1 compasses, 10-inch wing 1 table-vise 1 pincers, small 1 mallet, wood 6 auger-bits — i-mah, i-inch, |-inch, l-inch, li-iDct, l^-inch 2 screw-drivfer bits — J-inch and 4-inch 1 patent auger-handle 3 file-handles, iron — 4-inch ilat, 4-inch round, 5-inch... 1 linen tape-line (" Chesterman " Shefleld), 100 feet 2 small canvas bags for small stores Amount. Dolls. Cts. OS Price. Dolls. Cts. 181 12 70 06 85 40 ISJ 40 43 15 18 65 35 84 SUPPLIES, CLEANINa MATERIAL, SPARE PARTS, ETC., CARRIED IN BATTERY-WAGON BODY. 2 sides leather, bridle (84 pounds). 1 side leather, harness (20 pounds). 2 pounds beeswax. 3 poundR black wax. 36 buckles. 2 papers tacks, copper. 3 papers tacks, iron. 2 pounds rivets and burrs, copper. 2 pounds thread, patent. 5 pounds thread, shoe. 5 needles, collar. 50 needles, saddler's, assorted. FIBLD-ARTILLERY. 439 SUPPLIES, CLEANING MATERIAL, SPARE PARTS, ETC.- Continued. i thimbles. 10 pounds nails. 1 gross wood screws. 6 pieces sash cord, pounds). sxrppLiES— conimwed. braided (13i 85 pounds bar iron, assorted. 40 pounds toe-steel. 250 pounds coal, bituminous. 8 gallons coal-oil. 50 pounds wheel-greasfe. MATERIAL FOK CLEANING AND PRESERVATION. 4 gallons neat's-foot oil (3 cans). 2i pints sperm-oil. SO pounds harness-soap. 10 pounds sponge. 4 quires sand-paper. 6 quires emery-cloth. 5 pounds rotten stone. 25 papers tripoli. SPARE PARTS — GUN. 4 carrier latch-pins. 8 carrier latch-pin springs. 3 gas-check pads. 1 steel split ring. 4 vent-bushings, copper. SPARE PARTS— CARRIAGE. 1 bow-spring brake. 3 singletrees. 1 doubletree. 1 neck-yoke. 4 pole-pads. 13 linch-pins. 8 linch-washers. 4 ammunition-chest bolts and nuts. 3 turnbuckles for ammunition-chests. 3 breech-strap eye-washers. 3 nuts for assembling-bolts for la^- tongs. 2 springs for pole-prop at end of pole. 4 lid-props. 4 lid-prop plate pivots. 1 pintle-key and chain. SPARE PARTS— HARNESS. C breast-Straps. 6 bridles and bits, artillery, N. P. 4 collars steel. 9 girths, hair, artillery, N. P. 6 halters, artillery, N. P. 50 halter-straps. 4 martingales. 3 neck-yoke pads. 10 surcingles. 2 traces, lea'd, artillery, N. P. 3 traces, wheel, artillery, N. F. STEEL COLLAR. 3 trace-plates. 4 draft-springs. 4 pad-hooks. 3 pad bolts and nuts. 3 nuts for pad-bolts. 3 buckle-latches. 6 buckle-springs. 6 bolts and nuts for top connection. 4 nuts for top-connection bolt«. 6 bolts and nuts for bottom of collar. 4 nuts for bottom bolts. 6 bolts and nuts for extension. 4 nuts for extension-bolts. 6 bolts and nuts for trace-plate. 4 nuts for trace-plate bolts. 13 back 'Straps. 8 back-strap connections. 6 collar-pads, canvas. 3 gunners* gimlets. 3 vent-punches. 3 primmg-wires. 3 fuze- wrenches. 4 fuze-punches. 84 fuze-punch pins. 1 obturator spindle and wrench. 4 whips, artillery. 3 pickaxe-handles. 3 axe-helves. TOOLS AND IMPLEMENTS. 4 short rammers and sponges, com- bined. 1 sponge and rammer, jointed. 3 sponge-heads and sponges for short rammers and sponges, combined. 1 rammer-head for short rammers and sponges, combined. 3 sponge-neads and sponges for jointed sponge and rammer. 1 rammer-head for jointed sponge and rammer. 440 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGULT ABriLLERY. PRICE-LIST OF ARTILLERY-HARNESS. (New Pattern.) Components. BREAST-STRAP. Strap Double hooks, 2 ® 83.S0 eacb Breast-strap com plete BREECHING. Body Side-straps, 2 @ 56c. each Breeching complete BRIDLE. Curb-bit, Shoemaker Curb-strap Cheek-pieces, 2 ® S8c. each Crownpiece Beins Throat-lash Brow-band Brow-band ornaments, 2 & 8c. each . Couplings-strap Bridle complete HALTBB. Head-stall Strap Halter complete Leg-guard Loin-strap Trace-loops, 2 ® SSc. each. Martingale Saddle-trees, leather-covered, spring bar attached Back-straps, 8 ® 83e. each Cincha-straps, S @ 50c. each Stirrups, brass, 2 @ $1.20 each Stirrup-straps and sweat-leather attached, 2(a$1.48each Rawhide thongs, 3 ® 5c. eaoh Lead rein roller and strap Cantle-hook Saddle complete Saddle-cloth, hair Saddle-cloth, duck Saddle-bags Hair girth Traces, wheel, 2 @ $7.00 each Traces, lead, 2 @ S8.95 each Whip Collar, steel locking Crupper and hip-straps Trace-loops, 2 ® 32c. each Crupper and hip-straps complete Total 87 00 Wheel. Near Off Horse. Horse. 83 27 Lead. Near Off Horse. Horse. 59 69 45 15 17 4 2 5 1 17 9 Cost of one set of harness for 2 wheel-horses Cost of one set of harness for 2 lead-horses. . . tl70.69 138.81 FIELD-ABTILLBR7. 441 COST OF PACKING OUTFIT FOR H0TCHKI8S MOUNTAIN- GUN (CAL. 1.65-INCH). Pack-saddle for gun $44.16 Crupper 4.10 Belly-cincha 4.85 Saddle-cincba 3.89 Cargo-cincha 9,24 Wheel-straps 17 Hub-straps 40 Gun-pad 1.30 Lashing-rope 35 $68.36 Pack-saddle for carriage 41.44 Crupper 4.10 Belly-cincha 3.63 Saddle-cincha 3.89 Cargo-cincha 6.45 Trail-strap 14 Lashing-rope 35 59.90 Pack-saddle for ammunition 48.94 Crupper 4.10 Belly-cincha 3.63 Saddle-cincha 3.89 Cargo-cincha 3.93 Lashing-rope 35 64.73 HAKNHSB, ETC. Bridles, 3 at $1.93 each 3.84 Breast-collars, 3 at $3.73 each 5.44 Martingales, 3 at 77 cents each 1.64 Breechings, 3 at $3.61 each 7.33 Traces, 3 pairs at $1.30 per pair 3.60 Pole-straps, 3 at 36 cents each ' .53 21.16 Harness-sack 1.36 Neck-yoke 75 Neck-yoke brace 40 Neck-yoke brace-billet and chapes 13 1.27 442 A HANDBOOK POR LIQHT AMTILLMRT. Pole $41.31 Splinter-bar $7.51 Trail-hooks for attachment of splinter-bar 1.60 9.11 Ammunition-boxes, 4 at $3.18 each 12.73 Cartridge-pack 2.54 Total 282.26 CLASS VI. OFFICERS' SABRES. Sabre complete with scabbard $16.00 Scabbard 5. 00 Chamois case 75 CLASS VI. SABRE AND KNIFE FOR ENLISTED MEN. Sabre complete $5.00 Hunting-knife 1.10 CLASS VII. ARTILLERY ACCOUTREMENTS, ETC. Price. Dolls. eta. Light-artillery sabre-belt, -with slings, etc. . . . $0.99 ) . .18^ 1 4 Light- artillery sabre-belt complete 17 Light-artillery knapsack 00 60 Pistol-holster 79 Sabre-knot 65 53 Canteen-strap with snap, short, for saddle 20 Canteen-strap for dismounted service. ■ 29 Haversack 88 Haversack-strap 56 28 Tin cup 15 Knife 07 Fork 05 Spoon 02i Snap-hook for canteen-strap 03 Snap-hook for sabre-sling 82 FIELB-ARTILLBBY. US OFFICER'S BLACK LEATHER SWORD-BELT FOR FIELD SERVICE. Components. Price. Dolls. Cts. Waist-belt Sliding loops, leather, 3 at 2^ cents each Belt-plate Belt-plate hasp Belt-slides, leather, with ovals, 2 at 9J cents each. . . Long sling Short' sling Belt-buckle Sling-buttons, 2 at 9^ cents each Short-sling button with hook Snap-hooks for sword-slings, 2 at 55 cents each . . . . Sword-belt complete. 45 05 85 08 19 15 07 07 19 12 10 82 Note.— All the metallic parts of tbe officer's sword-belt are of brass, gold- plated. CLASS VII. HORSE EQUIPMENTS. (See also Aktillerthakness.) Saddle. (See Artillery-lMrrieas.) Sabre-straps, 2 at lOJ cents each $0 21 Stirrups, wood (without hoods), 2 at 21 cents each 42 Stirrup-hoods, 2 at 57J cents each 1 15 Stirrup-straps, 2 at 50 cents each 1 00 CuRB-BBiDLB. (See Artillery-harness.) Wateking-bridle. Watering-bit complete $0 73 Reins 50 Watering-bridle complete $1 23 444 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. Curry-comb $0 33 Double spring snap for lariats 14 Harness-sack for artillery-harness 3 15 Horse-brush 90 Horse-cover, cotton duck, with surcingle of the same material attached , ,. 3 29 Lariat tj6 Link, with snap 39 Mane-comb 08 Nose-bag 95 Picket-pin 84 Saddle-blanket, artillery 3 35 Saddle-cloth for officers of artillery 5 05 Brow-band, scarlet, officer's 49 Breast-straps, scarlet, officer's 3 55 Side-lines (or hopples) 1 30 Stirrup, with hood and socket for guidon attached 1 34 Sweat-leathers, each 55 Surcingle 91 Spurs, per pair 70 Spur-straps, per pair 30 Spurs for Officers. 3 spurs, 60 cents each |1 30 3 spur-chains, 40 cents each 80 2 spur-straps, 6| cents each 13 3 spurstrap buckles, 15f cents each 31^ 1 packing-box, pasteboard 05^ 1 pair spurs $3 50 Stencil Outfit. 1 stencil-plate of sheet brass, with coat of arms of the ser- vice, number of regiment, and letter of company |0 75 10 metal stencil-plates, numbers to 9 IGJ 1 stencil-brush ; 15 1 box of black marking-paste 08 1 packing-box 16^ Price of stencil outfit complete fl 31 FIELD-ABTILLEB T. 445 Marking Outfit. Istamp ^1 06 1 stamp-holder 55 2 thumb-screws, at 4 cents each 08 1 company letter 06i 19 figures and 1 blank, at 3 cents each 60 1 brass mallet 49 link-pad , 05i 1 glass bottle, ground-glass stopper 10^ 4 ounces indelible ink 09 1 inking-stick 02 1 packing-box 43 Price of marking outfit complete f3 53 In Class III. Artillery Implements and Equipments. Lanterns, common $1 00 " dark 1 25 globe 1 25 SUPPLY TABLE OF ORDNANCE STORES FOR SIX MONTHS OF A FOUR-GUN BATTERY OF LIGHT ARTILLERY— 3.2-INCH RIFLES. Expendible stores are marked with a star (thus *\ and must not be dropped until actually used. I. Battery Equipment. 4 short rammers and sponges combined. 1 sponge and rammer, jointed. 2 sponge-hds.— chamber-sponge* 1 sponge-head — bore-sponge.* 2 rammer-lieads — chamber.* 1 rammer-head — bore.* 8 sponges, woollen, chamber.* 4 sponges, woollen, bore.* 2 sponge-covers — bore-sponge. 3 sponge-covers — chamber- sponge. [folding. 6 watering-buckets, canvas, 4 lanyards for friction-primers. 2 vent-punches. 2. gunner's reamers. 4 priming-wires. 1 fuze-wrench. 2 paulins (13 feet by 12 feet). 1 spare pole.* 1 neck-yoke.* 1 doubletree * 2 singletrees.* 5 keys and chains.* 6 washers, linch.* 2 pole-pads.* 2 pickaxe-handles.* 3 axe-helves.* 2 g!is-check pads. 12 fuze-punch pins. 2 axes, hand. 2 shovels, long- handled. 6 files, hand, saw, assorted. 6 files, wood. M6 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 1 hammer, hand. 1 knife, shoe and saddler's. 2 rasps, wood, 10-inch. II. Harness, etc. 1 nipper. 1 pair bow-spring recoil-brakes. 6 bridles, artillery. [tern. 6 bridles, watering, cavalry pat 6 breast-straps. 9 girths, hair. 15 halters, N. P. 50 halter-straps.* Ill, 13 canteens and straps. 10 haversacks and straps. 6 spurs and straps. 6 sabre-belts and plates. 15 nose-bags. 30 saddle-blankets, red. 10 saddle-cloths, red. 10 surcingles. 2 traces, lead.* 3 traces, wheel.* Equipments, etc. 30 currycombs. 50 horse-brushes. 8 whips, artillery. EXPElifDIBLB SUPPLIES FOK SIX MONTHS. I. Materials for Cleaning and Preservation. 6 pounds cosmoline. 6 pounds harness-oil. 25 pounds cotton waste. 10 pounds sponge. 4 gallons neat's-foot oil. 2 gallons sperm-oil. 3 gallons asphalt varnish. 2 quarts blacking for leather. 4 quires sand-paper. 5 quires crocus-cloth. 6 quires emery-cloth. 12 pounds putz pomade. 2 pounds rotten-stone. 50 papers tripoli. 20 pounds harness-soap. 10 pounds Castile soap. 5 pounds borax. II. Paints, etc. 35 pounds paint, lead-colored. 25 pounds paint, black. 75 pounds paint, olive. 1^ pounds paint, first coat for 3.3-inch rifle, li pounds paint, second coat for 3.3-inch rifle. 2 pounds lampblack. III. Saddler's Materials. 2 pounds extract of logwood. 50 pounds wheel-grease. 4 gallons linseed-oil, boiled. 3 gallons spirits of turpentine. 3 pieces sash-cord. 6 brushes, paint, 4 sash-tools. 150 pounds harness-leather. 3 sides bridle-leather. 2 sides rawhide. 1 pound beeswax. 2 pounds black wax. 3 pounds thread, shoe. 2i pounds thread, linen, pat- ent No. 85. 3 ounces bristles. 3 pounds rivets and burrs, copper. 3000 tacks, iron. 2000 tacks, copper (1000 of 13- ounce, 1000 of 30-ounce). 144 wood-screws, l-inch,No. 8. 60 buckles (20, i-inch; 20, i-inch; 20, 1-inch). 40 buckles, IJ-inch, girth. 15 buckles, iron, roller, IJ-inch. 60 saddle-nails, japanned. 20 awls, saddlers', assorted. 6 awl-handles. 50 needles, saddlers', assorted. 4 needles, collar. FIELD-ABTILLEB T. ANNUAL ALLOWANCE OP AMMUNITION. 447 For each battery of artillery equipped as a battery of horse-artillery or a light battery, and serving as such: Gun. 3.2-inch rifle Hotchkiss revolv- ing cannon 3.6-inch mortar.. Maximum Charge. ^ lbs. L. X. Q. powder No. of projectiles for each gun of the command. 25 Standard projectiles 100 standard projectiles. For each battery: (a) Fifteen shells without fuzes (shell ballasted); (6) five full charges, 16 ounces. Ten 8 ounce charges, comprising each one 5-ounce and one 3-ounce charge bound to- gether; these can be used as 3-ounce, 5-ounce, 8- ounce, or 11-ounce charges. Each battery equipped as a battery of horse-artillery or a light battery will be allowed for instruction, other than target practice, as many blank cartridges and friction- primers as may be deemed necessary by the battery com- mander and approved by the post commander. For batteries armed with the Hotchkiss breech-loading mountain-gun there will be allowed for the annual target practice twenty-flve standard projectiles for each gun of the command, or their equivalent in money value if reloaded. For each machine-gun of small-arm calibre there will be allowed for the annual target practice two thousand ball cartridges, or their equivalent in money value if reloaded. Blank cartridges for salutes and for firing the morning and evening gun: 3.2-inch rifle, ^ lbs. I. K. powder. 3-inch rifle, 1 lb. of either mortar, cannon, or I. K. powder. 6-pdr. bronze gun, 1 lb. of either mortar, cannon, or I. K. powder. Light 12-pdr. bronze gun. If lbs. of either mortar, can- non, or I. K. powder. 448 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. VETERINARY MEDICINES. Veterinary medicines^ instruments, and supplies for the treatment of all public animals, and the authorized private horses of mounted officers, are furnished by the Quarter- master's Department. Eequisitions and estimates for veterinary supplies will be made in conformity with the standard supply table. Only the articles and the quantities thereof that are act- ually needed will be placed on the requisition. The quan- tity prescribed in the table is not to be considered an allowance, but as a limit not to be exceeded without special authority. The standard supplies of veterinary medicines and dressings are under charge . of the quartermaster, to be issued by him to the different commands at the post upon approved requisitions in such quantities and of such articles as may be deemed requisite, in conformity with the standard supply table. Battery commanders must deduct from the allowance, in making requisition, the quantity of each article on hand and available for issue. Veterinary instruments and books remain in the custody of the post quartermaster, and are loaned as needed. The pannier, pocket-case, and saddle-bags are easily im- provised, and are omitted from the table. For a greater or less number of animals than are pro- vided for in the table the proportions indicated will be observed in requisitions and issues. This table is ample and sufficiently varied for ordinary practice; but in order to provide for the necessities of epi- demics, and to indulge, as far as practicable, individuul preference and training, a special requisition for articles not in the supply table, with an explanation of the nature of the emergency or case rendering it necessary, may be forwarded through the regular channels for the action of the quartermaster-genei'al. FIELB-ABTILLEBT. 449 STANDARD SUPPLY TABLE. Articles. Quantities. MxDioiNBs FOR Three Months' Scfplt- SI Acid, carbolic, crystallized oz. Aconite, tincture of the root oz. Alcohol gals. Aloes, Barbadoes oz. Ammonia, aromatic spirits of lbs. Ammonia, carbonate of lbs. Ammonia, solution of gals. Belladonna, fluid extract of oz. Camphor lbs. Cantharides (Spanish flies), powdered oz. Charcoal, powdered lbs. Cosmoline, veterinary lbs. Ether, spirits of nitrous • (sweet spirits of nitre) lbs. Ether, sulphuric lbs. Flaxseed-meal : lbs. Ginger, powdered lbs. Gentian, powdered lbs. Glycerine oz, Iron, sulphate of desiccated oz. Lime, chloride of lbs, Luaar, caustic ■ oz. Oil, linseed gals. Opium, tincture of lbs. Oil, olive.. gals, Pepper, Cayenne, ground lbs. Potassa, nitrate of (saltpetre) lbs. Soap, Castile lbs. Soda, bicarbonate of lbs. Sulphur, washed lbs. Turpentine, oil of gals. Zinc, sulphate of oz. Dressings roR Six Months' Supply. Bandages 2i inches wide and 4 yards long, of heavy bed-ticking doz. Bandages 4 inches wide and 4 yards long, of heavy red flannel doz. Oakum His- Silk for ligatures oz. Sponges, coai'se lbs. 16 4 1 SO 1 1 4 1 2 1 4 3 2 25 2 2 8 8 25 1 2 3 1 1 3 10 4 2 2 8 2 2 10 18 4 2 20 3 H 2 6 H 3 8 3 30 3 3 12 10 50 1 3 4 2 i* 15 8 3 3 10 3 15 H 450 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLEBT. STANDARD SUPPLY 'r^ASL'E— Continued. INSTBUMENTS FOR EACH POBT— Ball forceps no. Bistouries. no. Catheters, gum, with stylet no. Corkscrews no. Dreuching-horns, tin no. Fleams (3 blades) no. Funnels, tin no. Graduate glasses, 6-oz no. Hobbles, casting no. Hones no. liancets no. Measures, tin, sets no. Mortars and pestles, wedgewood, large no. Needles, surgeons' no, Keedles, Seaton no. Probangs, celluloid, in two pieces no. Scales and wights, shop no. Scissors, carved no. Slings, suspending no. Spatulas no. Speculums, mouth no. Syringes, rubber, 2-oz no. Syringes, rubber, 24-oz no. Thermometers, clinical no, Tooth-rasps no. 6 2 2 10 10 Books fob Each Offices in Ceabge of— Blank books, 2-quire, for record of cases. . ..no. Practical Horse-Shoeing, Fleming no. The Farmer's Veterinaiy Adviser, Laws no. Or, Army Veterinary Manual, Holcombe. ..no. l.a FIELD-ABTILLER 7. 451 Articles of china and glassware upon which an allowance of 20 per cent per annum of total value is made. TABLEWARE AND KITCHEN UTENSILS ALLOWED A LIGHT BATTERY. Dinner-plates 75 Soup-plates 75 Meat-plates 7 Cups and saucers 75 Water- pitchers 7 Vegetahle-dishes 38 Salt-cellars 14 Pepper-boxes 14 Syrup-pitchers 14 Bowls 75 Pickle-dishes 9 Sugar-bowls 14 Gravy-boats 14 Mustard-pots 14 Tumblers 75 Dippers 7 Soup- ladles 7 Skimmers 3 Dishpans 4 Basting-spoons 7 Tea-spoons 75 Table-spoons 75 Table-forks 75 Table-knives 75 Bread-knives 4 Butcher-knives 4 Chopping-bowls 4 Coflee-mills 1 Meat-saws 3 Scales and weights 1 Frying-pans 4 Meat-forks 7 Meat-choppers or meat-cut- ters 2 Carving-sets 2 Cleavers 1 Mustard-spoons 14 Flour-sieves 1 Can-openers 7 Graters 2 452 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABT1LLEB.T. ALLOWANCE OF CLOTHING. Articles. Helmets and trimmings complete No. Forage-caps and trimmings Xo. Campaign hats No. Uniform coats No. Trousers pairs Canvas fatigue coats No Canvas fatigue trousers pairs Linen collars No. Dark blue flannel shirts No. Knit undershirts No. Drawers pairs Boots for mounted troops pairs Shoes for mounted troops pairs Barrack shoes pairs Stockings, woollen pairs Stockings, cotton pairs Blouses No. Overcoats No. Chevrons, eloth pairs Chevrons, gold lace pairs Stripes for trousers pairs Stable frock for mounted troops No. Overalls tor mounted troops pairs Blankets woollen No. Berlin gloves for mounted troops pairs Leather gauntlets pairs Suspenders pairs Cork helmets in lieu of campaign bats*. .No. Arctic overshoes* pairs Woollen mittens* .pairs Overcoats, far or other suitable material*.No. Furcaps* No. Fur gauntlets* pairs. First. ft ■ ■a § t § i 1 1 1 5 *When the necessity for their issue is certified to by the department com- mander, t Accounted for on return. ALLOWANCE OF EQUIPAGE. IN CAMP OR GIARRISON. Tents. 1 i % m 1 « H i la a A general officer 3 2 1 1 1 I 1 1 1 1 1 1 Field and staff officer above rank of captain Other staff officers or captains Subalterns of companies, to every two 2 To every 15 foot or 13 mounted men, . . To every 20 foot or 17 mounted men. . . "\ 2 2 2 2 1 FIELD- ABTILLEB Y. 453 TENTS FOR THE SICK, THEIR ATTENDANTS, AND HOSPITAL SUPPLIES. For 1 company.. 2 companies 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Tents. Hospital. Common. CORN BROOMS AND SCRUBBING-BRUSHES. To each battery, without regard to its numerical strength, 3 corn brooms and 3 scrubbing-brushes per month. BARRACK CHAIRS. One for each non-commissioned officer. One for every two enlisted men of all other grades. ALLOWANCE OF STOVES, FUEL, LAMPS, OIL, OFFICE FUR- NITURE, AND STATIONERY FOR A LIGHT BATTERY. Stoves. — 2 large stoves in each dormitory, 1 large stove in each mess-room and day-room, 1 small stove for each of the two rooms for non-commissioned officers, 1 small stove for the reading-room, blacksmith-shop, carpenter-shop, saddle-shop, and guard-room each, and one cooking-stove or range for the kitchen. Fuel (monthly). — For each enlisted man ^ cord of wood from May 1 to August 31, and ^ cord from Sept. 1 to April 30. Stations between 36 and 43 degs. N. lat. |* increase; stations further north ^increase. For guards, not to exceed 3 cords from Sept. 1 to April 30, with f cord increase for * J increase if mean temperature for 20 days < 30° F-; and if tem- perature is not above 10° F. an increase of i is allowed for any latitude. 454 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLBRT. stations between 36 and 43 degs. N. lat.j and 1 cord for those further north. Lamps. — One burner for every ten (10) men and every fraction thereof, when fraction is five or more, of maximum strength of organization, and lamps or lanterns, not exceed- ing 3 for each barracks, for lighting interior passage-ways. Office, guard-house and first sergeant each a lamp with single burner. Stables, number of lamps or lanterns re- quired, approved by department commander. Oil (monthly). — Four ounces per burner for 1-J-in. wicks and 2 ounces for smaller wicks during each hour of author- ized illumination. (1 gal. for 26 hours for large burner, or 52 hours for small burner.) Office Furniture. — To each desk, 1 ink-stand, 1 paper- folder, 1 ruler, 1 steel eraser, 1 piece of india-rubber, and 4 lead-pencils. Stationery (quarterly). — Battery commander : 6 qrs. writing-paper, i qr. envelope-paper, 10 sheets^ blotting- paper, 20 pens, 2 pen- holders, 1 pint black ink, 1 oz. red ink, i pint mucilage, 3 oz. sealing-wax, 1 piece oflSce tape, 80 envelopes. TABLE OF WEIGHTS OF CERTAIN ARTICLES OP CLOTHING AND EQUIPAGE. Article. Lbs. Oz. Article. Lbs. Oz. Overcoat 6 8 Blouse 2 Stable frock 1 4 Overalls 1 2 Drawers 14J Trousers 3 6 D. B. P. shirt 1 4 Knit undershirt 1 Mess-pan 1 10. Camp-kettle 5 8 Axe and helve 6 4 Hatchet and helve 1 8 Stockings, pair 4 Gauntlets, pair 7 Boots, pair 4 8 Shoes, pair 3 6 Leggins, pair 8 Blankets 5 Poncho 8 8 Rubber blankets 2 8 Spade 5 Shove], long 4 10 Shovel, short 5 Pickaxe and helve 7 12 MELD-ARrtLLER T. 455 TABLE OP MONTHLY PAY OF ENLISTED MEN. Year of enlistment. RA.HK AND SBRVICB. Company, Private — artillery, cavalry, and infantry Private (3d class)— engineers and ordnance. . Musician — engineers, artillery, and infantry.. Trumpeter— cavalry Wagoner — artillery, cavalry, and infantry Artificer— artillery and infantry Private— hospital corps Corporal— artillery, cavalry, and infantry Blacksmith, farrier, adli saddler — cavaliy — Sergeant— artillery, cavalry, and infantry Private (1st class)— engineers and ordnance . Corporal — engineers and ordnance First sergeant — artillery, cavalry, and infantry Sergeant — engineers, ordnance, and signal corps ,., ,. 1st class sergeant— signal corps Regiment. Chief trumpeter Saddler sergeant— cavalry Principal musician— artillery and infantrjt. , . . . Chief musician— artillery, cavalry, and infan- try. Sergeant-major— artillery, cavalry, and infan try ' Q. M. sergeant— artillery, cavalry, and infantry Sergeant-major and Q. M. sergeants-engineers. Ve(»rinary surgeon (senior) Veterinary surgeon (junior) Post. Ordnance sergeant Commissary sergeant Post guartermaster-sergeant. Hospital steward Acting hospital steward 4A cd at V $13 14 16 18 IS 18 17 90 S5 34 45 V 22 !■ 60 100 75 34 to $13 I Not f tio 18 I Not ) tio I Not f ad §^ $14 entitl nal p 19 16 19 18 21 26 8.i 46 entitl nal p 37 entitl ditio 35 Ed $15 ed to ay.t 47 84 ed to ay.t ed to nal $16 addi- 21 18 a* 20 83 85 addi- any pay. 37 48 + Under act May 15, 1873. t Act approved February 87, 1893, to take effect on and after 1st day of July 1893. 456 A HANDBOOK FOB LIOHT' ARTILLERY. On re-enlisting after 5 years' service, $3.00 per month in addition to pay received at time of discharge ($1.00 is re- tained), and for each 5 years' continuous service thereafter a further sum of $1.00 per month. The pay of a man who has ever re-enlisted under the act of August 4, 1854, and comes into the service again, com- mences with pay for fifth year. A certificate of merit entitles a soldier to $2.00 per month additional pay, commencing on the date of render- ing "distinguished service," and continuing through all subsequent service as an enlisted man. Enlisted men (retired) are entitled to three fourths of the monthly pay allowed by law to them in the grade they held when retired, with commutation of clothing and ra- tions. SUMMARY COURT. When charges are preferred against an enlisted man for offences cognizable by inferior courts-martial, they will be laid before the post commander, who, if he thinks that the accused should be tried, will cause him to be brought be- fore the summary court. Here he will be arraigned and allowed to plead, according to the practice of courts- martial. If an accused neither demands a removal of his case to a regimental or garrison court-martial; nor, being a non-commissioned officer above the rank of corporal, objects to trial by inferior court-martial; nor objects to be tried by the officer second in rank on the ground of his being the accuser; nor pleads guilty, witnesses will be sworn and evidence received, the accused being permitted to testify in his own behalf and make a statement; but the evidence and statement will not be recorded. When the summary court shall have arrived at a finding and judgment, the summary court record book, with the en- tries therein made in accordance with the headings of its FIELDARTILLER7. 457 columns, will be laid before the post commander for his action, which also will be entered in the record book, dated and signed. When a case is heard by the post commander, the proceedings will be recorded in the same book. No other record of the proceedings will be kept, and trials by summary court will not be published in orders. When a post commander sits as a summary court, no approval of the sentence is required by law, but he should sign the sentence as post commander and date his sig- nature. Rboord of Summakt Cottbt at. Name, rank, I company, and regiment, i .as .3 '3 Synopsis of specification. "F § tin p,.S3 s "S •S dS 1^ 15 Sentence, witb signature of trial officer. seI So.|S 2 §'•'2 S a « B o B o cd LIST OF PBBSCBIBED PUNISHMENTS FOB ENLISTED MEN. Akticle I. In all cases of desertion the sentence may include dis- honorable discharge and forfeiture of pay and allowances. Subject to the modifications authorized in Section 3 of this article the limit of the term of confinement (at hard labor) for desertion shall be as follows : Section 1. In case of surrender — (a) When the deserter surrenders himself after an ab- sence of not more than thirty days, one year. (6) When the surrender is made after an absence of more than thirty days, eighteen months. Sec. 3. In case of apprehension — {a) When at the time of desertion the deserter shall not 458 A HANDBOOK FOB LTOHT ABTtLLERY. have been more than six months in the service, eighteen months. (6) When he shall have been more than six months in the service, two and one hall years. Sec. 3. The foregoing limitations are subject to modi- fication under the following conditions: (a) The punishment of a deserter may be increased by one year of confinement at hard labor in consideration of each previous conviction of desertion. (5) The punishment for desertion when joined in by two or more soldiers in the execution of a conspiracy, or for desertion in the presence of an outbreak of Indians or of any unlawful assemblage which the troops may be op- posing, shall not exceed dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and confinement at hard labor for five years. Article II. Except as herein otherwise indicated punishment shall not exceed the limits prescribed in the following table : OfEences. Undke 17th Article of War. Selling horse or arms, or both Selling accoutrements Selling clothing Losing or spoiling horse or arms through neglect. Losing or spoiling accoutrements or clothing, through neglect. Limits of punishment. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and confine- ment at hard labor for three .vears. Four months^ confinemeut at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per montli for the same period; for non-commis- sioned offlcer, reduction in addition thereto. Two months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of JIO per month for the same period ; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. Four months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-com- missioned offlcer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. One month's confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10; for non-com- missioned offlcer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. FIELD AUTILLEB T. 459 Offences. Under 20th Article of War. Bebaving himself with disrespect to his commanding officer. Under 34th Article ov War. Refusal to obey or usin^ violence to officer or non-commissioned officer while quelling quarrels or disorders. Under 31st Article of War. Lying out of quarters Under 32d Article of War. Absence without leave — * Iiess than one hour From one to six hours t From six to twelve hours From twelve to twenty-four hours From twenty-four to forty-eight hours. From two to ten days From ten to thirty days From thirty to ninety days For ninety or more than ninety days. Limits of punishment. Six months' confinement at bard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-commis- Bioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. Dishonorable discharge, with forfeiture of all pay and allowances and con- finement at hard labor for two years. Forfeiture of $2; corporal, $3; sergeant, $4. Forfeiture of $1; corporal,$2; sergeant, $3; 1st sergeant or non-commissioned officer of higher grade, $4. Forfeiture of J2; corporal, 83; ser- geant, $4; 1st sergeant or non-com- missioned officer of higher grade, J5. Forfeiture of $3; corporal, 84; ser- geant, 86; 1st sergeant ornon-com- missioned officer of higher grade, Forfeiture of 85; corporal, $6 ; ser- geant, 87; 1st sergeant or non-com- missioned officer of higher grade, 810. Forfeiture of 86 and five days' confine- ment at hard labor. For corporal, forfeiture of 88; sergeant, 810; 1st sergeant or non-commissioned officer of higher grade. 812; or. for all non- commissioned officers, reduction. Forfeiture of $10 and ten days' con- finement at hard labor; for non-com- missioned ofiicer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. Forfeiture of 820 and one month's con- finement at bard labor; foi- non-com- missioned officer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. Three months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of 810 per month for same period ; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thei'eto. Dishonorable discharge and forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and six months' confinement at hard labor. * Upon trial for desertion and conviction of absence without leave only the court may, in addition to the limit prescribed for such absence, award a stop- page of the amount paid for apprehension. t Including first and excluding last. 460 A HAKDBOOK FOB LIQET ARTILLERY. Offences. Limits of punishment. Under 33d Artici-e of War. Failure torepairat the time fixed^etc-^ to the place of parade— For reveille or retreat roll-call and 11 P.M. inspection. Forfeiture of $1; corporal, $3; ser- geant, $3; 1st sergeant, $4. Forfeiture of $5; corporal, $8 ; ser- ^ geant, $10. For the weekly inspection Forfeiture of $S; corporal, $3; ser- geant, $5. For drill For guard-mounting (by musician) .... For stable duty Undeb 38th Akticlk of War. Drunkenness on— Guard . Six months* confinement at hard labor Duty as company cook Extra or special duty Atdrill and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. Forfeiture of $20. At parade At inspection At inspection of company guard detail. At stable duty ' sioned ofScer, reduction and for- feiture of $30. Under 40th Article of War. Under 51st Article of War. and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. Persuading soldiers to desert Under 60th Article of War. Under 62d Article of War. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and one year's confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and four years' confinemeut at hard labor. Assault, with intent to kill Burglaiy Forgery Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowaaces, and ten years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and ten years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and five years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and four years' confinement at hard labor. FIEL n-ABTILLER T. 461 Offences. Undsb 63d Article of War.— Con. Perjury. . Limits of punishitaent. False swearing. Bobbery. Larceny or embezzlement of prop- erty—* Of the value of more than 8100 .... Of the value of $100 or less and more than $50. Of the value of $50 or less and more than $20. Of the value of $80 or less Fraudulent enlistment, procured by false representation or concealment of a fact in regard to a prior enlist- ment or discharge, or in regard to conviction of a civil or military crime. Fraudulent enlistment, other cases of. Disobedience of orders, involvmg wil- ful defiance of the authority of a non- commissioned officer in the execution of his offlce. Using threatening or insulting la,n- guage or behavmg in an insubordi- nate manner to a non-commissioned officer while in the execution of his offlce. Absence from fatigue duty Absence from extra or special duty — Absence from duty as company or hospital cook. Introducing liquor into post or camp in violation of standing orders. Drunkenness at post or in quarters .... Drunkenness and disorderly conduct, causing the offender's arrest a,nd conviction by civil authorities at a place within ten miles of his station. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and four years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and two gears' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and six years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and four years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and three years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and two years' confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and one year's confinement at hard labor. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and confine- ment at hard labor for one year. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and confine- ment at hard labor for six months. Six months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. One month's confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10; for non-com- missioned ofBcer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. Forfeiture of $4; corporal, $5; ser- geant, $6. Forfeiture of $4; corporal, $5; ser- geant, $6. Forfeiture of $10. Forfeiture of $3; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction and forfeit- ure of $5. Forfeiture of $3 : for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction and forfeit- ure of $5. Forfeiture of $10 and seven days' con- finement at hard labor; for non- commissioned officer, reduction and forfeiture of $12. *In specifications to charges of larceny or embezzlement the value of the property shall be stated. 462 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. OfCences. Under 62d Artiolk op War.— Con. Noisy or disorderly conduct in quar- Abuse by non-commissioned officer of his authority over an interior. Non-commissioned ofilcer encouraging gambling. Non-commissioned officer making false report. Sentinel allowing a prisoner under his charge to escape through neglect. Sentinel wilfully suffering prisoner under his charge to escape. Sentinel allowing a prisoner under his charge to obtain liquor. Sentinel or member of guard drinking liquor with prisoners. Disrespect or affront to a sentinel Resisting or disobeying sentinel in lawful execution of his duty. Lewd or indecent exposure of person. Limits of punishment. Forfeiture of %i; corporal, $7; ser- geant, $10. Beduction, three months' confinement at hard labor, and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period. Eaduction and forfeitiu-e of $5. Reduction, forfeiture of $8, and ten days' confinement at hard labor. Six months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period. Dishonorable discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and one year's confinement at hard labor. Two months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period. Two months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period. Two months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction ia addition thereto. Six months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period: for non-commis- sioned officer, reduction in addition thereto. Three months' confinement at hard labor and forfeiture of $10 per month for the same period; for non-com- missioned officer, reduction in addi- tion thereto. Article III. Section 1. When a soldier shall be convicted of an offence the punishment for which, as authorized by Article II. of this order or the custom of the service, does not ex- ceed that which an inferior court-martial may award, the punishment so authorized may be increased by one half for every previous conviction of one or more offences within eighteen months preceding the trial and during the current enlistment; provided that the increase of punishment for five or more previous convictions shall not exceed that thus authorized when there are four previous convictions, and FIELD-ARTILLEBT. 463 that when one or more of such five or more previous con- victions shall have been by general court-martial, or when such convictions shall have occurred within one year pre- ceding the trial, the limit of punishment shall be dishonor- able discharge, forfeiture of all pay and allowances, and confinement at hard labor for three months. When the conviction is of an offence punishable under Article II. of this order or the custom of the service with a greater punishment than an inferior court-martial can award, but not punishable with dishonorable discharge, the sentence may, on proof of five or more previous convictions within eighteen months and during the current enlistment, impose dishonorable discharge and forfeiture of all pay and allowances in addition to the authorized confinement, and when this confinement is less than three months it may be increased to three months. When a non-commissioned ofiScer is convicted of an of- fence not punishable with reduction, he may, if he shall have been convicted of a military offence within a year and during the current enlistment, be sentenced to reduction, in addition to the punishment already authorized. Sec. 3. In every case when an offence on trial before a court-martial is of a character admitting of the introduc- tion of evidence of previous convictions, and the accused is convicted, the court, after determining its findings, will be opened for the purpose of ascertaining whether there is such evidence, and, if so, of hearing it. These convictions must be proved by the records of previous trials, or by duly authenticated orders promulgating the same, except in the cases of conviction by summary court, when a duly authenticated copy of the record of said court shall be deemed sufficient proof. Charges forwarded to the au- thority ordering a general court-martial, or submitted to a summary, garrison, or regimental court, must be accom- panied by the proper evidence of such previous convictions 464 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. as may have to be considered in determiring upon a sen- tence. Article IV. When a soldier shall, on one arraignment, be convicted of two or more offences, none of which is punishable under Article II. of this order or the custom of the service with dishonorable discharge, but the aggregate term of coniine- ment for which may exceed six months, dishonorable dis- charge with forfeiture of pay and allowances may be awarded in addition to the authorized confinement. Article V. This order prescribes the maximum limit of punishment for the offences named, and this limit is intended for those cases in which the severest punishment should be awarded. In other cases the punishment should be graded down ac- cording to the extenuating^ circumstances. Offences not herein provided for remain punishable as authorized by the Articles of War and the custom of the service. Article VI. Summary courts are subject to the restrictions named in the 83d Article of War. Soldiers against whom charges may be preferred for trial by summary court shall not be confined in the guardhouse, but shall be placed in arrest in quarters, before and during trial and while awaiting sen- tence, except when in particular cases restraint may be necessary. Article VII. The following substitutions for punishments named in Article II. of this order are authorized at the discretion of the court: Two days' confinement at hard labor for one dollar for- FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 465 feitnre; one day's solitary confinement on bread and water diet for two days' confinement at hard labor or for one dol- lar forfeiture; provided that a non-commissioned ofiicer not sentenced to reduction shall not be subject to confinement; and provided that solitary confinement shall not exceed fourteen days at one time, nor be repeated until fourteen days have elapsed, and shall not exceed eighty-four days in one year. Whenever the limit herein prescribed for an ofEence or offences may be brought within the punishing power of inferior courts-martial, as defined by the 83d Article of War, by substitution of punishment under the provisions of this article, the said courts have jurisdiction of such offence or offences. Article VIII. Non-commissioned officers above the rank of corporal shall not, if they object thereto, be brought to trial before regimental, garrison, or summary courts-martial without the authority of the officer competent to order their trial by general court-martial; nor shall sergeants of the post non- commissioned staff or hospital stewards be reduced, but they may be dishonorably discharged whenever reduction is included in the limit of punishment. U. 8. SIGNAL AND TELEGRAPH CODE. (Authorized by G. O. No. 59, A. G. O., June 88, 1889.) ALPHABET. A — F K P u. B G L Q V C -- H M R- -- w D I -- N-- S --- X E J - T — T- Z - . . . & 466 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLEBT. 1 -■ 3 -■ 3-- 4... NUMEEALS. 5 6 7 8 PtTNCTUATION MARKS. Comma Interrogation Parenthesis Pn Semicolon Si Quotation Qn Brackets Br Colon Ko Paragraph ' Dollar mark 8x Period Exclamation Dash Dx Hyphen Hx Underline Ux ■ Note. — A fraction is made by Inserting a dot between the numer ator and denominator: Example, | SIGNALS AND ABBREVIATIONS. 1. Wait a moment. 4. Start me. 5. Have you anything for me ? 7. Are you ready ? 8. Busy on other wires (or stations).. 9. Train order (or important military message) — give way. 13. Do you understand? 18. What is the matter ? 27. Adjust your magnet (or flash). 30. Circuit closed (or close station). 44. Answer quick. 73. Accept compliments. 92. Deliver (ed). 134. Who is at the key (flag, or torch)? Ahr. Another. Ans. Answer. Ok. Check. Col. Collect. D H. Dead head GA. Go ahead. G E. Good-evening. GM. Good-morning. GN. Good-night. G R. Government rate. NM. No more. O B. Official business. O K. All right. Opr. Operator. Pd. Paid. Qk. Quick. Sig. Signature. TO SIGNAL WITH FLAG OR TORCH. The flagman faces exactly toward the commv\nicating gtationj staff is vertical in front of centre of body, butt at FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 467 height of waist. The dot (-) is represented by a motion to the right, and the dash ( — ) by a motion to the left of the sender. The space, whether separating elements of spaced characters (C, 0, E, Y, Z, and " & "), or separating words, will be represented by a "front " motion. Thus the motions: Eight, right, front, right, represent C. Eight, front, right, represent 0. Eighti front, right, right, represent E. Each motion will embrace an arc of 90°, starting from and returning to the vertical. The long dash (letter " L " and numeral " naught ") is distinguished from the " T " dash by a slight pause at the lowest point of dip, and with this exception there will be no pause whatever between the motions required for any single letter. A slight paiise will be made between letters. At the end of each word, abbreviation, or conventional signal the space signal, or " front " motion, is made, preceded and followed by a pause equivalent to that made between letters. CONVENTIONAL SIGNALS FOR HELIOGRAPH OR FLASH LANTERN. To Call a Station. — Turn a steady flash on the station and keep it there until answered by a steady flash. Both stations will then adjust, each on the other's flash. When adjustments are satisfactory, the station called will acknowl- edge and cut off its flash, and the calling station will pro- ceed with the message. Adjustment. — If the receiver sees that the sender's mirror needs adjusting, he will turn on a steady flash until answered by a steady flash. When adjustment is satisfac- tory, the receiver will acknowledge, and the sender will resume his message. 468 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLMBY. COKVENTIONAL SIGKS FOE FLAG OR TORCH.* To Call a Station. — Signal the " call letter " of the station required, or, if the call letter be not known, signal " A " without pause until acknowledged. The calling station will then proceed with the message. To Acknowledge a Call. — Signal "I" three times fol- lowed by " front" and the call letter of the acknowledging station. To Break or Stop the Signals from the Sending Station. — Signal "A" without pause until acknowledged. To Start the Sending Station after Breaking. — Signal " G A " followed by " front " and the last word cori'ectly received; the sender will immediately resume his message, beginning with the word indicated by the recfeiver. If nothing has been received, signal "KR"; the sender will then repeat all. Error in Sending. — Signal seven dots (- ) rapidly followed by " front," and resume the message, beginning with the last word correctly sent. End of Address. — Signal the period ( -) followed by "front." Signature Follows. — Signal " Sig " followed by " front." To Acknowledge Receipt of a Message. — Signal "OK" followed by "front" and personal signal or initial of receiver. PENETRATION OF PROJECTILES. Experiments at-Lydd, in 1886, showed that earthen par- apets of sandy loam 13 feet thick were but little affected by the fire from B. L. 13-pdr. and 30-pdr. with steel * Each station should have its characteristic signal or call letter, as Washington, " W," and each operator his personal signal, (is Jones, " Jo." FIELD-ARTILLBB7. 469 shells, and the following rough rules will probably suffice against field-guns : For friable soil, such as sand, etc 3 yards For medium soil, such as ordinary earth 3^ yards For tenacious soil, such as clay 3 yards The following data, obtained from experiments by the Germans, may prove of service : PENETEATIOIS" FKOM AKTILLEEY-FIBE. Pield-artiUery. Shrapnel] ^^^^^^l^, [in earth, 16 to 39 in. Shrapnel, wood, overhead cover 3 in. Individual shot: Striking fair, earth 39 to 79 in. Striking fair, brickwork 39 in. Striking fair, snow about 37 ft. Garrison and Siege Artiilery. In earth 39 in. Wood, ) .. overhead cover j " • Earth 10 to 13 ft. PEKETEATION FROM INFANTKT-EIEE. Sand 29^ in. Ordinary earth 39 in. Rammed snow 6 ft. 9 in. Swampy or wet ground 79 in. Sheaves of grain. . . 16 ft. 9 in. Laid sods and turf 79 in. Pine 39in. Oak 34 in. Steel plate 0.8 in. Brickwork l^\n. A double thickness of planks filled in with broken stone 7.8 in. Penetration at all ranges has been increased with the new rifle (U. S.). At 200 to 300 yards protection is afforded by about 0.2 inch of steel plate and about 0. 3 inch wrought iron; at same distances penetration in earth is 25 inches, in pine, 30 inches, GUN-PITS FOR FIELD-ARTILLERY. THE FRENCH GUN-PIT. Description. — The French gun-pit consists of an epaule- ment, whose general direction is perpendicular to the line 470 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. of fire, with wings or returns at the sides, along which trenches are dug on the inside for the protection of the cannoneers. The earth for the epaulement is taken from a rectangular pit one and a half feet deep, and from the ramps and trenches leading to it. If there is not sufficient earth, more is obtained by digging a ditch in front. The lateral trenches may be prolonged and deepened to any extent. flench Ciav PO,. jrt. Pig. 136. Construction. — To trace the pit : 1. Lay off a line about ten feet in length perpendicular to the line of fire, to mark the foot of the interior slope of the epaulement. This line should be long enough to give the piece a field of fire of 90 degrees; mark the extremities and centre of the line with stakes or otherwise. MELD-AMTlLLMiT. All 2. In the wings lay off two lines five to seven feet in length, making with the first line angles such that the trenches shall not restrict the field of fire or interfere with the recoil of the piece. 3. Complete the rectangle of the pit, and mark the points of intersection of the trenches and the ramps lead- ing to it. 4. In soft ground it will be found to be more expeditious to use shovels; if the ground is hard, three picks and five shovels will be necessary for each detachment of eight men. The men should commence by breaking ground along the interior slope ; having picked a breadth of about two feet, they face about and advance toward the rear of the pit. As soon as there is room the shovels follow the picks. In picking the men should be instructed to strike to- gether to avoid accident. Under pressure this pit can be constructed in one and a half hours. THE GEEMAlf GUlir-PIT. The German gun-pit consists of a rectangular excavation one and a half feet deep, with a ramp leading to it from the rear. The epaulement is formed like an ordinary glacis, and. surrounds all but the entrance. This pit is easily and rapidly constructed, and, as seen from a distance, presents a very small target. The parapet being the same height all round, the gun can fire in any direction by widening the pit, which would then take the form of a semicircle. Construction. — 1. Lay off a line four yards in length perpendicular to the direction of the line of fire. At each extremity erect a perpendicular pf four yards. 472 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ARTILLERY. 2. From the vertices of the right angles thus formed lay off one yard on both the front and side lines, and mark the four points so determined, together with the rear ex- tremities of the sides, with sabres or stakes. GefrrLOn GurvFit>. ^Plan, Fig. 137. 3. Commence and continue the digging as prescribed in the construction of the French gun-pit. The pockets aa are for the reception of ammunition. 4. The ramp is laid out and completed after the pit is finished, or simultaneously with it, as may be most de- sirable. An ordinary gun detachment can construct this pit in one hour. THE AUSTBIAN GUN-PIT. A simple rectangular pit one and a half feet deep, with front epaulement and ramp. FIELB-ARTILLER Y. 4Y3 Construction. — Constructed similarly to the German, the earth from the pit being thrown to the front. It can be made in less than half an hour, and while af- fording no special cover to the cannoneers, as do the Ger- man and English, it can be made in half that time, and does not present a conspicuous target. AuatrCan. Gun^Pit:. PUuv Section onCentreZim^. S 10 IS Fig. 138. It has the further advantage of very rapid cover, and of being capable of transformation into any desirable pit if there be time. THE ENGLISH GUN-PIT. This type is a true "gun-pit," the bottom being below the natural surface of the ground, sloping up at back of pit toward the rear. It affords excellent cover for the piece and its detachment, can be readily marked out, and constructed in a comparatively short time. 474 A SANDmoK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. The lateral trenches, if extended, would afford a covered way along the front of the battery. The defects in this pit are a contracted field of fire, the conspicuous mark which the embrasure gives the enemy, the lack of ammunition-pockets, and want of drainage. Construction. — 1. Lay off 8 feet 6 inches on a line per- pendicular to the probable direction of fire for the interior crest, and at the middle point of this line determine a per- BngliaK Gitn^Pte. Flan- SectXoTV on- CenireLint' y f ^ Y f^ rLnFuiioa. Fig. 139. pendicular to it ; on this perpendicular lay off from the interior crest distances of 6 feet, 10 feet, and 18 feet, and through their extremities determine lines parallel to the interior crest; on these lines find points that are 6 feet from the perpendicular on both sides of it, putting in a stake or sabre at each point so determined. Extend the parallels at 6 feet and 10 feet, 4 feet on each side, and mark the points thus established for the lateral trenches. PIELL-AKTILLEltY. Alo 2. Commence excavating at the interior crest, throwing the earth to the front and sides (being careful to allow a berme of about one foot), thus forming an epaulement 1 foot 6 inches high and 10 feet 5 inches thick at bottom, extending round to the front corner of the lateral trenches. Then throw the earth out to the side front to form mounds about 4 feet high in front of the lateral trenches to still better protect the detachment, sufficient space being left in front for an embrasure. Dig down two feet throughout the pit back to the line 10 feet from the interior crest and level ofE the bottom. Slope up from the bottom of the pit at ten-foot line back to the eighteen-foot line. If desirable to connect adjoining pits of this class, extend the lateral trenches until they meet. Time of construction of pit complete in all its details, with detachment of eight cannoneers, gunner, and chief of section, in stiff clay, without previous practice, one hour and twenty minutes. OEDIKAKT KUSSIAN GUN-PIT. This type differs from the gun-pit proper, in that the wheels rest on the natural surface of the ground, the side- pits being for the cannoneers. The only apparent advan- tages are good cover for the detachment under heavy fire, drainage as far as the piece is concerned, and facility for ingress and egress. The obvious disadvantages are con- tracted space for working party in digging, contracted field of fire, and the mark presented by the embrasure to hos- tile fire. Construction. — Lay off on a line perpendicular to the probable direction of fire 10 feet, prolong the line 5 feet 3 inches in both directions, and mark the four points thus determined with stakes or sabres. At the middle point of the ten-foot line erect a perpendicular to it and lay off on this perpendicular to the rear 9 feet 2 inches; through this 476 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. point determine a parallel to the ten-foot line and lay off on it, on both sides of the perpendicular, 9. feet and 14 feet 3 inches, marking the four points so determined with stakes or sabres. The parallelograms whose vertices are thus established fix the surface-lines of the lateral trenches. Dig down to 4 feet 6 inches for the bottom of the trenches and throw the dirt to the front and side, giving the epaulement a height of 3 feet, and leaving space for the embrasure in Ruasiein- GunPlt. Fig. 140. front. When time permits, cut outside and rear steps for the trenches, as indicated, to admit of quick egress for the gun detachment. Time of construction complete, soil and detachment same as English pit, two hours. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 4,11 GENERAL OBSERVATIOSTS ON GUN-PITS. In forming the epaulement, leave a berme of at least a foot; and, when there is time, level and ram the earth, which, in front of the muzzle, should not be more than three and one half feet above the bottom of the pit. If there are side trenches, the earth in front of them should be high enough to afEord complete protection to the men occupying them. Pockets for the reception of the ammunition are very important in saving the ammunition from water which may accumulate, and from the fire of the enemy. The field of fire should not be less than 90 degrees. Avoid narrow embrasures as presenting an easy mark, and as likely to draw the fire of the enemy. Cover should first be provided for the men and horses; then for the material. If the position is occupied for some time, strengthen the parapet by earth from a ditch in front. Prolong the lateral trenches of the adjacent pits until they meet, forming a continuous parapet ; if possible, plank or macadamize the bottom of the pit. Traverses between the guns will be found effective. In order to conceal the parapets, cover the fresh earth with boughs, sod, or top-soil of the prevailing or surround- ing color. If in winter, use snow for this purpose. A very effective plan is to dig a small trench or parapet from fifty to seventy-five yards in front of the real pits, thus de- ceiving an enemy as to where the real fire comes from. If the ground does not afford natural cover for the lim- bers, limber-pits, similar to the Austrian gun-pits, can be easily constructed. They should be one foot deeper. TEEATMENT OF SICK MEN. Bleeding. — Blood from the veins is dark and flows slowly; that from arteries is bright red and is thrown out in spurts, 478 A HANDBOOK FOB Ll&Sr ABTILLEBT. To suppress bleeding from a vein, use cold water when slight; or place a moderately tight bandage below the wound. If an artery, completely obstruct the artery by pressure at the bleeding point, or between it and the heart. Do this by means of the fingers, a pad and bandage, a plug, or a tourniquet. Make a knot in a handkerchief and place it at the proper spot over the course of the artery, then tie the handkerchief around the limb and by means of a stick twist it tight. In bleeding from hand, fore arm, or arm apply around arm near the shoulder; in bleeding of the foot, leg, or thigh apply around leg between knee and hip according to circumstances. Chafing. — Chafing between the thighs may be alleviated by keeping the parts scrupulously clean, and powdered with fuller's earth, or a mixture of oxide of zinc and very finely powdered starch. Colic. — Dose of castor-oil, hot applications to belly, and a teaspoonf ul of Squibb's mixture or ginger essence in water. Cholera Morbus. — 1 teaspoonful of paregoric, ^ grain of morphine, or 1 teaspoonful of Squibb's mixture diluted may be given at once. Hot applications to belly. Stimu- lants in case of collapse. Constipation. — A seidlitz powder, or a tablespoonful of Kochelle or Epsom Salts before breakfast ; a teaspoonful of compound liquorice powder, or 3 or 3 compound cathartic pills, late at night. Burns and Scalds. — Cover with vaseline or carron oil (equal parts of lime water and oil). If oil is not at hand, use flour or scraped potato. A tablespoonful of baking- soda to a teacupful of water soon relieves, pain. Dress with lint or cotton-wool. Blisters should be carefully opened with a needle or scissors. Diarrhoea. — Dose of castor-oil; if after oil has acted the diarrhoea persists, a teaspoonful of Squibb's mixture FIBLD-ARTILLEEY. 479 diluted; or a camphor and opium pill, to be repeated in ar hour if necessary. Drowning. — If the patient has stopped breathing, tight clothing is first loosened; the individual is then turned over on his face, a roll of clothing, a rolled blanket, etc., being placed under his stomach, his mouth and nose are cleared of sand, mud, or other substances collected therein, and pressure is made upon the spine and kept up until water ceases to flow from the mouth. The patient is then turned over on his back, and the roll placed under his slioulder-blades so as to raise the shoulders and extend the throat. The tongue, being drawn well forward, is either secured by a string or rubber band, passing around the base of the organ and the chin, fixed by thrusting a small stick or pencil across the top of it behind the molar teeth, or held by an assistant. Then, kneeling behind the patient's head, seize the arms above the elbows and draw them outwards and upwards until they are fully extended above the head. After a pause of about two seconds the arms are carried back to their original positions, tlie oper- ator making firm pressure on the chest at the same time. This procedure is carried out at the rate of about fifteen times a minute. Whenever the arms are raised, the chest is expanded and air enters the lungs; when they are brought dbwn and pressure is made upon the chest, the latter is compressed and the air is expelled. The natural movements of respiration are hence imitated. This should be kept up for hours if necessary, and until natural breath- ing returns, or the case has been given up as hopeless by competent authority. During this time warm and dry clothing should have been placed on the patient, a fire built, and warm articles of any kind used to restore the heat of the body. The body and limbs should be constantly nibbed towards the trunk. As soon as the patient is able to swallow a teaspoonful of hot liquor in a tablespoon ful 480 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. of water may be given every few minutes until the danger is over. As soon as the patient begins to breathe of his own accord the artificial process should be timed to aid the natural respiration. Breathing may be stimulated by hold- ing hai'tshorn to the nose, slapping the skin, or by dashing hot water on the chest. After being restored the patient should be carefully cur- ried in a recumbent position, put in a warm bed, and care- fully watched for stoppage of breathing. If the patient has not stopped breathing when drawn out of the water, proceed as above, omitting artificial respiration except when the natural function begins to fail. Emetics. — Gunpowder dissolved in water. One table- spoonful of mustard in a pint of water and then copious draughts of tepid water. Twenty grains of sulphate of zinc dissolved in water, to be followed by a cupful of tepid water, and repeated every three minutes until 3 or 4 doses have been given or vomiting has occurred. Fainting. — Place patient on his back, head low, arms and feet may be elevated; loosen tight clothing; dash cold water in face; hold hartshorn to nostrils; a little whiskey and water when able to swallow. Frost-bites. — Eub with snow or cold water. Intoxication. — Pour water over head; give teaspoonful of ground mustard stirred up in a teacupful of lukewarm water; then, after vomiting has occurred, give a teaspoon- ful of aromatic spirits of ammonia in a teacupful of water, or a large draught of vinegar. If in danger of dying, general application of heat to body is imperative. Heat Exhaustion resembles an ordinary fainting spell, and is similarly treated. Unlike sunstroke this condition presents a cool moist skin. Sunstroke. — Its symptoms of warning are headache and oppression, followed after a time by loss of consciousneasj FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 481 breathing labored; skin intensely hot; perspiration ab- sent; the bladder and bowels sometimes discharge in- voluntarily. Convey immediately to a cool place ; remove clothing ; place in cold bath, or wrap with sheets soaked in cold water, and keep wet with ice-water if possible. If this cannot be done, sponge thoroughly and continually the head and body, lumps of ice being rubbed over the chest and placed over the large blood-vessels in the arm-pits and groins. Discontinue application of cold when consciousness returns, to be renewed only in case temperature rises above normal (98.9° F.) or insensibility returns. Sore Feet. — If the feet begin to chafe, rub the socks with common soap where they come in contact with sore places. By rubbing the feet with hard soap before the march you may escape having sore feet. The feet should be washed every night and thoroughly dried. Blisters should not be opened, but have a thread run through. TABLES OP WEIGHT, CAPACITY, ETC. NUMBER OF POUNDS IN A BUSHEL. Corn or rye , 56 Clover-seed 60 Dried apples or peaches 28 Hemp-seed 44 Wheat 60 Potatoes 60 Salt 50 Bluegrass-seed 14 Oats 32 Beans 60 Onions 67 Castor beans 46 Barley... 48 Peas 60 Timothy-seed 45 Flaxseed 56 NUMBER OF POUNDS IN A BARBEL. Flour 196 Beef, pork, or flsh. . . . 200 Salt _280 CYLINDERS FOR LIQUID MEASURES. Diam. Height. Igill If in. 3 in. ipint 2i " 3f " Ipint 3i " 3 " 1 quart ^" 6 " Diam. Height 1 gallon . 7 in. 6 in. 3 gallons 7 " 12 " 8 " 14 " 12 " 10 " 14 " 15 " 482 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLERT. CAPACITY OF BOXES. A cubic yard contains 21.69 bushels. 1 barrel = 34 X 16 X 28 inches i " =24X24 Xl4 " 1 bushel = 16 X 16.8 X 8 " 1 " = a cylinder 14 in. diam. X 14 In. deep ^ '■ = 12 X 11.2 X 8 inches Ipeck = 8X 8.4X8 " 1 gallon = 8X8 X 4.2 " (diy) 1 " = 6 X 6 X 6.42 " (liquid) i " = 7X 4 X4.5 " 1 quart = 4x 4 x4.1 " (dry) 1 " = 4 X 4 X 3.61 " (liquid) In' freighting ships 43 cubic feet are allowed to a ton. ABMT WAGON (iNSIDE MEASUKEMENT). ( 9i ft. at bottom ) length j jQ " " top i ' "^^''*^' ^ '*■ ■* ^■'' depth, 1 ft. 9 in. TO DBTEEMIKE THE QUANTITY OF GRAIN OB HAY. Corn. — Two cubic feet of sound dry corn in the ear will make one bushel of shelled corn. To determine the number of bushels of shelled corn in a crib of corn in the ear, multiply together the interior length, breadth, and height of the crib in feet, and divide by 3. Oats. — A nosebag will contain about 10 pounds of good oats. A cubic foot of good oats weighs about 25f pounds. To determine, approximately, the number of bushels of oats in a bin, multiply the length, breadth, and height in feet together, and multiply the result by 0.8047. To determine the number of bushels a wagon will con- tain, apply the same rule. FIELD-ARTILLEB.7. 483 Hay. Hay loose allow 5 pounds to a cubic foot Hayinstack " 8 ' " Hay baled " 11 " "" " Wagon-load of stack hay. ...... " 450 to 500 cubic feet to a ton " " " new-mown hay. . . " 700 cubic feet to a ton Straw. — Allow 10 to 12 pomids to a cubic foot. MBASUKES OF LENGTH. LONG MBASUBK. 12 inches make 1 foot ft. 3 feet " 1 yard yd. 5J yards " 1 rod rd. 40 rods " 1 furlong., fur. 8 furlongs, or 320 rods, " 1 mile mi. 3 miles " 1 league... lea. survetoe's meastihb. 7.92 inches make 1 link li. 100 links " 1 chain ch. 80 chains " 1 mile mi. SQITAEB MEASUKE. 144 square inches make 1 square foot. . sq. ft. 9 square feet " 1 square yard. sq. yd. 30J square yards " 1 square rod. . sq. rd. leo square rods " 1 acre A. LAND MEABUBE. 10,000 square links make 1 square chain 10 square chains " 1 acre 640 acres " 1 square mile CUBIC MEASURE. 1728 cubic inches make 1 cubic foot ... cu. ft. 37 cubic feet " 1 cubic yard ... cu. yd. 128 cubic feet " 1 cord. . . C. 484 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLEBT. LIQUID MEASURE. The standard U. S. gallon equals 331 cubic inches, and contains 8.3311 pounds of pure water at 62° F. A cubic foot of pure water at 62° P. weighs 62.33 pounds. The liquid quart is about six seyenths of a quart of dry measure. Name. Equivalent. Litres. Decalitres. Hectolitres. 1 eill.. . .1183 .4732 .9468 3.7858 1 pint 1 quart 1 gallon . . . 4 gills 2 pints 4 quarts Z\^ gallons 2 barrels 2 hogsheads 2 pipes 11.9337 33.8474 1.1934 1 hogshead 1 pipe 1 tun 2.3847 4.7694 9.5389 1 litre = 8.4536 gills = 2.1134 pints = 1.0567 quarts. DET MEASUEB. The bushel (Winchester) contains nearly 2150.42 cubic inches, and is a cylinder measure 18| inches across and 8 inches deep. A bushel measure will contain 9.31 gallons of pure water at 62° F. Name. Equivalent. Litres. Decalitre. 1 pint .5506 1.1012 8.8096 35.2384 1 quart 2 pints 8 quarts 4 pecks '• 1 peck 1 bushel 3.5238 1 litre = 1.816 pints = .908 quart. FIBLD-ABTILLBRT. 485 apothecaries' measure. 60 minims (Tti) 1 fluid drachm (f. 3) 8 drachms (water 1.733 cu. in., 437i grains) 1 fluid oz. (f. |) 20 ounces 1 pint (0.) 8 pints (water 70,000 grains) 1 gallon (gall.) 1 drop 1 grain 60 drops 1 drachm 1 drachm 1 teaspoonful 4 drachms 1 tablespoonful 8 drachms (2 tablespoonfuls) 1 ounce 2 ounces (water 875 grains) 1 wineglassful 3 ounces 1 teacupful MISCELLANEOUS TABLES. COUNTING. 12 things make 1 dozen doz. 12 dozen " 1 gross gr. 12 gross " 1 great gross g. gr. PAPER. 24 sheets make 1 quire qr. 20 quires " 1 ream ream 2 reams " 1 bundle bund. 2 bundles 1 bale BOOKS. A book in which Each sheet is folded into 2 leaves is a folio ( t* 4 ' (( quarto, or 4to t it 8 ' octavo, or 8vo < 00BOH«3g«gJ;05Og53g«g.ggJ;g»o^ 494 A HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ABTILLBBT. CAMP FURNITURE. The following-Darned articles, manufactured by the Gold Medal Camp Furniture Manufacturing Company, of Kacine, Wis., can be obtained of furniture dealers : Folding Camp-bed. — 6 feet 3 inches long by 2 feet 4 inches wide. When folded, it is 3 feet 4 inches long by 5 inches wide. Weight, 14 pounds. Cost, $3.50. Mosquito- bar frame, 75 cents. Folding Camp-table.— Top 3 feet 3 inches by 3 feet 2 inches. Will comfortably seat four persons. Folded it is 3 feet 2 inches long by 5 X 7 inches. Weight, 16 pounds. Cost, $3.75. Extra shelf, 75 cents. Folding Camp-chair.— Folded, 3 feet long by 8 x 3 inches. Weight, 4^ pounds. Cost, $2. Folding Camp-stool. — 75 cents. The attention of officers desiring such articles is called to the mess-chest and stove manufactured by H. K. Coale, 1223 Chamber of Commerce, Chicago 111. THE OFFICER'S FIELD MESS-CHEST FOR SIX PERSONS. Size, 22 X 15 X 12 inches. Weight, 60 lbs. Price, $50. ' CONTElirTS. SIIiTER-PIiATED WABB. 1 quadruple-plated butter-dish. 1 " covered sugar-bowl. 1 " creamer. 6 Rogers & Bros, best triple-plate steel knives. 6 (( te te " forks. 6 (I ce tt tablespoons. 6 it (t tt teaspoons. 1 tt a tt butter-knife. I (t tt tt sugar-shell. FIELD-ABTILLEBT. 495 1 large salt-shaker, strong glass. 1 " pepper-shaker, " " 1 screw-top oil-jug, " " 1 " vinegar-jug, " " 1 [japanned] tray, 13 X 16 inches. 1 large corkscrew. 6 individual butter-shells. 1 brass bottle-tray. WHITE ENAMELLED WABB. 6 cups. 6 saucers. 6 plates. 6 soup-bowls. 3 10-inch vegetable-dishes, B. & W. ware. 1 14-inch meat-platter, " " 1 16-inch 1 4-quart pitcher, " " 1 mustard-pot. 1 Sears' set carvers, 3 pieces, buck-horn handles. 1 best steel bread-knife. 1 new patent lemon-squeezer. 1 nickel-plated liquor-mixer. 1 agate-ware teapot. 1 syrup-jug. 6 snow-white enamel tumblers. 1 wire teapot-stand. COALE'S CAMP-STOVE AND OUTFIT. Sold with or without chest. This chest is made very strong, with metal corners, size 13 X 19 X 28 inches. Contains: 1 stove with oven (stove is 36 X Vt^ X 11 inches; has 4 cast-iron 7-inch lids; oven is 8 X 16^ X 10^ inches), 4 lengths pipe, 1 elbow, 1 baking- pan, 1 frjring-pan, 1 basting-spoon, 3 camp-kettles, 1 wash- 496 A HANDBOOK FOB LIGHT ABTILLEBT. bowl, 6 iron knives, forks, and spoons, 6 white enamel cups, 6 white enamel saucers, 1 carving-knife and fork, 1 tea-kettle, 1 saucepan, 1 poker, 1 wire broiler, 1 cake- turner, 1 basting-fork. This outfit is for rough and ready service, and can be thrown into a wagon on short notice. Price of outfit as above, with oven, packed in pine box $15.00 Same with chest 25.00 INDEX. A PAOE Abscess 207 Accidents to carriages 273 Accoutrements, cost of 442 Adiabatic transformation , . . . 363 Air-space, initial, defined 363 Allowance, projectiles for target practice 447 , revolver ammunition 160 of wagons 297 Ammunition, 3.2-inch gun, description of 96 , 3.6 " " " " 108 ,3.6 "(mortar) " " 117 , Hotcbltiss revolving cannon 322 , 1.65-inch mountain, description of 6, 7 ,3.0 " " " " 27-29 , fixed, for field-guns, " " 87 , 1.65-inch, instructions for packing 18 , how supplied to mountain-batteries. '. , . . 60, 61 , allowance for target practice 447 , allowance for revolver practice. 160 .how prepared 31, 32, 180, 181 , proportion of each kind for mountain-battery 34 , rounds in box for 1.65-inch 12 , care of 178 , how painted 178 chest, contents of 135 boxes for 1.65-inch 12 pack, rounds carried in 12 Angle of departure 364 of elevation 364 ofsight 364 497 498 INDEX PAGE Animals, salt and vinegar for 433 Apothecaries' measure 485 Artillery commander, duties of 376 corps 263 , divisional. 362 , transportation by sea 301 , how stored on shipboard 301, 302 , disembarkation from shipboard 303, 314 , transportation by rail 301 , organization of 261 , proportion of, in army 262 teams, power of 194 -wagon, weight and description of 149 -harness 150 -wagon harness 157 Axes, where carried on caisson 143 Axle-seats for field-gun carriage, nomenclature 127 Armament, how stored on railroad cars 306 on shipboard 302 Army-wagon, inside measurement 482 Austrian light artillery 121 mountain-artillery 70, 71 g^un-pits 473 B Barley, pounds in bushel 481 Barrels, weights and dimensions of 417 Barraclc chairs, allowance of 453 Battalion commander, duties of 377 Batteries, the different kinds of 361 Battery books and records 431 , light, enlisted men for 263 , composition of 262 , organization of 263 , present organization of 434 commander, duties of .'. .. 377 guard 181-187 , cost of 435 , special-duty men allowed 434 , supply table of ordnance stores for 445 tableware and kitphen utensijs 45 J INDBX. 499 FAQB Battery-wagon and forge, weight and description of 144 , nomenclature 145 , articles carried on 145 , storing of implements 147 Beans, pounds in bushel , 481 Beef ..pounds in barrel 481 Belt, oflcer's, cost of 443 Bivouacs , 388 Blacking for harness 62 Bladder, inflammation of 207 , irritation of 207 Blasting, dynamite 420 Blocks, etc 394 Blue-grass seed, pounds in bushel 481 Boats, buoyancy of 416 for bridges. ... 415 Books kept in light battery 431 Bowbrake, nomenclature and description 127 Bowels, inflammation of 208 Boxes, capacity of 482 Bran-mash, how made 206 Bread, rule for making 69 Breaking camp i 296 Breech-block, field-gun, description of 73 mechanism, field-gun, action of 81 , how dismounted 83 , how assembled 83 , 3.6-inch mortar 113 , Gatlinggun, action of ' 331 , Hotchkiss revolving cannon, how assembled 321 , how dismounted 320 Bridges, boat 415 , floating 415 , flying 414 , frame 406 ,lock 406-408 , sling 409 , stringer 411 , trestle 404 , roadway for 403 , passage of military 278 , weights borne by 402 500 INBEX. PAGE Bronchitis 208 Bronze-handle for field-gun 80 Bruce feed for Gfatling gun. 333 Buoyancy of boats 416 of casks 416 Bums 209 and scalds (men) 478 Bushel, cubic yards in 482 Caisson, field, nomenclature and description. 139 , weights and equipments 148 , articles carried on 140 , implements stowed on 141 , HotoKkiss revolving cannon 325 Camp, selection of 280 , laying out of 380, 282-387 , duties on reaching 281 , breaking of. 296 for mountain-batteries 67-68 for battalion of artillery 386 -furniture.. 494 -stove • , 495 Canister, general description 371 , 3.2-inch, description of 96 .3.6 " ■' " 108 , 1.65 " " " 7 .3.0 " " " 29 , how painted 178 , when used 373, 337 Canvas buckets, where carried on caisson 142 Cannoneers, 1.65-inch gun mountain -battery. 31 ,3.0 " '. • « •« ...; 34 Carpenter's and wheelwright's chest, contents of 145 Carriages, accidents to. . . ..' ^ 373 field-gun, description of. 129 , noinenclature. . . I35 , Hotchkiss revolving cannon 333 , Gatling gun 337 , Gardner gun 35I , Maxim automatic machine-gun 358 INDEX. 501 FXQE Carriage, metallic, for machine-gun 361 , 1.65-iuclL gun, description of 8 , how packed 17 , 3.0-inch gun, description of 84 , 3.6rinch mortar, description and nomenclature 114 , field-gun, axle-seat, nomenclature 127 , bowbrake, " 127 , elevftting device, nomenclature 1^7-129 , care of 174 , limber, articles carried on 136 Cartridge, 1 .65-inch gun, how assembled 32 -bags, how filled 180 -case, " " 32 Cargoes, how packed 41 , how loaded. 42 , how unloaded 47 Carrier-ring, description of 75 Cars, horse, dimensions of 308 , passenger, seating capacity 306 Castor beans, pounds in bushel 481 Casks, buoyancy of 416 Chafing(men) 478 Cholera morbus (men) 478 Clothing, allowance of 452 and equipment for men on march. 267 , table for calculating, accounts 492 , weight of 454 Clover-seed, pounds in bushel 481 Cold , 53 Collar, steel, description of and how fitted 154-156 Colic, spasmodic ., 65, 209 (men) 478 Commander, artillery, duties of 376 .battalion, " " 377 .battery, " " 377 Cooking, camp • 293 utensils in field 265 Corps, artillery 262 , duties of chief 377 Constipation - 210 (men)....- 478 Cordage 398 502 INDEX. PAQE Corns 310 Corn brooms, allowance of , 453 Com, how to determine quantity of 483 , pounds in bushel 481 Cracked heels 311 Cramp 56 Cross-flie , 366 Curb.. 311 Cubic measure 483 D De Bange obturator, description of 77 Definitions : Adiabatic transformation 363 Air-space, initial 363 Angle of departure 364 Angle of elevation 364 Angleof sight 364 Ballistics, exterior 363 , interior 363 Cross-fire 366 Density 363 Density, gravimstric 363 of loading 363 , sectional 363 , spherical 363 Detonation 363 Direct fire 365 Drift 365 Enfilade fire 366 Final velocity 365 Flanking fire 366 Gunpowder, ignition 363 , inflammation 362 , combustion 362 , ex|>losion 363 , slow 363 High-angle fire 365 Indirect fire 365 Initial velocity 365 Jump 365 Line of departure 364 INDEX. 503 PAGE Line of fire 364 of sight 364 Oblique fire 365 Plane of fire. . 364 Point of mean impact 367 Plane of sight 364 Probable rectangle 367 Probability of fire 366 Reduced length '. 363 Remaining velocity 365 Reverse fire 366 Similar guns 363 .Similarly loaded guns 363 Trajectory 363 Velocity of emission 363 , initial 865 , remaining 365 , final 365 Deflection, rule for correcting 95 Dentition of horse 196 Demolition 437^29 Destruction of horses 360 Detonation 363 Diarrhcea 478 Direct fire ; 365 Diseases of the horse (see Veterinary Treatment) 800 mule " " " 53 Disembarkation from shipboard 301, 314 Distances, estimation of 374 Distemper • 311 Ditches, how crossed 376 Divisional artillery 363 Dressing for harness 61 Dried apples, pounds in bushel 481 Drift 365 Driggs-Schroeder field-gun, 84 , how dismounted 85 , how assembled 86 Drowning 479 Dri vers, mountain-batteries, instructions for 63-64 Dynamite, description of 420 , how used in blasting 420 Dry measure • • • 484 504: INDEX. E PASS Elevating device for iield-carriage 127, 139 Emetics (men) 480 Enfilade fire 366 England, mountain-artillery 70 , light artillery 123 , gun-pit 474 Enlisted men, light battery, description of 263 , equipment and clothing on march 267 . , pay table for 455 Equipage, allowance of 452 , weight of ;..... 454 Equipment, etc., for officers on march 265 , of personnel of battery 264 , for enlisted men on march 267 , of 1.65-inch mountain-battery 20 ,of3.0 " " " 34 , weight of, in field-battery. ... 138 Exterior ballistics 363 Eye 54 P Painting 480 Farcy : 211 Peed, Bruce, for Gatling gun 332 , Acoles " " " 333 , improved, for Gatling gun ,. . . 834 Feeding animals on cars 304 animals 50, 238 Perry. . .'. 414 Pield-artillery, foreign 130-123 Field-gun carriage, nomencla,ture 125 , description 139 , axle-seat, nomenclature 127 , bowbrake " 127 , elevating device " 137-129 limber, description and nomenclature 131-135 Field-guns, construction of 73 , 3. 3-inoh, description of 89 , 3.6 " " " .. 108 , breech-mechanism 73 , action of 81 tNDBX. 605 FAQE Field-guns, Gerdom breech-mechanism 86 , Driggs Schroeder breech-mechanism 84 , how dismounted 85 , how assembled.. 86 , bieech-mechanism, how dismounted 83 assembled 83 .bronze-handle 80 , carrier-ring 75 , latch , 76 , latch-cover 75 , hinge-pin 76 , locking-recess 75 , guide-groove 75 , guide-sectors .• 75 , lever-handle 79 , obturator 77-78 , stop 76 , vent-cover 80 , pointing-arcs for 98 , " , how used. 95 , sight, front 90 , rear 9S , fixed ammunition for 87 , how disabled 275 Field-ovens, how made 394 Filters, how made 295 Final velocity 365 Fish, pounds in barrel 481 Fistula 54, 211 Firing, night 391 .indirect 890 , projectiles used 385 Fire, rates of 888 Flankingfire 366 Floats, cask, how made 416 Floating bridges 415 Flying bridges 414 Flaxseed, pounds in bushel 481 Flour, pounds in barrel 481 Foot inflammation 213 Foreign light artillery 120-133 506 INDEX. FAsa Foreign mountain artillery, 70-71 Forage, allowance of 239 , how fed 339 , weight of 339 Fords, how crossed 277, 414 Forge-chest, contents of 146 Founder ■ 313 Frame bridges 406 Freight, cubic yards to ton 483 France, mountain-artillery 70 .light " 12 364 of sight 364 Pleurisy 321 Pneumonia 333 Pointing-arc for field-guns 93 , how used 95 -scale, 3.6-inch mortar, 116 Pole-prop, where carried 136 Poll evil 54 Point of mean impact 367 Potatoes, pounds in bushel 481 Pork, pounds in barrel 481 Poultice, how made 306 Powder, care and transportation of 178 Probability of fire 366 Probable rectangle 367 Projectiles, how filled , 181 , kinds used in firing 385 , penetration of 468 Prolonge, length of, and where carried 136 , weight of 138 Price-list, accoutrements 443 , horse equipments 443 , light artillery harness 440 , light battery 435 , knife 443 , lanterns 445 , marking-outfit 445 , officer's belt 443 sabre 442 spurs 444 , revolver 160 , packing-outfit, 1.65-inch mountain-gun 441 , sabre, enlisted men's 442 , stencil outfit 444 Punctures from shoeing 233 Punishments 453 Purging 323 INDEX. 515 Q PAOB Quittor 224 Quadrant, gunners' 116 B Rack-a-rock 423 Rafts 417 Ration, the 433 , travel 434 Ramps for loading animals 305 Range-finding 375 Range, method of finding 381 Range tables : Hotcbklss revolving cannon 326 1.65-iuch mountain-gun 10 3.0 " " " 33 8.2-inch field-gun, shell 106 " " " " shrapnel > 104 3.6 " " " shell 112 " " " " shrapnel 110 3.6-inch " mortar, shell 118 " " " " shrapnel 119 Record books, battery .' 431 Reduced length "..... 363 Remaining velocity 365 Reports, rolls, and returns, battery 432 Reverse fire • 366 Revolver, cal. .45 Colt's, description 158 , nomenclature. 158 , how assembled 159 , weights, etc., of parts 159 , rapidity of fire 159 ; penetration 160 , price-list 160 Rheumatism 224 Ringworm 224 Rope, kinds of 393 , preservation of 393 Russian gun- pit 475 mountain-artillery ■ 70 light artillery 121 516 INDEX. S PAGE Sabre, officer's, price of 442 , enlisted men's, price of 442 Saddle, nomenclature 151 , liow placed on horse 170 Saddle-blanket, how folded, etc 169 Salutes 491 Saddler's chest, contents of. 146 Salt for animals . . , 483 , pounds in bushel 481 in barrel 481 Sand-crack 225 Scurvy 225 Sectional density 368 Shell, definition of 368 , when and how used 385 , penetration of 368 , how filled 31 , how painted 178 , 1.65-inch mountain-gun 7 ,3.0 " " " 28 , 3.2-inch field-gun 96 ,3.6 " " " 108 , 3.6-inch field-mortar 117 , P. A. base-percussion fuze for field 102, 108, 117 Shrapnel, definition of. 369 , how filled 32 , how painted 178 , fire of 370 , when and how used 369, 386 , rule for point of burst 371 , 3-ineh mountain 28 , 3.2-inch Prankford Arsenal field 97 ,3.6 " '• " ■' 108 , 3.2-inoh American Projectile Co. field 98 ,3.6 " '■ " '■ <• 108 , 3.6-inch mortar 117 , Prankford Arsenal combination fuze for 99, 108, 117 Shoeing, directions for 232 mule 51 Shovels, where carried on caisson 141 Sick men, treatment of , , . . . . 477-481 INDEX. 617 PAQE Signal code 465 Sighting 376 Sights, 1.65-inch mountain-gun 5 , 3.0 " " " 23 , 3.3-inch field-gun 90, 92 ,3.6 " " " 108 Similar guns 368 Similarly loaded 863 Sling bridges 409 for horse 810 Sores 235 Sore mouth 54 feet 481 Spain, mountain-artillery of 70 Switzerland, mountain-artillery of 70 Spare parts for 3.0-inch mountain-gun 29 Sprains 226 Special-duty men in light battery 434 Spherical density 863 Spurs, officer's, cost of 444 Square measure 488 Stalls, size of 233 Stable duty, grooming, etc 236 management, rules for 284 Stables and stable duties 283 , hut 334 Stationery, allowance of 454 Stencil outfit, cost of 444 Stop, field-gun 76 Storage, high explosives 426 Stoves, allowance of 463 , Sibley 393 Strangles 53, 227 Straw, how to determine quantity 483 Stringer bridge 411 Summary court 456, 465 Sunstroke : 237,480 Supplies and tools, 1.65-inch mountain-battery 19 ,3.0 " " " 30 Supply tablf of ordnance stores for light battery 445 of veterinary medicines 448 Surcingles, sizes of 154 518 INDEX. PAGE Sweeny ^ 338 Swelled legs 338 T Tableware, allowance for light battery ..._ 451 Target practice, how conducted 379 , allowance of ammunition for 447 Table of weight of clothing and equipage 454 of pounds in bushel 481 in barrel 481 Tents, allowance of , 453 , weights, dimensions, and allowance 388 , how pitched 389 , how struck, , 393 , heating of 393 Thrush 55, 338 Timber, strength of 403 Timothy-seed, pounds in bushel 481 Tools and supplies, 1.65-inch mountain-battery 19 ,3.0 " " " 30 Tool-box, field-limber, contents of 137 Training of horses 343-358 Transportation, allowance of 397 of artillery by sea and land 301 by rail 303 -horses by sea 307 of high explosives 425 Trajectory 363 Travel-ration 434 Trestle bridges 404 U Unharnessing 167, 383 Urine, retention of 239 , non-retention of 239 V Varnish, linseed-oil, how made , 163 for harness 161 Velocity of emission 363 INDEX. 519 PARE Velocity, muzzle, of 1.65-incli mountain-gun 1 , of 3.0 " " ■' ." 23 , of 3.3-incli field-gun 90 , of 3.6 " '■ 108 , of 3.6- inch field-mortar 118 Vents for field-guns 73 Vent-covers for field-guns , 80 Veterinary medicines 201-307 , doses, and how administered 203, 204 treatment 53 , abscess 207 , bladder irritation 207 inflammation 207 , bowels, inflammation 208 , bronchitis 208 .burns 209 , colds 53 .colic 59,209 . constipation 210 , corns 210 . cracked heels 211 . cramps 56 , curb 211 , distemper 211 .farcy. 211 , fistula '... 54, 211 , foot inflammation 212 , founder o 213 .galls 55,214 , glanders 56, 214 , grease 56, 215 . hide-bound 216 . hoof-bound ' 216 . hock lameness 216 , influenza 216 . lameness 218 . lampas 218 . laryngitis 218 . mange 56, 219 , navicular disease 21 9 , ophthalmia 220 , paralysis 220 520 iNDtlX. PASE Veterinary treatment, pharyngitis 330 , pleurisy 231 , pneumonia 333 , poll evil 54 .purging 333 . punctures from shoeing. 333 , quittor 334 , ringworm 334 , rheumatism 334 , sand-crack 335 , scurvy 335 , sores 335 , sore mouth 54 , sprains 336 , strangles 53, 237 , sunstroke 237 , sweeny 238 , swelled legs , 238 .thrush 55, 328 , urine, retention of. 339 , non-retention of 329 . warbles 230 , warts 230 . worms. ..^ 280 , wounds 330 Vinegar for animals 433 W Warbles 230 Wagon, army, inside measurement 483 Wagons, allowance of 397, 399, 300 , how packed 398 Warts , 330 Water-filters 295 , allowance in camp 396 at sea 313 -cart 150 Watering on march 273 of animals 50, 341 Wheat, pounds in bushel 481 Wheel. Archibald, description of 12i INDEX. 621 PAGE Wheel, Archibald, how repaired 125 Wheel-grease can, where carried 136 Weight, barrels 417 .forage 339 , nosebagf ul of oats 483 , clothing and equipage 454 , cubic foot of water 484 drawn by artillery teams 194 carried by mules, 1.65-inch mountain-battery 19 ,3.0 " " " 38 , Gardner gun 346 , Sotchkiss revolving cannon 316 , carriage 323 , limber 324 , Marimgun 353 per horse, 3.2-inch field-battery 138 , 3.6 " " '• 138 , field-caisson 143 of load, 3.2-inch field-gun, carriage, and equipment. . . . 138 , Archibald wheel 124 , 3.2-inch field-gun 89 ,3.6 " " " 108 ,3.6 " field-morter 113 , machine-guns 323, 338, 339, 346, 353 , field-gun limber 133 , tool-box 137 , field-caisson 139 , forge and battery -wagon implements, etc 148 , , artillery- wagon 149 , artillery-harness 157 , equipments in field-battery 138 , forge-chest 147 , saddler's chest 146 , carpenter's chest 146 , prolonge 138 , steel collar 154 Worms 230 Wounds 230 BOOKS H-OR ARMY AND NAVY OFFICERS PUBLISHED BY JOHN WILEY & SONS. ORDNANCE AND GUNNERT. For the use of the Cadets of the U. S. Military Academy. By Captain Henry Metcalf, Ordnance Department, U. S. Army Instructor of Ordnance and Gunnery, U.S.M.A. 12mo, 500 pp., cloth, with separate atlas containing 350 cuts, . . $5.00 MODERN FRENCH ARTILIIERS' FIRST AID HANDBOOK. Comprising a Series of Lectures to Members of the Hos^tal Corps and Company Bearers. By William D. Dietz, Late Cap- tain and Assistant Sutgeou IT. S. Army. 18mo, morocco, $1.25 PERMANENT FORTIFICATIONS. By Prof. D. H. Mahan, Revised and brought up to date by Col. James Mercur, U. S. Military Academy, West Point. Numer- ous plates, 1887. 8vo, lialf morocco, . . . {7^ EIiEMENTS OF THE ART OF WAR. ^ James Mercur, Professor of Civil and Military Engineering, United States Military Academy, Illustrated witb full-page and folding plates. Tuird edition. 8vo, cloth, . . $4.00 PRACTICAI. MARINE SURVEYING. By Harry Phelps, tr. S. Navy. 8vo, cloth, . . $2.50 AN ABRIDGEMENT OF MII.ITART I.AW. By Col. W. Winthrop, Deputy Judge Advocate-General, U.S. Army, late Professor of Law, TJ. S. Military Academy. Second and revised edition. 12mo, red cloth, . . . $2.50 A MANUAL FOR COURTS-MARTIAI.. Prepared by Lt. Arthur Murray, 1st Artillery, late Acting Judge Advocate-Oeneial, IT. S. A. Third edition. ISmo, mo- rocco, flap, ....... $1.50 CAVALRY OUT-POST DUTIES. By P. De Brack, translated from the French (third edition, 1863) by Major Camillo C. C. Carr, 8th Cavalry, IT. S. A. 18mo, mo- rocco, flap, ....... $2.00 GUNNERY FOR NON-COMMISSIONED OFFI- CERS. Compiled by Lt. Adelbert Cronkhite, 4th Artillery, with Ballis- ticTables, by Capt. James Chester, 3d Artillery, ISmo, morocco, flap, $2.00 ART OF SUBSISTING ARMIES IN WAR. By Capt. H. G. Sharpe, XJ. S. A. Morocco, ........ $1.50 THE ARMY OFFICER'S EXAMINER. By Lt. Col. W. H. Powell, U. 8. A. 12mo, cloth, . $4.00 ELEMENTARY NAVAL TACTICS. By Commander Wm. Bainbridge-Hoff , U. S. N. 8vo, cloth, $1.50 ATTACK OF FORTIFIED PLACES. Including Siege-Works, Mining and Demolitions. By James Mercur, XT. S. M. A., Professor of Civil and Military Engineering. 12mo, cloth $2.00 TEXT-BOOK OF ORDNANCE AND GUNNERY. For the use of the Cadets of U. S. M. A. By Capt. Lawrence L. Bruft, V. S. A. 8vo, cloth, $6.00 HANDBOOK FOR LIGHT ARTILLERY. By A. B. Dyer, First Lieut. Fourth U. S. Artillery. 12mo, cloth, . (3.00